Srom f ^e feifirari? of in (glemoti? of 3ubge ^amuef (Qliffer (jSrecfeinribge ^reeente^ 6l? ^amuef (gliffer (jBrecfeinribge feong to f ^e feifirati^ of (princefon C^eofogtcaf ^cminaxT^ BL 240 .D5 1833a Dick, Thomas, 1774-1857. The Christian philosopher CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPIIEB t>Ri THE CONNECTION OF SCIENCE AND PHILOSOPHY WITH RELIGION. . v-1 BY THOMAS DICK, Author of a variety of literary and scientific coMiMUNiCATiONS IN Nicholson's philosophical journal, the annals OF PHILOSOPHY, gTC. ETC. KEY & BIDDLE— 6 MINOR STREE'f » EXPLANATION OF THE ENGRAVlNli, (Fronting the Title.) The five figures on the upper part of the plate, marked 1, S, 3, ^ &c. represent the planets Herschel, Saturn, Jupiter, the Earth, an*' Moon, in their relatii c sizes and proportions ; together with teles copic views of the belts and rings of Saturn, and the belts of Jupitei The two figures immetl-ately below, marked 5 and 6, are intended to illustrate the description given of the eye, pp. 88 — 104. Fig, 'j represents -a front view of the human eye. Fig. 6 represents a s.ij"- tion of it, exhibiting the three coats and the three hmnors of which it is composed. Fig. 7 represents a rude view of the appearance which the rings and moons of Saturn will exhibit, in certain Ciiie.-, as beheld from a point 20 or 30 degrees north from his equator — sc' pp. 187, 188. The shade on the upper part of the rings repressnk the shadow of the body of Saturn, as it appears upon the rings a'^/OU oiidnigfjt. TO DAVID BREWSTER, LL. D. Fellow of the Royal Society of London ; Secretary to tno Royal Society of Edinburgh ; Honorary Member of the Royal Irish Academy ; Member of the Royal Swedish Academy of Sciences ; Honorary Associate of the Royal Academy of Sciences at Lyons, &c. &c. THIS VOLUME, Intended to illustrate the connection of science and phi- osophy with religion, and with the moral improvement of nankind, is inscribed, as a testimony of respect for the ac- (luisitions which science has derived from his philosophical discoveries and hterary labours, by his most obedient, an(J humble servant, THE AUTHOR, PREFACE TO THIS EDITION. >©io« The following pages were written under the impression that tlie visible manifestations of the attributes of the Deity are too frequ. nt!y overlooked by Christians in their views of tlie great objects of Religion, and in the worship they offer to the Father of their spirits; and are intended to show, that the Teachers of Rehgion, in imparting instruc- tion either to the old or to the young, ought to embrace a wider range of illustration, in reference to Divine subjects, than that to which they are usually confined. Throughout the w^hole of the discussions contained in this work, the Author has pursued his own train of thought ; and, in so doing, he trusts that he has been enabled to ren- der some of his illustrations more interesting to the young and untutored mind than if he had adhered rigidly to the sentiments of others, and to the technical language of science. The sketches of the different sciences aie not mere extracts, or * ompilations, but are, for the most part, original composition — in which it has been his main object to embody as many facts as his limits \\ ould permit— in order to excite the inquiring mind to further'investigations into the different departments of physical science. It is presumed, that no Christian reader will for once imagine, that tlie views illustrated in this work are intended to be subslituted in place of the peculiar revelations of the Bible. The object of the volume is to illustrate the har- mony which subsists between the system of Nature and the system of Revelation ; and to show, that the mamfef!lH» tions of God in the material universe ought to be blende;'] with our views of the facts and doctrines recorded in the volume of Inspiration. It is taken for granted, throughout the whole range of the following illustrations, that the Scriptures contain n 1 + X PREFACE. Revelation from Heaven ; and, under a firm belief of this iinjjoi aiuf i;utb, the Author has embellished his work with frequent quotations from the energetic and sublime lan^ g-uag-e of this Sacred Book. It would, therefore, be unitiir in any critic, who entertains doubts on this point, to find fault witb such quotations, or witli the allusions to Bible- nhraseology which occur, unless they can be shoAvn to be jutiodaced without judgment or discrimination. Tbe Author has carefully revised every portion of the present edition, and introduced a variety of corrections and modifications. He has likewise introduced additional mat- ter, to the extent of between 40 and 50 pages, and also several illustrative engravings. In its present form, the Author trusts, that, independently of the moral reflections it contains, it will be found to comprise popular descrip- tions of a greater number of scientific facts than is to be found in any other volume of the same size. Various topics, originally intended to be illustrated, have been unavoidably omitted. Some of these are stated in the last paragraph of Chapter IV. the illustration of which, in combination with other kindred topics, would fill a volume of nearly the sarne size as the present. This subject (for Vi'hich the author has abundance of materials) v»^ill be pro- secuted in another volume, mider the title of The Philo- sophy OF Religion; and will comprise, among many other subjects of discussion, illustrations of the moral rela- tion of inteUigent beings to their Creator, and to one an- other — the physical and rational grounds of those moral laws wliich the Deity has promulgated — the views whicli science affords of the incessant energies of Creating Power, and of the grand and multifarious objects over which Divine Providence presides — the relation of science to a future state, and of the aids v.^hich the discoveries of science ailbrd, for enp.bling us to form a conception of the perpetual improvement of the celestial inhabitants in knowledge and felicity. These subjects will be illustrated by a variety of interesting details of facts, in relation to tiie system of nature, the history of nations, and the moral state of Chris- tian and general society CONTENTS. Page. Introduction, , , , , . .17 Necessity of Revelation. Folly of discarding the Science of Nature from Religion. Beneficial Eiffects which flow from the study of the Works of God. CHAP. I. OF THE NATURAL ATTRIBUTES OF THE DEITY, Sect, 1. On the Relation of the Natural Attributes of tlie Deity to Religion, , . . , ,25 The Christif\n Religion founded on the Natural Attributes of God. His Power as interesting a subject as his Mercy. — Illustrated in two instances. Evils which arise from imperfect conceptions ot Divine Power. Defects in Religious Instructions on this subject. Sources of Illustration. Sect. 2. Illustrationsof the Omnipotence of the Deitt, . 32 The material world exhibits a more striking display cvf this Perfec- tion than the superriatural facts recorded in Scripture. Immense quantify of Matter in the universe. Mode of acquiring the most comprehensive conception of the bulk of the Earth — its variety of scenery — rits mass of solid matter. Magnitude of the bodies which compose the Solar System. Magnitude and number of the Stars. Procedure of the mind in acquiring the most impressive conceptions of such august objects. Reflections. Rapid Motions of the Celestial Bodies. How we acquire the ideas of relative velocities — weight of the Earth — immense physical forces — Grandeur of the motion of Saturn — immense number of bodies impelled through tlie heavens — Reliections. Immense Spaces which surround the Heavenly Bo.dfes--Reflect,ions. Popular illus- tration of the JVIotions of the Earth and Heavens. Extract from Dr. Ridgley, with remarks. Universe intended to adumbrate the Attributes of God, and to make a sublime impression on created beings. Similar trains of thought suggested in tlie Scriptures. Moral Effects of such contemplations. Humility. Folly of pride — low rank of man in the scale of being. Reverence and Venera- tion — Reason why mankind feel so little veneration of God — how it may be increased. The Deity unsearchable. Hope and Confidence in the prospect of futurity—Resurrection — Scenes of Eternity. Sect. 3. On the Wisdom and Intelligence of the Deity, . . 61 Wisdom defined — Displayed in the Structure of the Solar Sys- tem. Distance of the Sun. Rotation of the Planets — Principal reason why such a motion exists. Wisdom displayed in other Systems. Minute dis])lays of this attribute cannot be traced in the heavens. Wisdom, as displayed in the constitution of our globe — adjustment of its solid parts to the necessities of the be- ings which inhabit it. Mountains, their uses — exist in other 12 worlds. Diversity of color — ars;u.inent for a plurality of worlds — general color which prevails in t'le scene of nature — Water^ lis use in the system of nature — its composition, evaporation — mo- tion of the liquid element — its beneficial efiects. The Atmos- phere — its weight and pressure — its cimijionent parts — its various properties — necessary to animal life, flame, sound, twilight — wisdom displayed in its constitution. Expansion of, water in the act of freezmg. Variety of Nature, ...... 78 Vegetables — their number and variety. Animals — variety in their organization. Eyes of insects — their exquisite mechanism. Subterraneous Regions. Atmosphere. The Variety of Nature affords a faint idea of the infinity of the Creator. Illustrated in the number of animal parts and functions. Reflection. Variety the foundation of our judgments. Beauty and sublimity of Na- ture. Primeval state of our globe — other worlds. ~ Mechanism of Animated Beings, ...... 88 Structure of the Human Ete — its coats, humors, muscles, oi-bit, and motions. Wisdom displayed in its constiaiction. Light — its velocity, minuteness, colors, and adaptation to the eye. Manner in which Vision is performed — explained by a figure, and an experiment — illustrated by the view from Salis- bury Crags. Multitude of rays which ilow from every object — smallness of the image on the retina, illustrated by calculation — what proportion of the solar light falls on our globe — Reflections. Mechanism for viewing near and distant objects — contraction and dilatation of the pupil — distance at which we see distinctly. Summary view of adaptations in the structure of the eye. Eyes of superior intelligences. Visual organs of the inferior animals. Mechanism of the Bones iWxx^ixeiieCi. — exemplified in the joints of the fingers, the wrist, and the movements of wliich the head is susceptible. Moi-al Reflections on the impropriety of overlooking the Divine Wisdom in the system of nature. Sect. 4. On the Goodness or Benevolence of the Deity, . . Ill Benevolence of God in relation to Man — considered as a depraved intelligence. J^fercy displayed in the system of nature. Benevo- lence as displayed towards the lower animals. Extract from Dr. Paley. General Reflections. CHAP. II. A CURSORY VIEW OF SOME OF THE SCIENCES WHICH ARE RELATED TO RELIGION AND CHRISTIAN THEOLOGY. Introduction. Extensive range of Theology. Bad effects of setting Religion in opposition to Science. Harmony of the 02")eration3 of God in Nature and Revelation, . . . . .117 Natural History, ....... . 2C Its extensive i-ange. Outline of its principal objects — on the sur- face, and in the interior recesses of the earth — in the atmosphere — the vegetable, mineral, and animal kingdoms — and in the region of the heavens. Description of the Banian Tree. Reflections. Monkey Bread Tree. Splendor and felicity of insect life. In- visible worlds — infinity of the universe. Religious tendency uj this Science. It affords a manifestation of the Deity, and expands our conceptions of his operations — ennobles the human m.nd. * Recouuueuded by the Sacred writers. 13 Geography, ..*...,, 134 Its object — Figure of tlie Earth — Proofs of its spherical form. Fe- lation which tlie discovery of the figure of the earth bears to the plan of Providence. Magnitude and natural divisions of the earth. General features of its surface. Mountains — their general ranges, and the sublime scenes they exhibit. The Ocean — its extent, depth, bottom, and motions. Rivers — their number, size, and the quantity of water they pour into the ocean. How they are supplied — their use in the system of nature. Artificial divi- sion of the earth. Number and variety of its inhabitants. Num- ber which has existed since the Creation — number at the resur- rection, and the space they would occupy, Number M'hich the earth would contain — strictures on Malthus. Utility of the study of Geography to Religion — to Directors of Missionary Societies — to Private Cln-istians. Grandeur of its physical objects — utility of its moral facts. Geology, . . . . . . . 157 Its object and connection with religion — an interesting subject of inquiry. Materials which compose the crust of our globe. Vari- ous geological phenomena. Organic remanis — Mammoth, Tapir, Ell>, Megatherium, &c. Geological deductions not inconsistent with the Mosaic History — Genesis i, I, 2, explained. Short du- ration of the earth in its present form. The Deluge, and its effects on the earth's strata. Marine shells, &c. Grand and terrific objects which this science exhibits — illustrate the sublime descriptions of the Deity recorded in the Scriptures. Astronomy, ..... . . 16S Its sublime objects. Apparent motions of the Sun — of the Moon. Ecl'pses of the Sun and Moon. Apparent motion of the starry heavens. Stars and planets seen in the day-time, and with what powers of the telescope they may be distmguished. Apparent revolution of the celestial vault indicates Almighty power. Stars pever shift their relative positions. Solar System. The Sun — his size and probable destination illustrated — rhis spots and atmos- phere — diflferent kind of rays emitted from his body — his distance illustrated. Mercury — his size, rotation, quantity of light and heat, &c. Proportions of caloric on the different planets, Ve- nus — her size, phases, mountains, transits, and general phenom- ena. Original observations on, and mode by which her diurnal rotation may be determined. Earth — proofs of its annual and diurnal motions. The Moon — description of her majestic moun- tain scenery, luminous spots, celestial appearances, illuminating power, superficial contents, &.c. Mars — his distance, atinosphere, luminous zone, &c. New Planets — Ceres, Pallas, Juno, and Vesta — their anomalies, singularities, and probable origin. Me- teoric Stones. Jup'ter — his bulk, rotation, belts, and the appear- ances of his moons. Saturn — his figure, belts, moons, and quan- tity of light. His kings, their dimensions, motion, and phenom- ena — illustrated by a figure. Splendor of the firmament, as viewed from this planet (see the engraving.) Herschel — his distance, size, and quantity of light. Comets — their tails, velo- city, orbits, size, and number. New Comet. Motion of the solar system in absolute space — its destination — plurality of worlds intimated in Scripture. The Fixed Stars — their distance illustrated — their arrangement, changes — moral reflections, Re- lation of Astronomy to Kehgion — moral effects which its objects have a tendency to produce — crimniality of overlooking the works of God, &c. 14 Natural Philosophy, ...... 201 Its objects a.id difterent departments. Mechanics — subjects it em- braces, and its importance to the improvem.ent of mankind. Hy- drostatics — its leading- principles and uses, illustrated by figures. Pneumatics — its principles, and the experiments by which they are illustrated. Acoustics. Optics — leading facts and principles of this science. Burning-glasses, &,c. Electricity — its nature, phenomena, effects, and agency in the system of nature. Gal- vanism — its singular effects on metals, &c. and on the animal system — various facts which it explains. Magnetism — its vari- ous phenomena and effects. Relation of Natural Philosophy to Beligion — its inventions meliorate the condition of mankind — illustrated in the case of the electric fluid — it undermines the in- fluence of superstition — imfolds the incessant agency of God — indifference to this subject unreasonable. Chemistry, 219 Its objects, and present dignified station. General forms of mat- tei- — simple and compound substances. Caloric — its sources and properties. Oxygen, its properties and combinations — nitrous oxide, its singular effects. Nitrogen, its eftects on flame and animal life. Hydrogen, its properties and uses. Carbon, its nature, combinations, and antiseptic properties. Sulphur, its origin, combinations, and properties. Phosphorus, history of its discovery — how prepared — curious experiments with this sub- stance — Phosphoric phenomena in the system of nature. Con- nection of this science with Religion — it displays the wisdom and benevolence of God, and the mode of his present and future operations — improves the condition of man — and carries forward our views to a more glorious and auspicious era. Anatomy .and Physiology, 2! ' Their general object — human body, its different parts and divisions. Bones, their number, form, and positions. Muscles, their nature, vise, and extraoidinary strength. Heart and blood vessels, and the circulation of the blood. Respiration — curious structure of the lungs. Digestion. Perspiration. Sensation, and the sys- tem of nerves. Summary. Moral reflections — this branch of study teaches us our dependance on a Supeuor Power — and ex- cites to gratitude. History, 241 Its objects, advantages, and connection with Religion. Connection of the sciences and of the Divine dispensations with each other. Concluding remarks. CHAP. III. THE RELATION WHICH THE INVENTIONS OF ART BEAR TO THE OBJECTS OF RELIGION. Art of Printing, its origin, and beneficial effects — Dr. Church's Im- provements in, 246 Art of Navigation — Mariner's Compass, its discovery and use, 249 The telescope, its invention, and the discoveries matie by :t — sei-ves instead of a celestial vehicle — Magnifying powers of Dr. Her- schel's Telescopes, 252 The Microscope, smd the views it exhibits of the wisdom of God, 254 Steam Navigniioii, its utility in proinoting the intercourse of man- kind, and its relation to tiic objects of religion, . . . 25, 15 Air Balloons, utility of, when arrived at p;erfection— proposed im- provement in. History of their invention — Lunardi's ascent — the Parachute, 258 Acoustic tunnels. Experiments on the Conveyance of sound. M. Biot's remarkable experiment — Don Gautier's experiment and suggestion. Conclusions iii reference to the extensive con- veyance of sound, • . 262 Practical remarks — utility of the arts in relation to the Millennial . . . 265 era. CHAP. IV. SCRIPTURAL FACTS ILLUSTRATED FROM THE SYSTEM OP NATURE. I. Science may frequently serve as a guide to the true interpreta- tion of Scripture. Canon or rule for Scripture interpretation — illustrated, . .271 II. The Depravity of man illustrated, from a consideration of the state of the interior strata of the earth. Volcanoes, and the ter- rible ravages ihey produce. Earthquakes, and their dreadful effects. Thunder-storms, tempests, and hurricanes. General Reflections on this subject, . . . * . . . 274 ni. The Resurrection illustrated. Transformations of bisects, (ndestructibility of matter — conclusions from this fact, . . 282 IV. General Conflagration. Concludin'g i-eflectious. Topics omit- ted in tliis volume, 28^ CHAP. V. BENEFICIAL EFFECTS WHICH WOULD RESULT FROM CON- NECTING SCIENCE WITH RELIGION. I. The variety of topics would allure the attention of intelligent minds to religious subjects. Principle of novelty intended by the Creator to be gratified — illustrated in the variety which appears in the earth, the heavens, and the Volume of Revelation, . 289 II. Science enables us to take an extensive survey of the empire of God — illustrates many sublime passages of the Bible — qualifies us for complying with several Divine Injunctions — danger of selfish- ness and indifference in this respect. Our conceptions of God depend on our views of the extent of his dominions, . . 293 III. Science enlarges our views of the operations of Providence, in relation to the past and present scenes of the world. The econo- my of the inferior animals. The physical and moral economy of the celestial worlds, . 303 IV. Science, blended with Religion, would produce a general ex- pansion of mind, and liberality of views — in reference to the opinions and actions of men, and to the works and the ways ot God, illustrated at large, 310 V. It would induce a spirit of piety, and profound humility. Sources of piety — illustrated by an example. Humility — illustrated by the examples of Mr. Boyle, of Sir Isaac Newton, and of superior intelligences. General conclusions, 31<'' 16 APPENDIX. No. I. inustration of the rate of motion in the heavenly bodies, on the supposition that the earth is at rest, . . . .321 No. II. Experimental illustrations of the pressure of the Atmos- phere, ........... 323 No. III. On the ineans by which it may p-obably be ascertained whether the Moon be a habitable world, .... 324 No. IV. Remarks on the late pretended discovery of a Lunar for- tification, . k . . . . . . ; . 326 No. V. On the ideas of Magnitude, Motion, and Duration, as ex- pressed by numbers, *...*... 327 No. VI. On a Plurality of Worlds, . ^ .... 329 No, VII. On the first Inventor of Printing, .... 330 No. VIII. On Telescopes ; with a. brief notice of sl J^eiv Reflecting Te/escopfi constructed by the Author^ . , . . . 331 No. IX. On Steam Navigation, ■. > * . » . 334 No. X. Strictures on a certain sentiment respecting humah re- demption, 338 No. XL Extract from Dr. Dwight, ...... 343 No. XII. List of Popular Works on the different Sciences treated of in this Volume, with Occasional Remarks, ■, , , 343 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. INTRODUCTION. On the subject of religion, mankind have, in all ages, been prone to run into extremes. While some have been disposed to attach too much importance to the mere exer- tions of the human intellect, and to imagine that man, by the light of unassisted reason, is able to explore the path to true wisdom and happiness, — the greater part of religion- ists, on the other hand, have been disposed to treat scien- tific knowledge, in its relation to religion, with a degree of indifference bordering upon contempt. Both these disposi- tions are equally foolish and preposterous. For he who exalts human reason, as the only sure guide to wisdom and felicity, forgets, that man, in his present state, is a de- praved intelligence, and, consequently, liable to err ; and that all those who have been left solely to its dictates, have uniformly failed in attaining these desirable objects. During a period of more than 5,800 years, the greater part of the human race have been left solely to the guidance of their rational powers, in order to grope their way to the Temple of Knowledge, and the Portals of Immortality ; but what has been the result of all their anxious researches? In- stead of acquiring correct notions of the Great Author of their existence, and of the nature of that homage which is due to his perfections, " they have become vain in their imaginations, and their foolish hearts have been darkened. Professing themselves to be wise, they have become fools ; and have changed the glory of the Incorruptible God into an image made like to corruptible man, and to four-footed beasts, and creeping things." Instead of acquiring correct views of the principles of moral action, and conducting- themselves according to the eternal rules of rectitude, thej^ have displaj^ed the operation of the most diabolical passions, indulged in continiial warfare, and desolate^ n-i-.-;,^,, . .^^.-);,. ^v- .,f ^.\. vii^ir.v^^. '> CHAPTER I. OF THE NATURAL ATTRIBUTES OF THE DEITY, WITH PARTICULAR ILLUSTRATIONS OF HIS O^NINIPOTENCE AND WISDOM, SECTION I. 0)1 the Relation of the ^''atural Attrihuics of Deity to Religion. A FIRM conviction of the existence of God, and a compe-. tent knowledge of his natural perfections, lie at the founda- tion of all religion, both natural and revealed. In propor- tion as our views of the perfections of Deity are limited and obscure, in a similar proportion will be our conceptions of all the relations in which he stands to his creatures, of every part of his providential procedure, and of all the doctrines and re- quirements of revealed religion. By the natural or essential attributes of God, we under- stand such perfections as the following : — His Eternity, Om- nipresence, Infinite Knowledge, Infinite Wisdom, Omnipo- tence, and Boundless Beneficence. These are the characters and attributes of Deity, v/hich, we must suppose, form the chief subjects of contemplation to angels, and to all other pure intelligences — and, in investigating the displays of which, the sons of Adam would have been chiefly employed, had they continued in primeval innocence. These attributes form the ground work of all those gracious relations in which the God of salvation stands to his redeemed people in the econo- my of redemption — they lie at the foundation of the whole Christian superstructure — and were they not recognized as the corner stones of that sacred edifice, the whole system of the Scripture Revelation would remain a baseless fabric. The full display of these perfections will be exhibited in the future world-— the contemplation of this display will form ohq 26 THE CHRISTIAN PniLOSOPIIER. of the sublime employments " of the saints in light" — anf? prepare us for engaging in such noble exercises, is one of chief designs of the salvation proclaimed in the Gospel. The Christian Revelation ought not to be considered superseding the Religion of Nature, but as carrying it f ward to perfection. It introduces the Deity to us under qi relations, corresponding to the degraded state into which \ have fallen. It is superadded to our natural relations to G( and takes it for granted, that these natural relations must ever subsist. It is true, indeed, that the essential attribu of God, and the principles of Natural Religion, cannot be i ly discovered without the light of Revelation, as appears fr the past experience of mankind in every generation ; but ii cipialiy true, that, when discovered by the aid of this celest light, they are of the utmost importance in the Christian sy tem, and are as essentially connected with it, as the found tion of a building is with the superstructure. Many profe sed Christians, however, seem to think, and to act, as if t] Christian Revelation had annulled the natural relations whi( subsist between man and the Deity ; and hence the zealoi outcry against every discussion from the pulpit, that has not & direct relation to what are termed the doctrines of grace. But nothing, surely, can be more absurd than to carry out such a principle to all its legitimate consequences. Can God ever cease to be Omnipotent, or can man ever cease to be depend- ent for existence on his infinite power ? Can the Divine Being ever cease to be Omnipresent and Omniscient, or can man ever cease to be the object of his knowledge and super intendence 1 Can Infinite Wisdom ever be detached fron the Almighty, or can man ever be in a situation where he wil not experience the effects of his wise arrangements ? Can Goodness ever fail of being an attribute of Jehovah, or car any sentient or intelligent beings exist that do not experienc the effects of his bounty? In short, can the relation of Crea- ture and of Creator ever cease between the human race, in whatever moral or physical situation they may be placed, and that Almighty Being, " who giveth to all, hfe and breath, and all things ]" If none of these things can possibly happen, then the relations to which we refer must be eternal and un- changeable, and must form the basis of all the other relations in which we can possibly stand to the Divine Being, either as apostate or as redeemed creatures ; and, therefore, they ought to be exhibited as subjects for our frequent and serious contemplation, as religious and moral agents. But, unless we make such topics a distinct subject of attention, and ^^ NATURAL ATTRIBUTES OF THE DEITY. 27 ivoiir to acquire a clear and comprehensive conception of • natural relations to God) we can never form a clear con- tion of those new and interesting relations into which we 3 been brought by the mediation of Jesus Christ. f man had continued in his primitive state of integrity, he lid have been for ever exercised in tracing the Power, the eficence, and other attributes of Deity^ in the visible tion alone. Now that his fallen state has rendered ad- nal revelations necessary, in order to secure his happi- , — is he completely to throw aside those contemplations exercises which constituted his chief employment, while emained a pure moral intelligence ? Surely not. One t end of his moral renovation, by means of the Gospel, t be, to enable him to resume his primitive exercises, and ualify him for more enlarged views and contemplations of nilar nature, in that future world, where the physical and al impediments which now obstruct his progress will be .ipletely removed. It appears highly unreasonable, and indicates a selfish dis- sition of mind, to magnify one class of the Divine attributes the expense of another ; to extol, for example, the mercy God, and neglect to celebrate his Pov/er and Wisdom — se glorious perfections, the display of which, at the forma- 1 of our globe, excited the rapture and admiration of angels, I of innocent man. All the attributes of God are equal, ause all of them are infinite ; and, therefore, to talk of ling attributes in the Divine Nature, as some have done, nconsistent with reason, unwarranted by Scripture, and Is to exhibit a distorted view of the Divine character^ i Divine mercy ought to be celebrated with rapture by ry individual of our fallen ra.ce ; but with no less rapture aid we extol the Divine Omnipotence ; for the designs of cy cannot be accomplished without the intervention of In» e Pov/er. All that we hope for, in consequence of the lises of God, and of the redemption accomplished by s Christ, must be founded on the conception we form of >perations of Omnipotence. — An example or two may not mecessary for illustrating this position. are warranted, by the sacred oracles, to entertain the , that these mortal bodies of ours, after they have moul- 1 in the dust, been dissolved into their primary elementa- irts, and become the prey of devouring reptiles, during a i of generations or of centuries, — shall spring forth from ■ornb to new life and beauty, and be arrayed in more Kia ibnui than they now wear ; vi'a, ihxt ;'•! ihr- Inbr-bit- 28 THE CHRISTIAN iPHILOSOPHER. ants of our globe, from Adam to the end of time, though the bodies of thousands of them have been devoured by canni- bals, have become the food of lishes and of beasts of prey, and have been burnt to cinders, and their ashes scattered by the winds, over the different regions of sea and land,— shall be reanimated by the voice of the Son of God, and shall appear, each in his proper person and identical body, before God, the Judge of all. Now, the firmness of our hope of so astonish- ing an event, which seems to contradict ail experience, and appears involved in such a mass of difiiculties and apparent contradictions, must be in proportion to the sentiments we entertain of the Divine Intelligence, Wisdom, and Omnipo- tence. And where are we to find the most striking visible displays of these perfections, except in the actual operations of the Creator, within the range of our view in the material World? Again, v/e are informed, in the same Divine records, that, at some future period, the earth on which we now dwell shall be v/rapt up in devouring flames, and its present form and constitution for ever destroyed ; and its redeemed inhabitants, after being released from the grave, shall be transported to a more glorious region ; and that " new heavens and a new earth shall appear, wherein dwelleth righteousness." The divine mercy having given to the faithful the promise of these astonishing revolutions, and most magnificent events, our hopes of their being fully realized must rest on the infinite wisdom and omnipotence of Jehovah ; and, consequently, if our views of these perfections be limited and obscure, our nope, in relation to our future destiny, will be proportionably feeble and languid ; and will scarcely perform its office " as an anchor to the soul both sure and steadfast." It is not merely by telling a person that God is All-wise, and All-pow- erful, that a full conviction of the accomplishment of such grand events will be produced. He must be made to see with his own eyes v/hat the Almighty has already done, and wluiL he is now doing in all the regions of universal nature which lie open to our inspection ; and this cannot be effected v.ithout directing his contemplations to those displays of in- telligence and power which are exhibited in the structure^ the economy, and the revolutions of the material v/orld. If the i)ropriety of these sentiments be admitted, it will fol- low that the more we are accustonied to contemplate the won- ders of Divine intelligence and power,in the objects with which we are surroimdcd, the more deeply shall we be impressed \.if!) M •■otivi'-lion. •-•ml n C(»ufident hope^that all the purposes NATURAL ATTRIBUTES OF THE DEH /. 29 of divine mercy will ultimately be accomplished in our eter- nal felicity. It will also follow, that, in proportion as the mind acquires a clear, an extensive, and a reverential view of the essential attributes of the Deity, and of those truths in con- nection with them, which are objects of contemplation com- mon to all holy beings, in a similar proportion will it be im- pressed, and its attention arrested, by every other divine sub- ject connected with them. And it is, doubtless, owing to the want 6f such clear and impressive conceptions of the essen- tial character of Jehovah-, and of the first truths of religion, that the bulk of mankind are so little impressed and influenced by the leading doctrines and duties connected with the plan of the Gospel salvation, and that they entertain so many vague and untenable notions respecting the character and the objects of u superintending Providence, How often, for example, have we witntSsscd exptossioits of the foolish and limited notions which are frequently entertained respecting the operations of Onimpotcnce? When it has been asserted that the eaith with all its load of continents and oceans, is in rapid mo- tion through the voids of space — that the sun is ten hundred thousand times larger than the terraqueous globe — and that millions of such globes are dispersed throughout the immen- sity ©filature — some who have viewed themselves as enligh';, ened Christians, have exclaimed at the impossibility of such facts, as if they were beyond the limits of Divine Power, and ds if such representations were intended to tiirli away the mind from God and religion ; while, at the same time, they have yielded a firm assent to all the vulgar notions respecting oniens, apparitions, and hobgoblins, and to til^ supposed ex- traordinary powers of the professors of divinaii<»n and witch- craft. How can such persons assent, with intelligence and rational conviction, to the dictates of Revelation fespecting the energies of Oil'inipotertce which will be exerted at "the con- summation of ail things," and in those arrangements which are to succeed the dissolution of our sublunary system ? A firm beUef in the Almighty Power and unsearchable wisdom of God, as displayed in the constitution and movements of the material world, is of the utmost importance-, to confirm our faith, and enhvcn our hopes, of such grand and interesting events. Notwithstanding the considerations now stated, which plain- ly evince the connection of the natural perfections of God with the objects of the Christian Revelation, it appears some- what strange, that, when certain religious instructors happen to come in contact with this topic, they soein as ii' they wci"« 30 Tlir. CIirvT-TIAiN^ PHlLOSOPnER. I,( ' luiua tn I read u\nm {'oihiOhm ground ; and, as if it vvern imsiiitable to their office as Cliribtian teachers, to bring ibr- uard the stupendous works o:" the Almighty to illustrate his nature and attributes. Instead of expatiating on the numerous sources of illustration, of whiah the subject admits, till the minds of their hearers are thoroughly afiected with a view of the essential glory of Jehovah — they despatch the subject Mitl:- l«o or three vague proposition^* v^hich, though logically true, make no impression upon the heart ; as if they believed that such contemplations were suited only to carnal men, and mere philosophers ; and as if they were afraid, lest the sancti- tv of the piilpit should be polluted by particular descriptions of those operations of the Deity which are perceived through the medium of the corporeal senses. We do not mean to insinu- ate, that the essential attributes of God, and the illustrations of them derived from the material world, should form the sole, or the chief topics of discussion, in the business of religious instruction — but, if the Scriptures frequently direct our atten- tion to these subjects — if they lie at the foundation of all ac- curate and extensive views of the Christian Revelation — if they be the chief subjects of contemplation to angels, and all other pure intelligences, in every region of the universe — and if Ihey t?.ve a tendency to expand the minds of professed CanjSiir.s-, to correct their vague and erroiieous cancep- tions, and to promote their conformity to the moral character of God — we cannot find out the shadow of a reason, why such topics should be almost, if not altogether, overlooked, in the writings and the discourses of those A\ho profess to instruct mankind in the knowledge of God, and the duties of his wor- ship. VVe are infoiTned by our Saviour himself, that "this is life eternal, to know thee the living and true God,'" as well as " Jesus Christ whom he hath sent." The knowledge of God, in the sense here intended, must include in it the knowledge of the natural and essential attributes of the Deity, or those properties of his nature by which he is distinguished from all "the idols of the nations." Such are, his Self-existence, his All-perfect knowledge, his Omnipresence, his Infinite Wis- dom, his Boundless Goodness, and Almighty Power— attri- butes, which, as we have just now seen, lie at the foundation of all the other characters and relations of Deity revealed in the Scriptures. The acquisition of just and comprehensive conceptions of these perfections, must, therefore, lie at the fouiulation of all profound veneration of the Divine Being, and of all that is valuable in religion. Destitute of such conccp- NATURAL ATTRIBUTES OF TIIK DEITY. 31 tions, we can neither feel that habitual humiUhj, and that rtoereucc of the majesty of Jehovah which his essential glory is calculated to inspire, nor pay him that tribute of adoration and gratitude which is due to his name. Devoid of such views, we cannot exercise that cordial acquiescence in the plm of his redemption, in the arrangements of his providence, aad in the requirements of his law, which the Scriptures en- join. Yet, how often do we find persons who pretend to 'speculate about the mysteries of the Gospel, displaying, — by their tlippancy of speech respecting the eternal councils of tlie Majosty of Heaven — by their dogmatical assertions respect- iag.tho divine character, and the dispensations of providence — and by their pertinacious opinions respe(;ting the laws by which' God must regulate his own actions— thai they have never felt impressive emotions of the grandeur of that Being, whose " operations are unsearchable, and his ways past find- ing out ?" Though they do not call in question his immen- sity and power, his wisdom and goodness, as so many ab- stract properties of his nature, yet, the unbecoming familiarify with which they approach this august Being, and talk abo'it him, shows that they have never associated in their minds, the stupen.lous displays which have been given of these perfec- tions, in the works of his hands ; and that their religion (if -t may be^ so called) consists merely in a farrago of abstract o[)inions, or in an empty name. If, then, it be admitted, that it is essentially requisite, as the foundation of religion, to have the mind deeply im[)ressed with a clear and comprehensive view of the natural perfections of the Deity, it will follow, that the ministers of rcdigion, and all others whose province it is to communicate religious instruc- tion, oiight frequently to dwell, with particularity, on those proofs and illustrations which tend to convey the most de- linite and impressive conceptions of the glory of that Being whom we pr(3fess to adore. But from what sources are such illustrations to be derived ? Is it from abstract reasonings and metaphysical distinctions and definitions, or from a sur- vey of those objects and movements which lie open to the in- spection of every observer] There can be no difficulty in coming to a decision on this point. We might affirm, with the schoolmen, that " God is a Being whose centre is every wheie, and his circumference no where ;" that " he comprehends in- finite duration in every moment ;" and that " iafimte space may be con >idered as the sensorinm o{ \\\e. \ e mi!.;ht 32 THE CIiniBTIAN rillLOSOrilLR. also aiTirni with truth, that God is a Being of iiifmi^e pcrfec tion, glory and blessedness — that h« is without all bounds or limits, either actual or possible — that he is possessed of power sutlicient to perform all things which do not imply a contra-, diction — that he is independent and self-sufficient — that hia wisdom is unerring, and that he infinitely exceeds all other beings. But these, and other expressions of a siix^ar kind^ are mere technical tenm, which convey no adequate, nor ere« tolerable notion of what they import. Beings, constituted like man, whose rational spirits are connected with an organi- cal structure, and who derive all their knowledge through the medium of corporeal organs, can derive their clearest and most aflecting notions of the Diviiiity, cliiefty through the same medium, namely, by contemplatiiig the effects of his per- fections, as displayed through the ample range of the visible creation. And, to this source of illustration, the i;aspircd writers uniformly direct our views — " Lift up your eyes on hi:rh, and behoikJE ! who hath created these orbs. I who bringeth forth their host by number, and calleth them all by th^ir names 1 The everlasting God, the Lord, by the greatness of his might, for that he is strong in power." — " He hath made the earth by his power ; he hajh established the w^orld by his wisdom ; he hath stretched out the heavens by his uuder- Htanding." — These writers do not perplex, our minds by a multitude of technical terms and subtle reasonings ; but lead us directly to the source whence our most ample conceptions of Deity are to be derived, that, from a steady and enlightened contemplation of the effects, we may learn the greatness of the Cause; and their example^in this respect, ought, doubtless^ to be a pattern for every religious instructor. SECTION IL rduslraiions of the Omnipotence of the Deity. In order to elucidate more distinct ry whsit hxis been now .stated, I shall select a few illustrations of some of the Natura,! attributes of the Deity. And, in the first place, 1 shall offer a few considerj^tions which have a tendency ta direct, and to amplify our conceptions of Divine Power. Omnipotence is that attribute of the Divine Being, by which ho can accomplish every thing that does not imply a contra OMNIPOTENCE OF THE HF.ITY. 33 diction— ho wovPi- far it may transcend thf' comprehension of finite minds. By his power the vast system of universal nature was cabled from nothing into existence, and is continu- ally su}iported, in all its movements, from age to age. — In ehicidatinp- this perfection of God, we might derive some strik- ing illustrations from the records of his dispensations towards man, in the early ages of the world — when he overwhelmed the earth with the deluge, which covered the tops of the highest mountains, and swept the crowded i)opulation of the ancient world into a watery grave — when he demolished Sodom and Gomorrah, and the cities around them, with tire from heaven — when he slew all the first born of Egypt, and turned their rivers into blood — when he divided the Red Sea, and the waters of Jordan before the tribes of Israel — when he made the earth to open its jaws and swallow up Korah and ah his company — and when he caused Mount Sinai to smoke and tremble at his presence. But, these and similar events, how- ever awful, astonishing, and worthy of remembrance, were only transitory exertions of divine power, and are not calcula- ted, and were never intended, te impress the mind in so pow^- erfid a manner as those displays of Omnipotence which are exhibited in the ordinary movements of the material universe. Wc have no hesitation in asserting, that, with regard to this attribute of the Divinity, there is a more grand and impressive display in the Works of Nature, than in all the events recorded in the Sacred History. Nor ought this remark to be consi- dered as throwing the least reflection on the fullness and sufficiency of the Scripture revelation ; for that revelation as having a special reference to a moral economy, has for its objecr, to give a more particular display of the moral than of the natural perfections of God. The miracles to which wo have now referred, and eve:y other supernatural fact recorded in the Bible were not intended so much to drsplay the plenitude of the power of Deity, as to bear testimony to the Divine mission of particular messengers, and to confirm the truths they declared. It was not, for example, rnerely to display the energies of Almighty power, that the waters of the Red Sea were dried up before the thousands of Israel, but to give a solemn and striking attestation to all concerned, that the Mosi High God had taken this people under his i)eculiar protection — that he had appointed Moses as their leader and legislator— and that they were bound to receive and obey the statutes he delivered. The most appropriate and impressive illustrations of Omnipotence, are those which are taken trom the permanent operations of Deitv, which are visible every moment in the 3* 34 THE ciiiusTiAN niiLosoniErv. universe around us ; or, in, other word-^» tho?c whicii are de- rived from a detail of the fucts which have been observed in the material world, respecting ttia.i^nitude and motion. In the first place, the immense qtiantify of matter contained in the universe, presents a, most striking display of Almighty power. In endeavouring to fama a definite nation on this subject^ the raind is bewildered in its conceptions, and is at a loss where te ])cgin or to end its excursions. In order to form something approximating to a well defined idea we must pursue a train of thought commencing with those magnitudes which ^he mind can easily grasp, proceeding through all the intermediate gi:a- dations of magnitude, and fixing the attention on every portion of the chain, till we arrive at the object or magnitude of which we wisli to form a conception. We must endeavour, in the first place, to form a conception of the bulk of the world in which we dwell, which, though only a point in comparison of the whole material universe, is, in reality, a most astonishing magnitude, which the mind cannot grasp, without a laborious elfort. We can form some definite idea of those protuberate masses we denominate hills j which arise above the surface of our plains ; but were we transported to the mountainous scenery of Switzerland, to the stupendous range of the Andes in South America, or to the Himmalayan mountains in India, where masses of earth and rocks, in every variety of shape, extend several hundreds of miles in differOnt directions, and rear their projecting summits beyond the region of the clouds — we should find some difiiculty in forming an adequate con- ception of the objects of our contemplation. For, (to use the words of one who had been a spectator of such scenes,) " Amidst those trackless r<3gions of intense silence and soli- tude, Ave cannot contempl-ate, but with feelings of awe and admiration, the enormous masses of variegated matter which lie around, beneath, and above us. The mind labours, as it were, to farm a defiuito idea of tho^c objects of oppressive grandeur, and feels unable to grasp, the august objects which compose the surrounding scene." But what are all these mountainous masses, however variegated and sublime, when compared with the bulk of the whole earth 1 Vrerc they hurled from their basis, and precipitated into the vast Pacific Ocean, they would all disappear in a moment, except perhaps a few projecting tops, which, like a number of small islands, might be seen rising a few fathoms above the surface of the waters. The earth is a globe whose diameter is nearly 8,000 OMNrrOTKTsCE OF THE DEITV. 35 miles, and its circHinfoiciico about 25,000, and, consequently, its surface cojitnir^s noarly tvvo hundred millions of square miles — a magnitude too great for the mind to take in at one conception... In order to form a tolerable conception of tlie whole, we must endeavour to. take b. leisurely survey of its dilTerent parts. Were we to take our .station on the top of a mountain, of a moderate size, and survey the surrounding landscape^ we should perceive an e.\tcnt of view stretching 40 miles in every direction,, forming a circle SO miles in diameter, and 25.0 m clrcum.fercnce, and comprelicn.ding an area of 5,000 square m:!es. In such a situation the tcrfestial scene around and hei\ei\th us, consisting of hills and plains, towns and vilhigcs,, rivers and U^kes — v/or.M form one of the largest objects which the eye, and even the imagination, can steadily grasp at one time. But such an object, grand and extensive as it is, torms no more than the Jhrli) fhousandih jyart of the teriaqueous globe ; so that before we can acquire an adequate conception of the magnitude of our own world, we must con- ceive 40,000 landscapes of a similar extent, to pass in review before us : a,nd were a scene, of the ma,gnitude now stated, to puss before ns every hour, till all the diversified scenery of the earth v.ere brought under our view, and v/ere 12 hours a-day allotted for t\\i) observation, it woisld require 9 years and 48 days betV.re the whole surface of the globe could be contem- plated, even In this p;euc)'al and rapid manner. But, such a variety of successive landscapes passing before the eye, even although it were possible to be realized, would convey ordy a very vague and imperfect conception of the scenery of our world ; for objects at the distance of 40 miles cannot be dis- tinctly perceived ; the oidy view which would be satisfactory would be, that which is comprehended within the range of 3 or 4 miles from the spectator. Again, I have already stated, that the surface of the earth contains nearly 200,000,000 of square miles. — Now, were a person to set out on a minute survey of the terraqueous globe, and to travel till l>e passed along every square mile on its sur- face, and to continue his route without intermission, at the rate of 30 miles every day, it would require 18,264 years before he could finish his tour, and complete the survey of " this huge rotundity on which we tread :■' so that, had he commenced his excursion on the day in which Adam was created, and continu- ed it to the present hour, he would not have accomplished one- third part of this vast tour. In estimating the size and extent of the earth, we ought also to take into consideration, the vast variety of objects with 3b THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. which it is diversified, and the numerous animated beings with which it is stored ; — the great divisions of land and water, the continents, seas, and islands, into which it is distributed ; the lofty ranges of mountains which rear their heads to the clouds ; the unfathomed abysses of the ocean ; its vast subterraneous caverns and burning mountains ; and the lakes, rivers, and stately forests with which it is so magnificently adorned ; — the many millions of animals, of every size and form, from the elephant to the mite, which traverse its surface ; the numerous tribes of fishes, from the enormous whale to the diminutive shrimp, which " play" in the mighty ocean ; the ferial tribes which sport in the regions above us, and the' vast mass of the surrounding atmosphere, which encloses the earth and all its mhabitants as " with a swaddling band." The immense va- riety of beings with which our terrestrial habitation is furnish- ed, conspires, with every other consideration, to exalt our conceptions to that power by which our globe, and all that it contains, were brought into existence. The preceding illustrations, however, exhibit the vast extent of the earth, considered only as a mere superficies. But we know that the earth is a solid globe, whose specific gravity is nearly five times denser than water,, or about twice as dense as the mass of earth and rocks whicli compose its surface. Though we cannot dig into its bowels beyond a mile in per- pendicular depth, to explore its hidden wonders, yet we may easily conceive what a vast and indescribable mass of matter must be contained between the two opposite portions of its external circumference, reaching SOOO miles in every direc- tion. The solid contents of this ponderous ball is no less than 263,858,149,120 cubical miles — a mass of material substance of which we can form but a very faint and imperfect conception — in proportion to which all the lofty mountains which rise above its surface, are less than a few grains of sand, when compared with the largest artificial globe. Were the earth a hollow sphere, surrounded merely with an external shell of earth and water, 10 miles thick, its internal cavity would be sufficient to contain a quantity of materials one hundred and Ihiriy-three times greater than the whole mass of continents, islands, and oceans, on its surface, and the foundations on which they are supported. We have the strongest reasons, however, to con- clude, that the earth, in its general structure, is one solid mass, from the surface to the centre, excepting perhaps, a few ca- verns scattered, here and there, amidst its subteiTaneous re- cesses : and that its density gradually increases from its surface to its central regions. What an enormous mass of Uintei-icils, llu'iv, is comprt riciuT''(! u ithiii tile i"ujtits of tlfiit iilobe on which v/c tread ! The mind lahours, a^ it were, to Coin- prehend the mighty idea, and after all its exertion, feels; itself unable to take in such an astonishing magnitude at one eoni- prchensive gra.sp. How great must be the power of that Being who commanded it to spring from nothing into exist- ence^ who " measureth the ocean in the hollow of his hand, who weighetli the mpiyitains in scale?, and hangeth the earth uj)ou nothing !" It is esseiirtiairy requisite, b ;f );re. proceeding to the survey of objects and niAgmtiule.-i of a superior order, that we should endeavour,, by such a train of thouglit as the preceding, to form some tolerable and clear conception of the bidk of the globe we inhabit ; for h Is He only body we can i?se as a slnridard comparison to guice the mind in its conceptions, when it jams abroad to other regions of material existence. And, from what has been now stated it appears, that we have no adequale conception r^* a magnitude of so vast an extent : or, at least, that the mind cannot, in any one instant, form to itself a distinct and comprehensive idea of it, in any measure corres- ponding to the reality. Hitherto, then„ wc Ixave fixed only on a determinate ma.gni- tude— on a scale of a few in.cl>.c>\as it were, in order to assist us in our measurement and conception of magnitudes still more august and astonishing. When we contemplate, by the light of science, those magaificent globes which float around us, m the concave of the sky, the earth with all its sublime scenery, stupendous as it is, dwindles into an inconsiderable ball. If we. p.a3s from our globe to some of the other bodies of the plar^etarjf system, we shall find that one of these stu- pendous 04-bs is nxore than 900 ti.jnes the siz-o of our world, and encircled with a, ring 200,^000 miles in diameter, which would nearly reach from the earth to the inoon, and would en- close withiuj its vast circum'erence, several hundreds of worlds as larga a,s ovirs. Another of these planetary bodies, which appc^irs to tU- vulgciir ey:e onlj r^s a brnilnnt speck on the vault of hcf(,ven,, is ib*^nd to 1x3 of such a size, that it would re- quire 1,400 globes of the bulk of the earth to tbrm one equal to it in dimensions. The whole of the bodies, which compose the solar system, (\yitho;.it taking the sun and the comets into accomitj coAtftiin a m;iss o,f matter 2,500 times greater t'lan that of the earth. The suiibin^setfis .'pO: tinv-is laKgcr than all the planetary ij;lobf!s takpn togetlier ; and one million, three li'iridred tho.isrii 1 tiaijs larger than the terra-picons globe. This i:^ ono of th^ iiu-t glorious and niagnilicent visible ob- 38 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. jects, which either the eye, or the imagination, can contem plate ; especially when we consider, what perpetual, and incomprehensible, and powerful influence he exerts, what warmth, and beauty, and activity, he diffuses, not only on the globe we inhabit, but over the more extensive regions oi surrounding worlds. His energy extends to the utmost Hmits of the planetary system— to the planet Herschel, which re- volves at the distance of 1,800 millions of miles from his sur- face, and there he dispenses light, and colour, and comfort, to all the beings connected with that far-distant orb, and to all the moons which roll around it. Here the imagination begins to be overpowered and bewil dered in its conceptions of magnitude, when it has advanced scarcely a single step in its excursions through the material world : For it is highly probable that all the matter contained- v/ithin the limits of the solar system, incomprehensible as its magnitude appears, bears a smaller proportion to the whole mass of the material universe, than a single grain of sand to all the particles of matter contained in the body of the sun and his attending planets. If we extend our views from the solar system to the starry heavens, we have to penetrate, in our imagination, a space which the swiftest ball that was ever projected, though in per- petual motion, would not traverse in ten hundred thousand years. In those trackless regions of immensity, we behold an assemblage of resplendent globes, similar to the sun in si.ie, and in glory, and, doubtless, accompanied with a retinue of worlds, revolving, like our own, around their attractive influ- ence. The immense distance at which the nearest stars are known to be placed, proves that they are bodies of a prodigi- ous size, not inferior to our sun, and that they shine, not by reflected rays, but by their own native light. But bodies en- circled with such refulgent splendour, would be of little use in the economy of Jehovah's empire, unless surrounding world ; were cheered by their benign influence, and enlightened by their beams. Every star is, therefore, with good reason, con- cluded to be a sun, no less spacious than ours, surrounded by a host of planetary globes, which revolve around it as a cen- tre, and derive from it light, and heat, and comfort. Nearly a thousand of these luminaries may be seen in a clear winter night, by the naked eye ; so that a mass of matter equal to a thousand solar systems, or to thirteen hundred and twenty mil- lions of globes of the size of the earth, may be perceived, by every common observer, in the canopy of heaven. But all \\\v celestial orbs which are perceived by the unassisted sight, do OMNIPOTENCE OF THE DEITY. 39 not form the eighty thousandth part of those which may be descried by the help of optical instruments. The telescope has enabled us to descry, in certain spaces of the heavens, thousand of stars where the naked eye could scarcely discern twenty. The late celebrated astronomer, Dr. Herschel, has informed us, that, in the most crowded parts of the Milky-way, when exploring that region with his best glasses, he has had fields of view which contained no less than 588 stars, and these were continued for many minutes : so that " in one quar- ter of an hour's time there passed no less than one hundred and sixteen thousand stars through the field of view of his telescope." It has been computed, that nearly one hundred millions of stars might be perceived by the most perfect instruments, were all the regions of the sky thoroughly explored. And yet, all this vast assemblage of suns and worlds, when com- pared with what lies beyond the utmost boundaries of human vision, in the immeasurable spaces of creation, may be no more than as the smallest particle of vapour to the immense ocean. Immeasurable regions of space lie beyond the ut- most limits of mortal view, into which even imagination itself can scarcely penetrate, and which are, doubtless, replenished with the operations of Divine Wisdom and Omnipotence. For, it cannot be supposed, that a being so diminutive as man, whose stature scarcely exceeds six feet — who vanishes from the sight at the distance of a league — whose whole habitation is invisible from the nearest star — whose powers of vision are so imperfect, and whose mental faculties are so limited — it cannot be supposed that man, who " dwells in tab- ernacles of clay, who is crushed before the moth," and chain- ed down, by the force of gravitation, to the surface of a small planet, — should be able to descry the utmost boundaries of the empire of Him who fills immensity, and dwells in " fight unapproachable." That portion of his dominions, however, which lies within the range of our view, presents such a scene of magnificence and grandeur, as must fill the mind of every reflecting person with astonishment and reverence, and constrain him to exclaim, " Great is our Lord, and of great power, his understanding is infinite." " When I consider the' heavens, the work of thy fingers, the moon and the stars which thou hast ordained, — what is man that thou art mindful of him !" " I have heard of thee by hearing of the ear ;" I have listened to subtle disquisions on thy character and perfec tions, and have been but little affected, '* but now mine eve 40 THE CilKISTIAx\ riilLOSOPIlER. 8et!h thcc ; >vhert>roic I liuuiblc iny.dU and repent in dust and uslios." , , , , In order to feel (he l\il! force of the luipre.^aion raaae by such couteni,ihaion*, the innid niurft pause at ever.y step, in its ex- cursions ihrou'di the bountliess regioni? ot mat-eiial existence : lor it its not by a mere atleiitic-n to the ligures and numbers by which the ujagintudes of the great bodies of the universe are expressed, that we arrive at tiie most disliiicl and ample conceptions of objects so grand and overwhehning. Ihe mind, in its intellectual range, must dwell on every individual scene it contemplates, and on the various objects of which it is com- posed. J I must add scene to scene, magnitude to magni- tude, and compare smaller obje« ts with greater— a range of mountains with the whole earth, the earth with the planet Jupiter, Jupiter with the sun, the sun with a thousand stars, a thousand stars with SO millions, and 80 millions With all the boundless extent which lies beyond the limits orhioihil vision; and, at every step of this mental process, sutiicient tiine must be allowed for the imagination to exnatiale on the objects before it, till the ideas aj>uroximate, as near as possible, to the reality, in order to form a comprehensive cohceplioii of the extent of the terraqueous globe, the mind must dwell on art extensive landscape, and the objects with which it is adorned ; it must endeavour to survey the many thousands of diversitied landscapes which the earth exhibits — the hills and plains^ this lakes and rivers^ and mountains^ wdiich strelch in endless variety over its surface — it must dive into tlie vasl ciaVerns (jf the ocean — penetrate; into the subterraneous regions of tliB; globe, and wing its way amidst clouds and tempests, through the surrounding atmosphere. It must next extend its flight through the most expansive regions of the solar system^ realizing, in imaginatioui those mcigniiicent scenes which can be described neither by the naked eye-, nor by the telescope ; and comparing the extent of our sublunary world, with the more magniiicjiit globes that roll around us. Leaving the sun and all his attendant planets behind, till they have diminished to the size of a small twinkling star, it must next wing its w^iy to the starry regions, aiul pass trom one system of worlds to another, iVum one JNebuluj* to another, from one region of iS'ebulaj to another, till it arrive at the utmost boundaries of creation which huuiun genius has explored. It hiust also endeavor to extend its flight beyond all that is visible by the best telescopes, and expatiate at large in that boundless cx- ♦ I'ur iin .ic.'o.iui v^ the .\\bidcc, ;,ee Cli. 11. Art. .7s!ronomy. OMNIPOTENCE OF THE DEITY. 41 panse i«to %vhich no human eye has yet penetrated, and v.hich is, doubiteris, replenished with other worlds, and systems, and lirmaments, where the o^jerations orinlinite power and benefi- tience are displayed in endless variety, throughoui the iilimit- «ibie regions of space. Here, tl\en, with reverence, let us pause, and wonder! Ovei- all this vast assemblage of material existence, God pre- sides. Amidst the diversified objects and intelligences it contains, he is eternally and essentially present. By his un- erring wisdom, all its complicated movements are directed. By his Almighty iiat, it emerged from nothing into existence, mid is continually supported from age to age. " He spakk AND IT WAS done; HE COMxVIANDEl) AJN D IT STOOD FAST." " By the word of the Lord were the heavens made, and all ihe host of them hy the spirit of his mouth." What an aston- ishing di.>play of Divine power is here exhibited to our view ! How far transcending all tinite comprehension must be the energies of Him who only " spake, and it was done ;" who only gave the command, and this mighty system of the uni- verse, with all its magnificence, started into being ! The in- finite ease with which this vast fabric was reared, leads us irresistibly to conclude^ that there are powers and energies in the Divine inind which have never yet been exerted, and which may unfold themselves to intelligeilt beings, in the pro- duction of still more astonishing and magiiiiicent effects, dur- ing an endless succession of existence. That man who is not impressed with a venerable and overwhelming sense of the power and majesty of Jehovah, by such comtemplations, must have a mind incapable of ardent religious emotions, and unquaUtie, or extended to ten thousand worlds 'I — whether they shall be left to view the operations of the Almighty throughout eternity past and to come, as confined to a small globe pla-ced iu the immeiisity of space, with a number of bril- liant studs fixed in the arch of heaven, at a few miles distance ; or, as extending tlirough the boundless dimensions of space '^ — whether they shall be left to entertain no higher idea of the Divine majesty than what may be due to one of the superior orders of the seraphim or cherubim, — or, whether they s'lall be dii-ertod to (brr.i the most august conception-; of the King eter- n-Ts, itmunrta.!, and iiivix.ble, Ci^rrcipo.idin^ lo the displays he 42 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. has given of his glory in his visible works ? If it be not, both reason and piety require, that such illustrations of the Divine perfections should occasionally be exhibited to their view. In the next place, the rapid motions of the great bodies of the universe, no less than their magnitudes, display the Infinite Power of the Creator. We can acquire accurate ideas of the relative velocities of moving bodies, only by comparing the motions, with which we are familiar, with one another, and with those which lie beyond the general range of our minute inspection. We can acquire a pretty accurate conception of the velocity of a ship, impelled by the wind — of a steam-boat^ — of a race horse — of a bird darting through the air^of an arrow flying from a bow —and of the clouds when impelled by a stormy wind. The velocity of a ship is from 8 to 12 miles an hour — of a race horse, from 20 to 30 miles — of a bird, say from 50 to 60 miles, and of the clouds^ in a violent hurricane* from SO to 100 miles an hour. The motion of a ball from a loaded cannon is in- comparably swifter than any of the motions now stated ; but of the velocity of such a body we have a less accurate idea ; because, its rapidity being so great, we cannot trace it distinct- ly by the eye through its whole range, from the mouth of the cannon to the object against which it is impelled. By experi- ments, it has been found-, that its rate of motion is from 4S0 to SOO miles in an hour, but it is retarded every moment, by the resistance of the air and the attraction of the earth. This velocity, however, great as it is, bears no sensible proportion to the rate of motion which is found among the celestial orbs. That such enormous masses of matter should move at all, is wonderful ; but when we consider the amazing velocity with which they are impelled, we are lost in astonishment. The |)lanet Jupiter, in describing his circuit round the sun, moves at the rate of 29,000 miles an hour. The planet Venus, one of the nearest and most brilliant of the celestial bodies, and about the same size as the earth, is found to move through the spaces of the firmament at the rate of 76,000 miles an hour ; and the planet Mercury, with a velocity of no less than 150,000 miles an hour, or 1750 miles in a minute — -a motion two hun- dred times swifter than that of a cannon ball. These velocities will appear still more astonishing, if we consider the magnitude of the bodies which are thus impelled* and the immense forces which are requisite to carry them along in their courses. However raoidly a ball flies from the nioiifh of a cannon, it is the flight of a body only Rfew inches ill iliauielcr; but one of the bodies, whose motion has been OMNIPOTENCE OF THE DEITY. 43 just now stated, is eighty-nine thousand miles in diameter, and would comprehend, within its vast circumference, more than a thousand globes as large as the earth. Could we contem- plate such motions, from a fixed point, at the distance of only a few hundreds of miles from the bodies thus impelled — it would raise our admiration to its highest pitch, it would over- whelm all our faculties, and, in our present state, would pro- duce an impression of awe, and even of terror, beyond the power of language to express. The earth contains a mass of matter equal in weight to at least 2,200,000,000,000,000,000,- 000 tons, supposing its mean density to be only about 2^ times greater than water. To move this ponderous mass a single inch beyond its position, were it iixed in a quiescent state, would require a mechanical force almost beyond the power of numbers to express. The physical force of all the vyiyriads of intelligences within the bounds of the planetarv system, though their powers were far superior to those of man, would be altogether inadequate to the production of such a motion. How much more must be the force requisite to impel it with a velocity one hundred and forty times swifter than a cannon ball, or 68,000 miles an hour, the actual rate of its motion^ in its course round the sun ! But whatever de- gree of mechanical power would be requisite to produce such a stupendous effect, it would require a force one hundred and fifty times greater to impel the planet Jupiter, in his actual course, through the heavens ! Even the planet Saturn, one of the slowest moving bodies of our system, a globe 900 times larger than the earth, is impelled through the regions of space at the rate of 22,000 miles an hour, carrying along with him two stupendous rings, and seven moons larger than ours, through his whole course round the central luminary. Were we placed within a thousand miles of this stupendous globe, (a station which superior beings may occasionally occupy,) where its hemisphere, encompassed by its magnificent rings, would fill the whole extent of our vision — the view of such a ponderous and glorious object, flying with such amazing velo city before us, would infinitely exceed every idea of grandeur we can, derive from terrestrial scenes, and overwhelm our powers with astonishment and awe. Under such an emo- tion, we could only exclaim, " Great and Marvellous are THY works, Lord God Almighty !" The ideas of strength and power implied in the hnpulsion of such enormous masses of mattei; through the illimitable tracts of space, are forced upon the mind with irresistible energy, far surpassing what any abstract propc 5i*.ions or reasonings can convey ; and con- 44 THE ciiJirsTiAN piiiwiSoriirrR. strain us to exclaim, " Who i^^ a strong Lord like unto thee ! Thy riiiht hand is Iwconie glorious m power 1 tue Lord (xod oniiii(Jo1cnt rcfgneth !"' . ^ If we consider the iiHi;!e»se Ktn»&ei' of bo^^ies thus impeiied throun-h the vast s|)aces of tlie universe— the rapidity with whlcirthe comets, when near the sun, are carried through the regions they traverse,— if we consider the high probability, if iitlt absolute certainty, that the sun, with ail his attendant |)lanets and coniets, is impelled with a still greater degree oi' velocity towards some distant region of space, or around scms wide circumference — that all the thousands of systems of taat nebula; to which the sun belongs, arc moving in a similar maa- ner — that all the nebuhi? in the heavens are moA ing around some magniiicent central body — in short, that all the suns and worlds in the vmiverse are in rapid and perpetual motion, as constituent portions of one grand and boundless empire, of which Jehovah is the Sovereign— and, if we consider still farther, that all these mighty rrfoves^^nts have been going on, without intermission^ during the course of many centuries, and some of them, perhaps, for myriads of age^s l)efore the foundations of our world were laid — it is impossible for the lunnan mind to form any adequate idea of the stupendous forces which are in incessant operation throughout the unr limited empire of the Almighty. To estimate such mechani-> cal force, even in a single instance, completely ba^s tl^ mathematician's skill, and sets the power of nunjbers at de- liance. " Language," and figures, and comparison a, are " lost in wonders so sublime," and the mind, overpowered with such reflections, is irresistibly led upwards, to search Cor the cause in that OMNiroiErcT Being who upholds the pil- lars of the universe — tho titunder oi" whose power none can couiprehend. While contciijplating such august objects, how emphatic and impressive a})pears the language of the sacred oracles, " Canst thou by searching lind dut God ? Canst thou find out the Almighty to perfection^ Great things doth he which we cannot comprehend. Thine, O Lord, is the great- ness, and the glory, and the majesty ; for all that is in heaven and earth is thine. Among the gods there is none like unto tlief, O Lord, neither are there any AvorUs like unto thy works. Th<;u art great, and dost wondrous things, thou art God alone. I last thou not known, hast thou not heard, that the everlasting God, the Lord, the Creator of all things, tamteth not, neither »s weary I there is no searching of his understanding. Let all the earth fear the Lord, let a,ll the inhai>itants of the world OMNIPOTENCE OF THE EhEITY. 45 Stand in awe of him ; for, he spake^ and it was done ; he com- manded, and it stood fast." Again, the immense spaces which surround the heavenly bodies, and in which they perform their revoUitions, tend to expand our conceptions on this subject, and to illustrate the magnificence of the Divine operations. In whatever point of view we contemplate the scenery of the heavens, an idea of grandeur irresistibly bursts. »pon the mind ; and, if empty space can^in any sense, be considered as an object of sub- limity, nothing can fill the mind with a grander idea of mag- nitude and extension, than the amplitude of the scale on which planetary systems are constructed. Around the body of the swi there is allotted a cubical space, 3,600 millions of miles in diameter,^ in which eleven planetary globes revolve — every one being separated from another, by intervals of many millions of miles. The space which surrounds the utmost limits of our system, extending in every direction, to the nearest fixed stars, is, at least, 40,^000,000,000,000 mites hi, diameter ; and, it is highly probable, that every star is surrounded by a space of equal, or even of greater extent. A body impelted with the greatest velocity which art can produce^ — a cannon ball, for instance, would require twenty yeaj-s to pass through the space that intervenes betweea the earth aiijd the sun,, and four mil- lions,, seven hundred thousand, years,, ere it could reach the nearest star. Though the stars seem to be crowded together in clusters,. and some of them almost to touch one another, yet the distance between any twO: stars which seem to make the near- est approach, is such as neither words can express, nor ima- gination fathom. These immense spaces are as unflithomable on the one hand,, as the magnitude of the bodies v/hich move in them, and their prodigious velocities, are incomprehensible on the other ; and they form a part of those magnificent pro- portions according to which the fabric of universal nature was arranged — all corresponding to the majesty of that infinite and incomprehensible Being, " who measures the ocean in the hollow of his hand, and meteth out the heavens with a span." How wonderful that bodies at such prodigious distances should exert a mutual influence on one another ! that the moon at the distance of 240,000 miles should raise tides in the ocean, and currents in the atmosphere ! that the sun, at the distance of ninety-five millions of miles, should raise the vapors, move the ocean, direct the course of the winds, fructify the earth, and distrit»ute light, and heat, and color, through every region of the globe ; yea, that his attractive influence, and fructifying ener- gy, should extend even to the planet Ilerschcl, at the distance 4* 4Q Tun cmiisTTAN piiiLosarirEfe. ofciglilcoii Imndrcd millions of miles ! So that, in ever >- p ->fnt of view in which the universe is contemplated, we perceive the same f:;rand scale of operation by which the Ahnighty has ar- rannod the provinces of his universal kingdom. We would now ask, in the name of all that is sacred, whe- ther such magnificent manifestations of Deity ought to be considered as irrelevant in the business of religion, and M-hcther they ought to be thrown completely into the shade, in the discussions \vhich take place in religious topics^ in '• the assemblies of the saints V It^religion consists in the intellec- tual apprehension of the perfections of God, and in the moral effects produced by such an apprehension — if all the rays of glory emitted by the luminaries of" heaven, are only- so many reflections of the grandeur of Kim who dwells in light unap- proachable — if they have a tendency to assist the mind in forming its conceptions of that ineffable Being, whose uncre- ated glory cannot be directly contemplated — and if they are calculated to produce a sublime and awful impression on all created intelligences, — shall we rest contented with a less glorious idea of God than his works are calculated^ to afford I Shall we disregard the works of the Lord, and contemn " the rperations of his hands," and that, too, in the face of all the invitations on this subject, addressed to us from heaven l For thus saith Jehovah : " Lift uj) your eyes on high, and behold who hath created these things, who bringcth forth their hosl by number. — I, the Lord, who maketh all things, who strctch- eth forth the heavens alone, and spread abroad the earth bv himself; all their host have I commanded." And, if, at the command of God, we lift up our eyes to the " finnament ot his power," surely we ought to do it, not Avith a brute "uncon- scious gaze," not with the vacant stare of a savage, not as ft we were still enveloped with the mists and prejudices of the dark ages— but as surrounded by that blaze of light which modern science has thrown upon the scenery of the sky, in or- der thut we may contemplate, with fixed attention, all that enlightened reason, aided by the nicest observations, has ascer- tained respecting the magnificence of the celestial orbs. To overlook the sublime discoveries of modern times, to despise tlunn, or to call in question their reahty, as some religionists have done, because they bring to our ears such astonishing re- ports of the " eternal power" and majesty of Jehovah — is to act as if we were afraid lest the Deity should be represented 4s4nore grand and magnificent than he really is, and as if we would be Ix^ttcr i)leased to pay him a less share of homage and adoration than is diie to his name. oMNtPOTENcr: or the djiity. 47 t*erhaps sonic may be disposed to ihsinuato, that the views now stated are above the level of ordinary eomprehension, and founded too much on scientific consideration?, to be stated in deta,il to a common audience. To any insinuations of this kind, it may be replied, that s-uch illustrations as those to which we have referred^ are more easily comprehended than many of those abstract discussions to which they are frequently ac- customed ; since they are definite and tangible, being derived from those objects v.liich strike the senses and the imagina- tion. Any person of common understanding may be made to comprehend the leadmg ideas of extended space, magnitude, and motion, which have been stated above, provided the des- criptions be sufficiently simple, clear and well defined ; and should they be at a loss to comprehend the principles on which the conclusions rest, or the mode by which the magnificence of the works of God has been ascertained, an occasional re- ference to such topics would excite them to inquiry and inves- tigation, and to the exercise of their powers of observation and reasoning on such subjects — which are tt)o frequently directed to ftir less important objects. The following illustra- tion, however, stands clear of every objection of this kind, and is level to the coiupi.'^heasion of every man of common sense. — Either the earth moves round its axis once in twenty-four hours — or, the sun, moon, planets, comets, stars, and the whole frame of the universe move around the earth, in the same time. There is no alternative, or third opinion, that can be formed on ttys point. If the earth revolve on its axis every 24 hours, to produce; the alternate succession of day and night, the portions of its surface about the equator must n\()ve at the rate of more than a thousand miles an hour, since the earth is more than twenty-four thousand miles in circum- ference. This view of the fact, when attentively considered, furnishes a most sublime and astonishing idea. That a globe of so vast dimensions, witli all its load of mountains, conti- nents, and oceans, comprising within its circumference a mass of two hundred and sixty-four thousand million of cubical miles, should whirl around with so amazing velocity, gives us a most august and impressive conception of the greatness of that Power which i^irst set it in motion, and continues the rapid whir] from age to age ! Though the huge masses of the Alpine mountains were in a moment detached from their foundations, carried aloft through the regions of the air, and tossed into the Mediterranean sea, it would convey no idea of a force equal to that which is every moment exerted, if the earth revolve on its axis. But should the motion of our earth be called in 48 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. question, or denied, the idea of force, or power, will be inde* finitely increased. For, in this case, it must necessarily be admitted, that the heavens, with all the innumerable host of stars, have a diurnal motion around the globe ; which motion must be inconceivably more rapid than that of the earth, on the supposition of its motion. For, in proportion as the ce- lestial bodies are distant from the earth, in the same proportion would be the rapidity of their movements. The sun, on this supposition, would move at the rate of 414,^000 miles in a minute ; the nearest stars, at the rate of fourteen hundred mil- lions of miles in a second : and the most distant luminaries,, with a degree of swiftness which no numbers could express.* Such velocities, too, would be the rate of motion, not merely of a single globe like the earth, but of all the ten thousand tunes ten thousand spacious globes that exist within the boun- daries of creation. This view conveys an idea of power, still more august and overwhelming than any of the views already stated, and we dare not presume to assert^, that such a degree of physical force is beyond the limits of infinite perfection ; but on the supposition it existed,, it would confound all our d.eas of the wisdom and intelligence of the Divine mind > and would appear altogether inconsistent with the character whicb the scripture gives us of the Deity as "the only wise God." For, it would exhibit a stuperbdous system of means altogether disproportioned to the end intended — namely, to produce the alternate succession of day and night to the inhabitants of our j globe, which is more beautifully an(J harmoniously affected ^ by a simple rotation on its axis, as is the case with the other globes which compose tlie planetary system. Such considera- tions, however,, show us,, that, on wh.atever hypothesis, whether on the vulgar or the scientific, or in whatever other point of view, the frame of nature may be contemplated, the mind is ii-resistibly impressed with ideas of power, grandeur and magni- ficence. And, theretore, when aii inquiring mind is directed J to contemplate the works of God,, on any hypothesis it may \ choose, it has a tendency to rouse reflection, and to stimulate the exercise of the moral and intellectual faculties, on objects which arc worthy of the dignity of immortal minds. U e niay now be, in some measure, prepared to decide, whether illustrations of the omnipotence of the Deity, derived from the system of the material world, or those vague and me- taphysical discjuisitions which are generally given in theologi- cal systems bo most calculated to impress the mind, and to * Sec Appendix, No. 1. OMNIPOTENCE OF THE DEITY. 49 inspire it with reverence and adoration. The following is a description given of this attribvite of God, by a well known systematic writer, Avho has generally been considered as a judi- cious and orthodox divine : — ■ " God is almighty. Rev. i. 18, chap. iv. 8. This will evi- dently appear, in that, if he be infinite in all his other perfec- tions, he must be so in power : thus, if he be omniscient, he knows v.'hat is possible or expedient to be done ; and if he be an infinite sovereign, he wills whatever shall come t.^ pass. Now this knowledge would be insignificant, and his power inefficacious, were he not infinite in powei\or almighty. Again, this might be aigued from his justice, either in rewarding or punishing ; for if he were not infinite in power, he could do neither of thc::-e, at least so far as to render him the object of that desire or ft-ar, which is agreeable to the nature of these perfections ; neither could infinite faithfulness accomplish all the promises which he hath made^ so as to excite that trust, and dependence which is a part of religions v.'orship ; nor couW he say without limitation, as he does, / Jiare spolen if, 1 iviU aho bring it to pass ; 1 have puvjjosed if, I will also do it ; Isa. xM- li.—^.But since power is visible in, and demonstra- ted by its effect, and infinite power, by those effects which cgnnot be produced by a creature, w-e may observe the al- mighty power of God in all his works, both of nature and grace : thus his eternal power is understood, as the apostle says, Bij ike things that are made, R,om. i. 20, not that there Avas an eternal production of things, but the exerting this power in time^ proves it tO; be infinite and truly divine ; for no creature can produce the smallest particle of matter out of nothing, much less furnish the various species of creatures, with those endowments in which they excel one another, and set forth their Creator's glory. And the glory of his power is no less visible in the works of providence, whereby he upholds all things, disposes of them according to his pleasure, and brings about events which only he who has an almighty arm can ef feet." — Ridgleifs Body of Divinil!j, p. 39. This is the Vvhole that Dr. Ridgley judges it necessary to state, in illustration of the attribute of Omnipotence, except what he says in relation to its operation " in the work of grace," in "the propagation and success of the Gospel," &;c. subjects, to which the idea of power, or physical energy, does not pro- perly apply. Such, however,, are the meagre and abstract dis- quisitions generally given by most systematic writers. There is a continual play on the term " Infinite," which, to most mind^s conveys no idea at all, unless it bo as.sociutod with 50 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOFHER. ample conceptions of. motion, magnitude, and extension ; and it is constantiy applied to subjects to which it was never in- tended to apply, such as " mfinite faithfulness, infinite justice, infinite truth," &c. an application of the term which is never sanctioned by Scripture, and which has a tendency to intro- duce confusion into our conceptions of the perfections of God. Granting that the statements and reasonings in such an extract as the above were unquestionable, yet what impression can they malve upon the mind ? Would an ignorant person feel his conceptions of the Divinity much enlarged, or his moral powers aroused by such vague and general statements ? And, if not, it appears somewhat unaccountable, that those sources of illustration, which would convey the most ample and defi- nite views of the " eternal power" and glory of God, should be .studiously concealed from the view. Vague descriptions and general views of any object will never be effectual in awaken- ing the attention, and arresting the faculties of the mind. The heart will always remain unimpressed, and the understanding will never be thoroughly excited in its exercise, unless the intellect have presented before it a well-defined and interesting object, and be enabled to survey it in its various aspects ; and this object must ahvays have a relation to the material world, whether it be viewed in connection with religion, or with any other subject. Thus I have endeavoured, in the preceding sketches, to pre- sent a few detached illustrations of the omnipotence and gran- deur of the Deity, as displayed in the vast magnitude of the material universe — the stupendous velocities of the celestial bodies — and in the immeasiuable regions of space which sur- round them, and in which their motions are performed. Such a magnificent spectacle as the fabric of the universe presents — so majestic, God-like, and overwhelming, to beings who dwell " in tabernacles of clay" — was surely never intended to be overlooked, or to be gazed at with indifference, by creatures endowed with reason and intelligence, and destined to an im- mortal existence. In forming a universe composed of s: many immense systems and worlds, and replenished with such a variety of sensitive and intelligent existences, the Crea- tor, doubtless, intended that it should make a sublime and reverential impression on the minds of all the intellectual be- ings to whom it might be displayed, and that it should convey some palpable idea of the iniinite glories of his nature, in so i'ur as material objects can be su])posed to adumbrate tha OMNIPOTENCE OB THE DEITY. 5i ^perfections of a spiritual and uncreated Essence. Dwelling in *' light inaccessible" to mortals, and for ever veiled from the highest created being, by the pure spirituality and immensity of his nature, there is no conceivable mode by which the in- finite grandeur of Deity could be exhibited to finite intelli- gences, but through the medium of those magnificient opera- tions which are incessantly going forward throughout the boundless regions of space. Concealed from the gaze of all the ". principalities and powers" in heaven^ in the unfathoma- ble depths of his Essence, he displays his presence in the universe he has created, and the glory of his power, by launching magnificent worlds into existence^ by adorning them with diversified splendors-, by peopling them with various ranks of intelligent existence, and by impelling them in their move- ments through the illimitable tracts of creation. It will readily be admitted by every enlightened Christian^ that it must be a highly desirable attainment, to acquire thti most glorious idea of the Divine Being which the limited ca- pacity of our minds is capable of receiving. This is one of the graiid difficulties in religion. The idea of a Being purely IMMATERIAL, yct pei'Vading infinite space-, and possessed of lio sensible qualities, confounds and bewilders the human in- tellect, so that its conceptions-, on the one hand, are apt to verge towards e^ctravagancy, while, on the other, they are apt to degenerate into something approaching to inanity. Mere abstract ideas ^nd reasonings respecting infinity, eternity, and absolute perfection, however sublime we may conceive them to be-, completely fail in arresting the understanding, and afTecting the heart ; our conceptions become vague, empty, and confused, for want of a material vehicle to give them or- der, stability, and expansion. Something of the nature of vast extension, of splendid and variegated objects-, and of mighty movemtmts, is absolutely necessary, in order to convey to spirits dwelling in bodies of clay, a defmite conception of the invisible glories of the Eternal Mind ; and^ therefore, in the immense variety of material existence with which the universe is adorned, we find every requisite assistance of this kind to direct and expand our views of the great object of our adora- tion. When the mind is perplexed and overwhelmed with its conceptions, when it labors as it were, to form some well^ defined conceptions of an Infinite Being, it here finds some tangible objects on which to fix, some sensible substratum foi* its thoughts to rest upon for a little, while it attempts to pene-^ irate, in its excursions^ into those distant regions which eye k^xh not soen, and to connect the whole of its mental «'-3:%tf 52 THK CliinSTIAN PHILOSOPHER. uith the cnri:;ies of the " King, Etcrnd, Imnioitd, and Iii- visil.le." " .,,,.,., To such a tr;iiii of tliouiihl we are uruionnly directed m the sacred oracles, where Jehovnh is represented as describing liiinselt* by the cffpcla which his power and wisdom have pro- flueed.— " Israefshal! be saved in the Lord with an cverlast- ini; salvation. For thus saith Jehovah that created the hea- vens ; God liimself that formed the earth and made it ; he Tiath established it, he created it not in vain, he formed it to 'be inhabited ; I am the Lord, and there is none else." " I have made the earth and created man upon it, my hands have stretc^.ed out the heavens, and all their host have I connnand ed." ^ liiy.vrkcn mito me-, O Israel : I am the first, I also am the last. I?Piine 'hand d^o hath laid the foundation of the earth, and \ny righlliand hath spanned the heavens : when I call unto theVn, they stand up tog-ther." " Who hath mea sured the waters in the hollow of his hand, and meted out heaven wilh the span, and weighed the mountains in scales l lie who sittethupoft-the'circle of the earth, and the inhabitants thereof, are a-- grassheippers ; that stretched out the heavens as a curtain, that faintdth not, neither is weary." *' The LorJ made the hcaven^^ the heaven of heavens, w-lth all their hosts ; honor and majesty are before him, and his kingdom ruleth over all."* Such sublime descriptions of Jehovah, and references to his material works, are reiterated in every por- tion of the sacred volume ; and the import and sublimity of such expressions cannot be fully appreciatedi, unless we take into view all the magnificent objects v.hich science has unveii- ed in the distant regions of creation. This subject is calculated, not merely to overpower the in- tellect with ideas of sublimity and grandeur^ but also to prp- -duce a deep moval impression upon the heart ; and a Christian phihjsopher woiddbe dfMicient in his duty, were he to overlook this tendency of the objects of his contemplation. One important moral etT(3ct which this subject has n. natural tendency to produce-, is, profound nuMiMTYi What nn in- significant being does man appear, when he compares himself Mith the mngnilicence of creation, and with the myriads of exalted intelligences v.ith which it is jjeoplcd ! What are all the honors and splendors ot'this earthly ball, of which mortals are so proud, when j)!a(;ed in competition with the resplendent glories of the skins? Such a display as the Almighty has given of hiuisclf, in the magnitude and variety of his works, » ^<■^. xlv. iSi. ]-. xhiiu 12, V4. xl. 12. 22. Sir. OMNIPOTENCE OF THE DEITY Ot? ivas evidently intended '-to stain tlie pride" of all ln.imai^ ^randeun that " no flesh sliould gloiy in his presence." Yet^ there is lid disposition that appears so prominent among puny mortals, as pride, ambition, and vain-glory — the very opposite of hnmih'ty, and of all those tempers which become those " who dwell in tabernacles of clay, and whose foimdatic'n is in the dust." Even without taking into account the state of mn?' as a depraved intelligence, what is there in his situation thr.t should inspire him with " loi\y looks," and induce him to look down on his fellow-men with supercilious contempt ? Ho derived his origin from the dust, he is allied Vv'ith the beasts that perish; and he is fast hastening to the grave, where his Carcass will become the food for noisoioe reptiles, lie i^'s every moment dependant on a Superior Being for every pulse that beats, and every breath he draws^ and for all tliat he pos- sesses ; he is dependant even on the meanest of his species for his accommcdations and comforts. He holds every enjoy- ment on the most precarious tenure, — his friends may be snatched in a moment from his embrace ; his riches may take to themselves wings and fly away ; and his health and beauty may be blasted in an hour, by a breath of wind. Hunger and thirst, cold and heat, poverty and disgrace, sorrow and disap- pointment, pain and disease, mingle themselves with all his- pursuits and enjoyments. — His knowledge is circumscribed within the narroVest limits, his errors and follies are glaring and innumerable ; and he stands as an almost undistinguish- able atom, amidst the immensity of God's v\'orks. Still, with all these powerful inducements to the exercise of bumibty man dares to be proud and arrogant. ■-- — ■' Man, proud Man, Dressed in n little, brief authority, Plays such fantastic tricks before high Heaven As make the angels weep." ilov/ aiTccting to contemplate the warrior, flushed with dia- bolical pride, pursuing his conquests through heaps of slain, in order to obtain possession of " a poor pitiable speck of perishino; earth ;" exclaiming in his rage, " I will pursue, f will overtake, I will divide the spoil, my lust shall be satisfied upon them, I will draw my sword, my hand shall destroy thein" — to behold the man of rank glorying in his wealth, and his empty titles, and looking around upon the inferior orders of his fellow-mortals as the worms of the dust — fo behold the man of ambition pushing his way through bribery, and treachery^ and slaughter, to gain possession of a throne, ih-.f b? 'niv ^-^-^--r d'^'^v:^. v.'i'h pr:>viu ore-eminence tipon hi^ M THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. fellows — to behold the haughty airs of the noble dame, inflated with the idea of her beauty, and her high birth, as she struts along, surveying the ignoble crowd as if they were the du^t beneath her feet — to behold the smatterer in learning, puffed up with a vain conceit of his supei-ficial acquirements, when he has scarcely entered the porch of knowledge — in fine, to behold all ranks from the highest to the lowest, big with an idea of their own importance, and fired >\ith pride and re venge at the least provocation, whether imaginary or real ! How inconsistent the manifestations of such tempers^ with the many humiliating circumstances of our present condition, and with the low rank wliich we hold in the scale of Universal Being? It is not improbable, that there are in the universe, intelli- gences of a superior order, in whose breasts pride never found a place — to whom this globe of ours, and all its inhabitants, appear as inconsiderable as a drop of water filled with micro scopic animalculijc, does to the proud lords of this earthly re- gion. There is at least one Being to whom this sentiment is applicable, in its utmost extent : — " Before Him all nations are as a drop of a bucket, and the inhabitants of the earth as grasshoppers ; yea, they arc as nothing, and are counted to him less than nothing and vanity." Could we wing our way, with the swiftness of a seraph, from sun to sun^ and from world to world, till we had surveyed all the systems visible to the naked eye, which are only as a mere speck in the map of the universe — could we, at the same time, contemplate the glorious landscapes and scenes of grandeur they exhibit — could we also mingle with the pure and exalted hitelligences v/hich people those resplendent abodes, and behold their hum- ble and ardent adorations of their Almighty Maker, their benign and condescen'ling deportment towards one another ; " each esteeming anott 3r better than himself," and all united in the h mds of the pu est allection, without one haughty or discord«Jit feeling — wkit indignation and astonishment would seize us, on our retmn ti> this obscure corner of creation, to behold beings enveloped in the mist of ignorance, immersed in depravity and wickedness, liable to a thouscuid accidents, exposed to the ravages of the earthquake^ the volcano, and the storm; yet proud as Lucifer, and glorying in their shame ! We should l)e apt to view them, as we now do those bedlam- ites, who fancy themsiilv^ to be kings, surrounded by their nobles, while they are chained to the walls of a noisome dun- geon. " Sure pride was never made for man." Haw abhor- rent, then, niust it appear in the eyes of superior beings, who OxMNIPOTF.NCE OF THE DEITY. 5o» have taken an expansive range throuoh the field of creation ? How abhorrent it is in the sight of the Ahnighty, and how amiable is the opposite virtue, we learn iVoni his word : — " Every one that is proud in heart is an abomination to the Lord." — *' God resisteth the proud, but giveth grace to the humble." — " Thus saith the High and Lofty One, who in- babiteth eternity, I dwell in the high and holy place ; with him also that is of an humble and contrite spirit ; to revive the spirit of the humble, and the heart of the contrite ones." — While, therefore, we contemplate the omnipotence of God, in the immensity of creation, let us learn to cultivate humility and self-abasement. This was one of the lessons ^hich the pious Psalmist deduced from his survey of the nocturnal heavens. When he beheld the moon walking in the bright- ness, and the innumerable host of stars, overpowered with a sense of his own insignificance, and the greatness of divine condescei^sion, he exclaimed, " Lord ! what is man, that thou art mindful of him, or the son of man, that thou shouldst visit him!" Again, this subject is also calculated to inspire us with REVERENCE and VENERATION of God. Profouud veneration of the Divine Being lies at the foundation of all religious wor- ship and obedience. But, in order to venerate God aright, we must know him ; and, in order to acquire the true know- ledge of him, we must contemplate him through the niedium of those works and dispensations, by which he dis{>lays the glories of his nature to the inhabitants of our world. I have already exhibited a few specin^ens of the stupendous opera- tions of his power, in that portion of the system of the uni- verse which lies open to our inspection ; and there is surely, no mind in which the least spark of piety exists, but must feel strong emotions of reverence and awe, at the thought of that Almighty and Incomprehensible Being, who impels the huge masses of the planetary globes, with so amazing a rapid- ity through the sky, and who has diversified the voids of space with so vast an assemblage of magniticent worlds. Even those manifestations of Deity which are coniincd Jo the glo])(3 we inhabit, when attentively considered, are calculated to rouse, even the unthinking laind, to astonishment and awe. The lofty mountains, and expansive plains, the mass of water in the mighty ocean, the thunders rolling along the sky, the lightnings flashing from cloud to cloud, the hurricane and ('lie tempest, the volcano vomiting rivers of fire, and the eartji- quake shaking kingdoms, and leveling cities with the ground — all proclaim the Majesty of Him, by whom the elements of Ug THE CHRISTIAN PIIILOSOPHER. natuic aie arranged and directed, and seem to address the sons of men in language like this : " The Lord reigneth, he, ;s clothed v.ith majesty; at his wrath the earth trembles; a iircgocth before him, and burncth up his enemies," — "Let 'ill the earth fear the Lord, let all the iuhabitants of the world Kind in awe of him,." There is one reason, among others, why the bulk of man- kind feel so little veneration of God, and that is, that they soldom contemplate, with fixed attention, " the operations of :as hands." If we wish to cherish this sublime Sentiment iri our hearts, v/e must familiarize our minds to frequent excur? sions over all those scenes of Creation and Providence, which the volume oif nature, and thp volume of inspiration unfold to view. We must endeavour to assist our conceptions to the graiideur of these objects, by every discovery which has been, or may yet be made, and by every mode of illustration by which a sublime and comprehensive idea of the particular object of contemplation may bo obtained. — If we v/ould wish to acquire some delinite, though imperfect conception of the physical extent of the universe, our minds niight be assisted by such illustrations as the following : — Liglit flies from the sun with a velocity of nearly two hunclred thousand miles in a moment of time, or, about L,400,000 times swifter than the motion of a cannon ball : Suppose that one of the highest order of intelligences is endowed with a power of rapid mo- tion superior to that of light, and with a corresponding degree of intellectual energy ; that he has been flying \yithout inter- mission, from one province of creation to another, for six thousand years, and will continue tlie same rapid course for a thousand millions of years to come ; it is highly probable, if- not absolutely certain, that, at the end of this vast tour, he AV'ould have advanced no farther than " the suburbs of crea- tion" — and that all the magnificent systems of material and intellectual beings he had surveyed, during bis rapid flight, and for such a length of ages, bear no more proportion to the vvhole Empire of Onmipotence, than the smallest grain of sand does to all the particlos of matter of the same size con t lined in ten thousand Vv orlds. ]S' or need we entertain the liast fear, that the idea of the extent of the Creator's power, « onvcyed by such a representation, exceeds the bounds of •ality. On the other hand, it must fall almost infinitely short .1 it. For, as the poet has justly observed — " Can in:\n conceive beyond what God can do ?" Were a seraph, in prosecuting the tour of creation in the -laruier now stated, ever to arrive at a limit beyond which no OMNIPOTENCE OF THE DEITY. ll farther displays of the Divinity could be perceived, the thought would overwhelm his faculties with unutterable anguish and horror : he would feel^ that he had na\y5 in some measure, comprehended all the plans and operations of Omnipotence, and that no farther manifestation of the Divine glory remained to be explored. But we may rest assured, that this can never happen in the case of any created intelligence. We have every reason to believe, both from the nature of an Infinite IJeing, and from the vast extent of creation already explored, (hat the invnense ma^s of material existence, and tJie endless variety of sensitive and intellectual beings Avith which the uni- verse is replenished, are intended by Jehovah, to present to his rational, offspring, a sjiadoiv, an emblem, or a rtpresenla- tion, (in, so far as fiiiito extended existence can be a repre- sentaj^ion,) of tl\e Iiijinite Perfections of his natin-e, which would otherwise hc^ve remained fqr ever impalpable to all subordinate iutelligeiices. In this mani.er, then, might we occasionally exercise our minds on the grand and diversified objects which the universe exhibits ; and, in praportion as we enlarge the sphere of our contemplations, in a similar proportion will our views of God himself be extended, and a corresponding sentiment of vene- ration impressed upon the mind. For the soul of man can- not venerate a mere abstract being, that was never manifested through a sensible medium, however many lofty terms may bo used to describe his perfections. It venerates that -Inef!a- ble Being, who conceals himself behind the scenes of Crea- tion, through the medium of the visible displays he exhibits of his Power, Wisdom, and Beneficence, in the Economy of Nature, and in the Records of Revelation. Before the uni- verse was formed, Jehovah existed alone, possessed of every attribute which he now displays. But, had only one solitary intelligence been created, and placed in the infinite void, without a material substratum beneath and around him, he could never have been animated with a sentiment of profound veneration for his Creator ; because no objects existed to ex- cite it, or to show, that hi^ Invisible Maker was invested with those attributes which he is now known to possess. Accor- dingly, we find, in the sacred writings, that, when a sentiment of reverence is deipanded from the sons of men, those sensi- ble objects which are calculated to excite the emotion, are uniformly exhibited. ',' Fear ye not me ? saith the Lord. — Will ye not tremble at my prcriicnce ? who have plncpr' *^ - sand for the bound of the sea, by a perpetual decree, that lit cannot pass it ; and though the waves ihereof toss themselves 5* .^3 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. vet they cannot prevail; though they roar, yet can they not >a?s oyer it." " Who would not fear thee, O liing of nations ? J'hoii art the true God, and an everiasting King. — Thou hast .ifide the earth by thy power, thou hast estabhshed the world y thy wisdom, thou hast stretched out the heavens by thy dis- retion. When thou utterest thy voice there is a noise of ,• aters in the heavens, thou causest the vapours to ascend ■; oiu the ends of the earth, thou makest lightnings with rain, [id bringest forth the winds out of iky treasures."* Ijut, however enlarged and venerabla conceptions of God , -o may derive from the manifestations of his poAver, they must fall infinitely short of what is due to a being of bound- less perfection. For there may be attributes in the Divine. Essence, of which we cannot possibly form the least concep- tion — attributes which cannot be shadowed forth or represent- ed by any portion of the material or inte.Uectual world yet dis- covered by us, or by all the mighty achievements by which hu- nian redemption was elfected — attributes which have not been yet displayed, in their effects, tcx the highest orders of intelli- gent existence. And, therefore, as that excellent philosopher and divine, the honorable Mr. Boyle, has well observed — " Our ideas of God, howeyer so great, will rather express the greatness of our veneration, tharx the Immen,sity of his Perfec- tions ; and the notions worthy of the most intelligent men, are far short of being worthy the incomprehensible God — the brightest idea wo can frame of God being infinitely inferior, nnd no more than a Parhelion'\ in respect of the sun ; for though that meteor is splendid, and resembles the sun, yet it resides in a cloud, and is not only much beneath the sun in distance, but inferior in bigness and splendor." In short, v^ere we ha1)itually to cherish that profoimd ven- eration of God which his works are calculated to^ inspire, Avith what hunulity would we approach the presence o.f this August Being! with what emotions of a\ye Avoidd we present our adorations ! and with what reverence would we talk of his inscrutable purposes, and incomprehensible operations I \\c would not talk about him, as some writers have done, with the same case and indillerence, as a mathematician would talk * Jcrcni. X. 7 — 13. j A PayheUcn or J\Joch-Snn, is a meteor in tUe form of a very bright ii-!it appearing on one side of the sun, and somewhat resembling tlie ap- t)i;irance of thai luminary. This phenomenon is supposed to be produced by the refraction and rcileclion of the sun's rays from a Avatcry cloud. — S.inc-tnncs throe or four of ilicse parlielia, all of lliem bearing a certain rc- •nmlanrc to the real sun, have been seen at one lime. QMNIPQTENCE OF T^E DEITY. 59 about the properties of a triangle, or a philosopher about the effects of a mechanical engine ; nor would we treat, with a spirit of levity, any of the solemn declarations of his word, or the mighty movements of his providence. We would be ever ready to join with ardor in the sublime devotions of the inspired writers, " Great and marvellous, are thy works, Lord God Almighty, just and true are thy ways, thou King of saints. Who would not fear thee, O Lord, and glorify thy pame? Let all the earth fear the Lord, let all the inhabitants of the world stand in awe of hini." Lastly, the views we have taken of the omnipotence and grandeur of the Deity are calculated to inspire us with hope and CONFIDENCE iu the prospect of thai eternal existence ivhich lies before us. The period of our existence in this terrestrial scene will soon terminate, and those bodies through which we now hold a cpiTOspondence with the visible creation, crumbled into dust. ' The gradual decay, and the ultimate dissolution of human bodies ^ present a, scene at which reason stands aghast; and, on a ' cursory survey of the chambers of the dead, it is apt to excUiini, in the language of despair, " Can these dry bones live 1" A thousand difficulties crowd upon the mind which appear repugnant to the idea, that ',' beauty shall again spring out of the ashes, and. life out of the dust." But, wUen we look abroad to the displays of Divine power and in- telligepce., in the wide expanse of Creation, we perceive that -r^- —"Almighty God Has done much more ; nor is his arm impaired Through length of days. — And what he can^ he will j His faithfulness stands bound to see it done." We perceive that he has created systems in such vast pro- fusion, that no man can number them. The worlds every moment under his superintendence and direction, are unques- tionably far more numerous than all the human beings who have hitherto existed, or will yet exist till the close of time. Ai^d, if he h[\s not only arranged the general features of each of these worlds!, aud established the physical la,ws, by which its economy is regulated, but has also arranged the diversified circumstances, and directs the minutest movements of the myriads ofsenshive and intellectual existences it contains, we ought never, for a moment, to doubti that the minutest parti- cles of every human body, however widely separated from each other, and mingled with other extraneous substances, are known to him whose presence pervades all space ; and that all the atoms requisite for the construction of the Resurrection- body will be re-assembled for this purpose " by the energy of CO THE ClIlHaTIAN rHiLOSOPIIEB. that mighty power, whereby he is able to subdue all things to hinisoir." If we suppose that a number of human beings, amounting to three hundred thousand millioiAS, shall start from tlie grave inta ne\v life, at the general resurrection, and that the atoms of each of these bodies are j^ust now under the si)ecial superintendence of the Ahnighty — and that, at least .in equal number of worlds are under his particular care and direction — the exertion of power and intelligence, in the for- mer case, cannot be supposed to be greater that what is requi- site in the latter. To a Being possess_ed of infinite power, conjoined with boundless Intelligence, the superintendence of countless atoms, and of countless worlds, is equally easy, whiu-e no contradiction is iiuplied,. For as tlie poet has well observed, — "He summons into being, Avitli like ease, A Nvliole creation, and a single grain." And since this subject tends to strengthen our hope ofa re-, surrection from the dead, it is also calculated to inspire us with confidence in the prospect of those eternal scenes which will burst upon the view, at the dissolution of all terrestrial things. Beyond the period fixed for the conflagration of this world, "a wide and unbounded prospect lies before us ;" and though, at present, " shadows-, clouds, and darkness rest upon it," yet the boundless magnificence of tlie Divine empire which science has unfolded, throw s a radiance over the scenes of futuiity, which is fraught with consolation in the view of " the wreck of matter a,nd the crush of worlds.'"^ ft opens to us a prospect of perpetual improvement in knowledge and felicity ; it pre- sents a field in which the human faculties may be for ever ex- panding, for ever contemplating new scenes of grandeur rising 'to the view, in boundless perspective, through an interminable succession of existence. It convinces us that the happiness of the eternal state will not consist in an unvaried repetition of the same perception and enjoyments, but that new displays of the Creator's glory will be continually bursting on the aston- ished mind, world, without end. And as we know the same beneficence and. care, which are displayed in the arrangement of systems of worlds, are also displayed in supporting and jM-oviding for the smallest microscopic animalcul;t*, we have no reason to harbor the least fear, lest we should be overlooked in the inunensity of creation, or lost amidst tji.e multiplicity of those works among which the Deity is incessantly employed ; for, as he is Omnipresent arid Omniscient, Ms care and ii.O.u- eiico mast cxlcuti to every creature he ha.s formed. Th(..e- WISDOM OF THE DEITY. 61 fore, though "the elements shall melt with fervent heat, and the earth, and all the works therein be dissolved, yet, we, ac- cording to his promise, look for new heavens and a new earth wherein dwcUeth riirhteousness," SECTION III, On the Wisdom and Intelligence of the Deity, In surveying the systeni of i^ature with a Christian and a Philosophic eye, it may be considered in different points of view. It may be viewed either as displaying the power and magnificence of the Deity, in the immense quantity of mate- rials of which it is composed, and in the august machinery and movements by which its economy is directed ; — or, as mani- festing his Vt^isdom, in the nice adaptation of every minute circumstance to the end it was intended to accomplish ; — or ^s illustrating his unbounded beneficence in the provision which is made for the accommodation and happiness of the numerous trib^es of sentient and intelligent beings it contains. Having, in the preceding section, endeavored to exhibit some of those objects which evince the Omnipotence of Deity, anc: the pious emotions they are calculated to excite, I shall now offer a few popular illustrations of Divine Wisdom, as display- ed in the arrangements of the material v/oild — which shall chiefly be confined to those objects which are most prominent and obvious to the vulgar eye. Wisdom is that perfection of an intelligent agent, by which he is enabled to select and employ the most proper means in order to accomjilish a good and important end. It includes the idea of knowledge or intelligence, but may be distinguished from it. Knowledge is opposed to ignorance, wisdom is op- posed to folly or error in conduct. As applied to God, it may be considered as comprehending the operations of his Omni- science and benevolence, or, in other words, his knowledge to discern, and his disposition to choose those means and ends which are calculated to promote the order and the happiness of the universe. The Wisdom of God is, doubtless, displayed in every ar- rangem^ent he has made throughout all the provinces of his immense and eternal kingdom, however far they may be re- moved from the sphere of humetn observation. But it is only 62 THE eilRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. in those parts of ihc system of nature which lie open to our particular investigation, that the traces of this perfection can be distinctly perceived. The Heavens declare the glory of God's AVisdom, as well as of his Power. The planetary sys- tem — that portion of the heavens with which we are best ac- quainted — disi)lays both the magnificence and the skill of its Di\ine Author, — in the magnitudes, distances, revolutions, proportions, and uses of the various globes of which it is com- posed, and in the diversified apparatus by which light and darkness are alternately distributed. The sun, an immense luminous world, by far the largest body in the system, is ])laced in the centre. No other position would have suited for an equable distribution of iUumiuation and heut through the dif- ferent parts of the system. Around \\\m^ at ditlerent distances, eleven primary planets revolve, accompanied with eighteen secondaries, or moons, — all in majestic order and harmony, no one interrupting the movements of another, but invariably keej)ing the paths prescribed them, and performing their revo- lutions" in their appointed times. To all these revolving globes, the sun dispenses motion, light, heat, fertility, and other unceasing eniBrgies, for the comfort and happiness of their respective inhabitants — without which, perpetual sterility, eternal winter, and eternal night, would reign over every re- gion of our globe, and throughout surrounding worlds. The distance at which the heavenly bodies, particularly the sun, are placed from the earth, is a manifest evidence of Di- vine Wisdom. If the sun were mucl^ nearer us than he is at present, the earth, as nqw constituted, would be wasted and parched with excessive heat ; the waters would be turned into vapor, and the rivers, seas, and oceans, would soon disappear, leaving nothing behind them but frightful ba.rren dells and gloomy caverns ; vegetation woidd co,nq)letely cease, and the tribes of animated nature languish and die. On the other hand, were the sun much farther distant than he now is, or were his bulk, or the influcDce of his rays, diminished one half of what they now are, the ia,nd au,d the ocean would soon be- come one frozen mass, and universal desolation and sterility would overspread the fair face of natiu-e, and, instead of a pleasant and comfortable abode, our globe would become a frightful desert, a state of misery and perpetual punishment.* ^ It forms no oUjcction to those remarks, that calorie, or the matter ot heal, does not a!tojj,-.ot)).er depend npon the direct influence of the solar rays. Tlie sui)stance of calori'i m iy be cliiefly coiniectcd \v\t\\ the constitution •jf tlie 2;lobe y\c inhabit. Hut still, it is quite certain, that the earth, as areseuUyconstUuliil, would siiiTcr t;0ects most disastrous to sentient beinta. WISDOM OF THE DEITF. 63 But herein is the vvisdom tifGod disphiyed, that he has formed the sun of siich ^ determintlte size, and placed it at such a convenient distance, as not td annoy, but to refresh and cheer us, and to enliven the soil with its genial influence ; so that we plainly perceive, to use the language of the prophet, that " He hath established the world by his wisdom, and stretched out the heavens by his understanding." The rotation of the several planetary globes around their axis, to produce the alternate succession of day and night, strikingly demonstrates the \\ isdom and benevolence of their great Author. Were the earth and the other planetary worlds destitute of a diurnal motion, only one half of their surfaces could be inhabited, and the other half would remain a dark and cheerless desert; The sun would be the only heavenly orb which would b6 recognized by (he inhabitants of each respect- ive world, as existing in the uhiversc, and that scene of gran- deur which night unfolds ill the boundless expanse of the sky, would be for ever veiled from their view. For^ it appears to be one grand design of the Cieator, in giving these bodies a diurnal motion, not only to cheer their inhabitants with light and warmth, and the gay colouring j^irddtlced by the solar rays ; but also to opell to them a prospect of otHel* portions of his vast dominions, which are dispersed in endless variety throughout the illimitable regions of space ; ih order th^tt they may acquire a more sublime impression of the glory of his kingdom, and of his eternal Power and Godhead. BiJtj were perpetual day to irradiate the planets, it would throw an eter- nal and impenetrable veil over the glories of the sky, behind which, the magnificent operations of Jehovah's power would be, in a great measufe, concealed. It is this circumstance which we should consider its the principal reason why a rota- tory motion has been impressed on the planetary globes ; and not merely that a curtain of darkness might be thrown around their inhabitants, during the repOse of sleep, as in the world in which we dwell. For, iii some of the other planetary worlds belonging to our system, the Intelligent beings with which they are peopled, may stand in no need of that fiocturnal repose which is necessary for nuin ; their physical powers may be in- capable of being impaired, and their mental energies may be wore it removed much nearer to, or much flirthcr from the central kmiinary. Those phinets wliicli are removed several hundreds of millions of miles ffirthcr from the sim than our i!;lobe, may possibly experience a degree of lieat much greater than oius ; but, in this case, tlic constitution of the soUd parts of tiiese globes, and ol" their surrounding!, aiaiosphuits, must be very rliflorf^nt from what obtoins in the nbv.sicrjl .uriiu.sieaicuts r.f mmv irlnt.»> C4 THE CHHISTIAN PHILOSOPHER; in perpetual exercise; And in some of those bodies whicK are surrounded with an assemblage of rings and moons, as the planet Saturn, the diversified grandeur of their celestial phe~ nomena, in the absence of the sun, may present a scene of contemplation and enjoyment, far more interesting than all the splendours of their noon-day. Besides, had the planets no motion round their axis, and were both their hemispheres supposed to be peopled with inhabitants, their physical state and enjoyments would be as opposite to each other, as if they jived uilder the government of two distinct independent be- ings. While the one class w as basking under the splendors of perpetual day^ the other would be involved in all the horrors of an everlasting night. While the one hemisphere would be parched with excessive heat, the other woiild be bound in the fetters of eternal ice ; and^ in such a globe as ours, the mo tion of the tides^ the ascent of the vapors, the currents of the atmosphere, the course of the winds, the benign influences of the rains and dews, and a thousand other movements which produce so many salutary and beneficial eflects would be completely deranged. Hence we find that in all the planetary bodies on which observations can conveniently be made, a rotatory motion actually exists, in the secondary, as well as in the primary planets, and even in the sun himself, the centre, and the mover of the whole : in which arrangement of the Al- mighty Creator, the evidences of wisdom and design are Strikmgly apparent. This amazing scene of Divine workmanship and skill, which the planetary system exhibits, we have reason to be- lieve, is multiplied, and diversified, to an indefinite extent, throughout all the other systems of creation, displaying to the intelligences of every region, " the manifold wisdom of God." For there can be no question, that every star we now behold, either by the naked eye, or by the help of a telescope, is the centre of a system of planetary worlds, Avhcre the agency of God, and his unsearchable wisdom, may be endlessly varied, and, perhaps, more strikingly displayed than even in the sys- tem to which we belong. These vast globes of light coula never have been designed merely to shed a few glimmering rays on our far distant world ; for the ten thousandth part of them has never yet been seen by the inhabitants of the earth, since the Mosaic creation, except by a few astronomers of the past and tiie present age ; and the light of many of them, in all probability, has never yet reached us ; and perhaps never will, till the period of "the consummation of all terres- frlal thine:?'." They were not made in vam : for ivMch a ^^up- THE WISDOM OF THE DEITY, 65 position would be inconsistent with every idea we can form of the attributes of a Being of infinite perfection. They were not iritendef^- ttaoi-cIv io diversify the voids of infinite spfice with a useless splendor, whifch has no .relation to jntellectuai natures ; for this would give us a most distorted and inconsist- ent idea of the character of Him who is " the only wise God ;" and we are told, by an authority \yhicli cannot bo questioned; that " by ht« wisdom he made the heavens, and stretched them out by his understanding." The only rational conclusion, therefore, which co,h be deduced, is, that they are destined to distribute illumination and splendor, vivifying influence, and happinessj among incalculable numbers of intelligent beings, of various degrees of physical, moral, and intellectual excel- lence. And; wherever the Creator has exerted his Almighty energies in the production of sensitive and intellectual natures, we may rest assured, that there also, his infinite wisdom and mtelligence, in an endless variety of arrangements, contriv- ances, and adaptations, are unceasingly displayed. But, after all, whatever evidences of contrivance and design the celestial globes may exhibit^ it is not in the heavens that the most striking displays of Pivine wisdom can be traced by the inhabitants of our world. It is only a ^q\v general relations and adaptations that can be distinctly perceived among the orbs of the firmament ; though, in so far as we are able to triace the purposes which they subserve^ the marks of beauty, order, and design^ are Uniformly apparent. But we are placed at too great a distance from the orbs of heaven, to be able to inves- tigate the particular arrangements which enter into the physi- cal and moral economy of the celestial worlds. Were we transported to the surface of the planet Jupiter, and had an opportunity of surveyings at leisure^ the regions of that vast globe, and the tribes of sensitive and intellectual existence which compose its population — of contemplating the relations of its moons to the pleasure and comfort of its inhabitants — the constitution of its atmosphere as to its reflective and re- fractive powers, in producing a degree of illumination to com- pensate for the great distance of that planet from the sun — its adaptation to the functions of animal life— the construction of the visual organs of its inhabitants, and the degree of sensi- bility they possess corresponding to the quantity of light re- ceived from the sun — the temperature of the surface and atmos- phere of this globe corresponding to its distance from the cen- tral source of heat^ and to the physical constitution of sensi- tive beings — in short, could we investigate tlie relations which inanimate nature,- in all its varieties and sublin)itiesi bears td (i 60 tnt CiitUSTIAN PHlLOSOPiU.R. the necessities and the happiness of the animated existences that traverse its different regions, we should^ doubtless, behold a scene of Divine Wisdom and intelligence, far more admira- ble and astonishing than even that which is exhibited in our sublunary world* — But since it is impossible for us to investi- giate the econom}^ of other worldsj while We are chained down to this terrestrial sphere^ we must direct our attention to those arrangements and contrivances in the constitution of our own globcj which lie open to our particular inspection^ in order to perceive more distinctly the benevolent designs of Him " in whom we live and move^ and have our being." And here an attentive observer will find, in almost every objectj when min- utely examined, a display of goodness and intelligence, which will constrain him to exclaim, " O the depth of the riches both of the wisdom and the knowledge of God." Wisdom^ considered as consisting in contrivance, or the se- lection of the most proper means in order to accomplish an important end, may be exemplified and illustrated in a variety of familiar objects in the scene of nature. The earth on which we tread, was evidently intended by the Creator to support meln and other animals, along with their habitationsj and to furnish those vegetable productions which are necessary for their subsistence; and, accordinglyj he has given it that exact degree of consistency which is requisite for these purposes. Were it much harder than it now is ; were it, for example^ as dense as a rock, it would be incapable of cultivation, and vegetables could not be produced from its surface. Were it softer, it would be insufficient to support us, and we should sink at every step, like a person walking in a quagmire. Had this circumstance not been attended to in its formation, the earth would have been rendered useless as a habitable world, for all those aninictted bein^rs Mhich now trav- erse its surface. The exact adjustment of the solid parts of our globe to the nature and necessities of the beings which inhabit it, is, therefore, an instance, and an evidence of Wis- dom. The diversity of surface which it every where presents^ in the mountains and vales with which it is variegated, indicates the same benevolent contrivance and design. If the earth were divested of its mountains, and its surface every where uniformly smooth, there would be no rivers, springs, or foun^ tains ; for water can flow only Worn a higher to a lower place ; the vegetable tribes would droop and languish; man and other animals would be deprived of what is nc^cessary for their exis- tf.'nce and co'?!'.V>vt ; wo ishuuld be 'l"'^'*:V'te of mnnv nsfful MOUNTAINS. ^T stones, minerals, plants, and trees, which are now produced on the surface, and in the interior of mountains ; the sea itself would become a stagnant marsh, or overflow the land ; and the whole surface of nature in oin- terrestrial sphere, would present an unvaried scene of dull uniformity. Those picturesque and sublime scenes which fire the imagination of the poet, and which render mountainous districts so pleasing to the philosophic tra- veller, would be completely withdrawn ; and all around, when compared with such diversified landscapes, would appear as fatiguing to the eye as the vast solitudes of the Arabian de- serts, or the dull monotony of the ocean. But in consequence of the admirable distribution of hills and mountains over the surface of our globe, a variety of usetul and ornamental effects is produced. Their lofty summits are destined by providence to arrest the vapors which float in the regions of the:=air; their internal cavities Ibrm so many spacious basins for the recep- tion of waters distilled from the clouds ; they are the original sources of springs and rivers, which water and fertilize the earth ; they form immense magazines, in which av^ deposited stones, metals, and minerals, which are of so essential service in the arts that promote the comfort of human life ; they serve for the production of a vast variety of herbs and trees ; they arrest the progress of storms and tempests ; they aflbrd shcl^ ter and entertainment to various animals which minister to the wants of mankind : In a word, they adorn and embellish the face of nature — they form thousands of sublime and beautiful landscapes, and afford from their summits the most delightful prospects of the plahis below. All these circumstances de-s monstrate the consummate wisdoni of the Great Architect of nature, and lead us to conclude, that mountains, so f^r from being rude excrescences of nature, as some have asserted, form an essential part in the constitution, not only of our globe, but of all habitable worlds. And this conclusion is confirmed, so far as our observation extends, with regard to the moon, and several of the planetary bodies which belong to our system, whose surfaces are found to be diversified by sublime ramifi^ cations of mountain scenery ; which circumstance forms one collateral proof, among many others, that they are the abodes qX sentient and intellectual beings. Again, the coloring which is spread over the face of nature indicates the wisdom of the Deity. It is essential to the pre- sent mode of our existence, ar^d it was evidently intended by the Creator, that we should be enabled easily to recognize the forms and properties of the various objects with which we are surrounded, lint were the objects of nature destitute of color, 68 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. or were the same unvaried hue spread over the face of' crea- tion, we should be destitute of all the entertainments of vision, and be at a loss to distinguish one object from another. We should be unable to distinguish rugged precipices from fruitful hills ; naked rocks from human habitations ; the trees from the hills that beai- them, and the tilled from the untilled lands. ^* We should hesitate to pronounce whether an adjacent en- closure contain a piece of pasturage, a plot of arable land, or a iield of corn ; and it would require a little journey, and a mi- nute investigation J to determine such a point. We could not determine whether the ifirst person we met were a soldier in his regimentals, or a s^yain in his Sunday suit ; a bride in her ornaments, or a widow in her weeds." Such would have been the aspect of natm-e, and such the inconveniences to which we should have been subjected, had God allowed us light, without the distinction of colors. We could have dis-. tinguished objects only by intricate trains of reasoning, and by circumstances of time, place, and relative position. And, to what delays and perplexities should we have been reduced, had we been obliged every moment to distinguish one thing from another by reasoning \ Our whole life must then have been employed, rather iii study than in action ; and, after all, we must have remained in eternal uncertainty a.s to many, things, which are now quite obvious to every one as soon as jie opens his eyes. We could neither have communicated our thoughts by writing, nor have derived instruction from others through the medium of books: so that we should now have heen almost as ignorant of the transactions of past ages, as we are of the events which are passing in the planetary worlds ; and, consequently, we could never have enjoyed a written revelation from heaven, nor any other i^ifallible guide to direct us in the path to happiness, if the Almighty had not distinguished the rays of light, and painted the objects around us with a diversity of colors,^so essentially connected are the minutest, and the most magnificent works of Deity. But now, in the present constitution of things, color characterizes the class to which every individual belongs, a^d indicates, upon the first inspection, its respective quality. Every object wears its peculiar livery, and has a distinguishing mark by which it is characterized. ' Tl:^e different hues which are spread over the scenery of the world, are also highly ornamental to the face of nature, and afford a variety of pleasures to the eye, and the imagination. It is this circumstance which adds a charm to the fields, the valleys, and the hills, the lofty mountain, the wincUng rivei^ COLORS. G9 and the expansive lake ; and which gives a splendor and sublimity to the capacious vault of heaven. Color is, there- fore, an essential requisite to every norld inhabited by sensi- tive beings ; and we know, that provision has been made for diffusing it throughout all the globes which may exist in the distant regions which our telescopes have penetrated ; for the light which radiates from the most distant stars is capable of being separated into the prismatic colors, similar to those which are produced by the solar rays ; which furnishes a pre- sumptive proof that they are hitended to accomplish designs in their respective spheres analogous to those which light sub- serves in our terrestria.1 habitation, — or, in other words, that they are destined to convey to the minds of sentient beingSj impressions of light and color, and, consequently, beings sus- ceptible of such impressions must reside within the sphere, oi inca-e immediate influence of these far distant orbs. The same benevolent design is apparent in the general color which prevails throughout the scene of sublunarij nature. H^d the fields been clothed witU hues of a deep redx or o, brilliant white, the eye would have been dazzled with the splendor of their aspect. Had a dark-blue, or a black color generally prevailed, it would have cast a universal gloom over the face of nature. But an agree^^ble gree^ holds the medium between these two extremes, equally remote from a dismal gloom and excessive splendor, and bears such a, relation to. the structure of the eye, that it refreshes, instead of tiring it, and supports, instead of diminishing it:^ force. At the same time, though one general color prevails over the landscape of the earth, it is diversified by an admirable variety of shac|es^ so that every individual object in the vegetable world ca,n be accnmtely dis- tinguished from another ; thus producing a beautiful and varie- gated appearance over the whole scenery of nature. "Who sees not in all these things, that the hand of the Lord hath wrought this 1" If from the earth we turn our attention to the waters, we shall perceive similar traces of the exquisite wisdom and skill of the Author of nature. Water is one of the most essential elementary parts in the constitution of our globe, without which the various tribes of beings which now people it could not exist. It supplies a necessary beveiage to man, and to all the animals that people the earth and the air. It forms a solvent for a great variety of solid bodies ; it is the element in which an infinitude of organized beings pass their existence ; it acts an important part in conveying life and nourishment to all the ic^m^ c?f IhG vegetable kingdom, and gives salubrity to tho 6* 70 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. atmospherical regions. Collected in immense masses in the basins of the sea, it serves as a vehicle for ships, and as a me- dium of communication between people of the most distant lands. Carried along with a progressive motion over the beds of streams and of rivers, it gives a brisk impulse to the air, and prevents the umvholesome stagnation of vapors ; it re- ceives the filth of populous cities, and rids them of a thousand* nuisances. By its impulsion it becomes the mover of a mul- titude of machines ; and, when rarified into steam, it ia trans- tormed into one of the most powerful and useful agents under the dominion of man. All which beneficial effects entirely depend on the exact degree of density, or specific gravity, which the Creator has given to its constituent parts. Ha^ it been much more rarified than it is, it would have been alto- gether unfit to answer the purposes now specified ; the whole face of the earth would have been a dry and barren wastes vegetable nature could not have been nourished ; our floating edifices could not have "^een supported ; the lightest bodies would have sunk, aitd all regular intercourse with distant nations would have been prevented. On the other hand, had its parts been much denser than they ai"e ; for example, had they been ofthe consistency of a thin jelly, similar disastrous effects would have inevitably followed ; no ships could have ploughed the ocean ; no refreshing beverage would have been supplied to the animal tribes ; the absorbent vessels of trees, her])s and flowers, would have been unable to imbibe the moisture requisite far their nourishment ; and we should thus have been deprived of all the beneficial eflects we now derive from the use of that liquid element, and of all the diversified scenery of the vegetable world. But the configuration and consistency of its parts are so nicely adjusted to the constitu- tion of tlie other elements, and to the wants of the sensitive and vegetal>le tribes, as exactly to subserve the ends intended in the system of nature. Water has been ascertained- to be a compound body formed l)y the union of two diflcrent kinds of air — oxygen and hydro- gen. It has the property of becoming, in certain cases, much lighter than air ; though, in its natural liquid state, it is 800 times heavier than that fluid ; and has also the property of afterwards resuming its natural Vvcight. Were it not for'this j)roperty, evaporation could not be produced; and, conse- quently, n.> clouds, rain, nor dew, could be fomied, to Avater and fertdize the different regions of the earth. But, in con- fejecpience of ihis wonderful property, the ocean becomes an mexhaustible cistern to our world. " From its expansive sur- WATERS. 71 flice are exhaled those vapors which supply the rivers, and nourish ihe vegetable productions of every land. " The air and the sun," says an elegant writer, '' constitute the mighty engine which works without intermission to raise the liquid treasures ; while the clouds serve as so many aqueducts to convey them along the atmosphere, and distribute them, at seasonable periods, and in r^^gular proportions, through all the regions of the globe." Notwithstanding the properties now stated, motion ivas siill requisite, to ensure all the advantages we now derive from the liquid element. Had the whole mass of waters been in a stagnant state, a thousand inconveniences and disastrous consequences would have inevitably ensued. But tke All- Wise Creator has impressed upon its various masses a circu- lating motion, which preserves its purity, and widely extenck its beneticial influence. The rills pour their liquid stores into the rivers ; the rivers roll their watery treasures into the ocean ; the waters of the ocean, by a libratory motion, roll backwards and forwards every twelve hours, and, by means of currents, and the force of winds, are kept in constant agitation. By the solar heat, a portion of these waters is carried up into the atmosphere, and, in the form of clouds, is conveyed by the winds over various regions ; till, at last, it descends in rain and dew, to supply the springs " which run among the hills." So that there is a constant motion and circulation of the watery element, that it may serve as an agent for carrying forward the various processes of nature, and for ministering to the wants of man and beast. In fine, were the waters in a state of perpetual stagnation, tlie filth of populous cities would be accumulated to a most unwholesome degree ; the air would be filled with putrid ex- halations, and the vegetable tribes would languish and die. Wer« they deprived of the property of being evaporated, (in which state they occupy a space 1400 times greater than in their liquid state,) rain and dew could" never be produced, and the earth would be turned into " a dry and parched wilder- ness ;" neither grass nor corn could be sufficiently dried to lav up for use ; oiir clothes, when washed, could never be dried; and a variety of common operations, which now conduce to our convenience and comfort, could never be carried on. But the infinite wisdom of the Creator, foreseeing all the cfl^ects which can possibly arise from these principles of na- ture, has effectually provided against such disasters, by arrang- ing all things, in number, weight, and measure, to subserve the 72 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. bcnelicial ends for which they were ordained. " He caiisetn the vapors to ascend from the ends of the earth ; he sendeth the springs into the valleys, which run among the hills. They ijive drink to every beast of the field ; the wild asses quench their thirst. By them the fowls of heaven are refreshed, which .sing among the branches. He watereth the hills from his chambers, and the earth is satisfied with the fruit of his works." Let us now attend to the atmosphere, in the constitution ot whicli the wisdom of God is no less conspicuous than in th^ other departments of nature. The atmosphere is one of the most essential appendages to the globe we inhabit, and exhibits a most striking scene of Divine skill and omnipotence. The term atmosphere is ap- plied to the whole mass of fluids, consisting of air, vapors, electric fluid, and other matters, which suiTOund the earth to a certain height. This mc\ss of fluid matter gravitates to the earth, revolves with it in its diurnal rotation, and is carried along with it in its course ro.und the sun every year. It has been computed to extend about 45 miles above the earth's surface, and it presses on the earth with a force proportioned to its height and density. From experiments made by the barometer, it has been ascertained, that it presses with a weight of about 15 pounds on every square inch of the earth's surface ; and, therefore, its pressure on the body of a middle- sized man, is equal to about 32,000 lbs. qy 14 tons avoirdu- pois, a pressure which would be insupportable, and even fatal, were it not equal in every part, and counterbalanced by the spring of the air within us. The pressure of the whole atmos- phere upon the earth, is computed to be equivalent to that of a. globe of lead 60 miles in diameter, or about 5,000,000,000,- 000,000 tons ; that is, the whole mass of air which surrounds the globe, compresses the earth with a force or power equal to that of fwe thousand millions of millions of ions.* This amazing pressure is, however, essentially necessary for the preservation of the present constitution of our globe, and of ihe animated beings which dwell on its surface. It prevents the heat of the sun from converting water, and all other fluids an the face of the earth, into vapor ; and preserves the ves- sels of all organized beings in due tone and vigor. Were the atmospherical pressure entirely removed, the elastic fluids contained in the finer vessels of men and other animals, would * Sec x\ppeiKlix, No. II. ATMOSPHERE. ^3 inevitably burst tbem, and life would become extinct ;* and most of the substances on the face of the earth, particularly liquids, would be dissipated into vapor. The atmosphere is now ascertciined to be a compound sub- stance,^ formed of two very diftbrent ingredients, termed oxij- g-e/i. and nitrogen gas. Of 100 measures of atmospheric air 21 are oxygen, and 79 nitrogen. The one, namely, oxygen, is the principle of combustion, and the vehicle of heat, and is absolutely necessary for the support of animal life, and is the most powerful and energetic agent in nature. The other, is altogether incapable of supporting either fiame or animal life. Were we to breathe oxygen air, without any mixture or alloy, our animal spirits would be raised, and the fluids in our bodies would circulate with greater rapidity ; but we should soon in- fallibly perish by the rapid and unnatural accumulation of heat in the animal fi-ame. If the nitrogen were extracted from the air, and the whole atmosphere contained nothing but oxygen, or vital air, combustion would not proceed in that gradual manner ^yhich it now does, but with the most dreadful and irresistible rapidity : not only wood and coals, and other substances now used for fuel, buf even stones, iron, and other metallic substances, would blaze with a rapidity which would carry destruction through the whole expanse of nature. If even the proportions of the two airs were materially altered, a variety of pernicious effects would instantly be produced. If the oxygen were less in quantity than it now is, fire would lose its strength, candles would not diffuse a sufficient light, and animals would perform their vital functions with the utmost difficulty and pain. On the other hand, were the nitrogen diminished, and the oxygen increased, the air taken in by res- piration would be more stimulent, and the circulation of the animal fluids would become accelerated ; but the tone of the * The necessity of the atmospherieal pressure, for the comfort and pre- servation of animal Hfe, might be iUustrated by the effects experienced by tliose who have ascended to the summits of very high mountains, or who have been carried to a gi-eat height above the surface of the earth in balloons. Acosta, in his relation of a journey among the mountains of l^eru, states, that "he and his companions were surprised with such extreme pangs of straining and vomiting, not without casting up of blood too, and with so violent a distemper, that they would undoubtedly have died had they remained two or three hours longer in that elevated situa- tion." Count Zambeccari, and his companions, who ascended in a balloon, on the 7th of November, 1783, to a great height, found their iitinds and feet so swelled, that it was necessary for a surgeon to make incisions in the skin. In both the cases now stated, the persons ascended to so great a lieiglit, that the pressure of the atmosphere was not sufficient; to counterbalance the pressui-e of the fluids of the body. 74 THE CHRISTIAN PHILQSOPHER, vessels thus stimulated to increased action, would be destroy ed, by too great an excitement, and the body would inevitably waste and decay. Again, were the oxygen completely ex- tracted from the atmosphere, and nothing but nitrogen remain- ed, fire and flame would be extinguished, and instant destruc- tion would be carried throughout all the departments of vege-i table and animated nature. For a lighted taper will not burn for a single moment in nitrogen gas, and if an animal be plunged into it, it is instantly suffocated. Again, not only the extraction of any one of the component parts of the atmosphere, or the alteration of their respective proportions, but even the slightest increase or diminution of their specific gi-avity, would be attended with the most dis- astrous effects. The nitrogen is found to be a httle lighter than common air, which enables it to rise towards the higher regions of the atmosphere. In breathing, the air which is evolved from the lungs, at every expiration, consists chiefly of nitrogen, which is entirely unlit to be breathed again, and therefore rises above our heads before the next inspiration. — Now, had nitrogen, instead of being a little lighter, been a slight degree heavier than common air, or of the same specific gravity, it would have accumulated on the surface of the earth, and particularly in our apartments, to such a degree as to have produced diseases, pestilence, and death, in rapid succession. But being a little lighter than the surrounding air, it fiies up- wards, and we never breathe it again, till it enter into new and salutary combinations. Such is the benevolent skill which the Author of Nature has displayed, for promoting the com- fort and preservation of every thing that lives.* Farther, were the air colored, or were its particles much larger than they are, we could never obtain a distinct view of * The necessity of atmospherical j^ir for the svippovt of life, was stri- kingly exemplified in the fate of the unhappv men Avho died in the Black- hole of Calcutta. On the 20Lh of June, 1756, about 8 o'clock in the evening, 146 men were forced, at the point of the bayonet, into a dungeon only 18 feet square. They had been but a few minutes confined in this infernal prison, before every one fell into a perspiiation so profuse, that no idea can be formed of it. This brought on a raging thirst, the most diffi- pult respiration, and an outrageous delirium. Such was the horror at their situation, that every insult that could be devised against the guard "VVilhout, and all the opjirobrious names that the Viceroy and his officers could be loaded with, were repeated, to provoke the guard to fire upon them, t^nd terminate their sufiermgs. Before 1 1 o'clock the same evening^ one:thn-d of the men were dead ; and before 6 next morninc:, only 23 came out ahye, but most of thcin in a high putrid fever. AUlhese dreadful, pflects were occasioned by the want of atmosj)herie air, and by their breathmg a snperabuiulant quantity of the nitn.gcn emitted from tlieif Umirs. ATMOSPHERE. 75 any other object. The exhalations which rise fiohi ihc earth, beino- rendered visible, would disfigure the rich landscape of the universe, and render lifb disagreeable. But the Almighty^ by rendering the air invisible, has enabled us not only to take a delightful and distinct survey of the objects that surround us, but has veiled from our view the gross huinors incessant- ly perspired from animal bodies, the filth exhaled from kitchens, streets, and sewers, and every other object that would excite disgust. Again, ?rere the different j)ortions oj the atmosphere comfJetehj stationarij, and not susceptible of agitation, all nature would soon be thrown into confusion; The vapors which are exhaled from the sea by the heat of the sun would be suspended, and remain for ever fixed over thosd places from whence they arose; For want of this agitation of the air, which now scatters and disperses the clouds over every region^ the sun would constantly scorch some districts^ and be for ever hid from others ; the "balance of nature would be destroyed ; navigation would be useless, and we could no iono^er enjoy the productions of different climates. In fine,' were the atmosphere capable of being frozen, or converted into a solid mass, as all other fluids are, (and we know nd reason why it should not be subject to cong-[?lation, but the will of the Creator,) the lives of every animal in the air, the waters, and the earth, would, in a few moments, be complete- ly extinguished. But the admirable adjustment of every cir- cumstance, in relation to this useful element, produces all the beneficial effects which we now experience, and strikingly de- monstrates, that the Intelligent Contriver of all things is " wonderful in counsel^ and excellent in working." From the instances now stated ^ we may plainly perceive^ that if the Almighty had not a particular regard to the happi- ness of his intelligent ofispring, and to the comfort of every animated existence ; or, if he wished to inflict summary pun- ishment on a wicked world, he could easily eflect, by a very slight change in the constitution of the atmosphere, the entire destructionof the human race^ and the entire conflagration of the great globe they inhabit^ — throughout all its elementary re- gions. He has only to extract one of its constituent parts, and the grand catastrophe is at once accomplished. With what a striking propriety and eniphasis, then, do the inspired writers declare, that, " In Him we live, and move, and have our being ;" and that " in His hand is the soul of every living thing, and the breath of all mankind !" A irreat variety of other arhnirnblG -properties is possessed bv the atniosi)hcro, ofwhi^ :i I rihail hricily uolice oiily llic ibl- 73 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. lowing : — It is the vehicle of smells, by which we become ac- quainted with the qualities of the food which is set before us, and learn to avoid those places which are damp, unwholesome, and dangerous. II is the medium of sounds, by means of which knowledge is conveyed to our niinds. Its undulations, like so many couriers, run fOr ever backwards and forwards, to convey our thoughts to Others, and theirs to us ; and to btiiig hews of transactions which frequently occur at a consi- derable distance. A few strokes on a large bell, through the ministration of the air, will convey signals of distress^ or of joy, iii a quarter of a minute, to the population of a city con- taining a hundred thousand inhabitants. So that the air may be considered as the conveyer of the thoughts of mankind, which are the cement of society. It transmits to our ears all the harmonies of music, and expresses every passion of the Soul : it swells the notes of the nightingale, and distributes alike to every ear the pleasures which arise from the harmo- nious sounds of a concert. It produces the blue color of the 5ky, and is the cause of the morning and the evenii>g twilight, by its property Of bending the rays of light; and reflecting them in all directions. It forms an essential requisite fOr carrying on all the processes of the vegetable kingdom^ and serves for the production of clouds, rain, and dew, which nourish and fertilize the earth. In short, it would be impossible to enume- rate all the advantages we derive from this noble appendage to our world. Were the earth divested of its atmosphere, or were only two or three of its properties changed or destroyed, it would be left altogether unfit for the habitation of sentient beings Were it divested of its undulating quality; we should be deprived of all the advantages of speech and conversation — ^of all the melody of the feathered songsters, and of all the pleasures of music ; and; like the deaf and dumb, we could have no power of communicating our thoughts but by visible signs. Were it deprived of its reflective powers^ the sun would appear iii one part of the sky of a dazzling brightness, while all around would appear as dark as midnight^ and the stars would be visible at noon-day* Were it deprived of its refrdctive powers; instead of the gradual approach of the day and the night which we now experience, at sunrise, we should be transpcii-ted all at once from midnight darkness to the s]>len- dor of noon-day : and; at sun-set, should make a sudden tran- sition from the splendors Of day to all the horrors of midnight, which would'bewilder the traveller in his journey, and strike the creati(jn with an;ject, I shall just notice one circumstance more, which hafl a relation both to the waters and to tlie atmosphere. It is a well known law of nature, that all bodies are expanded by heat, and contracted by cold. There is only one exception to this hnv which exists in the ccoiiomj^ of our globe, and that is, the c.rpansion of writer^ hi ihe act of freeziuf^;. — -While the parts of every other body are reduced in biilk,and (heir specific gravity increased by the application of cold ; water, on the contrary, when coiigealed into ice, is 'increased in bidk, and becomes of a less specific gravity than the surrounding water, and, there- fore, swims upon its siirface. Now, had the case been other- V, ise ; had \vater, when deprived of a portion of its heat, fol- lowed thegciieral law of nature, and, like all other bodies, be- come specifically heavier than it was before, the present con- stitution of nature vroukl have been materially deranged, and many of om- present comforts, and even our very existence, ^vould have been endangered. At whateyer time the tempera- ture of the atmosphere became reditced to 32'' of the common thermometer, or to what is called the freezing point, the water on the surface of our rivers and lakes woiild have been con- verted into a layer of ice ; this layer would have sunk to the bottom as it froze ; another layer of ice would have been im- mediately produced, which would also have sunk to ihe former layer, and so on in succession^ till, iii the course of time, all our rivers from the surface to the bottom, and every other por- tion of water, capable of being frozen, would have been con- verted into solid masses of ice, which all the heat of summer could never htive melted. We should have been deprived of most of the advantages we now derive from the liquid ele- ment, and, in a short time, the face of nature would have •3e<', transformed into a frozen chaos. But in the existing co.;: r tution of things, all such dismal effects are prevented, in crn sequence of the Creator having subjected the waters to a lavv contrary to that of other fluids, by means of which the frozen water swims upon the surface, and prevents the cold from penetrating to any great depth in the subjacent fluid ; and when the heat of the atmosphere is increased, it is exposed to its genial influence, and is quickly changed into its former liquid state. How admirably, then, does this excepiion to the general law of nature (lisj^lay the infinite intelligence of the ^rrs'at v'onlrivfT of all IhiuH'-^, a'ld his providential ciM'C (or iho 7 78 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. comfort of his crc.itnrc.s, when he arninged and established the economy ut^ nature. VARIETY OF NATURE. As a striking evidence of Divine Intelligence, we may next consider the immense variety ivhich the Creator has introduced into every department of the material world. In every region on the surface of the globe, an endless multi- plicity of objects, all dilVcring from one another in shape^ color^ and motion, present themselves to the view of the beholdef. Mountains covered with forests, hills clothed with verdure, spacious plains adorned with vineyards, orchards, and wav- ing grain ; naked rocks, abrupt precipices, extended vales, ileep dells, meandering rivers, roaring cataracts, brooks and rills ; lakes and gulls, bays and promontories, seas and oceans, caverns and grottoes — meet the eye of the student of Nature, in every country, with a variety which is at once beautiful and majestic. Nothing can exceed the variety of the vegetable kingdom, which pervades all climates, and almost every por- tion of the dry land, and of the bed of the ocean. The im- mense collections of Natural History which are to be seen in the Museum at Paris, show, that botanists are already ac- quainted with nearly fifty-six thousand difierent species of plants.* And yet, it is probable, that these form but a very small portion of what actually exists, and that several hundreds of thousands of species remains to bo explored by the indus- try of future ages. For, by far the greater part of the vegeta- ble world still remains to be surveyed by the scientific botanist. Of the numerous tribes of vegetable nature which flourish in the interior of Africa {ind America, in the immense islands of New Holland, New Guinea, Borneo, Summatra, Java, Cey- lon, Madagascar, and Japan ; in the vast regions of Tartary, Thibet, Siberia, and the Burinan empire ; in the Phillippines, the Moluccas, the Ladrones, the Carolina?, the Marcpiesas, the Society, the Georgian, and in thousands of other Islands which are scattered over the Indian and Pacific oceans — little or nothing is known by the naturalists of Europe, and yet it is a fact which admits of no dispute, that every country hitherto explored, produces a variety of species of plants peculiar to vtself ; and those districts in Europe which have been fre- quently surveyed, present to every succeeding explorer a new field of investigation, and reward his industry with new dis- coveries of the beauties and varieties of the vegetable king- dom. It has been conjectured by some Naturalists, on the ♦ Edinbijrgh Philosophical Journal, July, 1822, p. 43. VARIETY OF NATURE. 79 ground of a nmlthude of o])Scrvations, that " there is not a square league of earth, but what presents some one phint pe- cuUar to itself, or, at least, which thrives there better, or ap- pears more beautiful than in any other part of the world." This would make the number of si)ecies of vegetables to amount to as many millions as there are of square leagues on the surface of the earth. Now, every one of these species of plants differs from ano- ther, in its size, structure, form, flowers, leaves, fruits, mode of propagation, color, medicinal virtues, nutritious qualities, internal vessels, and the odors it exhales. They are of all sizes, from the microscopic mushroom, invisible to the naked eye, to the sturdy oak, and the cedar of Lebanon,and from the slender willow to the Banian tree, under whose shade 7000 persons may find ample room to repose. A thousand different shades of color distinguish the different species. Every one wears its peculiar livery, and is distinguished by its own native hues; and many of their inherent beauties can be distinguished only by the help of the microscope. Some grow upright, others creep along in a serpentine form. Some flourish for ages, others wither and decay in a few months : s(mie spring up in moist, others in dry soils ; some turn towards the sim, others shrink and contract when we approach to touch them. Not only are the different species of plants and flowers dis- tinguished tVom each other, by their different forms, but even the different individuals of the same species. In a bed of tulips or carnations, for example, there is scarcely a flower in which some diiference may not be observed in its structure, size, or assemblage of colors ; nor can any two flowers be found in which the shape and shades are exactly similar. Of all the hundred thousand millions of plants, trees, herbs, and flowers, with which our globe is variegated, there are not, per- haps, two individuals precisely alike, in every point of view in which they may be contemplated ; yea, there is nut, perha[)s, a single leaf in the forest, when minutely examined, that will not be foimd to differ, in certain aspects, from its fellows. ^uch is the wonderiul and infinite diversity with which the Creator has adorned the vegetable kingdom. His wisdom is also evidently displayed in this vast profusion of vegetable nature — in adai)ting each plant to the soil and sit- iiation in which it is destined to flourish — in t'urnishing it v/ith those vessels by which it absorbs the air and moisture on which it tceds — and in adapting it to the nature and necessities of animated beings. As the earth teems v.ith animateC€ of tliese ])rotuberaaccs is covered with a multitude of small hemisplieres placed with tlie utmost reguUrity in rows, crossing each other ii,\akind of lattice work. These little hemispheres have each of them a minute transparent convex Ur^s in the middle, each of wliich has a distiiwt branch of the ojrt.ic nerve ministerintf to it; so that tlibdifterent lenses may be considered as so many distinct eyes. Mr. Leeuwenhock c,(>unted ^236 in tkc two eyes of a silk worm, when in itsJZy state; 3180 in each s^ye of the beetle ; ami 8000 in the two eyes of a common fiy. Mr. Hook reckoned 14,000 in the eyes of a ilron e fly ; and, in one of the eyes of a dragon fly, there have been reckoned 13,500 dt fcUi>5.t, iovts'es, and> coiiseciuently, in both cyes^ 27,000, every one VARIETY OF NATURE. 81 Our astonishment at the variety which appears in the animal kingdom is still farther increased when we consider not only the diversities which are apparent in their external aspect, but also in their internal structure and organization. When we reflect on the thousands of movements, adjustments, adapta- tions, and compensations, which are requisite in order to the construction of an animal system, for enabling it to form its intended functions ; — when we consider, that every species of animals has a system of organization peculiar to itself, coi> sisting of bones, joints, blood vessels, and muscular motions, differing in a variety of respects from those of any other spe- cies, and exactly adapted to its various necessities and modes of existence ; and when we consider, still farther, the incom- prehensibly dehcate contrivances, and exquisite borings, pol- ishings, claspings, and adaptations, which enter into the or- ganization of an animated being ten thousand times less than a mite ; and that the different species of these animals are likewise all differently organized from one another, — we can- not but be struck v»'ith reverence and astonishment, at the In- telligence of that Incomprehensible Being who arranged the organs of all the tribes of animated nature, who " breathed into them the breath of life," and who continually upholds them in all their movements ! Could we descend into the subterraneous apartments of the globe, and penetrate into those unknown recesses which lie towards its centre, we should, doubtless, behold a variegated scene of wonders, even in those dark and impenetrable re- gions. But all the laboi* and industry of man have not hith- erto enabled him to penetrate farther into the bowels of the earth than the six thousandth part of its diameter; so that we must reinain for ever ignorant of the immense caverns and masses of matter that may exist* and of the processes that may be going on about its central regions. In those rc- of which IS capable of forming a distinct image of any object, in the same manner as a common convex glass; so that there are 27,000 images formed on tlie retina of this httle animal. Mr. Leeuwenhoek havins; j)rcpared the eye of a fly for the purpose, placed it a little farther from his microscope than when he wonld examine an object, so as to leave a projier local dis- tance between it and the lens of his microscojje ; and then looked tln-ough both, in the manner of a telescope, at the steeple of the chm-ch, which was 299 feet high^ and 750 feet distant, and could plainly see through every little lens, the whole steeple inverted, though not larger than the point of a fine needle : and then directing it to a neighboiuing house, saw through many of these little hemispheres, not only the front of the house, but also the doors and windows, and could discern distinctly, whether the windows were open or shut. Such an exquisite piece of Divine mechanism tran- scends all huntaii coinprelicnsio!]. 7* 82 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. gions, however, near the surface, which He withhi the sphere of human inspection, we perceive a variety analogoosf to that which is displayed in the other departments of nature. lie.e we find substances of various kinds formed into saata^ or lay- ers, of ditJerent depths — earths, sand, gravel, marl, clay, sand- stone, free-stone, marble, hme-stori^e, fossils, coals, peat, and similar materials. In these strata are fmmd metals and mine- rals of various descriptions — sak, nitrate of potash, ammonia, sulphur, bitumen, platina, gold, silver^ mercuiy, iron, lead, tin, copper, zinc, nickel, manganeze, cobalt, antimony, the dia- mond, rubies, sapphires, jaspers, emeralds, and a countless variety of other substances, of incalculable benefit to man- kind. Some of these substances are so essentially requisite for the comfort of man, that, without t-hem, he \voi.il4 stioa degenerate into the savage state, and be depiived of all those arts which extend his knowledge, and which cheer m\d embel- lish the abodes of civilized life. if we turn our eyes upward to the regions of the atmos- phere, we may also behold a spectacle of variegated magni- tice.nce. Sometimes the sky is covered with sable clouds, or obscured with mists ; at other times it is tinged with a variety crf hues, hy the rays of the rising or the setting sun. Some- times it presents a pure azure, at other times it is diversified ^kfith strata of dappled clouds. At one time we behold the rainbow rearing its majestic arch, adorned with all the colors of light; at another, the Aurora Borealis illuminating the sky with its fantastic corruscations. At one time we behold the fiery meteor sweeping through the air ; at another, we per- ceive the forked lightning darting from the clouds, and hear the thunders roMing through the sky. Sometimes the vault of heaven appears hke a boundless desert, and at oiher times adorned with an innumerable host of stars, and with the moon " walking in brigiitness." In short, whether we direct our view to the vegetable or the animal tribes, to the atmosphere, the ocean, the mountains, the plains^ or the subterranean re- cesses of the globe, we behold a scene of beauty, order and variety, which astonishes and enraptures the contemplative mind, and constrains us to join in the devout exclamations ot the Psalmist, " Hoio manifold are thy works, O Lord ! In wis- dom hast thou made them all, the earth i,s full of thy riches ; so is the great and wide sea, wherein are things creeping, in- numerable, both small and great beasts." This countless varietv of objects which appears throughout every department of our sublunary system, not only displays the depths of Divine wisdom, but also presei>'s us with a faint VARIETY OF NATURE. 83 idea of the infinHy of the Creator, and of the immememffltiplU city of ideas and conceptions which must have existed in the Eternal Mind, when the tabric of our globe, and its numerous tribes of inhabitants ^vere arranged ajid brought into existence. And, if every other world which iioats in the innnensity of space, be diversitied with a sinnlar variety of existence, alto- gether different fron>, ours, (as we have reason to believe, from the variety we akeady perceive, and from the boundless plans and conceptions of the Creator,) the human mind is lost and confounded, when it attempts to form an idea of those endlessly diversilied plans, conceptions, and views, which must have existed during an eternity past, in the Divine mind. When we woidd attomj»t to enter into the conception of so vast and varied operations, we feel our mvn littleness, and the narrow lin>Kts of oj-ii; {(Kible p.owers, and can only exclaim, with the Apostle Paul, " 6 the depth of the riches both of the wis- dom and knowledge of God ! how unsearcliuble are his coun^ oils, and his ways of creation and providence past- finding out" This characteristic of variety, which is stamped on all the works of Omnipotence, is, doubtless, intended to gratify th«g principle of curiosity, and the love of novelty, which are m>- planted in the human breast ; and thus to excite rational be- ings to the study and investigation of the works of the Crea- tor ; that therein they may behold the glory of the Divine chamcter, and be stimulated to the exercise of love, admira- tion, and reyererice. For, as the records of revelation, and the dispensations of Providence, display to ns the various as- pects of the moral character of Deity, so, the divereified phe- nomena, and the niulti})licity of objects and operations which the scenery of nature exhibits, present to ils a specimen of the ideas^ as it were, of the Eternal Mind, in so far as they can be adumbrated by material objects, and exhibited to mortals, through the medium of corporeal organs. To convey an adequate conception of the numljer of these ideas, as exhibited on the globe in which we live, would baffle the arithmeticitm's skill, and set his numbers at defiance. — We may, however, assist our conceptions a little, by confining our attention to one department of nature ; for example, the Animal Kingdom. The number of the dilferent species of animals, taking into account those which are hitherto undis- covered, and those which are invisible to the naked eye, can- not be estimated at less than 300,000. In a human body there are reckoned about 446 muscles, in each of which, ac- cording to anatomists, there are at least 10 several intentions, or due qualifications to be observed — its proper figure, its just 84 THE OHKISTIAN PIIILOSOPII F.R, maonitude, the right disposition of its several ends, upper and lower, the position of the whole» the insertion ot" its proper nerves, veins, arteries, &c. so that in the muscular system ^lone, there are 4,460 several ends or aims to be attended to. The bones are reckoned to be in nutuber about 245, and the distinct scopes or intentions of each o»f these are above 40 ; in all, about 9,800 ; so that tho systcui of bones and muscles alone, without taking any other parts into consideration, amounts to above 14,000 different intentions or adaptations.. If now, we suppose, that all the species of animals above sta- ted, are differently constructed, and, taken one with another^ contain at an average^ c^ system of bones aud muscles as nu- merous as in the human body — the luimber of species must be multiplied by the number of different aims or adaptations, and the product will amount to 4,200,000,000. If we were next to attend to the many thousands of blood vessels in an animal body, and the numerous liganie-nfcs, membranes, hu-» mors, and fluids of various stescnptioJiis — the skin, with its millions of pores, and every other part of an organical system,^ with the aims and intentions of each, we should have another sum of m.any hundreds of millions to be multijdied by the for- mer product, in order to express the diversilied ideas which enter into the construction of the animal v^ovhl. And, if w^ still farther consider, that of the hundreds of toiiHions of indi- viduals belonging to each species, no two individuals exactly resemble each other — that all the myriads eif vegetables with which the earth is covered, are distinguished from each other, by some one characteristic or another,, and tha§ every grain ot sand contained in the mountains, and in the bed of the ocean, as shown by the microscope, discovers a different form an J configuration from another — we are here presented with an tm«i;eofthe injinily oi^ the conceptions oi" liiiyx in whose in- comprehensible mind they all existed, during countless ages, before the universe was formed. To overlook this amazing scene of Divine Intelligence, or to consider it as beneath our notice, as some have done — if it be not the characteristic of impiety, is at least, the mark of a weak and undiscriminating mind. The man who disregards the visible displays of Infinite wisdom, or who neglects to in- vestigate them, v\l>en opportunity offers, acts as if he consider- ed himself already possessed of a sufficient portion of intelli- gence, and stood in no need of sensible assistances to direct his conceptions of the Creator. Pride, and false conceptions of the natiue and design of true religion, frequently lie at the foundation of all that indiffeience and neglect with which the VARIETY OF NATURE. §5 visible works of God are treated, by those who make preten sions to a high degree of spiritual attainments. The truly jiious man will trace, with wonder and delight^ the footsteps of his Father and his God, wherever they appear in tl^e varie- gated scene of creation around him^ and will be filled with sorrow, and contrition of heart, thatj amidst his excursions and solitary walks, he has so often disregarded '> the works of the Lord, and the operation of his hands." In fine, the variety which appears on the face of nature^ not only enlarges our conceptions of Infinite Wisdom, but is also the tbundation of all our discriminations and judgments as rational beings, and is of the most essential utility in the affairs of human society. Such is the variety of which the features of the human countenance are susceptible, that it is probable th^t no two individuals, of all the millions of the race of Adam, that have existed since the beginning of time, would be found to resemble each other. We know no two human beings presently existing, however similar to each other, but may be distinguished either by their stature, their forms, or the features of their faces ; and on the ground of this dissimi-. larity, the various wheels of the machine of society move on- ward, without clashii^g or confusion. Had it been otherwise — had the fa,ces of men, and their organs of speech been cast exactly in the same mould, as would have been the case, had the world been framed according to the Epicurean system, by blind chance directing a concourse of atoms, it might have been as diflicult to distinguish one human countenance from another, as to distinguish the eggs laid by the same hen, or .he drops of water which trickle from the same orifice ; and, consequently, society would have been thrown into a state of universal anarchy and confusion. Frit^nds would not have been distinguished, from enemies, villains from the good and honest, fathers froni sons, the culprit from the innocent per- son, nor the branches of the same family from one another. And what a scene of perpetual confusion and disturbance w^ould thus have been created ! Frauds, thefts, rob^beries, murders, assassinations, forgeries, and injustice of all kinds, might have b^en daily committed without the least possibility of detection. — Nay, were even the vavieUj of tones in the human voice, peculiar to each person, to cease, and the hand- tvriiing of all men to become perfectly uniform, a multitude of distressing deceptions and perplexities would be produced in the domestic, civil, and commercial transactions of man- kind. But the All-wise and Beneficent C'reator has prevented all such evils and iticonvenieAces^ by the chnructer of variehj 86 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. which he has impressed on the human species ; and on all his works. By the peculiar features of his countenance every man may be distinguished in the light ; by the tones of his voice he may be recognii^ed in the dark, or when he is sepa- rated ftoni his fellows by an impenetrable partition ; and his jiand-writing can attest his existence and individuality, when continents and oceans interpose between him and his rela- tions, and be a witness of his sentiments and purposes to future generations. Thus, I have taken a very cursory view of some evidences of Divine Wisdom, which appear in the general constitution of the earth, the waters^ and the atniospkere, and in the char- acteristic of vnriehj, which is impressed on all the objects of the visible creation. When these and other admirable arrange- ments, in our sublunary system, are seriously contemplated, every rational nnd pious niind will be disposed to exclaim with the Psalmist — ''' There is none like unto thee, O Lord, neither are there any works like unto thy works." — ^* Thou art great, aud dost wondrous things, thou art God alone." — " O that men would praise the Lord for his goodness, and for his wonderful works towards the children of men !" When we consider not only the vtUityy but the beauty and grandmv of the ^vise arrangements of nature, what reason have we to admire and adore the goodness of the great Author of our existence! Were all the diversities of shape and color, of mountains and vales, of rivers and lakes, of light and shade, which now embellish the v^irious landscapes of the world, to disappear, and were one unvaried scene perpetujilly to present itself to the eye, how dull and w eavisome, and nur interesting would the aspect of the universe api)ear to an intelligent n>ind ! Although the variegated beauties which adorn the suriUce of our globe, auU the vault of heaven, are not essential to our existence, as sensitive beings, yet, were they completely withdrawn, apd nottung presented to the eye, but a bouadless expanse of barren sands, the mind would rcr coil upon itself, its activity would be destroyed, its powers would be confined, as it were, to a prison, and it would roam in vain amidst the siuyrounding waste^ ix\ search of enjoyment. Even the luxuries of a pal9.ce, were it possible to procure- them amidst such a scene of desolation, would become stale '»""! insipid, and would leave the rational soul, almost desti- tute o.f ideas and of mental energy, to the tiresoine round of ^ PRIMEVAL STATE OF NATURE. 87 checHitisH existence. Bitt in the actual state of the world we live in, there is no hiitdscape in nature, from the Icehcrj^s of Greenland to the verdant scenes of the Torrid Zone, in which ohjects, ehher of suhliiriiiy or of beauty^ in bounU. STRUCTURE OF THE EYE. 91 want to look upward, one of these muscles lifts up the orb of the eye ; if we would cast our eyes to the ground, another muscle pulls them down. A third muscle moves the globe outwards towards the temples ^ and a fourth draws it towards the nose. A fifth, which slides within a cartilaginous ring, like a cord over a pulley, and is fastened to the globe of the eye in two points, makes it roll abou.t at pleasure. A sixth lies under the eye, and is designed to temper and restrain, within proper bounds, the action of the rest, to keep it steadily fixed on the object it beholds, and to prevent those frightful contor- tions which otherwise might take place. By these, and a multitude of other mechanical contrivances, all acting in har- monious combination, the eye, as a natural telescope and mi- croscope, is made to advance, to recede, to move to the right, and to the left, and in every other direction ; and to view near and distant objects with equal distinctness ; so that a single eye, by the variety of positions it may assume, performs the ofiice of a thousand.* The utility of these several movements, and the pain and inconvenience which would be suffered, were any of tliem wanting, can scarcely be conceived, by any one whase eyes have always remained in a sound state. AVc are so much ac- customed to the regular exercise of our visual organs, that we seldom reflect on the numerous delicate springs which must be set in action, before the functions of vision can, with ease, be performed. But were any one of the muscular organs, now described, to fail in its functions, we should soon experience so many inconveniences, as would throw a gloom on all the other comforts of life ; and convince us, how much we are in- debted, every moment, to the provident care and goodness of our Beneficent Creator, for thousands of enjoyments which we seldom think of, and for which wq are never sufficiently grateful. — " With much compassion, as well as astonishment, at the goodness of our loving Creator," says Dr. Nieuvventyt, ^' have I considered the sad state of a certain gentleman, who, as to the rest, was in pretty good health, but only ^\anted the use of those two little muscles that serve to lift up the eyelidj and so had almost lost the use of his sight — being forced, as long as this defect lasted, to shove up his eyelids every mo- ment, with his own hands. "| How admirable^ then, is the formation of the eye, and how * Flies and othev insects, whose eyes arc immoveable, have several thoii% sands of distinct globes in each eye. See note pa^^e 80. t Nieuwentyt's Religious Philosopher, vol. 1. p. 233 92 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. grateful ought we to feel at the consideration, that we are per- mitted to enjoy ail the transporting pleasures of vision, without the least perplexity or effort on our part ! If the loss of action in a single muscle produces so many distressing sensa- tions and efforts, what would be the consequence if all the muscles of the eye were wanting or deranged? And, is it man that governs these nice and intricate movements ? Or is it the eye itself, as a self-directing machine, that thus turns around, seasonably and significantly, towards every visible object ? Man knows neither the organs of vision, nor the functions they ovight to perform. The eye is only an unconscious ma- chine, in the hands of a Superior Intelligence, as a watch, or a steam engine, is in the hands of a mechanic. It is God alone who constantly performs its movements, according to certain laws, which he has subm,itted to Qui- inclinations and desires ; ''>.for in him we live and movey — We are desiroKS to see certain objects around us : this is all the share we have in the operations of our eyes ; and without perplexing oui understanding, without the least care or management, in re - gard to any of the functions, we can, in a few moments, take a survey of the beauties and sublimities of an extensive land- scape, and of the glories of the vault of heaven. Thus, the Divine Being operates not only in this» but in a thousand difr ferent ways, in the various senses and contrivances which be- long to our animal system ; and yet, thoughtless and ungrate- ful man often inquires, in the language of doubt and he;>itation, f* Where is Qod my Maker ?" — He is in us, and around us, directing every movement in our ani^nal frame to act in har- mony with the surrounding elements, and to. minister to our enjoyments ; and it is only when his exquisite operations are deranged bv external violence, that we feel inconvenience ov pain. Such are only a few general outlines of the structure of the eye : for no notice has been taken of the numerous minute yeins, arteries, nerves, lymphatics, glands, and many other particulars which are connected with this organ. But^ all this delicc^te and complicated apparatus, in the struc«":ure of the eye, would have been of no use whatever for the purpose of vision, had not a distinct substance b^en created to act upon it, exactly adapted to its nature and tunctions. In order that the eve might serve as the medium of our perceptions of visible ODjeCvS, i.i^ni was lormed, and made to travel from its source iitthe rate of 195,000 miles in a second of time. This prodi- gious velocity of light is, doubtless, essential to the nature of yi^- .7* . 'since it actually exists, and since we find that it ra,di- STRUCTURE OF THE EYE. 93 ates with the same swiftness from the most distant visible star, as from the sun which cnhghtens our system. To abate the force of tliis amazing velocity, its particles have been formed almost infinitely small — a circmnskuice v>hich alone prevents this delightful visitant from Uecoainng the most tre- mendous and destructive element in nature. Dr. Nieuwentyt has computed, that, in one second of time^ there flows 418,- 6S0,000,()00,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000* particles of light out of a burning candle, which number con- tains at least 6,337,242,000,000 times the number of grains of sand in the whole earth, supposing every cubic inch of the. earth to contain a million of grains. It has been justly re- marked, by Mr. Ferguson and other authors, that " if the particles of light w«re so large ^ that a miUio.n of them, were equal in bulk to an ordinary grain of sand, we durst no more open our eyes to the light, than sufFer sand to be shot point blank against them, from the mouth of a cannon." It may also be remarked, that the property which all bodies possess^ of' reflecting light, is essential to the purpose of vision, without which, the splendid and variegated scene of nature would be changed into a dreadfid gloom ; and were the rays of light of one uniform eolor, and not compounded of varioa.is hues, one object could not be distinguished from another, and the beauti- ful aspect of our globe would instantly disappear. Thus we see, that the eye is ad?ipted to light, and light to the. eye; and in this admirable adaptation the wisdom of the Creator is strijvingly displayed. For light has no eftect upon the ear, or upon any other organ of sensation ; so as to pro- duce a perception of visible objects ; as, on the other hand, the undulations of the air have no effect upon the eye, so as to pro- duce the sensation of sound. The eye did not produce the light, nor did the light form the eye ; they are pericctly distinct from each other, yet so nicely adapted in every particular that had any one quality or circumstance been 'wanting in either, the functions of vision could not have been performed in the manner in which they now operate ; which strikingly demonstrates, that one and the same Intelligent Being, pos- sessed of a wisdom beyond our comprehension, formed the curious structure of the eye, and endued the rays of light with those properties of color, motion, and minuteness, which are calculated, through the medium of this organ, to produce, in sentient beings, the ideas of visible objects. And, surely, he never intended that such exquisite skill and contrivance should 94 THE CHRISTIAN THILOSOPHER. be altogether overlooked by rational beings, for whose pleasure und eryoyment all this benevolent care is exercised. BilANNER IN WHICH VISION IS PERFORMED, Let us now attend a little to the manner in which vision is performed, by the medium of light acting on the organs of sight. If we take a common convex glass — a reading glass for example — and hold it at some distance from a candle or a window sash, placing a piece of white paper behind the glass, at the distance of its focus, the image of the candle or sash will be painted on the paper, ^n an inverted position. This exp.e^ riment may he performed, with a better effect, by darkening a room, and placing the convex glass in a hole cut out of the window shutter, when the rays of light flowing from the objects without, and passing through the glass, will form a picture of the objects opposite the window, on the white paper» adorned with the most beautiful colors. In a manner similar to this, are the images of external objects depicted on the back part of the inner coat or membrane of the eye. The rays of light, proceeding in all directions, from surrounding objects, and falling on the eye, are transmitted through the pupil ; and be-; ing refracted by the different humours, (particularly by the crystalline humour, which acts the part of a convex lens,) they converge to a focus on the retina, where the images of visible objects are painted in an inverted position ; and, by means of the optic nerve, these images are conveyed to the mind. The following figure will perhaps more distinctly iilustrate this point. point. Let «, b, c, x, y, represent t\\e globe of the eye, and A, B, C, an object at a certain diskince from it. IS ow, it is well known that every point of a visible object sends out rays of light in all directions ; and, therefore^ a certa,in pojtion of the rays which flow from the object ABC, will fall upon the cornea, between x and ?/, and, passing through the aqueous humour, m, n, and the crystalline humour, o,p, and the vitreous humour, D E, will be converged to a focus on the retina, and WONDERS OF VISION. {>5 paint a distinct picture, a 6 c, of the object A B C, in an inver- ted position. The rays from the point A of the object, after being retracted by the ditierent humours, will be brought to a point at a ; those Irom B, will be converged at b ; and those from C, at c ; and, of course, the intermediate rays between A B, and B C, will be formed between a b, and 6 c, and the object will become visible by means of its image or represen- tation being painted on the retina, in all the colors and propor- tions which belong to it. If we take a bullock's eye, and cut off the three coats from the back part, and put a piece of thin white paper over that part, and hold the eye towards the win- dow, or any bright object, we shall see the image of the object depicted upon the paper, and in an inverted position, as stated above. In order that we may more distinctly perceive the wonders of vision, and the numerous circumstances on which it de- pends, let us suppose ourselves placed on. an eminence, which commands a view of a variegated and extensive landscape. Let us suppose om-selves stationed on Arthur's seat, or on the top of Salisbury Crags, in the vicinity of Edinburgh. Turning our face to the north-west, the city, with its castles, spires, and stately edifices, presents itself to our view. Beyond it, on the north and west, a beautiful country, adorned with villas, plan- tations, and fertde fields, stretches as far as the eye can reach, till the view is bounded by the castle of Sterhng, at the distance of more than thirty miles. On the right hand, we behold the port of Leith, the shipping in the roads, the coast of Fife, the isles of Inchkeith and of May, and the Frith of Forth, gradu-r ally losing itself in the German ocean. If we suppose the length of this landscape to be forty miles, and its breadth twenty-five, it will, of course, comprehend an area of a thou- sand square miles. The first circumstance v»'hich strikes the mind, is the immense midtitude of rays of reflected light which flow, in all directions, from the myriads of objects which compose the surrounding scene. In order to form a rude idea of this infinity of radia- tions, I fix my attention on a single object. I direct my eye to Nelson's monument, on the Calton hill. From the parapet at the top, a thousand difierent points send forth a thousand different cones of rays, which, entering my eye, render the dif ferent parts of it distinctly visible, besides myriads of rays from the same points, which flow in every other direction through the open spaces of the atmosphere which surround them. How many thousands of millions, then, of difierent radiations,, must be issuing forth every moment from the whole maas of 06 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSGrilER. the monument ! And if one object pours forth such a flood of rays, how inmiense must be the number of radiations which are issuing from all the objects which compose this extensive landscape ! Myriads of rays, from myriads of ob- jects, must be crossing each other in aa infinity of directions, so that the mind is confounded at the apparent confusion which seems to exist in this immensity of radiations ; yet every ray- passes forward in the crowd, in the most perfect order, and without being blended or confused with any other ray, produces its specific etiect on every eye that is open to receive it. But ibis is not all : these millions of rays which flow from the ^linutest points of the surrounding scene, before they can pro- ^itce the sensation of vision, and form a picture of the land- sca}>e on the retina, must be compressed into a space little: more than one-eighth of an inch in diameter, before they can enter the pupil of the eye ; yet they all pass through this small aperture without tlie least confusion, and pamt tlie images of their respective objects in exactly the same order in whicfet these objects are arranged. Another circumstance demands attention. The rays which proceed from the objects before me, are not all directed to the spot where I stand, but are dit- fused throughout every point of the surrounding space, ready to produce the same effect, wherever sentient beings are pre- sent to receive them. Were the whole inhabitants of Edin-_ burgh placed on the sloping declivity of Arthur's seat, and along the top of Salisbury Crags, and were millions of other spectators suspended in the surrounding atmosphere, similar sensations would be produced, and a scene similar to that which I now behold, would be depicted in every eye. Amidst the infi.nity of cones of light, crossing each other m an infinity of directions, no confusion v*'ould ensue, but every spectator, whose eyes were in a sound state, would obtain a correct view of the scene before him ; and hence it happens^ that, when- ever I shift my position to the right hand or to the left, other streams of light enter my eye, and produce the same eftect. Let me now attend to another circumstance, no less admi- rable than the preceding, and that is, tlie distinct impression M'hich 1 have of the shape, color, and motion, of the multipli- city of objects I am now contem.plating, and the small space within which their images are depicted at the bottom of my eye. Could a painter, after a long series of ingenious efforts, delineate the extensive landscape now before me, on a piece of paper not exceeding the size of a silver sixpence, so that every object might be as distinctly seen, in its proper shape and color, as it now appears when 1 sur\cy the scene around WONDERS OF VISION. 97 me, he would be incomparably superior to all the masters of his art that ever went before him. This effect, which far transcends the utniost efforts of human genius, is accom- plished in a moment, in millions of instances, by the hand of nature, or, in other words, by " the finger of God." All the objects I am now siu-veying, comprehending an extent of a thousand square miles, are accurately delineated in the bottom of my eye, on a space less than half an inch in diameter. How delicate, then, must be the strokes of that Divine pencil, which has formed such a picture ! I turn my eyes to the castle of Edinburgh, which appears one of the most conspicuous ob- jects in my field of view. Supposing that portion of it which strikes my eye to be 500 feet long, and 90 in height, I find, by calculation, that it occupies only the six hundred thousandth part of the whole landscape, and, consequently, fills in my eye ho more than the twelve hundred thousandth part of an inch. I next direct my eye towards the Frith of Forth, and perceive a steamboat sailing between Queensferry and Newhaven, I distinctly trace its motion for the space of 40 minutes, at the end of which it reaches the chain pier at Newhaven, having passed over a space of five miles in length, which is but the eighth part of the lineal extent of the landscape in that direc- tion ; and, consequently, occupies, in the picture formed on my retina, a lineal space of only one-sixteenth of an inch in extent. And, if the boat be reckoned about 88 feet in length, \ts image is only the three hundredth part of this extent ; and of course, fills a space in the eye of only the four thousand eight hundredth part of a lineal inch. Yet, m,y perception of the motion of the vessel could be produced only by a corres- ponding motion of its image in my eye ; that is, by the gra- dual motion of a point one 4,800th of an inch in diameter, over a space one sixteenth of an inch in length. How incon- ceivably tine and accurate, then, must be the impression of those strokes which the rays of light, from visible objects, pro- duce on the retina of the eye ! The mind is lost in wonder >\hen it attempts to trace so exquisite and admirable an effect. I take a reflecting telescope, and, through it, view some of the distant parts of the landscape. My wonder is still in- creased, when I consider the new directions into which the rays of light are bent — the crossings and recrossings, the re- fractions, and reflections, that take place between the mirrors and the lenses of the instrument, and the successive images that are formed — so that, instead of a scene of confusion, which, previous to experience, might have been expected from the numerous additional bendings and intersections of the rays 98 THE CHRISTIAN PHILQSOPHER. — I now perceive hundreds of objects, with the most perfect distinctness, which were before invisible. Rays of light from distant and minute abjects, which a moment before made no sensible impression on my eye^ being collected and variously modified by the telescope^ now paint a vivid representation of their objects, in their true iigures, colors, and }>ositions. From a consideration of the innumerable modifications of the rays of light, and of the immense variety of effects they produce in every region of the earth: — I am led to investigate u'hat proportion of the solar light falls upon our glob^^ in order to produce so diversified a scene of sublimity and beauty. Supposing the sun's rays to be chiefly confined, in their effects, within the limits of the planetary system, since they diverge in every direction, they must fill a cubical space 3,600,000,,_00tk miles in diameter; Avhich, consequently, will contain about 24,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000 of cubical miles, so that an eye, placed in any point of this vast space, would re- ceive a distinct impression from the solar rays. The solidity of the earth is about 264,000,000,000. cubical miles, and, therefore, it receives only the 9o;ogo:()oo;i«j7o 'iistruct(Ml, and how, nicely they are adapted to tlie several ends they vvert; intended to subserve.-— Were any one of these parts wanting, or obstn^cted in its fiinctions, vision would either be impeded, or rendered painfi.l and distressing, or completely destroyed. If any of the Iil- mors of the eye were wanting — if they were less transparent — if they were of a dillVrent refrdctive power — or if they wee of a gtt'dt*er or less coilVexily Ihaii the)' rio'^v are, however ni'.nlUe the alteration niiglit be, vision would inevitably be obstructed, and every object would appear confused and in- distinct. If the retiiln, on which the images of objects are painted, were fiat, instead of being concave, while objects in the middle of the view appeared distinct, every object towards the sides would dppcar dim and confused. If the cornea \vore As opaque as the sclerotica, to which it is joined, or it" the retina were not connected with the optic nerve, no visible object could possibly be perceived. If oneof the six mus- cles of the eye were wanting, or impeded in its functions, we could not turn it to the right ; if a second were deficient, we could not turn it tj> the left ; if a thirds we could not lit\ it up- wards ; if a fourth, we could not move it downwards ; and if if were deprived of the other two miiscles; it would be apt to roll about in fiightt\d contortions. If the eyes were placed in any other jSart of tKe body than the head— if they were much more prominent than they now are — if they were not sur- rounded by the bony socket in which they are lodged — and if they were not frequently covered by the eye-Hd — they would be exposed to a thousand accidents from which they are now protected. If they wanted moisture, and if they were not fre- quently wiped by the eye-lids, they would become less trans- parent, aild more liable t<^ be inflamed ; and if they were not ^lleltered by the eye-brows, the sweat and moisture of the forehead woidd frequently annoy them. Were the iii^'Jit which acts upon theni devoid of color — were it not reflected from objects iii every direction — were its motion less swift, or its particles much larger than thtiy now are— in short, were any one circumstance connected with the structure of this organ, and with the niodificdtion of the rays of light materially dif- fbreiitfrdni its present arrangement, we should either be subject- ed to the hourly recurrence of a thousand painful sensations, or be altogether deprived of the entertainments of vision. riow admirable an organ, then, is the eye, and how nicely adapted to unveil to our viiew the glories of the universe ! \^ ithout the applic;it!ori of any ski!! or laborious (efforts, on ouf 9 i JX2 THE CHRISTIAN PIIILOSOIIIER. r..irt, it iwvn^' in every diiectioii, transport:-; lis to every sur- roundint; ol.jer-t, depicts the nicest yliades and coloiri on its delicate menibra,ne^, mid " Takes in, at once, the landscape of the world ./It a small inlet, lokich a grain might close, And half creates the woiKprous v.'orld ^vo see." — Youkg. — TIow strikingly does it display, in eveiy part of its stnictvire .'uid adaptations, the marks of benevolent design, and of In- jiiiite liileiligencQ ! llovvover common it is to open our eyes, and to behold, in an instant, the beauties of an extensive land- scape, and however little we maybe accustomed to admire this vvonderpal ellect, — there is not a doctrine in Religion, nor a fact recorded in Revelation, more mysterious and incompre- liensible. An excellent I'rt^nch writer has v/ell observed — "The sight of a tree and of the sun, which God shows me, is as real and as immediate a revelation a*^ that which led Moses towards the burning bush. The only difierence between both these actions of God on-Moses and me, is, that the first is out of the common order and economy ; whereas the other is oc- casioned by the sequel and connection of those laws which God has established for the regulation both of man and na- ture." If, then, the eye of man (who is a depraved irdiabitant of a v/orld lying partly in ruin=') is an organ so admirably fitted for extending our prospects of the visible creation — we may rea- sonably conclude, that organized beings, of superior intelli- gence and moral purity, possess the sense of vision in a much greater degree of perfection than man, in his present state ol degradation — and that they may be enabled, hy their nulnral ^isgans, to penetrate into regions of the universe far beyond v hat man, by the aid of artiticial heip:^, will ever be able to -i.'iscry. It may not be altogether extrijvagant, nor even be- ymd the reality of existin.g facts, to suppose, that there are intelligences in the regions of Jupiter or Saturn, wh»se visual (wgans are in so perfect a state, that they can descry the iuountains of our moon, and the continents, islands, and oceans which diversify our globe, and are able to delineate a juap of its surface, to mark the period of its diurnal rotation, ; isd even to distinguish its cities, rivers, and volcanoes. It is ?|;5ite evident, that it must be equally easy to Divine Wisdom :.;jd Omnipotence, to form organs with povv'crs of vision far ; arpassing what I have now supposed, as to lorm tin organ in Vv'hich the magnificent scene of heaven and earth is dej)icted, iii a moment, within the coinpass of half an inch. There are animals v.hose range of vision is circumscribed withm the VISUAL ORGANS OF ANIMALS. 103 imits of .1 few feet or inches ; and, had we never perceived objects through an organ in the same state of pfufection as thai: with which we arc furnished, we covdd have tornicd as httle conception of the subhtnity and extent of our pres»int range of sight, as we can now do of those powers of vision, wliich would enable us to descry the inhabitants of distant worlds.— The invention of the telescope shows, that the penetrating power of the eye may be indeftnitely increased; a]id, since the art of man can extend the limits of natural vision, it is easy to conceive, that, in the hand of Omnipotence, a slight modification of the human eye might enable it, with the utmost distinctness, to penetrate into regions to which the imagina- tion can set no bounds. And, therefore, it is not unreasona- ble to believe, that, in the future world, this will be one pro- perty, among others, of the resrirrection-hody, that it will be furnished wsth organs of vision, far superior to the present, hi order to qualify its intelligent inhabitant for taking an ample survey of the " riches and glory" of the empire of God. I have dwelt somewhat particularly on the functions of the eye, in order to show, that it is only when we take a miniUn inspection of the operations of the Creator, that his Infinite: Wisdom and Intelligence are most distinctly perceived. Th j greater part of ( 'hristians will readily admit, tiiat the Wisdoiii of God is manifested in every object, but few of them take th;; trouble to hiipiire, iii what particular coairivaticcs arul adapiu- tions this wisdom is displayed ; and, therefore, rest satioticd with vasiue and general views, which seldom produce any deep jirnpression on the mind. " The v»'orks of tlie Lord," which are " great" and admirable, " must be sou-j^-lit out by ail those who have pleasure therein ;" and the more mi-iutely they are inspected, the more exquisite and admirable do all his arrange- ments appear. Were we to enter into an investigation of the visual organi of the loirer animals^ and to consider the numerous varietie.-- which occiu- in tlieir structure, position asid movements, and how nicely the peculiar organization of the eye is adapted tv) the general structure of the anhnal, and to its various necessi- ties and modes of existence — the operation of the same inscru- table Wisdom and Intelligence would meet our eye at QWQty step. Birds, for example, which procure their food by thei, beak, have the power of seeing distinctly at a very small di:i- tancft ; and, as tlieir rapid motion through the air renders it. necessary tlut t-iey should descry objects at a considerabb distance, thoy have two pccidUir mechanical coiitrivance.: ,, connected with their (jrgans of vision, fur producing both ihe;:.c JO-l TflE CHRISTIAN Pini^USOrilER. eftects. One of these coiitriviinct'iS consists im a flexible nm, formed of bone, which surrounds the broadest part of the eye, and, by occasionally pressing upon its orb, shortens its focal distance, and thus enables it to inspect very near objects.— - The other consists of a peculiar muscle, which draws back,, as, occasion requires, the crystalline humour, by which means it can take a distinct view of a distant huKlscap.e ; and can pass iVom the sig;\ii of a very near, to the sigkt of c\ t^stant object, with rapidity and ease. In Jiskesy which live in a medium of u diflerent refractive powei- from that of air, the crystalline hu- mour has a greater degj'eo of ccinva^^ity, and more nearly ap- proaches to a globular foi'm than that of laud anin^'^s — which conformation is essentially requisite to distinctness of vision in the watery element. A lish, of course, cannot see distinctly in air, nor a quadruped under water ; and every person who has dived into the water with his eyes open, knows, that, though he may perceive the general forms and colors of ob- jects, his vision is obscure and indistinct. In hares and rau-^ bits the eyes are very convex and prominent, so that they can see nearly quite round them ; whereas, in doj^s, which pursue hese animals, the visual organs are placed more in the front :)f the head, to look rather before, than behind the.m. Some animals, as cats and owls, which pursue th(ur }»Fe-y in the dark, lave the pupil of their eye so formed as to. be capable of great expansion, so that a few rays of light nray make a lively im- j^ression on their retina ; while the eagle, which is able to look directly at the sun, has its pupil capable of being contracted Jihnost to a point. Insects, such as the beetle, thejhj, and the huiterf.ij, whose eyes are incapable of motion, have several thousands of small transiparent globes set in a convex hemis- pb.ere, every one of which is capable of forming an image of an object ; so tiiaf they are enabled to view the objects around them without moving their heads. But, it would be beyond the limits of my plan to prosecute this subject any farther : enough has already been stated^ to show, that the eyes of men and other anii-ials are master-pieces of art, which far transcend the human understanding ; and that they demonstrate the con- summate wisdom of Hini, who planned and constructed the organical functions of the various tribes of anhivited e:^istence. I shall now conclude this branch of my subject, by present- xn^ an instance or two oC the ineckanism of the boncsy and the movements it is fitted to produce. The bones of (he hum;ui frame are arti-'Hlaled, or coimected together in ditrereut ways, but :nost frequently in the following manner. — Eitiier, 1. a boue with a round head is articulated MECHANISAI OF THE BONES. 10/ with a cavity, and plays in it as a ball in a socket ; or, 2. they are connected tojjjether by a hinge-like articulation, which en- ables a bone to move up or down, backwards ur forwards, liku a door upon its hinges. An idea of these two motions, and tlie purposes they serve, may be obtained, by considering the construction of the pedestal of a telescope, and the joints on vvhich it moves. One of the joints is of the nature of a hinge, by which a vertical motion, or a motion upwards and dowii- wards is produced. A horizontal motion, or a motion towards the right hand or the left, is produced by a pivot moving in a socket ; so that, by these two motions, the telescope can bo made to point in any direction. Such is the nature of the ar- ticulations of the bones, and the movements they produce ; and wherever one or other of these motions, or both of them com- bined, are requisite lor the comfort and couvenience of the in- dividual, such a povv'er of motion is uniformly found to exist. If the movement of a joint in every direction would, in any particular case, be found inconvenient, the hinge-like articu- lation is fixed upon ; but if a motion, in every direction, is required for the convenient use of particular members, and lor tlie variety of evolutions vvhich a sentient being may have oc- casion to make, the bail and socket articulation is combined with, the former. For exam5>le, let any person, for a moment, consider the joints of his nugers, and compare them with the joint at his u-rist, where the hand is connected with the fore arm. If he hold the bad: of bis hand upwards, he will tind that he can move his fingers upvvards or downwards ; but he camiot turn them to the right hand, or to the left, so as to niakc them de- scribe a circiilar motion. He will also find that his ivrist is cipalil^ of a similar movement, so that the hand may be bent ia a vortical directiori. But, in addition to this motion, it is also capable of being turned in a horizontal direction, or fiom one side to another. In the former case, we have an example of the hinge articulation ; hi the latter, it is combined with an articulation which produces nearly the same etlect as a pivot moving in a socket. Now, had the joints of tlie fingers l>een capable of tlio same motions as the wrist, the hand would hav(. lost its firmness, and been incapable of })erf,oreal system, every thing is so arranged and adapted to another, as at once to contribute to ease, and facility of molioji, in all the varied operations and movements we have occasion to perform ; which circumstance forcibly demonstrates both the benevo- lent intentions, a,nd the admirable wisdom of Him " whose hands have made, a^nd fashioned us," and v/ho " breathed into our nostrils the breath of life,." The above, are only two or three out of a hundred of similar instances, wh,ich might be produced to show the benevolent care which ha& been exercised in arranging and articulating the system of bones, of' which the ]>rop-work of the human frame is composed. Were we to enter into an investigation of the actions and uses of the various muscles, the wonderful system of veins and arteries, the action of the heart, stomach, and bowels ; the process of respiration, and insensible perspiration, and the system of nerves, glands, lymphatics, and lacteals — a thousand instances of Divine wisdom and beneficence would crowd upon our view, which could not fail to excite the pious and contemplative mind to join in the devotions of the " sweet singer of Israel," " I will praise thee ; for I an\ fearfidly and wonderfully made ; mar- vellous are thy worLs^ and that my. soul knoweth right well." — But as I intended to present only, ix Hew specimens of the Wisdom of God, as dispjayed in tl^e construction of the mate- rial world, I shall coAClude this department of my subject with a single reflection.* How foolish Cijulungmfefid is it for rational heino-s to over- look the wise anclh.i>}uvoUnt arrangements of the Creator, in the material imiverse ! Moyv many thousands of human beings pass their existence without once reflecting on the numerous evidences of divine Wisdom and Beneficence, which appear around them, or feeling the least spark of gra- titude for their preservation and comforts, to that Being " in whose hand their breath is, and whose are all their ways !" Yea, how many are there who consider themselves as stand- ing high in the ranks of the Christian profession, who aflect * Those who wish to prosecute this subject, particularly that part of it which relates to the contrivances of Divine Wisdom, which appear in the animal system, will find ample 2:ratificatiou in Kieuwentyt's " Religious Philosopher," Vol. 1. and Dr. Paley's "Natural Theology." A variety of useful remarks on this subject will also be found in Ray's "Wisdom of God in the Creation," Derham's " Physico-Tlieology," and Bonnet's " Contemplation of Nature." lOvS THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. to look down, with a certain degree of contempt, on the study ot'fhe material works of God, as if it were too gross a subject tor their spiritual attainments ! They profess to trace the M-isdoni of God in the Scriptures, and to feel gratitude for his pardoning mercy ; but they seldom feel that gratitude which they ought to do for those admirable arrangements in their ovvii bodies, and the elements around them, by which their lives are preserved, and their happiness promoted ; and even seem to insinuate, that thoy have little or nothing to do with the contrivances of the God of Nature. They leave it to tlie genius of infidel philosophers to trace the articulations of the bones, the branchings of the veins and arteries, the properties of light, and the composition of the atmosphere, while they profess to feast their minds on more sublime and spiiitual en- tertainments. But, surely, such astonishing displays of the v.isdom and benignity of the Most High, as creation exhibits, were never intended to be treated by his intelligent ofispring with apathy or indilierence.; a«d to do so, must indicate a certain degree of base ingratitude towards Him whose inces- sant energy sustains the whole assemblage of sentient and intelligent beings, and who displays himself, in their construc- tion and preservation, to be " wonderiid in counsel, and ex- cellent in working." Shall we imagine, that, because God stands in the gracious relation of our Redeemer, he has ceased to stand in the relation of our Creator and Preserver ? Or shall vv'c consider those subjects as imwortlrv: of our attention, which are the theme of the praises of the heav&nly host ? — Rev. iv. 11. Can we suppose that the Almighty displayed his infinite wisdom in the curious organization of the human eye, that man — the only being -in tlila woiici who is endowed v»"iih {"acuities capable of appreciatino; its structui e, and for Vviiose use and entertainment it was intendcd-^shoiild over- look such a wonderful piece of Divine workn-anship, and feel no gratitude for the bestowment of so adniirabfe a gift i Shall we extol the ingenuity displayed in a clock or a watch, iri a chess-player, or steam engine, and shall we ieel no sentiment of admiration at the view of millions of instances of Divine mechanism, which infinitely transcend the powers of the human understanding ? To act in this manner, as too many are dis- })osed to do, is unvvorthy of man, both as a Chii.-^tlan and as an intelligent agent. Such was not the conduct of the inspired writers ; their spirituality of views did not lead them to neglect the contemplation of any of the works of God. " i vvili me- diUito on (ill thy works,'' says thv.^ Psahuist, "arid tiiWi of all thy doings; 1 v,-ill uiter abunvUai\'v the liicniurv of ihy great MORAL REFLECTIONS. 109 goodness, and speak of all thy wondrous a\ ctiks," Accord- ingly we find, that the wonders of the human frame, tl^e eco- nomy of the animal and the vegetable tribes, the scenery of the V dry land," and of the \\ mighty c|eep," and thq glories of the heavens, Avere the frequent ■sui3Jects of their devout contemplation. They considered them in relation tq the un- ceasing agen(;y of God, by whom they were formed and ar- ranged, and as declaring his Wisdom, Goodness, and Omnipo- tence ; and, with this view, ought allthe scenes of tl^e visible creation to be investigated by his intelligent creatures. We have reason to believe, that it is owing, in part, to want of attention to the l)ivine wisdoin and beneliceqcCj as exhibit- ed in the construction of the visible world, that many profess- ed Christians entertain so vague and confused ideas respect- ing the wisdom and goodness of Deity, as displayed in the economy of Redemption. The terms, Wisdom, Goodness, and Beneficence, in their mouths, become words almost Avith- out meaning, to which' no precise or definite ideas are attach- ed ; because they have never considered the instances and the evidences of these attributes, as displayed in the material creation. And, if our minds have not been impressed Avith a sense of the Avisdom and beneficence of God, in those objects Avhich are presented to the external senses, Ave cannot be sup- jiosed to have hmiimous and distinct ideas of those spiritual objects and arrangements Avhich are removed beyond the sphere of our corporeal organs. — For all our ideas, in relation to Religion and its objects, are primarily derived from the in- timations we receive of external objects, through the medium Df our senses ; and, consequently, the more clearly Ave per- ceive the agency of God, in his visible operations, the more ihall we be qual.iJied to perceive the Avisdoin and harmony of lis dispensations, as recorded in the volume of inspiration. We live in a Avorld, all the arrangements of which are the effects of infinite Avisdom.. We are surrounded Avitli Avonders on every hand ; and, therefore, Ave cease to adnfuT, or to fix our attention on any one of the AVonders daily performed by God. We have never been accustomed to contemi>.late, or to inhabit a Avorld A\here benevolence' and Avisdom are not displayed ; and, therefore, Ave are apt to imagine, that tUe, cir- cumstances of our terrestrial existence could not have been much otherwise thin they actually are. We behold the sun in the morning, ascending froni the east — a thousand shining globes are seen in the canopy of the sky, Avhen he has disap- peared in the Avest. We open our eye-lids, and the myriads of objects which compose an extensive landscape, are, in a 110 TIIF. CIiniSTIAN PITILOSOriTER, moment, painted on our retina, — we wish to move cm- bodies, and, in uu instint, the joints and muscles of onr hands and fef3t perform tboir sever.'il tunctions. We spread out onr wet clothes to dry, and m a few hours the moisture is evaporated. We behold the lie ids drenched with rain, and in a few days it (iisappears, a'id is dispersed throuoh tlie surrounding atmos- phere', to be again embodied into clouds. These are all com- inon operations, and, therefore, thoughtless a!Kl ungrateful juan seldom considers the obligations he is under to the Author of his existence, for the numerous enjoym.ents whi«-h flow from these wise arrangements. But were the globe we hihabit, and all its appendages to remain in their present state — and were only \\v^ principle of evaporation and the refractive and rejhc- tive properties of the air to be destroyed — we should soon feel, by the universal gloom which wordd ensue, and by a thousand other inconveniences we should sutler, what a mis- erable world was allotted for our abode. We should n»ost sensibly perceive the wisdom and goodness we had formerly overlooked, and would most ardently implore the restoration of those arrangements for which we were never sufliciently grateful. And why should we not now — while we enjoy so many comforts flowing from the plans of iniinite Wisdom — jiave our attention dn-ectcd to the benevolent contrivances within ns, and arovnid us, hi order that grateful emotions may be hourly arising in 6nr hearts, to the Father of our spirits l For the essence of true religion consists chiefly in s;ratilude to the (rod of our life, and the Author of our salvation; and every pleasing sensation we feel from the harmoir.es and the beauties of nature, ought to inspire us with this sacred emotion, " Hearken unto tins, O man ! stand still, aiid consider the w(»n- derful works of (i'»d. Coiitemplate the balancings of the cloutis, the woudrous works of iiiin who is perfect in knovvl<;dg(^''' " He hatti rua.l-.' the eurih Uy his power, he hath establisbed the world by bis wisdom. When he utierwth his voice, (here is a noise of waters in tbe heavens ; ho causeth the vapors to as- cend from the ends of the, earth, and bringeth the winds out of his treasures." While it is shimel^ui for man to bo inattentive to the wonders which surround him, what can be more pleasing and congenial to a rational asid devout mind, than conten){)lations on the works of the Most High 'I » What can be more gratifying," says Sturm, " th in to contonplate, in the heavens, in the earth, in the water, iu the night and day, and, indeed, throughout all nature, the proofs which they ailord of the wisdom, the purily and the goodness of our great Creator and Preserver ! What can be more deligiitful than to recognize, hi the wIkjIc creu- BENEVOLENCE OF TiiE DEITY. Ill tion, in all the natural world, in every thing we see, traces of the evcr-workiirg providence, and tender mercy of the great Father of all !" SECTION IV. On the GoodiiesSj or Benevolence of the Deitv. The Benevolence of God is that perfection of his nature, by which he communicates happiness to the various ranks of sensitive and intelligent existence. The system of Nature, in all its parts, exhibits an unbound- ed display of this attribute of the Divine Mind, both in rela- tion to man, and in relation to the subordinate tribes of anima- ted existence, in relation to Man — the magnificence and glory of the heavens — the variegated coloring ^vhich is spread over the scene of nature — the beautiful flowers, shrubs, and trees, with which the earth is adorned, v.diich not only delight the eye, but perfume the air with their dehcious odors — the various Idnds of agreeable sounds that charm the ear — the music of the feathered songsters, v/hich iiil the groves with their melody — the thousands of pleasant images which delight the eye, in the natural enihellishments of creation — the agree- able feelings produced by the contact of almost every thing we have occasion to touch — the pleasure attached to eating, drinking,, muscular motion and activity — the luxuriant profu- sion, and rich variety of aliments which the earth affords — and the interchanges of thought and afiection — all proclaim the Benevolence of our Almighty Maker, and skow that the com- munication of happiness is one grand object of all his arrange- ments. For these circumstances are not essenfioJly requisite to our existence. We might have lived, and breathed, and walked, though every thing we touched had produced pain ; though every thing we ate aiid drank had been bitter ; though every movement of our hands and feet had been accompanied with uneasiness and fatigue ; though every sound had been as harsh as the saw of the carpenter ; though no birds had Vi^arbled in the groves ; though no flowers had decked the fields, or filled the air with their perfumes ; though one un- varied scene of dull uniformity had prevailed, and beauty and sublimity had been swept from the face of nature ; though tlie earth had been covered with a mantle of black, and no radiant orbs had appeared in our nocturnal sky. But what a inisera- 112 THE CHRISTIAN nilLOSOPIIER. ble world should we then have inhabited^ compared with that which we now possess I Life would have passed away with- out enjoyment ; and pain would have overbalanced, thp plea- sure of existence. Whereas, in the existing constitution of things, all the objects around us, and every sense of which we are possessed, when preserved in its natural vigor, have a direct tendency to produce pleasing sensations, and to con- tribute to our enjoyment : and it is chietly when we indulge in foolish and depraved passioiis, and comnill immoral ac- tions, that the benevolent intentions of the Deity are frus- trated, and pain and misery produced. If we consider, further, that the inexhaustable bounty or thp Creator, and the numerous pleasures Aye enjoy, are bestowed upon a guilty racO oC men; the benevolence of the Deity will appear in a still more striking point of view. Man has dared to rebel against his Maker ; he is a depraved and ungrateful creature. The great majority of our race have banished Ood from their thoughts, trampled upon his laws, neglected to con- template his works, refused to pay him that tribute of rever- ence and adoration which his perfections demand, have been ungrateful for his tavours, have blasphemed his name, and have transferred to " four-footed beasts, and creeping things," that homage which is due to him alone. It has been, the ehief part of their employment, in all ages^ to counteract the effects of his Beneticence, by inthcting injustice, oppression, and tor- ture, upon each other ; by maiming the human frame, burning cities and villages; turning fruitful fields into a wilderness, and by every other act of violence, carrying death ijnd destruction through the world. And \i' water^ air, and the light of heaven, had been placed within the limits of tbeir coijtrol, it is more than probable, that whole nations would have been occasion- ally deprived of these elements, so essential to human exis- tence. Yet; notwithstanding the prevalence ot' such deprav- ed dispositions, the strearrts of Divine benevolence towards our apostate race; have never yet beeii Interrupted. The earth has never stO[)ped in its career, and thrown nature into a scene of confusion ; the light of heaven has never ceased to illume the world ; the springs oi^ water have never been dried lip, nor has the fertile soil ceased to enrich the plains with golden harvests. God "hath not left himself without a wit- ness," to his beneficence, in any age, in that he hath unceas- ingly bestowed on the inhabitants of the world, " rain from heaven, ?fnd fruitful seasons, tilling their hearts with food and glaciiiess;" This is one of the characters of Deity which forms the most perfect contrast to tho selfish and reveniieful BENEVOLENCE OF THE DEITY. 113 dispositions of man; which as far transcends hjiiman .benevo- lence, as the heaVens in extent surpass the earth — a character calculated to excite our highest love and admiration, and which we are called upon; in the Sacred Ordcles, to imititte and re- vere. " Be ye merciful^ as your Father who is in heaven is merciful : for he maketh his sun to rise on the evil and on the good, and sendeth rain on the jiist and on the unjust." "O that men would praise the Ijoid for his goodness, and for his wonderful works to the children of men." From such considerations, we learji, even from the system of nature, that mercy is an attribute of the Deity ; for, if mercy consists in bestowing favours on those who are unworthy, or who merit punishment, the greatest sinners in all ages have shared in it, and every individual of the human race, now ex- isting, enjoys a certain portion of those pomforts which flow from the benevolent arrangements which the Creator, has es- tablished. " He maketh the sun to rise on the evil and on the good." Though the nations in ancient times^ as well as at present, "walked in their own way," indulging in impiety, falsehood, lewdness; war, devastatioxis, revenge, abominable idolatries, and every other violation of his la\y, he still support* ed the functions of their animal franies, and caused the influ ence of the sun, the raiiii^^ and the devvs^ to, descend upon their fields, that they might be refreshed with his bounty, and filled " with food and gladness," If mercy were not an es- sential attribute oi^ the Deity, he would have cut them down in the midst of their first transgressions, shattered to pieces the globe on which they dwelt, and buried them in eternal ob- livion. But whether Divine mercy will extend to the final for- giveness of sin, and the communication of eternal happiness to such beings, can be learned only from the discoveries of revelation. In relation to the inferior animals — ^the immense multitude of living creatures with which the earth is replenished, is a striking evidence of the vast profusion of Divine Benefi- cence. More than a hundred thousand species of animated beings are dispersed through the different regions of the air, the water, and the earth; besides myriads \vl)ich are invisible to the unassisted eye. To estimate the number of individuals belonging to any one species is beyond the power of man. — What countless myriads of herrings, for example, are contained in a single shoal, which is frequently more than six miles long, and three miles broad ! To estimate the number of individu- als in all the different species would, therct^pre, be as impossi- ble as to count the grains of sand in the Arabian deserts. — 1 114 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. There is not a single spot, in any region of the globe, but what teems with animated beings. Yet, all this vast assem- blage of sensitive existence is amply provided for by the bourttiful Creator. " These all wait upon him, and he giveth ihem their meat in due sea^n." They enjoy not only life, but also a happij existence. The sportive motions, and gesti- culations of all the animal tribes— the birds skimming through the air, warbling in the groves, and perching on the trees — the beasts of the fioiu, bounding in the forests^ and thr-ough the lawns —the fishes sporting in the waters— the reptiles wriggling in the (Tust, and the winged insects, by a thousand wanton mazes — all declare that they are rejoicing in their existence, and in the exercise of those powers with which the Creator has fur- nished them. So that wherever we turn our eyes-, we evident- ly pei-teive, tliat ^' the earth is full of" the goodness of the Lord," and that " his tender mercies are over all his works." This subject is boundless — but it would be inconsistent with the limited plan tjf this work, to enter into any particular details. And it is the less necessary, ^vhen vv e consider, that every in-^ stance of Divine Wisdom is, at the same time^ an instance of hemmlence -, for it is the ultimate object of all the wise contri- vimces in "the system of Nature, that happiness may be co3n- municated to the various ranks of sensitive and hiieiiigent ex- istence. Goodness chooses the end^ and wisdom selects the most proper means for its accomplishment ; so that these two attributes must always be considered m simultaneous opera- tion. And, therefore, the instances I have already specified, of the Wisdom and Intelligence of the Creator, may also be considered, as exemphficati(5ns of Divine Benevolence. — I shall, therefore, conclude this topic with the following extract from Dr. Paley : — " Contrivance proves design ; and the {»roaiinent tendency of the contrivance, indicates the disposition of the designer. The world abounds with contrivances ; and all the contrivan ces we are acquainted with, are directed to beneficial purpoises Evil, no ddsibt, exists ; but it is never, that we can perceive, the object of contrivai-ice. Teeth are contrived to eat, not to ache ; their aching now and then^ is incidental to the co'ntri- viuice, perhiips inseparable from it : or even, if you will, lei it bo called a defect in the eontrivunce^ but it is not the object oi it. This is a distinction which well deserves to be aticnded to. In describing imj>lements of husbandry, you will haruiy say of a sickle, that it is made to cut tiie reaper's iingeis, though from the construction of the instrument, and the man- ner of using it, this mischief often iiappens. Bui if yoU taid RENEVOLENCr. OF THE BF.ITY. 11,5 occasion to describe instruments of torture or execution, this, you would say, is to extend the sinews ; this to dislocate the joints ; this to break the bones ; this to scorch the soles of" the leet. Here pain and misery are the very objects of the contri- vance. Now nothing of this sort is to be foinid in the works of nature. We never discover a train of contrivance to bring about an evil purpose. No anatomist ever discovered a sys- tem of organization calculated to produce pain and disease ; or, in explaining the parts of the human body, ever said, this is to irritate ;• this to inllame ; this duct is to convey the gravel to the kidneys ; this gland to secrete the humor which forms the gout. If, by chance, he come at a part of vvliich he knows not the use, the most he can say is, that it is >iscless ; nO one ",ver suspects that it is put there to incommode, to annoy, or 'arment. Since, then, God ha.th called forth his consummate wisdom to contrive and provide for our happiness, and the world appears to have been constituted with this design at first, so long as this constitution is upheld by him, we must, in reason, suppose the same design to continue." — ~rahifs Mu- red Pkilosophij, Book II. Chap. 5. Thus, I have endeavored, in this and the preceding section, to exhibit a few specimens of the Wisdom and Goodness of God, in the system of nature. These might have been multi- plied to an indefmite extent, but the instances adduced, I pre- sume, are sufficient to show, that the economy of the material world is not altogether a barren subject, to a pious and con- templative mind. Every intelligent believer in Revelation, will readily admit, that it would be a highly desirable object, to induce upon the mass of Christians such a habit of devout at- tention to the visible works of creation, as would lead them, in their social and solitary walks, to recognize the agency of God, in every object they behold ; to raise their thoughts to Him as the Great First Cause, and to expand their hearts with emo- tions of gratitude, liow very diiferent must be the senti- ments and the piety of the man who looks on the scene of wisdom and magnificence around him, with a " brute uncon- scious gaze," as thousands of professed Christians do — and the grateful and pious emotions of him who recognizes the be- nevolent agency of God, in the motions of his fingers, and his eye-balls ; ''in the p.ulsation of his heart ; in the picfeur'e of e:^- ternal objects, every m.o^ntont formed on his retina ; in the re- flection of the rays of light, and the diversified colors they pro- duce ; in the drying of his clothes ; in the constitution of the atmosphere ; in the beauty and magnifieence of the earth and the heavens ; and in every other o'uect that meetii his eycjri 116 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. the expanse of nature ! The numherless astonishing instances of Divine agency, which every where present therpselves to our view in the scene around us, seem evidently intended to arrest the mind to a consideration of an " ever-present Dei- ty ;" and I envy not the sentiments or the feelings of that man who imagines, that he stands in no need of such sensible me- diums, to impress his mind with a sense of the benevolent care and omnipresence of God. CHAPTEIl 11. CONTAINING A CURSORY VIEW OF SOINIE OF THE SCIENCES. WHICH ARE RELATED TO RELIGION AND, CHRISTIAN THEOLOGY. »oio« Theology has generally been viewed as a study of a very limited range: and, hence, when it has been admitted into the circle of the sciences, a much smaller space has been allotted for its discussion, than has been devoted to almost any other department of human knowledge. When considered, how- ever, in its most extensive sense — in its relations to the Divine Being — to his past and present dispensations towards the hu- man race— to the present circumstances, and the future des- tiny of man — and to the physical aixd moral coiulition of all the sentient aud intelligent b(iings of which we have any inti- mation; — it ought to be viev/ed as the most varied and com- prehensive of ajl the sciences ; gs embracing, within its ex- tensive grasp, all the otlier departments of useful knowledge, both human and divine. As it has God for its object, it must include a knowledge of the universe he has formed — of the movements which are continually going on throughout the wide extent of his empire, in so far as they lie open to our in- spection — of the attributes which appear to be displayed in all his operations — of the moral laws he has framed ibr the regu- lation of holy intelligences — of the merciful arrangements he has made for the restoration of fallen man — of the plans by which the knowledge of his will is to be circulated and exten- ded in the world in which we live — of the means by which truth, and moral purity, and order, are to be promoted among our apostate race, in order to their restoration to the happiness they have lost — together with all those diversilied ramilications of knowledge, which have either a more remote, or a more im- mediate bearing on the grand object now specified. Like the lines which proceed from the circumtcrence to the centre of 10* lis THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. an immense circle-:-:all the mq,ral* arts ^n^ sciences which have been invented by men — every department of human knowledge, however far it may, at first si^ht, appear to be re- moved from rehgion — may be considered as having a direct \)earing on Theology, as the grand central point, and as hav- ing a certain tendency to promote its important objects. It is much to be regretted, that Theology has so seldom been contemplated in this point of view — and that the sciences have been considered rather as so many independent branches of secular knowledge, than as subservient to the elucidation of the facts and doctrines of religion, and to the accomplish- ment of its benevolent designs. Hence, it has happened, that Philosophy and Religion, instead of marching hand in hand to the portals of immortality, have frequently set themselves in hostile array ; and combats have ensued equally injurious to the interests of both parties. The Philosopher has occasion- ally been disposed to investigate the economy of nature, without a reference to the attributes of that Almighty Being who presides over its movements, as if the universe were a self-moving and independent machine ; and has, not unfre- quently taken occasion, from certain obscure and insolated facts, to throw out insinuatiojis hostile to the truth and the character of the Christian Revelation. The Theologian, on the other hand, in the heat of his intemperate zeal against the infidel philosopher, has, ungardedly, been led to declaim against the study of science, as if it were unfriendly to reli- gion — has, in effect, set the wojks of God in opposition to his word — has confounded the foolish theories of speculative minds with the rational study of the works of Deity — and has thus prevented the mass of mankind from expanding their minds, by the contemplation of the beauties and sublimities of nature. It is now high time that a complete reconciliation were effected between these contending parties. Religion ought never to disdain to derive her supports and illustrations from the researches of science ; for the investigations of philoso- phy into the economy of Nature, from whatever motives they may be undertaken, are nothing else than an inquiry into the plans and operations of the Eternal Mind. And Philosophy ought always to consider it as her highest honor, to walk as an * The epithet moral is here used in its application to arts, because there are certain arts which must be considered as having an immoral tendency, such as, the art of war, the art of boxing, of gambling, &c. &c. and which, therefore, cannot liavc a direct tendency to promote the objects of reli- gion. INTRODUCTION OF THE SCIENCES. 119 handmaid in the train of that rehgion which points out the path to the regions of eternal bhss. By their mutual aid, and the subserviency of the one to the other, the moral and intel- lectual improvement of man will be promoted, and the bene- volent purposes of God, in the kingdom of providence, grad- ually accomplished. But when set in opposition to each other, the human mind is bewildered and retarded in its progress, and the Deity is apt to be considered as set in opposition to him- self — as proclaiming one system of doctrines from the econo- my of revelation, and another, and an opposite system, from the economy of nature. But if the Christian Revelation, and the system of the material world derived their origin from the same Almighty Being, the most complete harmony must sub- sist between the revelations they respectively unfold ; and the apparent inconsistencies which occur, must be owing chiefly to the circumstances of our present station in the universe, and to the obscure and limited views we are obUged to take of some of the grand and diversified objects they embrace. And, therefore, we have reason to believe that, when the ^system of nature shall be more extensively explored, and the leading objects of revelation contemplated in a clearer light, without being tinged with the false coloring of party opinions and contracted views, and when rational inquirers shall conduct their researches with a greater degree of reverence, humility, and Christian temper — the beauty and harmony of a^ the plans and revelations of the Deity, in reference both to the physical and the moral world, will be more distinctly perceived and appreciated. In the following cursory sketches, it forms no part of my plan to trace even an outline of the different sciences which are connected with religion, much less to enter into any particular details, in relation to their facts and principles. It would be comparatively easy to fill up the remaining sheets of this vol- ume with skeletons of the different sciences ; but such mea- gre details as behooved to be brought forward, could not be interesting to the general reader, and would fail in accomplish- ing the object proposed. My design simply is, to select some leading facts, or general truths, in relation to some of the phy sical sciences, for the purpose of showing their connection with the objects of religion and the interests of rational piety. At the same time, such definite descriptions will be given as \^ill enable common readers to appreciate the objects and bearings of the different branches of knowledge which may be presented to their view. 120 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHERo The first science* I shajl notice is, that of NATURAL HISTORY. This science, taken in its most comprehensive sense, in- chicles a knowledge and description of all the known facts in the material universe. it is to be regretted, that most books published under the title of JVatural History, to which common readers have ac- cess, contain nothing more than a general description of ani- mals, as if this science were confined merely to one class of feeings ; whereas there is an infinite variety of other objects seldom noticed, which would appear no less interesting, and,, in some instances, much more novel ai>d gratifying to the gene- ral reader, and to the youthful mind. All the diversified Ibrms^ if matter, whether existing on the surface or in the bowels of the earth, in the ocean, the atmosphere, or in the heavens, form the legitimate objects of this department of the science of nature. Were we, therefore, to sketch a comprehensive outline of the subjects of Natural History, we might, in the first place, take a cursory survey of the globe we inhabit, in reference to its magnitude, figure, motions, and general arrangements — the form, relations, and extent of its continents — the numerous islanf's which diversify the surface of the ocean — the magni- tude, the direction, and the extent of its rivers, and the quan- tity cf water they pour into the ocean — the direction, elevation, and extent of the different ranges of mountains which rise from its surface — the plains, morasses, lakes, forests, dells, and sandy deserts, which diversify its aspect — the extent, the mo- tions, the color, and the different aspects of the ocean, and the facts which have been ascertained respecting its sallness, its depth, its bottom, and its different currents. VVe might next take a more particular view of some of the most remarkable objects on its surface, and give a detail of the facts which are known respecting the history of volcanoes-^heir number — the countries in which they are situated — the awful pheno- mena they exhibit — and the devastations they have produced : + The term science, in its most general and extensive sense, signifies knowledge, parliculuvly that species of katAvledge Avhicli is acquired by the exertion of the human facnlties. In a more restricted sense, it. denotes, a systematic species of knowledge, which consists of rule and order, such as Mathematics, Astronomy, Natural Philosophy, kc. — In the di.scussions contained in this work, it is used in its most general sense, as driioting tlie various departments of human Iciiowlediie, in which sense, hi^iitory, bulli natural, civil, and sacred, may be tCxincd scUiu:. NATURAL HISTORY. 12f the history of earthquakes, their phenomena and efTecfs, and the countries most subject to their ravages — basaltic and rocky wonders, natural bridges, precipices, cataracts, ice islands, icebergs, glaciers, whirlpools, mineral wells, recipro- cating fountains, boiling springs, sulphuric mountains, bitu- minous lakes, volcanic islands — the various aspects of nature in the ditferent zones, and the contrasts presented betweea the verdant scenes of tropical climes^ and the icy cliffs of the polar regions. We would next take a survey of the subter- raneous wonders which lie beneath the surface of the earth — the immense chasms and caverns which wind in various direc- tions among the interior strata of our globe — such as the Great Kentucky cavern, and the grotto of Antiparos — the mines of salt, coal, copper, lead, diamond, iron, quicksilver, tin, gold, and silver — the substances which compose the vari- ous strata, the fossil bones, shells, and petrifactions which are embedded in the different layers, and the bendings and dis- ruptions which appear to have taken place in the substances which compose the exterior crust of the earth. We might next survey the aimosphere with which the earth is environed, and give n detail of the facts which have been ascertained respecting its specific gravity and pressure, the elementary principles of which it is compounded, its refractive and reflect- ive powers, and the phenomena which result from its various properties and modifications — the meteors which appear in its dijfferent regions — thunder and lightning, winds, hail, rain, clouds, rainbows ; parhelias or mock-suns, meteoric stones, the aurora borealis, luminous arches, ignes fatui, the mirage, the fata morgana, hurricanes, monsoons, whirlwinds and wa- terspouts, sounds and echoes. In prosecuting our survey of sublunary nature, we Avould next advert to the various orders of the vegetable tribes — their anatomical structure — the circulation of their juices — the food by which they are nourished — the influence of light and air on their growth and motions — their male and female organs — their periods of longevity — their modes of propagation — their diseases and dissolution — their orders, genera, and species — their immense variety — their influence on the salubrity of the atmosphere — the relation which their roots, leaves, and fruits bear to the wants of man and other animals, in supplying food, clothing, and materials for constructing habitations — the gums and resinous substances they exude — the odors they exhale — the variety of cqlors they exhibit — the vast diversity of forms in which they appear — and the beauty and variety which they spread over the whole face of nature. 122 THE CHRISTIAN PIIILOSOPIIER, The mine.Yal kingdmn would next require to be surveyed. We would inquire into the facts which have been ascertained respecting" the earthij, saline, injlunui-ahh', and meiallic sub- stances which are found on the.surlace and in the bowels of the earth — their specific and distinguishing cha,racters — the elementary principles, or simple substances, of which they are composed— :rthe regions of the earth where the respective minerals most frequently aliound — and the ends which they are designed to accomplish in the constitution of the globe. We would consider, more particqlarly, the various metals such as iron, copper, lead, tin, gold, silver, bismuth, zinc, &c. in reference to the substances v/itli which they are united in their native ores — the changes produced upon them by the action of oxygen and the didbrent acids-r-their combustibility — their combination w-ith phosphorus, sulphur, and carbon ; and various compounds into which they may be formed — their important uses in the arts which minister to the comfort and embellishment of human life — their rekition to the multifarious necessities of man — and the wisdom and goodness of the Creator, as displayed in their arrangement in the bowels of the earth, and in the admirable properties of which they are possessed. In these details, the natural history of Iron would hold a prominent place. Ir, jioint of ulilihj, it claims the high- est rank in the class of metals, and is intrinsically more valua- ble than gold and silver, and all the diamonds of the East. — There is scarcely a mineral substance in the whole compass of nature, wdiich affords a more striking instance of the bene- ficial and harmonious adaptation of things in the universal sys- tem. We would, therefore, consider it in reference to its vast abundance in all p.arls of the w^orld — the numerous substances into which it enters into com])ination — its magnetical property — its capability of being fused and welded — the num.exous useful utensils it has been the means of producing — its agency in carrying forward improvements in art and science,. in the civilization of barbarous tribes, and in promoting the progress of the human mind ; and the aids which it ajibrd^ to the Chris^ tian missionary in heathen lands. Having surveyed the inanimate parts of the terraqueous globe, and its appendages, we might next direct our attention to the animated tribes with which it is peopled. Beginning at JMaii, the head of the animal creation, we would detail the principal facts which have been ascertained respecting his structure and organical functions — the- muscular movements of the human body, the system of bones, nerves, veins, and arteries ; ihe process of respiration ; and the organs of vision, NATURAL HISTORY. 123 hearing, smelling, tasting, arid feeling, by which he holds a correspondence with the matcrinl world — the modifications which appear in his corporeal frame and in his mental facul- ties, dnring the periods of infancy, puberty, manhood, and old age-^the causes and phenomena of sleep and dreaming — the varieties of the human race, in respect of color, stature, and features — the deviations from the ordinary course of nature, which occasionally occur, in the case of monsters, dwarfs, and giants — the moral and intellectual faculties— and those distin- guishing characteristics which prove tlie superiority of man. over the other tribes of animated nature. The inferior ranks of the animal creation would next demancl our attention. We would take a survey of the numerous irihe^ of Quadrupeds., Birds, Fishes^ Serpents, Lizardsi and Insects^ in reference to the characteristic marks by which the different species are distinguished, — their food^ and habitations — the different modes in which they display their architective fa^ulty^ in constructing places Df abode for shelter and protection — ■ the clothing Avith which they are furnished — their sagacity in finding out the proper means for subsistence and self-preser- vation — thoir hostilities — their artiiices in catching their prey, and escaping their enemies — their modes of propagation — their transformations froni 01:^6 state and form to another — their migrations to different countries and climates — their various instincts — their care in rearing and protecting their youilg— their passionsj mental characters, and social disposi- tions—their language^ or modes of communication with each other— their capacities for instruction and improvement— their different powers of ioco-motion-^thc adaptation of all their organs to the purposes for which they' seem intended — the indications they give of being possessed of moral disposi- tions and rational powers — their different periods of longevity^ and the ends v/hlch they are hiiended to subserve in the system ot nature. Along with these details, certain views might be exhibited of the various forms of sensitive life, and modes of existence-^ which obtain in those numerous sp^^cies of animals which are invisible to the naked eye, and which the inicro-jcope discovers in almost every department of nature. ;Having surveyed the objects which compose our sublunary system, we would next direct our view to the regions of the sky, and contemplate the fimiU which have been discovered ill relation to the celestial or!)y. We would first attend to the apparcal niotion of the sun, the diabrent points of the horizon at which he se^Mns to rise and set^ and the different degrees of elevation !<> \vhif n lie arriv^o, at diiicici;!: seasons of the year, 124 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. — the different aspects he presents as viewed from different parts of the earth's surface, and the different lengths of days and nights in diffefSnt parts of the world. We would next attend to the Varied phases of the moon — the direct and re- trograde motions of the planets^^the apparent diurnal motion of the wholfe celestial sphere; from east to west-^atid the dif- ferent clusters of stars which are seen in our nocturnal sky, at different seasons of the year. We would next consider the deductions which science has made, respecting th^ order and an-angement of the planets which compose the solar system — their distances from the sun, and from the eartli — their magnitudes — the periods of their diurnal and annual revolu- tions — the secondary planets, or moons, which accompany them — their eclipses — the various phenomena whi(;h their surfaces present when viewed through telescopes — the phy- sical influence which some of them produce on the surface of our globe — and the singular appearance of those bodies called Comets, which occasionally visit this part of Our system. We would, in the next place, extend oilr vieWs to the starry re- gions, and consider the number of stars \yhich present them- selves to the naked eye — the immensely greater, numbers which are discovered by telescopes — the systems into which they appear to be arranged — the facts which have been ascer- tained respecting new stars — double and treble stars — stars once visible, which have now disappeared, from the heavens — variable stars, whose lustre is increased and diminished at different periods of time^^and the structure and position ot the many hundreds of JYcbtdcej or starry systems, v/hich ap- pear to be dispersed throughout the immensity of creation. xMl the particulars now stated, and many others which might have been specified — considered simphj as facts which exist in the; system of Nature — form the appropriate and legi- timate objects of Natural History, and demand the serious attention of every rational intelligence, that wishes to trace the perfections and agency of the Almighty Creator. To in- vestigate the causes of the diversified phenomena which the material world exhibits, and the principles and modes by which many of the facts now alkided to aro ascertained, is the peculiar province of Natural Philosophy^ Chemistry, and the Maiheniatical Sciences. Amidst soi vast a variety of objects as Natural History presents, it is difficult to fix on any particular facts, as speci- mens of the interesting nature of this department of know- ledge, without going beyond th»' liuiits to which 1 am neccs- sarilv cournuMl in this volume, i .-hull cuiit»;nt myself ^\■ith a NATUKAT. in STORY. 1'35 descnption of two objects^ which have a reference chiefly (o the vegetable kingdom. . The first of these is . The Banian Tree. — " Thi>^ tree, which is also called the Burr tree, or the Indian Fig\ is orie of the most curious and beautiful of Nature's productions, ih.the genial climate of Indian where she ; sports with the greatest variety and profu- sion. Each iree is in itself a grove ; and some of them are of an amazing size and extent^ and, contraiy to most other animal and vegetable. productions, seem to be exempted from decay. Eveiy branch from . the main body, throws out its own roots .; at first, in sn^all tender fibres, several yards from the ground ; these continually grow thicker, until, by a gra- dual descent, they reach the surface, and there, striking in, they increase to. large trunks.^ and become parent trees, shoot- ing out new l>ranches from the tops. These, in time, suspend their. roots, and, receiving nourishment from the earth, swell into trunks, and shoot forth other branches ; thus continuing in- a state of progression, so long as the earth, the first parent of them all, contributes her sustenance. A Banian tree, with tiiany hunks, tbrms the most beautiful walks, vistas, and cool recesses, that can be imagined. The leaves are large, sof>, and of a lively green ; the fruit is a small fig, when ripe, of a bright scarlet, afibrding sustenance to monkeys, squirrels, peacocks, and birds of various kinds, wliich dwell among the branches. ... " The Hindoos are. pecuharly fond of the Baniaii tree ; thf^v consider its long duration, its outstretching armsl and its oVershadmving beneficence, as emblems of the Deity, and almost pay it divine honors. The Brahmins, who thus ' find a tarie in every sacred grove,' spend much of their time in religious solitude, under the shade of the Banian tree ; they plant it liear their temples or pagodas ; and in those villages where iliere is no structure erecteu for public worship, they place an image under one of these trees, and there perform a morning and evening sacrifice. The natives of all castes and tribes al'e foitd of recreating in tlie cool recesses, beau- tiful walksi and lovely vistas of this umbrageous canopy, im- pervious to tlie hottest beams of a tropical sun. These are the trees tinder WliicK a sect of naked philosophers, called Gymnosophists assembled in Arrian's days, and this historian of Aiicient Greece presents a true picture of the modern Hindoos. ' In winter,' he says, ' the Gymnrit-iophists enjoy the benefit of the sim's ravs in the open air ; and in summer, M hen the heat becomes excessive, thry pass their time in cool juid moist places, undcir Ifirae trr'osS, which, ac(;ordinj]: to the 'ft 126 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPilEK. accounts of Nearchus, cover a circumference of Jive acres^ anil extend their branches so far, that te')i tkoasand men may easily find shelter under them.' " On the banks of tlie river Narbuddy, in the province of (^uzzerat, is a ]>anian tree, supposed, by some persons, to be the one described by INearchus, and certainly not inferior to it. It is distini.'ui^hed by the name of Cubbeer Burr, which was given it in honor of a famous saint, lii*;!! floods have, at \arious times, swept away a considerable part of this extraor- dinary tree ; but ^^ hat still remains, is nearly two thousand feel in circumference, measured round the principal stems ; the overhanging branches^ not yet struck down, cover a much lar- ger space ; and under it grow a number of custard-apple and other fruit trees. The large tiimks of this single tree amount to three hundred and fifty ; and the smaller ones exceed three thousand ; every one of these is constantly sending forth bran ches and hanging roots, to form other trunks, and become the parents of a future progeny. The Cubbeer Burr is famed throughout Hindostan, not le room to repose under its shade. It has long been the custom of the BritLsh residents in India, on their hunting and shooting parties, to form extensive encampments, and spend weeks together, un der this delightful and magnificent pavilion, which alfords a shelter to all travellers, particularly to the religious tribes of the Hindoos. It is generally filled wiih greenwood pigeons, doves, peacocks, and a variety of feathered songsters — with monkeys which both divert the spectator, by their antic tricks, and interest hini by the paternal affection they display to their young offspring, in teaching them to select their food, and to exert themselves in jumping from bough to bough, — ^^and is sKadcd by bats of a large size, many of them measuring up- wards of six feet, from the extremity of one wing to the other. This tree affords not only slieiter, but sustenance, to all its in- habitants, being covered amid its blight foliage, with small figs, of a rich scarlet, on which they all regale with as much delight as the lords of creation on their more costly fare, in their par- ties of pleasure.'' — See Encyciopwdia Jh itannica^ Art. Ficns. This tree, which is doubtless, one of the most singular and magnificent objects hi the vegetable kingdom), appears to be a world lU miniature, in which thousands both of humun behigs, NATURAL HISTORY. 127 arid of the inferior tribes that traverj^o tlic eartli and the air, may find ample a(*comtnodation and sul»sistA'iice. Whtit ii striking contrast does it present to the forests of trees, or mushrooms, which are perceived by the liclp of the microscope, in a piece oi^ movldiness — every plant of which is several hun- dreds of times smaller than the point of a fine needle ! Yet both are the elTects of the agency of the same All-wise and Omni- potent Being. And what an immense variety of gradations is to be found in the vegetable world, between these two ex- tremes—every part of the vast interval being filled up with flowers, herbs, shrubs, and trees of eery color, form, and size, and in such vast multitudes and profusi n that no man can number them ! An object, which approximates in a certain degree to the o>ie now described, is mentioned in " Statmton's Accoun- of Macartney's Embassy to China," p. 70. It is called by Bo- tanists, Adansoma, and is also known by the name of t,i<>. JSIorikey Bread Tree, and was discovered in the island of St. Jago. " The circumference, or girth of the l)a-.e, was 56 feet, which soon divided into two vast branches, the one in a per- pendicular direction, whose periphery, or girth, was 42 feet, the other 26. Another, of the same species, stood near it, whose single trunk, girthing only 38 feet, was scaiccly noti- ced," The only other specimen 1 shall exhibit to the reader has a relation both to the animal and to tho vegetable kingdom. ft is well known th tt the examination of flowers, and vegeta- bles of every description, by the microscope, opens a new and interesting field of wonders to the inquiring naturalist. .Sir John Hill has given the following curious account of what ap- peared on his exaatining a carnation : " Tho princi[)al flower in an elegant bouquet was a carna- tion : the fragrance of this led me to enjoy it frequently and near. The sense of smelling was not the only one atfected on these occ-^^ioas : while that was satiated with the powerful sweet, the ear was constantly attacked by an extremely solr, but agreeable m u-muring sound. It was easy to know that some aninjal within the covert must be the musician, and that the little noise must come from some little creature, suited to produce it. I instantly distended the lower part of the flower, and placing it in a lull light, could discover troops" of little in- sects frisking, with wild jollity, among the narrow pedestals that supporled its leaves, and the little threads that occupied its centre. What a fragrant world for tlieiv habitation ! What a perfect security lioin all anu -yance, m tlie duiky hiuk that 128 THE CIIKISTIAN PIllLOSOPlIEn. surrounded the scene of, action ! Adapting a microscope to take in, at one view, the whole base ot'tlie liower, I gave my- self an opportunity of cojitenipUiting what they were about, and this for many days together, without giving them the least disturbance. Thus, I could cUscover their economy, their, passions, and their enjoyments. The inicroscope, on this o.^r. casion, had given what nature seenied to have denied to the objects of contemplation. Tfie base of the flower extended itself under its' influence, to avast jilain ; the slencler. stems of the leaves became trunks of. so many stately cedars ; the direado in the midJl.G seeiiied coJ.nmiiS of masc3y structure, sup- porthig at ttie top their severaj, omanicnts ; and t\ne narrow spaces between were eiil;irged in walks, par(,evrtJ.s, a.nd terra- ces. On the polished bottoms of these, brighter than Parian marble, walked in pairs, alone, or ill larger couip:i!iies, the winged inhabitants : these, from httl«3 dusky flies, for such only the naked eye would have shown them, were raised to glo-, rious glittering animals, stained with livii\g purple, and with a glossy gold, that would have made all the labors of the loom, •ontemptible in the comparison. — I could, at leisure, as they valked together, admire their elegant linibs, their velvet shoul- iors, and their silken wings ; their bcvcks v)ing with the' emr jyrean in its blue ; and then- cyes^ each formed of a thousand ■>thers, out-glittering the little planes on a brilliant ; al)ove de- scription, and too great aimosi fur admiration. I could observe them here singling out their favorite fenudes ; courting them with the music of their buzzing wings, with little sungs, formed' fjDr their little organs, leading them from walk to walkj aino.ng the perfumed shades, and pouiting out to their taste, the drop of liquid nee tar,' just bursting irom some vein within the living trunk — kere were the perfumed, groves, the wore than myi!i,$ic shades of the J)Qet's' fancy realized. Ile're fhe happy lovers spent their days in joyful dalliance, or in the triumph of tljeir little hearts, skip.})ed after one another, front stem to s^ein, among the painted trees, or \vinged their short lUght- la the close shadow of some broader leaf, to revel uiidisiurbc4 \\\ th^ heights of all felicity." This picture of the splendor and I'elicity of insect life, Uiay, to certain rtuders, appear , somewhat overtdvirgod. Biit those who have been much in the habit of cVintemphiling the. beuu- ties of the auinud and vegetable world, through microscopes, can easily enter into a 1,1^ the vjewrf nhich are here destjribod. I have selected this example, for the pniposc of illustrating the uabouiidod goodness of the Creator, in t]ie vast profusion ot' enjoyment lie has conmiunicated, even to the lowest tribes of NATURAL IlISTOR . 129 nnimal exii^tenco, and as a specimen of those invisible worlds which exist beyond the range of our natural vision. For it appears that there is a gradation of worlds downwards, as \^ell as upwards. However small our globe may appear when com- pared with the sun, and with the immensity of starry systems which lie dispersed through the infinity of space, there ai o worlds fdled with myriads of living beings, which, in point of size and extent, bear as small, a proportion to the earth, as the earth bears to the vast assemblage of the celestial worlds. A single flower, a leaf, or a drop of water may appear as large and as diversified in its structure, to some of the beings which inhabit it, as the whole earth appears to the view of man ; and a thousand scenes of magnificence and beauty may be presen- ted to their sight, of which no distinct conception can be formed by the human mind. The many thousands of trans- parent globes, of which their eyes are composed, may magnify and multiply the objects around them without end, so that an object scarcely visible to the eye of man, may appear to them as a vast extended universe. *' Having examined," says St. Pierrc, " one day, by a mi- croscope, the flowers of thyme, I distinguished hi them, with equal surprise and delight, superb flagons with a long neck, of a substance resembling the amethyst, from the gullets of which seemed to flow ingots of liquid gold. I have never made observations of the corolla^ simply of the smallest flower, without finding it composed of an admirable substa-ice, half transparent, studded with brilliants, and shining in the most lively colors. The beings which live under a reflex thus enriched, must have ideas very different from ours, of ligh^ and of the other phenomena of nature. A drop of dew, fil- tering in the capillary and transparent tubes of a plant, pre- sents to them thousands of cascades ; the same drop fixed as a wave on the extremity of one of its prickles, an ocean with- out a shore ; evaporated into air, a vast aerial sea. — It is cre- dible, then, from analogy, that there are animals feeding on the leaves of plants like the cattle in om- meadows, and on our mountains, which repose under the shades of a down im- perceptible to the naked eye, and which, from goblets formed like so many suns, quaff nectar of the color of gold and silver." Thus it appears, that the universe extends to infinity on either hand ; and that whenever matter exists, from the pon- derous globes of heaven down to the invisible atom, there the Almighty Creator has prepared habitations for countless or- ders of existence, from the seraph to the animalcula, in order 11* 130 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. to demonstrate his bomidless beneficence, and the hifinite va ricty of modes by which he can dilluse happiness tbtqugli the universal system. ' * ' " How sweet, to muse upon His s^ill displayed !. Infinite skill ! iji all tliat he lias made : - '' To trace in natiire's most minute design The signature and stamp of Power Divine ; Contrivance exquisite, expressed with fease'^ Where unassisted sight no beauty sees ; The shapely limb and lubricated joint, "Within the small dimcnsiqiis of a point; Muscle and nerve miriiciiilously'spun, '■ His mighty work who speaks, and it is done. Til' invisible in things scarce seen revealed ; To Avhom an atom isan ample field !" — CovvPEr's Retirement. With regard to the relh^ious tendency of the study of ]Va- tural History, it may be remarked — that, as all the objects wliich it embraces are the ivorkmanship of God — the deline- ations and descriptions ofthe Natural Historian, must be con- sidered as " The history of the operations of the Creator ;" or, in other words, so tar as the science extends, " The his- tory of the Creator himself:" for the marks of his incessant agency, his power, wisdom, and beneficence arc impressed on every object, however minute, throughout the three king- doms of nature, and throughout every region of earth, air, and sky. As the Deity is invisible to mortal eyes, and can- not be directly contemplated. by iinile minds, without some material medium of communication — there are but two me- diums with which we are acquainted, by which we can attain a knowledge of his nature and perfections. These are, either the /acis which have occurred in the course of his providen- tial dispensations towards our race, since t!ie connncncement of time, and the' moral truths connected with ilaem — or, the facts which are displayed in the economy of nature. The lirst class of facts is recorded in the Sacred History, and in .he Annals of Nations ; ^he second class is exhibited in the diversified objects and motions which appear throughout the system of the visUile universe. The one may be termed the Moral History, and the other, the J)Caiur(il History of the operations of the Creator. It is obviously incumbent on every rational being, to contemplate the Creator through both these mediums ; for each of them conveys its (listinct and jiecuiiar revelations; and, consequently, our perception of Deity through the one medium, does not supersede the necossily of ourcon- teinplating him through the other. "While, therefore, it is our duty to contemplate the perfections, the providence, and the agency of God, as displa\ ed in the Scri]>ture Kevelation, h is NATURAL HISTORTC. 131 also incumbent upon us, to trace his attributes in the System of Nature, in order that we may be enabled to contemplate the eternal Jehovah, in every variety of aspect, in which he has been pleased to exhibit himself; in the universe he has formed. The visible creation may be considered as a permanent and sensible manifestation of Deity ; intended every moment to present to our view, the unceasing energies of Him " in whom we live and move." And if the train of our thoughts were directed in its proper channel, we would perceive God in every object, and in every movement : we would behold him oper- ating in the whirlwind, and in the storm ; in the subterraneous cavern, and in the depths of the oceaii ; in the gentle rain, and the refreshing breeze ; in the rainbow, the fiery meteor, and the lightning's flash ; in the splendors of the sun, and the majestic movements of the heavens; in the frisking of the lambs, the songs of birds, and the buzz of insects ; in the circulation of our blood, the movements of our joints, the mo- tion of our eyeballs, and in the rays of light which are conti- nually darting from surrounding objects, for the purposes of vision. For these, and ten thousand other agencies in the systems of nature, are nothing else but the voice of Deity, proclaiming to the sons of men, in silent but emphatic lan- guage, " Stand stiH, and consider the wonderful works of God." If, then, it be admitted, that the study of Nature is the study of the Creator — to overlook the grand and beaiitiful scenery Avith which we are surroinidedj^ or to undervalue any thing which Infinite Wisdom has formed, is to overlook and con- temn the Creator himself. Whatever God has thought pro- per to create, and to present to our view in the visible world it becomes man to study and contemplate, that, from thence he may derive motives to excite him to the exorcise of rever- ence and adoration, of gratitude and praise. In so far as any individual is unacquainted with the various facts of the his- tory of nature, in so far does he remain ignorant of the mani- festations of Deity ; for every object, on the theatre of the universe, exhibits his character and designs in a different point of view. He who sees God only as ho displays himself in his operations on the earth, but has never contemplated the firma-" ment with the eye of reason, must be unacquainted with those amazing energies of eternal Power, which are displayed in the stupendous fabric and movements of the orbs of heaven. He who sees God only in the general appearances of nature, but neglects to penetrate into his minute operations, must re- 132 iiiK cum ST I AN rniLoriOPHF.R, main ignorant of those astonishing manifestations of Divine wisdom and skill which appear iii the cuntriv'a,nces, adapta- tions, and functions af the animal and the vegetable king- doms. For, the more we know of the work, the more ac- cm-ate and comprehensive will he oitr viiivrs of the Intelligence by whom it was designed ; and the fartlier we carry our inves- tigations of the works of God, the more admirable and a^-to- nishing will his plans and perfections ap^xear. In short, a devout contemplation of the works of nature tends to ennoble the human soul, and to dignify and exalt the affec- tions. It inspires the mind with a relish of the beauty, the hariJiony, and order which subsist in the universe aroiuid us — it elevates the soul to the love and admiration of that lUiing who is the author of our comforts^ and oi" all that is sublime and benificent in creation, and excites UiJ to join with all holy beings in the chorus of praise to the God and Father of all. For they "Whom Nature's works can diarm, with God himself Hold converse, grow familiar day by day With his concej)tions, act upon his plan, And form to his the relisli of their souls." The man who surveys the vast field of nature, with the eye of reason and devotion, will not only gain a more comprehen- sive view of that illimitable power v/hich organized the uni- verse, but will lind his sources of enjopnent continually in- creased, and will feel an ardent desire after that glorious world, where the veil v\diich now hides from our sight some of the grandest manifestations of Deity will be withdrav/n, and the wonders of Omnipotence be displayed in all their splendor and perfection. In conformity with these sentiments, we find the inspired writers, in numerous instances, calling our attention to the wonders of creating power and wisdom. In one of the first speeches in which the Almighty is introduced as addressing the sons of men, and the longest one in the Bible," our atten- tion is exclusively directed to the subjects of Natural History ; — the whole address having a reference to the economy of Divine Wisdom in the arrangement of the world at its first creation — the wonders of the ocean, and of light and darkness — the phenomena of thunder and lightning, rain, hail, snow, frost, and other meteors in the atmosphere — the intellectual faculties of man, and the economy and instincts of quadrupeds, birds, fishes, and other tribes of animated existence. Indeed, * Job, chap, xxxviij. xxxix. xl. xl'. NATURAL IIISTOUY. loS the greater part of the yubiiine de.scrii)tions contained in the book of Job has a direct reference to the agency of God iu the material creation, and to the course of his p.roviclence in rehition to the ditlcrent chV^racters of inen; and the reasonirigs of (he diOercnt speakers in that sacred drama proceed on the supposition that their auditors were intimately acquahitcd with the varied appearances of nature, and their tendency to exhibit the character and perfections of the Omnipotent Creator We find the Psahiiist, in the 104th Psalm, employed in a de- vout description of similar objects, lix^m the contenip|ation of Vvhich his nfmd is raised to adoring views of their Almighty Author — and, from (he ^^hole of his survey, he deduces the following conclusions :— " llow manifold are thy works, O Lord ! Ill luisdom thou hast made them all ! The earth is full of thy riches ; so is this great and wide sea, wherein are things creeping innumerable, both small and great beasts. The Glory of the Lord shall endure for ever ; the Lord shall rejoice in all his works.* I will sing unto the Lord as long as I live ; I will sing praises to my God, while I have my being." ■ ; But in order to enter into the spirit of such sublime reflec- tions, we must not content ourselves with a superficial and cursory view of the objects and operations of nature, — we must not think it suliicient to a,cquiesce in such vague propo- sitions as these — " The glory of God is seen in every blade of grass, and every drop of water ; all nature is full of wojiders, from tUedust of the earth to the stars of the firmament." We must study the' works of creation with ardor, survey them with minute attention, aud endeavour to acquire a spacijic and com- prehensive know-ledge of the Creator's designs. We must endeavour to acquire a knowledge of the particular modes, circumstances, contexture, configurations, adaptations, struc- ture, functions, and relations of those objects in which bene- volence and design conspicuously appear — in the animal and the vegeiabte wurkl, hi thu ocean, the atmosphere, and the hea- * Th,e glory of the Lord in this passag;e, denotes the display of his per- fections in, the material universe : and the declaration, of the inspired wri- ter plainly injiniates, thai this disjilay will contiuue for ever, and will ix- niain as an ol)jt(-t of uuceasing conteniolation to all ijitolli£,ouocs, and as an eternal monvvncnt "of his 'l^)\ver and WisVloni. For, although the eartji and the aerii^l heavens will be changv?d at the close of that dispensation of Providence which respects our world, yet the j^eneral ij;anie of the uni- verse, in its other parts, m iU reni;\hi substantially the saa^c ; and not only so, but will in all probabiliry be |k'rp,,?tually increasing in magnitude and grandeur. And the change which will be ejected in'r-espect to tlic terra- queous globe and its appendages will be such, that Jehovah will have rea- son to "rejoice" iu this, as well as in all his other works. 134 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. vei)s ; that the mind may be enabled to draw the conclusion with full conviction and intelligence — " In ivisdom thou hast made them all.^^ The pointed interrogatories which Jehovah addressed to Job, evidently imply, that Job had previously ac- quired an intimate acquaintance with the works of nature. It seems to be taken for granted, as a matter of course, that he made himself acquainted with the general range of facts in the visible creation ; and the intention of the several questions presented to his consideration evidently was to impress him with a sense of his own impotency, and to lead him to the in- vestigation of the wonders of Creating Power which he had formerly overlooked. — The conclusion which the Psalmist draws respecting the Wisdom displayed throughout all the works of God, plainly intimates, that he had made the ditTerept parts of nature the subject of minute examination, and qf deep reflection ; otherwise he could not have rationally deduced his conclusion, or felt those emotions which filled his mind with the pious ra^pttu'e so beautifully expressed in that hymn of praise to the Creator of the world. We have, therefore, reason to believe, from these and other instances, that pious men, " in the days of old," were much more accustomed than modern Christians to contemplate and admire the visible works of the liord — and it is surely much to be regretted, that we who enjoy so many superior means of information, and who have access to the brilliant discoveries of later and more enlightened times, should manifest so much disregard to " the works of Jehovah and the fper part of tlie ves.sel. ' GEOGRAPHY. 137 disappear, which would not happen if the earth were a plane in that direction. 4. That the earth is round, from east to west, appears from actua,! experiment ; for many navigators, by sailing in a westerly directioil, hate gone quite round it, from east to west ; and, were it not for the frozen seas within the polar regions which interrupt navigation in those direc- tions, it would, long ere now, have been circumnavigated from north to south. 5. All those proofs are coiihrmed and illus- trated by eclipses of the moon^ which present an ocular de- monstration of the earth's rotundity. An eclipse of the moon is caused by the intervention of the body of the earth between the sun and the nldon ; ih which c?.se^ the shadow of the earth falls upon the nioon. This shadow is found in all cases, and in every position of the earth, to be of a circular figure : which incontrovertibly proves, that the whole mass of land and water; of which the earth is composed, is nearly of a glo- bular form. The moitntains and vales which diversify its sitr- face detract little or nothing from its globular shape ; for they bear no more proportion to its whole bulk than a few grains of sand to a common terrestrial globe ; the highest mountains on its surface being little more than the two thousandth part of its diameter. Some of the mountains on the snrfaee of the moon are higher than those on the earth, and yet that body ap- pears both to the naked eye, and through telescopes, of a spherical figure. To some readers, the discovery of the true figure of the earth may appear as a maitcr of very trivial importance iii re- ligion. I hesitate not, however^ to affirm that it constitutes a most important fact in the history of Divine Providence. Had not this discovery been made, it is probable, that the vast con- tinent of America might yet have remained undiscovered ; for Columbus, who first discovered that new world, had learned, contrary to the general opinion of the times, that the earth was of "a spherical figure ; and, from the maps then existingj be began to conjecture, that the nearest way of sailing to the East Indies, would be to sail westward. And although ho missed the object of his research, he was the. means of laying open to view a vast arid unknown region of the earth, des* fined, in due time, to receive from the Eastern world, the blessings of knov.ledge, civilization^ and religion. On the know^ledge of the spherical figure of the earth, the art of navi- gation, in a great mea.su.re depends ; and all the voyages of discovery, Avhich have been made in later years, were under- tik^u in consequence of the !fnawled(?e. r^f this fact. Had n-n'iliind remained uuacqna^itod with this discovery, the cir 1 ^ 133 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. ciimn&figation of the globe would never have been attempted, vast portions of the habitable World would have remained unknowh and unexplored — no regular intercourse would have been maintained between the various tribes of the human race, and, coiisfe^uently^ the blessings of Divine Reveiatibn could never hsive been communicated to the greater part of the Gen- tile world. ]5csides, the knowledge of the true figure and magnitude of our sublunary world forms the ground-work of all the sublime discoveries which have hitherto been made in the regions of the firmament. For its diameter forms the base line Of those triangles by which the distances and magni- tudes of the celestial globes have been determined ; without a knowledge of the extent of which; the important results which have been deduced respecting the system of the universe, could not have been ascertained, and, consequently, our views of the grandeur and omnipotence of the Deity^ and of the mag- nificence and extent of his dominions-, must have been much more circumsci-ibed than they now are. Such is the intimate connection that subsists between every part of the chain of Divine dispensations, that if any one Imk had been either bro- ken or dissolved, the state of things, in the moral and intellec- tual world', would have been very diflbrent frioni what it now is ; diid the plans of Providence, for accomplishing the renova- tion and improvement of mankind, would have been either par- tially or totally frustrated. With regard to the mascnitmU of the earth — I have aheadv stated the mode by which we may acquue the most accurate and comprehensive conception of this particular, ih the course of the illustrations which Were given of the Omnipotence of Deity, (pp; 34 — B8.) It is liecessary here only to remark — that, according to the latest computations, the diameter of the earth is abodt 7;930 mdes; and hs circumference 24,912 miles ; and, consequently^ the whole surface of the land and water it contains, comprehends an area of 197»552,1G0 milts. The proportion of land and water on its surface cannot be very ac- curately ascertained ; but it is quite evident, from an hjspec- tion of a map of the world, that the water occupies at least two-thirds of its surface, and, of course, the land cannot oc- cupy more than one-third. Supposing it to be only one-fourth of the earth's surface^ it will contain 49,387,040 square mdes, which is considerably more than what is stated in most of oii. late systems of Geography; in some of which the extent of the land is rated at 39 millions, and in others, so low as 30 millions of square miles — the former of which statements be- in" less than one-fifth, and the latter less than one-sixth of GEOGRAPHY 139 the snrftice of the globe. But, it is quite obvious that the ex- tent ot" the hintl cannot be less than one-fourth of the area of the globe, and must, therefore, comprehend at least 50 millions of square miles. And if a large Arctic continent, eleven hun- dred leagues in length, exist around the North Pole, as some French philosophers infer, from Captain Parry's late discove- ries* — the quantity of land on the terraqueous globe will be much greater than what has been now stated. General Divisions of the Earth. — The surface of the earth is divided, from north to south, by two bands of earth, and two of water. The first band of earth is the an- cient or Eastern Continent, comprehending Europe, Asia, and Africa ; the greatest length of ^yhich is found to be in a line beginning on the east nohit of the northern part of Tartary, and extending fVom thence to the Cape of Good Hope, which measures about 10,000 mdas, m a direction nearly from North-east to South-west ; but if measured according to the meridians, or fi'om north to south, it extends only 7,500 miles, from the northermost cape in Lapland to the Cape of Good Hope, This vast body of land contains about 86 millions of square miles, forming nearly one-fifth of the whole surface of the globe. The other band of earth k, what is commonly called the New Continent, which comprehends North and South America. Its greate^it length lies in a line beginning at the mouth of the river Plata, passing through the island of Jamaica, and terminating beyond Hudson's Bay ; and it meastires about 8,000 miles. Tiiis body of land contains about 14 millions of square miles, or somewhat more than a third of the old continent. It may not be improper here to remark, that the two lines now mentioned, which measure the greatest lengths of the two continents, divide them into two equal parts, so that an equal portion of land lies on each side of these lines, and that each of these lines has an inclination of about 30 degrees to the equator, but in opposite d.irections ; that of the old conti- nent extending from the north-east to the south-west; and that of the new continent, from the north-west to the south- east; and that they both terminate at the same degree of northern and southern latitude. It may also be noticed, that the ojid and new continents are almost opposite to each other, and that the old is more extensive to the north of the equator, and the new more extensive to the south. The centre of the oid'eontinent is in the 17th degree of north latitude, and the ♦ Hee Monthly Magaziiie, Apiil, 1823, p. 259, 140 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. centre of the new, in the 17th degree of south latitude; SO that they seem to be made to counterbalance each other, in order to preserve the equability of the diurnal rotation of the earth. There is also a singular connection between the two continents, namely, that if they were divided into two parts, all four would be surrounded by the sea, were it not for the two small necks of land called the isthmuses of Suez and Panama.* Between the two continents^ now mentioned, lie two im- mense bands of water, termed the Pacific and the Atlantic oceans, whose greatest length is likewise in a direction from north to south. Besides the two bands of earth to which I have adverted, many extensive portions of land are dispersed through the ocean, which covers the remaining part of the earth's surface ; particularly the extensive regions of New Holland, which occupy a space nearly as lurge as the whole of Europe, and the Arctic continent, which probably exist within the Norther-^. Polar regions, and which some French writers propose to designate by the name of Borcasia, is in all probability, ot pqual extent. There .are also the extensive islands of New ruinea, Borneo, Madagascar, Sumatra, Japan, Great Britain, lew Zealand, Ceylon, Iceland, Cuba, Java, and thousands of others, of different dimeiisions, scattered through the Pacific, the Indian, and the Atlantic oceans, and which form a very considerable portion of the habitable regions of the globe. General Features of the Earth's Surface. — In taking a general survey of the external fea.tures of the earth, the most prominent objects that strike the eye are those huge olevations which rise above the level of its general surface, termed Hills and Mountains. These vja distributed in various forms and sizes, through every portion of the conti- Dents and islands ; and running into immense chains, form a sort of connecting band to the other portion of the earth's sur- face. The largest mountains are generally formed into im- mense chains, which extend, in nearly the same direction, for several hundicJs, and even thousands of miles. It has been observed by some philosophers,' that the most lofty mountains ^orm two immense ridges, or belts, which, with some inter- ruptions, extend around the whole globe, in nearly the same direction. One of these ridges lies between the 45th and 55th degree of North latitude. Beginning on the western shores of France and Spain, it extends eastward, including the Alps * See Buffon's Natural History, vol. 1. JEOGRAryV. 141 Jinfl the PyrenccvS^ it^ Europe, the Uiahun and Ahaic moun- tains, in Asia — extending iioni thence to the shores of Kains- chatka, andj» after a short interruption iioni tlie sea, they rise again, on the western coast of America, aiid terminate at Canada, near the eastern shore. It is sui)posed that the cliain is continued completely round the glohe, through the space that is covered hy the Atlantic ocean, and that the Azores, and other islands in that direction^ are the only summits that are visible, till we canyd to the British isles. The other ridge runs along the Southern hemisphere,, between the 50th and 30th degrees of South latitude, of which, detached portions arc found in the mountains of Tu/>uman^ and of Paraguay, in South America, — of" Monomotpji and- C^ffiaria, in Africa ; in New Holland, New Caledonia, the New Hebrides, the Friend- ly, the Society, and other islands in the Pacilic ocean. From these ridges flows a variety of tamiiications, in both hemi- spheres, towards the Equator, and the Polps, which altogethei present a magnificent scenf>ry, which diversifies and enlivens the surface of our globe. The highest nidpuntains in the w^orld, according to some late accounts p.ub]ished in the '.'.Tra,nsa,ptions of the Asiatic Socie- ty," are the Iliiu.alsLija chain, north of Bengal, on the borders of Thibet. The highest mounta,,in in this range is stated to be about 27,000 feet, or g. liUlc. ni.ore tljiin five miles in a per- pendicular height, and is visible at the distance of 230 miles. Nineteen different mountains in this chain are stated to be above four miles ia perpendicular elevation. Next to the Himalayas, are the Andes, in Soutli America, v/hich extend more than 4000 miles in length, from the province of Quito to the straits of Magellan. Tbjs highest summit of the Andes, is Chimborazo, which is said to be 20,600 feet, or nearly four miles, above the level of the sea. The highest mountains in Europe, are the Alps, which run through Switzerland and the north of Italy, — the Pyrenees, which separate France from Spain, and the Dofrafeld, which divide Norway from Sweden The most elevated ridges in Asia, are Mount Taurus, Imaus, Caucasus, Ararat, the Uralian, Altaian, and the mountains of Japan — in Africa, Mount Atlas, and the mountains of the Moon Some of the mountains in these ranges, arc found to contain im- mense caverns or perforation?, of more than two miles in cir- cumference, reaching from their summits to an immeasurable depth into the bowels of the earth. From these dreadful open ings are frequently thrown up, to an immense height, torrents of fire and smoke, rivers of melted metals, clouds of ashes, and cmders, and sometimes red-hot stones and enormou.; 9cks, to 12* 142 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. the distance of several miles, accompanied with thunders, light- nings, darkness, and horrid siii)terraDeous sounds — producing the most terrible devastations through all the surrounding dis- tricts. The most noted mountains of this kind in Europe, are mount Hecla, in Iceland ; Etna, in Sicily ; and Vesuvais, near the city of Naples, in Italy. Numbers of volcanoes are also to be found in South America, in Africa, in the islands of the Indian ocean, and in the Empire of Japan.* We who live in Great Britain, where the highest mountain is little more Ihan three quarters of a mile in perpendicular elevation, can form no adequate idea of the magnificence and awful sublimity of the mountain scenery in some of the coun- tries now mentioned ; especially when the volcano is belching forth its (lames with a raging noise, and spreading terror and desolation around its base. From the tops of the lofty ridges of the Andes, the most grand and novel scenes sometimes burst upon the eye of the astonished traveller. He beholds the upper surface of the clouds far below him, covering the subjacent plain, and surrounding, like a vast sea, the foot of the mountain ; while the place on which he stands appears like an island in the midst of the ocean. He sees the lightnings issuing from the clouds, and hears the noise of the tempest, and the thunders rolHng far beneath his feet, while all is serene around him, and the blue vault of heaven appears without a cloud. At other times, he contemplates the most sublime and extensive prospects — mountains rangea around him, covered vAth eternal snows, and surrounding like a vast amphitheatre, the plains below — rivers winding from their sources towards the ocean — cataracts dashing headlong over tremendous cliffs — enormous rocks detached from their bases, and rolling down the declivity of the mountains Avith a noise louder than thunder — frightful preci}>ices impending over his head — unfathomable caverns yawning from below — and the distant volcano sending forth its bellowings, with its top enveloped in the fire and smoke. — Those who have stu- died nature on a grand scale, have always been strucic with ad- miration and astonishment at the sublime and awful exb.ibition of wondei*s which mountainous regions exhibit ; .and, perhaps, there is no icrrcslrial scene v.hich presents, at one view, so many objects of overpowcrmg magnitude and grandem*, and which inspires the mind with so impressive an idea of the power of that Almighty Being, \\ho " weighclh the mounlains in scales, and takcth up the iojes as a \Qiy little thing." * A more particular description of the phenomena of these terrific ol>- jects will be found in Chap. iv. Sect. 2. GEOGRAPHY. 143 The Ocean. — Thr, ocean siuToimds the earth on all sides, and penetrates into the interior parts of dificrent countries ; sometimes by large openings, and frequently by small straits. Could the eye take in this immense sheet of waters at one view, it would appear the most august object under the whole heavens. It occupies a space on the surface of the glolje at least three times greater than that which is occupied by the land; comprehending an extent of 148 milhons of square miles. Though the ocean, strictly speaking, is but one im- mense body of waters extending in different directions, yet different names have been appropriated to different portions of- its surface. That portion of its waters v.hich rolls between the western coast of America and the eastern oif Asia, is call- ed the Pacific ocean ; and that portion v»^hich separates Europe ai»d Africa from America, the .Atlantic ocean. Other portions are termed the JS'orlhern^ Soulhcrn, and Indian oceans. When its waters penetrate into the land, they form what are called gulfs, and mediterranean seas. But without following it through all its windings and divisions, I shall simply state a few general facts. With regard to the Depth of this body of water, no cei tain conclusions have yet been formed. Beyond a certain depth, it has hitherto been found unfathomable. We know, in general, that the depth of the sea increases gradually as we leave the shore ; but we have reason to believe that this in- crease of depth continues only to a certain distance. The numerous islands scattered every where through the ocean, demonstrate, that the bottom of the v>-atcrs, so far from uni- formly sinking, sometimes rises into lofty mountains. It is highly probable, that the depth of the sea is somewhat in pro- portion to the elevation of the land ; for there is some reason to conclude, that the present bed of the ocean formed the in- habited part of the ancient world, previous to the general De- luge, and that we are now occupying the bed of the former ocean ; and, if so, its greatest depth will not exceed four or five miles ; for there is no mountain that rises higher above Ihc level of the sea. But the sea has never been acUially sounded to a greater depth than a mile and 66 feet. Along the coast its depth has always been found proportioned to the height of the shore ; where the coast is high and mountainous, the sea that washes -it is deep ; but where the coast is lovr, the v.atcr is shallow. To calculate the quaniify of walcr it contains, we must therefore suppose a medium depth. If we reckon its average depth at two miles, it will contain 296 millions of cu- bical miles of water. We shall have a )no!e specific idea of 144 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. this enormous mass of water, if we consider, that it is suffi- cient to cover the whole globe, to the height of more than eight thousand feet ; and if this water were reduced to one spherical mass, it would form a globe of more than SOO miles in diameter. With regard to its Bottom — As the sea covers so great a part of the globe, we should, no doubt, by exploring its interior re cesses, discover a vast number of interesting objects. So far as the bed of the ocean has been explored, it is found to bear a great resemblance to the surface of the drj land ; being, like it, full of plains, caverns, rocks, and mountains, some of which are abrupt and almost perpendicular, while others rise with a gentle acclivity, and sometimes tower above the water, and form islands. The materials, too, which compose the bottom of the sea, are the same which form the basis of the dry land. It also resembles the land in another remarkable particular ; — many fresh springs, and even rivers, rise out of it ; an instance of which appears near Goa, on the western coast of Hindostan, and in the Mediterranean sea, not far froni Marseilles. The sea sometimes assumes different colors, The materials which compose its bottom, cause it to reflect different hues in different places ; and its appearance is also affected by. the winds and by the sun, while the clouds that pass over it communicate all their varied and fleeting colors. When the sun shines, it is green ; when he gleams through a fog, it is yellow ; near the poles, it is black ; while in the tor- rid zone, its color is often brown ; and, on certain occasions, it assumes a luminous appearance, as if sparkling with fire. The ocean has three lands of motions. The first is that undiilation M'hich is produced by the wind, and which is en- tirely confined to its surface. It is now ascertained that this motion can be destroyed, and its surface rendered smooth by throwing oil upon its waves. The second motion is, that con- tinual tendency which the whole water in the sea has towards the west, which is greater near the equator than towards the poles. It begins on the west side of America, where it is moderate ; but as the waters advance westward, their motion is accelerated ; and, after having traversed the globe, they re- turn, and strike with great violence on the eastern shore of America. Being stopped by that continent, they rush, with impetuosity, into the Gulf of Mexico, thence they proceed along the coast of North America, till they come to the south side of the great bank of Nev/foundland, when they turn off and rnn down through the Western Isles. This motion is most probably owing to the diurnal revoiutiuiiof the eartli on its axi^-, ^ GEOGRAPHY. 145 Ivhich is in a directiqn contrary to the motion of the sea. The third motion of the sea is the tide, which is a re^ukir swell of the ocean every 12^ hours. Tlie motion is now ascertained to be owing to the attractive iniiut-nce of the moon, and also partly to that of the sun. There is always a llux and retlux at the same time, in tw q parts of the globe, and these are opposite to each other ; so that when, our Antipodes have high water we have the sqme. AVhen the attractive powers of the sun and moon act in the same direction, which happens at the time of new and full moon, w^e have the highest or spring tides ; but when their attraction is opposed to each other, which hap- pens at the quarters, we have the lowest, or neap tides. Such is the ocean, — a most stupendous scene of Omnipo- tence, which forms the most magnificent fqature of the globe we inhabit. When vve stand on the sea-shore, and cast our eyes over the expanse of jts waters, till the sky and the waves seem to mingle, all that the eye can take in at one survey, is but an inconsiderable speck, less than the hundred thousandth part of the whole of this vast abyss. If every drop of water can be divided into 26 millions of distinct parts, as some phi- losophers have demonstrated,* what an immense assemblage of watery particles must be contained in the unfathomable ca- verns of the ocean ! Here the powers of calculation are com- pletely set at defiance ; and an image of infinity, inmiensity, and endless duration is presented to the mind. This mighty expanse of waters is the grand reservojr of nature, and the source of evaporation, which eiiriches the earth with fertility and verdure. Every cloud which floats in the atmosphere, and every fountain, and rivulet, and flowing stream are indebt- ed to this inexhaustible source for those watery treasures which they distribute through eyery region of the land. In fine, whether we consider the ocean as rearing its tremendous Dillows in the midst of the tempest, or as stretched out into a smooth expanse — whether we consider its immeasurable ex- tent, its mighty movements, or the innumerable beings which glide through its rolling waves — -we cannot but be struck with astonishment at the grandeur of that Omnipotent Being who holdfi it waters " in the hollow of his hand," and who has said to its foaming surges, " Hitherto shalt thou come, and no far- ther, and here shall thy proud waves be stayed." Rivers. — The next feature of the earth's surface which may be noticed, is, the rivers with which it is indcntc^ ui every * The demonstration of this proposition may be seen in Nieuwentyt's Rel. PJiilosoplier, vol. iii. p, Si)2. 146 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. direction. — These are exceedingly numerous, and seem to form as essential a pari in the constitution of our globe, as the moun- tains from which they flow, and as the ocean to. which they di- rect their course. It is reckoned, that in the old continent, there are about 430 rivers which fall directly into the ocean, or into the Mediterranean arid the Black seas ; but in the new continent, there am only about 145 rivers known, which fall directly mto the sea. In this enumeration, however, only the great rivers are included, such as the Thames, the Danube, the Wolga, and the Rhone. Besides these, there are many thousands of streams of smaller dimensions, which, rising from the mountains, wind in every direction, till they fall into the large rivers, or are carried mto the ocean. The largest rivers in Europe are — the Wolga, which, rising in the northern parts of Russia, runs a course of 1700 miles, till it falls into the Caspian sea — the Danube, whose course is 1300 miles, from the mountains in Switzerland to the Black sea — and the Don, which runs a course of 1200 miles. The greatest rivers in Asia are — -the Hoanho, in China, whose course is 2400 miles — the Boorhampooter, th<^ Euphrates, and the Ganges. The longest river in Africa, is the Nile, the course of which is estimated at 2000 miles. In the contijient of America, the ri- vers appear to be formed on the grandest scale, both as to the length of their, coiu'se, and the vast body of waters which they pour into the ocean. The Amazon, the largest river in the world, runs a course of above 3000 mil&s across the continent of South America, till it falls into the Atlantic ocean, where it discharges a body of waters 150 miles in breadth. Next to this is the river St. Lawrence, which is more than 2400 miles from its mouth through tL^ lake of Ontario to the lake Alempigo and the Assiniboils ; and the rivers La Plata and Mississ-i^ppi, each of wkose courses is not less than 2000 miles. When we consider the number and the magnitude of these majestic streams, it is evident that an enormous mass of wa- ter is continually pouring into the ocean, from every direction. From observations which have been made ow the river Po, which runs through Lombardy, and waters a tract of land 380 miles long, and 120 broad, it is found, that it nioves at the rate of four miles an hour, is 1000 feet broad, and 10 feet in depth, and consequently, supplies the sea v.ith 5068 millions of cubical feet of water in a day, or a cubical mile in 29 days. On the supposition that the quantity of water which the sea re- ceives from the great rivers in all countries, is ))roportional to the extent and surflice of these countries, it will follow, that tho GEOGRAPHY. 147 quantity of waters carried to the sea by all the other rivers on the globe, is 1083 times greater than that furnished by the 1?o, (supposing the land, as formerly stated, to contain abblit 49 miUions of square miles,) and will supply the ocean with 13,630 cubical miles of water in a year. Now, reckoning the ocean, as formerly, to contain 296 millions of cubical miles of water, this last number, divided by the former, will give a quo- tient of 21,716. . Hence it appears, that, were the ocean com- pletely drained of its waters, it would require more than tiventy thousand ijears'^ before its caverns could be again completely filled by all the rivers in the world running into it at their pre- sent rate. Here^ two questions will naturally occur — Whence do the rivers receive so constant a supply of waters ? and why has ^lot the ocean long ago overflowed the world ? since so prodi- gious a mass of water is continually flowing into its abyss. This was a diftrculty which long puzzled. philosophers ; but it is now satisfactorily solved from a consideration of the effects of evaporation. By the heat of the sun the particles of water are drawn up into the atmosphere iroili the surface of the ocean, and float in the air in the form of" clouds or vapor. These vapors are carried, by the winds, over the surface of the land, and are again condensed into water on the tops and the sides of mountains-, which, gliding down into tlicir crevices and caverns, at length break ouli into springs, a number of which meeting in one conunon valley becomes a riVer ; and many of these united together at length form such streams as the Tay, the Thames, the Danube, and the Pchiiie. That evapo- ration is sutlicient to account for this effect, has been demon- strated by many experiments and calculations. It is found that, from the surfiice of the Mediterranean sea, which con- tains 762j000 square miles, there are drawn up into the air, every day, by evapoi-ation, 5280 millions of tons of water, while the rivers which flow iiito it yield Only 1827 millions ot tons in the same time ; so that there is raised in vapor from the Mediterranean nearly three times the quantity of water which is poured into it by all its rivers. One third of this falls into the sea before it reaches the land ; another pcirt falls on tlie low lands, for the nourishment of plants ; and the other third part is quite sufticient to supply the sources of all the * BufFon makes this result to be 8!2 years, in which lie is folldycd by Goldsmith, find most suhscqucnt writer"^ : !nit he proceeds on the False a'^- sumption, thai the ocean covers only hail' the surface of the globe, and that it contains only S5 miUions of square miles, and he estimates the average O^pth of the ocean to be only 440 yards, or one fourth of a mile. 148 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. rivers which run into the sea^ This is in full conformity to what was long ago stated bj Ah inspired JVaturalist : "All the rivers run into the sea, and yet the sea is not full; unto the place from whence the rivers earned thither do they return again," but, before they regain their former place; they make a circuit over our heads through the regions of the atmosphere. Such are tlie varied movements and transformations which are incessantly going on in the rivers, the ocean, and the at- mospMere, in order to preserve the balance of nature, and to supply the necessities of the animal and the vegetable tribes ; all under the agency and direction of Him who " formed the ^ea ond the dry landj" arid vrho has arranged all things in num- ber, weight, and measure; to subserve the puvposes of his will. Rivers serve many important purposes in the economy of bur globe. They carry off the redundant waters which fall in raiiis; or which ooze from the springs; which might otherv/isc settle into stagnant pools ; they supply to the seas the loss of waters occasioned by their daily evaporation ; they cool the air and give it a gentle circulation ; they fertilize the coimtries through which they flow; theif v/aters afford a wholesome drink, and the fishes tliey contftin, a delicious food for the nour- ishment of man : they facilitate commerce; by conveying the productions of nature and art from the inland courifrfes to the sea ; they form mechanical powers for driving machinery of diiferent kinds ; they enliven and diversify the scenery of the countries through which they pass ; and the cataracts which they fi-equently form among the mountains, present us with scenes the most picturesque and sublime ; so that every part of the constitution of nature is rendered subservient both to utility and to pleasm-e. VVaving the consideration of other particulars.! shall simply state some of the artificial divisions of flic earth, and two 6^ three facts respecting it* inhabitants. The land Iiq.s generally been divided into four parts, Eu- rope, Asia, Africa, and, America, to which has been lately added the divif^ion called Australasia, which comprehends New Holland; New Guinea, New Zealand, Yan Dioman's land, and several other islands in the Pacific ocean. Europe comprehends the following countries, Norway, Sweden; Hen- murk, Russia, Prussia, Germany, Au>-tria^ Turkey, Haly, Switzerland, Franco, Ilolland, or the Netheilands, Spain, Portugal, and Great Britain and Ireland, together with the islands of Sicily, Malta, Candia, Corsica, Sardinia, Majorca, PvTinorca, Ivica; Zealand, Funan, Gothland,' Iceland, and seve- ral others of sinaller note. — ^.^=;a, the largest and most popu- GEOGRAPIiy. I 19 lOns division of the ancient continent, contains the Empires of China and Japan, Chinese Tartary, Thibet, llindostan, or British India, the Birman Empire, Persia, Arabia, Turkey in Asia, Siberia, Independent Tartarj, and a variety of territories inhabited by tribes with which we are very imperfectly acquaint- ed ; together with the immense islands of Borneo, Sumatra, Java, Ceylon, Segalien, the Phillippines, and thousands of others of smaller dimensions. It was in Asia where the human race was first planted ; it became the nursery of the world after the universal deluge, and it was the scene in which the most me- morable transactions recorded in the sacred history took place. But its inhabitants are now immersed in Mahometan and Pa- gan darkness ; and the Christian religion, except in a few in- i^;ulated spots, is .almost unknown among its vast population. It is the richest and most fruitful part of the world, and pro- duces cotton, silks, spices, tea, colfee, gold, silver, pearls, dia- monds and precious stonea : but despotism, in its worst forms, reigns uncontrolled, over every part of this immense region. ^ifrica comprehends the following kingdoms, — Morocco, Algiers, Tunis, Tripoli, Egypt, Zaara, Negroland, Guinea, Nubiaj Abyssinia, Caffraria, Dahomy, Benin, Congo, Angola, and various other territories. By far the greater part of Afri- ca remains hitherto unexplored, and, consequently, we are pos- sessed of a \Qiy slender portion of information respecting the nuiiTerous trifjes that jnay inhabit if. This quarter of the world, which onc« contained several flourishing kingdoms and .states, is now reduced to a general state of barbarism. That most abominable traffic, the slave trade, is carried * on to an unlimited extent on its eastern coasts, by a set of European ruffians, whose villanies arc a disgrace to human nature. Its iTiost strilqng features are those immense deserts, near its northern parts, which comprise nearly one third of its surface. The deserts of Zaara are 1500 miles long, and 800 broad. ; Aniericci is dividfed into North and South. It remained un- kno#n to the inhabitants of the Eastern Hemisphere till the year 1492, when it was discovered by Columbus, who first landed on Guanahani, or Cat Island, one of the Bahama isles. North America comprehends the following countries : The United States, New and Old Mexico, Upper and Lower Canada, Nova Scotia, New Brunswick, and Labrador. South America comprehends the immense districts called Terra Fir- ma, Peru, Guiana, Amazonia, Paraguay, Brazil, Chili, and Patagonia. — Between N. and S. America lie the islands of Cuba, St. Domin;go, Jamaica, and Porto Rico, known by the name of th« IVest Indies, Besides those, there are connected 15 150 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. ^vith America, the Bahama, and Carribbee islands, Newfound- land, Cape Breton, Tobago, Trinidad, Terra del Fnego, &c. America is distinguished by its munerous and extensive lakes, which resemble large irdand seas. Its rivers, also, form one of its grand and distinguishing features, being the largest on the globe. It is likewise diversified with lofty and extensive ranges of mountains. When first discovered it was almost wholly covered with immense forests, and thinly peopled with a number of savage tribes. Its mingled population of Abori- ghies and Europeans, is now making rapid advances in know- ledge, civilization, and commerce. In regard to the huuuui inhabitants that occupy the differ- ent regions now specified — they have been divided by some geographers into the six following classes — 1. The dwarfish mhabitants of the polar regions ; as the Laplanders, the Greenlanders, and the Esquimaux. — 2. The flat-nosed olive- colored tawny race ; as the Tartars, the Chinese, and the Japanese. — 3. The blacks of Asia with European features. Of this description are the Hindoos, the Birmans, and the in- habitants of the islands in the Indian ocean. — 4. The woolly- haired negroes of Africa, distinguished by their black color, their fiat noses, and their thick lips. — 5. The copper-colored nritive Americans, distinguished likewise by their black hair, small black eyes, high cheek bones, and flat noses. — 6. The sixth variety is the white European nations, as the British, the French, the Italians, and the Germans. The number of inhabitants which people the earth at one ne may be estimated to amount to at least eight hundred ■.dUlions ; of which 500 millions may be assigned to Asia ; 80 millions to Africa; 70 mUlions to America; and 150 millions to Europe. — Willi regard to their religion, they may bo estimated as follows Pagans, . . . 490,000,000 Mahometans, . . 130,000,000 Roman CatholKs, . 100,000,000 Protestants, . . . 43,000,1(00 Greeks and Aiminians, 30,000,000 Jews, .... 7,000,000 800,000,000 t rom this estimate it appears, that there are more than 4 t'.agans and Mahometans to 1 Christian, and only one Pro- tectant to 17 of all the other denominations. Although all ^.0 Roman Catholics, Greeks, and Protestants were reckon- ci true Christians, there still remain more than 620 millions unr fellow men ignorant of the true God, and of his will as GEOGRAPHY. 151 revealed In the Sacred Scriptures ; which shows what a vast field of exertion still lies open to Christian benevolence, be- fore the blessings of civilization, mental improvement, rational liberty, ai)d Christianity be fully communicated to the Pagan and Mahometan world. If we suppose that the earth, at an average, has always been as populous as it is now, and that it contains 800 mil- lions of inhabitants, as above stated, and if we reckon 32 years for a generation; at the end of which period the whole human race is renewed; it will follow, that 145 thousand millions of human beings have existed on the earth since the present system of our globe commenced, reckoning 5829 years; from Adam to the preseiit tirne.* And, consequently, if mankind had never died, there would have been 182 times the present number of the earth's inhabitants now in exist- ence. It follows from this statement, that 25 millions of mankind die every year, 2853 every iiour, and 47 every minute, and that at least an equal number, during these pe- riods, are emerging iVom non-existence to the stage of life ; so that almost every moment, a rational and immortal being is qsl^ered into the world, and another is transported to the invisil^le state. Whether, therefore, we contemplate the world of matter, or the world of mind, we perceive incessant changes and revolutions going on, which are gradually carry- ing forward the earth and its inhabitants to some important consummation. — If we suppose, that, before the close of time, as many human beings will be brought into existence, as have already existed, during the by-past ages of the world, there will, of course, be found at the general resurrection, 290,000,000,000 of mankind. Vast as such an assemblage would be, the whole of the human beings here supposed, al- lowing 6 square feet for every individual, could be assembled within the space of 62,400 square miles, or on a tract of land not much larger than that of England, which contains, ac- cording to the most accurate calculation, above 50,000 square miles. * Tins calo.ulation proceeds o,n the supposition, that only 4004 years elapsed between the Mosaic Creation and the birth of Chnst, according to tlic Hebrew Chronology. But Dr. Hales, in his late work on Scripture CJirouoIogy, lias proved, almost to a demonstration, that, from the Crea- tion to the birth of Christ are to be reckoned 5411 years ; and this com- putation nearly agrees with the Samaritan and Se[)tuagint Chronology, and with that of Josei>lius. Accordijig to this cutation, 72P»5 ye.iis aie to be rci-koried from the Creation to the i)rescnt time; and, coni(" fluently, 2'iO thousand millions of human bein;.'s will have exist«;d sin:e the Creation, which is more than 22G times the number of iuliabitaiila presently existing. 152 THE CHRISTIAN nilLOSOPUER. Our vvoilu is cnpablc of sustaining a much greater number of inhabitants ,tlian has ever yet existed upon it at any one time. And siace we are informed in the Sacred Oracles, that God " created it not in vain, but /briireti it to be inhabited," we have »-cason to'bebeve, that, in future ages, when the phy- sical and moral energies of 'mankind shaU be fully exerted, and when Peace shall wave her olive branch over the nations, the earth will be much more populous than it has ever been, and those immense deserts, where ravenous animals now roam undisturbed, will be' tiansiVrnied into scenes qf fertility and beauty. If it be admitted, that the produce' of 12 acres of land is sufTicient to' maintain a family consisting of six per- sons, and [f WQ reckon only one-fourth of the surface cf the globe capable of cultivation, it can be proved, that the earh could afford s\istenance for 16,000 millions of inhabitants, or twenty times the number that is piesrntly supposed to exist. So that we have no reason to fear diat the world will be over- stocked vvirh inhabitants tor many ages to come ; or that a period may soon arrive when the increase of population will surpa.ss the means of subsistence, as some of the disciples of Ma'thus have lately insinuated. To suppose, as some of those gentlemen seem to do, that wars and diseases, poverty and pestdence, are necessary evils, in order to prevent the increase of the human race beyond the means of subsistence which nature can alTord — ^^vhi|e the immense regions of New Holland, Nev/ Guinea, Borneo, rind the greater part of Africa and America are a^lmost destitute of inhabitants — is both an insult on the dignity of h\iman nature, and a reflection on the wisdom and beneficence of Divine Provideneej The Creator is benevolent and bountiful, and '' his fenidei^ mei-'cies are over all his works ;" but man, by his tyranny, ambitiohj and self- ishness, has counteracted the streams of Divine beneficence, and introduced into the social state, poverty, disorder., and misery, with all their attendant train of evils.; and it is not before such demoralizing pfiriciple.'^ i}e i]i somjs measure era- e!icated, and the princii^les of Christian benevolence brought into active operation, that the social state of man wdl be greatly meliorated, and the bounties of Ijeaven fully enjoyed by the human race. If, in tiie present deranged state of the social and political world, it be found. difficidt, in any parti- cular coimtry, to find sustenaiiee for its iiih:d>itants, emigra- tion is the obvious and natural remedy ; and the rapid emi- grations which are now taking place to the Capo of Good Hopf', Nfuv Holland, Van Dicman's Land, and America, are, doubtless, a part of those arrangements of Providence, by GEOGRAPIIF. 153 which the Creator will accomplish his designs, in peopling the desolate wastes of our glohe, and promoting the progress of knowledge, and of the true religion among the scattered tribes of mankind. With that brancn of knowledge to which I have nov/ acl- verted, every individual of the human race ought to be in some measure acquainted. For it is unworthy of the dignity of a rational being, to stalk abroad on the surface of the earth, and enjoy the bounty of his Creator, without considering the nature and extent of his sublunary habitation, the variety of august objects it contains, the relation in which he stands to other tril^es of intelligent agents, and the wonderful machinery which is in constant operation for supplying his wants, and for producing the revolutions of day and night, s|)ring and autumn, summer and winter. — In a religious point of view. Geography is a science of peculiar interest. For " the salvation of God," which Christianity unfolds, is destined to be proclaimed in every land, in order that men of all nations, and kindreds, and tongues may participate in its blessings. But, without ex- ploring every region of the earth, and the numerous islands which are scattered over the surface of the ocean, and open- ing up a regular intercourse with the ditfcrent tribes of human beings which dwell upon its surface, we can never carry'into effect the purpose of God, by " making known his salvation to the ends of the earth." — As God has ordained, that " all flesh shall see the salvation" he has accomplished, and that human beings shall be the agents for carrying his designs into effect — so, we may rest assured, that he has ordained every mean requisite for accomplishing this end ; and, consequent- ly, that it is his will that men should study the figure and magnitude of the earth, and all those arts by which they may be enabled to traverse and explore the ditferent regions of land and water, which compose the terraqueous globe — and that it is also his will, that every one who feels an interest in the present and eternal happiness of his fellow-men, should make himself acquainted with the result of all the discoveries in this science that have been, or may yet be made, in order to stimu- late his activity, in conveying to the wretched sons of Adam, wherever they may be found, " the unsearchable riches of Christ." To the Missionary, and the Directors of Bible and Mis sir feels greal pleasure in referring his rcnd- CV55 to a small volume; lately }.)ubli.shed, by James Doufflas, E-q. of Cavers, em.illed, "Hints on rxlission^," — a work which deserves the attentive perusal, both of the philosopher, the politician, and the Christian, and par- ticularly of the Directors of Missionary Societies ; and which is charac- t.crizeil by a spirit of enlightened philanthropy, and a condensation of Ihmight, which has seldom been ctjualled in the discussion of such topics. It concentra-es, as it Avere, into a focus, the liglit which has been reflected from hundreds of volumes ; and the original hints it suggests, claim the scrisiunce (if this volume, in a less uipeuoivt; fjru), an.l willi a ihw iuod.ii; aiiuiio, Cu bring it within the GEOGRAPHY. 155 But even to every private Christian, Geography is an inter- esting branch of study, without some knowledge of which his prayers and his Christian sympathies cannot be judiciously and extensively directed. \Ve occasionally hear the ministers of religion, at the comnicncemcnt of public worship, on tho first day of the week, imploring the Divine blessing on their brethren throughout the Christian church, who are commenc- ing the same exercises ; and at the close of worship in the afternoon, that the same blessing may seal the instructions which have been delivered in all the churches of the saints ; as if all the public religious services of the universal church were, at that moment, drawing to a close. This is all very well, so far as it goes : the expression of such benevolent wishes is highly becoming and congenial to the spirit of Christianity. But a very slight acquaintance with Geogra- phical science will teach us, that, when we in this country are commencing Ihe religious services of the first day of the week, our Christian brethren in the East Indies, who live under a very different meridian, have finished theirs ; those in Russia, Poland, Greece, Palestine, and on the banks of the Caspian sea, have performed one half of their public religious worship and instructions ; and those in New Holland and Van Die- man's Land have retired to rest, at the close of their Sabbath. On the other hand, our friends in the West India Islands and in America, at the close of our worship, are only about to conv mence the public instructions of the Christian Sabbath. If, then, it bo submitted, that our prayers, in certain cases, ought to be specijic^ to have a reference to the particular cases and relations of certain classes of indbviduals, there can be no valid reason assigned, why they should not have a reference to the geographical positions of the diiferent portions of the Christian Church, as well as to those who live on or near our own meri- dian : that, for example, in the beginning of our public devo- tions, we might implore that the; blessing of God may accom- pany the instructions which have been delivered in the Eastern parts of the world ; and at the close of worship, that the same agency may direct in the exercises of those in tho AVestern hemisphere, who are about to enter on the sacred services of that day. On the same principle, we may perceive the absur- dity of those " coiic'eris^^* for prayer in difierent places at ihs rangje of thouc^ht possessed by g:eneral i-eciclcrs, would not have a tendency * to promote its benevolent o'ojects. * The author doe's not seem to mean, that it is nhaurd for Christians in every part of tlie earth to assemble on the same day in their respective places of devotion, to pray for a universal extensiun of chnrslianity. This objoc- loU THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. same, hour, which were lately proposed, and attempted by a certain portion of the religions world. Eyen within the limits of Europe, this could not be attempted, with the prospect of Christians joining in deyotion at one and the same time ; for, when it is six o'clock in one part of Ein*ope, it is eight at another, and five o'clot>k at a third place ; inuch less could such a concert take place throughout Europe, Asia, 'and Ame- rica. So that science, and a calm consideration of the nature and relations of things, may teach us to preserve our devotional fervor and zeal within the bounds of reason and propriety ; and, at the same time, to turcct our reflections, and our Christian sympathies, to take a Avider range than that to which they are usually confined. Besides the considerations now suggested,, a serious con- templation of the physical objects and movements which this science exhibits, has a tendency to excite pious and reverential emotions. To contemplate this huge ^lobe of land and water, flying with rapidity through the voids of space, conveying its vast population from one region to another, at the rate of fifteeri hundred thousand miles in a day, and whirling round its axis at the same time, to produce the constant succession of day and night, — to contemplate the lofty ridges of mountains that stretch around it in every direction ; the flaming volcanoes ; the roaring cataracts ; the numerous rivers, incessantly rolling tJieir watery treasures into the seas ; the majestic ocean, and its unfathomable caverns ; the vapors rising from its surface, and replenishing the springs and rivers ; the avalanche hurbng down the mountain's side with a noise like thunder ; the luxu- riant plains of the torrid zone ; the rugged clifls and icebergs of the polar regions ; and thousands of other objects of diver- sified beauty and sublimity, — has an evident tendency to expand the conceptions of the human niind, to increase its sources of animal enjoyment, and to elevate the alfections to that All-Powerful Being who gave birth to all the sublimities of Nature, and who incessantly superintends all its movements. In fine, from the numerous moral facts, ^hich Cxcography unlblds, we learn the vast depth and extent of that moral de- gradation into which the human race has fallen — the ferocious tempers, and immoral practices, which are displayed in the regions of Pagan idolatry — the horrid cruelties, the vile abo- minations, that are daily perpetrated under the sanction of what tion would lie with cqiial wei:i;hr. ae;ainst the sabbath. His only objection appears to be against iha suppfisiliv}!, that christians, nieetiiij!^- in difierent j)art« of the earth at the same hour ot' the day, arc praying in all places/ii the same moment. — ilmericun Editor. GEOLOGY. 157 is termed religion — the wide extent of population, over which 5,he prince of darkness sways his sceptre — the difficulties which require to be smmounted before the " Gospel of salvation" can extend its full inihience throjigliOut tlje l*£tgaij world — and the vast energies which are requisite to accomplish this glorious event. All these portions of information are calculated to confirm and illustrate the Scriptural doctrine of the universal depravity of man — to exercise the faith of the Christian, on the promises of Jehovah, iii reference to the conversion of the benighted nations — to rouse his sympathies towards his de- graded brethren of mankind, to' excite his intercession in their behalf, and to dli-eci' his benevolence and activity, in devising and executing schemes for enlightening the people who are sitting " in darkness, and in the shadow of death." GEOLOGY. Another subject intimately related to the former, is, the science of Greology. This science has for its object, to investigate and describe the internal structure of the earth, the arrangement of the ma- terials of which it is composed, the circumstances peculiar to its original formation, the different states under which it has existed, and the various jcjiangcs which it appears to have un- dergone, since the Almighty created the substance of which it is composed. From a consideration of the vast quantity of materials contained in the internal structure of our globe, and of the limited extent to which men can carry their operations, when they attempt to penetrate into its bowels, it is obvious, that our knowledge of this subject must be very shallow and imperfect. The observations, however, which have been made on the structure of our globe during the last half century, and the conclusions Seduced from them, are highly interesting, both to the philosopher, ayU to the 'Christian. Before the facts, on which this branch of ' Natural History is founded, were accurately ascertained, a variety of di)jections to the Mo- saic history of the creation were startcji by certain sceptical philosophers, founded on pariiiil an<| erroueous views of the real structure and economy of the earth, l^ut it is now found, that the more accurately and minutely t^e system of nature is explored, the Jiiore distinctly do ^ve perceive the harmony that subsists between the records of Revelation, and the operations of the Creator^ in the material world. If both be admitted as the effects of the agency of the same Almighty and Eternal Being, they must, in the nature of things, completely bar- I5S THE CHRISTIAN PHILOROPHER. monizo, and run never be repugnant to each other — wliether vvG bo capable, in every instance, of perceiving their com- plete coincidence, or not. If any facts could be produced in the visible creation which directly contradict the records of the Bible, it would form a proof, that the oracles which we hold as Divine, were not dictated by the Creator and Go- vernor of the universe. But, although some garbled facts have been triinnphantly exhibited in this view, it is now ascer- tained, from the discoveries which have been lately made in relation to the structure and formation of the earth, that the truth of the facts detailed in Sacred History, rests on a solid and immutable basis ; and that the Supreme Intelligence who arranged the fabric of heaven and eartli, ajul he alone, commu- nicated to the inspired writers the doctrines, and the facts the-y have recorded ; and, we have reason to believe, (hat as Geol- ogists proceed in their researches and investigations, still more sensible proofs of the authenticity of Revelation will be brought to light. Geology has, of late, become an interesting object of in- quiry to the student of general science, and is now prosecuted with ardor by many distinguished ])hilosophers. The observa- tions which have been made in various parts of the world, by late navigators ; the facts which have been ascertained by Pallas, Saussure, De Luc, Humboldt, and other intelligent travellers ; and the discoveries which have been brought' to light by modern chemists and mineralogists, have all con- spired to ficilitate Geological inquiries, to render them more enhghtened and satisfactory, and to prepare the way for future ages establishing a rational, scriptural, and substantial theory of the earth. The man who engages in such inquiries has always at hand a source of rational investigation and enjoy- ment. The ground on which he treads — the eispect of the j surrounding country — the mines, the caves, and the quarrres which he explores — every new country in which he travels, every mountain he climbs, and every new surface of the earth that is laid open to his inspection, otler to him novel and in- teresting stores of information. On descending into mines, we are not only gratified by displays of human ingenuity, but we also acquire views of the strata of the earth, and of the revo- lutions it has unflergone since the period of its formation. — Our researches on the surface of the earth, amidst abrupt pre- cipices and lofty mountains, introduce us to the grandest and most sublime works of the (^n^itor, and present to our view the effects of sfupend«)us forces, which have overtiuiied irjonn- tains. and rent the foundations of nature. '* In the nudst of GEOLOGY. 159 such scenes, the Geologist feels his mind invigorated ; the magnitude of the appearances before him extinguishes all the little and contracted notions he may have formed in the closet ; and he learns, that it is only by visiting and studying those stdpendous works, that he can lorm an adecpiate con- ception of the great relations of the crust of the globe, and <)f its mode of fbrmation."* The upper crust, or surface of (he earth, is found to be com- posed of different strata, or beds placed one above another. These strata, or layers, are very much mixed, and their direc- tion, matter, thickness, and relative position, vary considerably in different places. These strata are divided into seven classes, as follows : — black earth, clay, sandy earth, marl, bog, chalk, and scabeous or stony earth. The surface of the globe, considered in relation to its inequalities, is divided into High- land, Lowland, and the bottom of the sea. Highland com- prises Alpine land, composed of mountain groups, or series of mountain chahis : Lowland comprises those extensive flat tracts whi^h are almost entirely destitute of small mountain groups. To the bottom of the sea belong the flat, rocky bot- tom, shoals, reefs, and islands. At first sight, the solid mass of the earth appears to be a con- fused assemblage of rocky masses, piled on each other without regularity or order, where none of those admirable displays of skill and contrivance are to be observed, which so powerfully excite attention in the structure of animals and vegetables. But, on a nearer and more intimate view, a variety of beautiful arrangements has been traced by the industry of Geologists, and the light of modern discoveries ; by which they have been enabled to classify these apparant irregularities of nature. The materials of which the solid crust of the earth is composed, have been arranged into the four following classes : — 1. Those rocks which contain neither any animal nor vegetable remains themselves, nor are intermixed with rocks v.hich do contain them, and are therefore termed Frimitive, or Frimary rocks ; the period of whose formation is considered as ante- cedent to that of the creation of organic beings. These are granite, gnesis, mica slate, and clay slate, which occur abun- dantly in all regions of the globe, with quartz rock, serpentine, granular limestone, &c. which occur more sparingly. — 2. Rocks containing organic "remains, or generally associated with other rocks in which such substances are found, and which, as^ having been formed posterior to the existence of organized * Edinburgh Encyclop. Art. Mineralogy. 160 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. beings, are termed Secondai'y. These are greywacke, sand- stone, limestone, and gypsum of viirious kinds, fflate clay, with certain species of trap ; and they are found lying above the primary or older rocks. — 3. Above these seconc^ry roeks^beds of gravel, sand, earth, and moss, are found, which have been termed Alluvial rocks, or Formations. This class compre- hends those rocky substances formed from previously existing rocks, of which the materials have been broken down by the agency of water and air ^ they are therefore generally loose in their texture, and are never covered with any, real sailed and rocky secondary strata. — 4. Volcamc rocks ; under which class are comprehended all those rocks, beds of lava, scoria), and other matter thrown out at certain points of the earth's surface by the action of subterraneous lire. " The phenomena of Geology show, that the original formation of the rocks has been accompanied, in nearly all its stages, by a process of waste, decay, and recomposition. The rocks, as they were successively deposited, were acted upon by air and water, heat, &;c. broken into fragments, or worn down into grains, out of which new strata were formed. Even the newer secondary rocks, since tl\eir consolidation, have been subject to great changes, of which veiy distinct monu- ments remain. Thus, we have single mountains a\ hich, from their structure, can be considered only as remnants of great formations, or of great continents no longer in existence. Mount Meisner, in Hesse, six miles long and three broad, rises about ISOO feet above its base, and 2100 above the, sea, overtopping all the neighbouring hills IVom 40 to 50 miles round. The lowest partof the mountain consists of the same shell, limestone, and sandstone, which exist in the adjacent country. Above these are, first, a bed of sand, then a bed of fossil wood, 100 feet thick at some points, t.nd the whole is covered by a mass of basalt, 500 feet in height. On eonsF- dering these facts, it is impossible to avoid concluding, that this mountain which now overtops the neighbouring country, occupied at one time, the bottom of a cavity in the midst of higher lands. The vast mass of fossil wood could not all have grown there, but must have been transported by water from a more elevated surface, and lodged in what was then a hollow. The basalt which covers the wood must also have flowed in a current from a higher site ; but the soil over which both the wood and the basalt passed, bus been swept away leaving this mountain as a solitary menioiial to attest its exist- ence. Thus, also, on the side of Mount Jura next the Alps, where no other mountain interposes, there are found vast q^OLOGY, 161 olocks of granite (some of 1000 cubic yards) at the height of more than 2000 leet above the Lake* of Geneva. These blocks ore foreign to the rocks among which they He, and have evidently come from the opposite chain of the Alps ; but the land which constituted the. inclined plane over which they were rolled or transported, has been worn away, and the val ley of lower Switzerland; with its lakes, now occupies its place. Transported masses of primitive rocks, of the same descrip- tion, are found scattered over the north of Germany which Van Buch ascertained by their characters to belong .o the mountains of Scandinavia ; and which, therefore^ carry us back to a period when an elevated continent, occupying the basin of the Baltic, connected Saxony with Norway. — Supp to Ency. Brit. vol. 6. The production of a bed for vegetation is e.fTect'*^! by the decomposition of rocks. This decomposition is effected by the expansion of water in the pores or fissures of -ocks, by- heat or congelation— by the solvent power of moisture — and by electricity, which is kno\*ii to be a powerful agent of de- composition. As soon as the rock begins to be softened, the seeds onichens, which are constantly floating in the air, make it their resting place. Their generations occupy it till a finely divided earth is formed, which becomes capable of si^pporting mosses and heath ; acted upon by light and heat, these plants imbibe the dew, and convert constituent ])arts of the air into nourishment. Their death aiid decay aflbrd food for a more perfect species of vegetable ; and, at length, a mould is forn> ed, in which even the trees of the forest can fix their roots, and which is capable of rewarding tile labors of the cultivator. The decomposition of rocks tends to the renovalion of soils, as well as their cultivation. Finely divided matter is carried by rivers from the higher districts to the low countries, and alluvial lands are usually extremely fertile. By these opera- tions, the quantity of habitable surface is constantly increased ; precipitous cliffs are generally made gentle slopes, lakes are tilled up, and islands are formed at the mouths of great rivers ; so that as the world grows older, its capacity for containing an increased number of inhabitants is gradually en-arging. Of all the momorinls of the past history of our globe, the most interesting arc those myriads of remains of organized bodies which exi=t in the interior of its outer crusts. In these, we find traces of innumerable orders of beings existing under different circumstances, succeeding one another- a. distant epoch?, and varying through multiplied changes of form. " If we examine the secondary rock^:, bcp;inning vith the most 11 1G2 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. ancient, the first organic remains which present themselves^ ate those of aquatic plants and large retids, but of species differ- ent from ours. To these succeed madrepores; encrenities; and other aquatic zoophites; living beings of the simplest forms which remain rJttached to 6ne spot, and partake, in some degree, of the nature of vegetables. Posterior to thesoj are ammonites, and other molliisci, still very simple in their forms, and entirely difterent from any animals now known. After these, some fishes appear ; rtnd plants, consisting (jf bamboos and ferns, increase, but still difterent from those which exist. In the next period, along with fin increasing number of extinct species of shells and fishes, we meet with amphibious and viviparous quadrupeds, such as crocodiles and tortoises, and some reptiles, as serpents, which show, that dry land now ex- isted. As we approach the newest of the solid rock forma- tions, we find lamantins, phocse, and other cetaceous and mammiferous sea animals, with some birds. And in the new- est of these fonuations, we find the remains of herbiferous land animals of extinct species, the paleotheriunij anaplothe- rium, &c. and of birds, with some fresh water shells. In the lowest beds of loose soil, and in peat bogs; are found the re- mains of the elephant, rhinoceros, hij)popotanms, elk, &c. of difterentespecies from those Mhich now exist, but belonging to the same genera. Lastly, the bones of the species which are apparently the same with those now existing alive, ara never found except in the very latest alluvial depositions; or those which are either formed in the sides of rivers, the bottoms of ancient lakes and marshes how dried up^ in peat beds, in the fissures and caverns of certain rocks; or at small depths below the present surface, in places whore they may have been over- whelmed by debris, or even buried by man. Human bones Tire never found except among those of animal species now living, and in situations which show; that they have been con;paratively speaking, recently deposited." — Siipp. to Encij. Brit. vol. 6. More than thirty difterent species of animals have been found embedded in the secoiidary strata — no living examj>les of which are now to be fovnid in any quarter of the globe. Among the most remarkable of these are the following. — 1. The Alammoth^ which bears a certain resemblance to the Elei)hant, but is much larger, and difters considerably in the size and form of the tusks, jaws, and grinders. The fossil re- mains of this animal are more abundant in Siberia than in Dther countries ; there being scarcely a spot, from the river Don to Kamtschatka, in which they have not been fouixd. GEOLOGY. 1G3 Not only single bones and perfect skeletons of this animal are frequently to be met with ; but, in a late instance, the whole animal was faund preserved in ice. This animal was dis- covered on the banks of the frozen ocean, near the mouth of the river Jena, in 1799, ; and in 1805, Mr. Adams got it con- veyed over a space of 7000 miles to Petersburgh, where it is deposited in the Museum. The flesh, skin, and hair were coinpletely preserved, and even the eyes were entire. It was provided with a long mane, and the body was covered with liair. This hair was of different qualities. There were stiff black bristles from 12 to 15 inches long, and these belonged to the tail, niane^ and ears. Other bristles were from 9 to 10 inches long, and of a brown color ; and besides these, there was a coarse wool, from 3 to 5 inches long, of a pale yellow color. This mammoth was a male : it measured 9 feet 4 inches in height, and was 16 feet 4 inches long, without inclu- ding the tusks. The tusl,<:s, measuring along the curve, are 9 feet G inches ; and the two together weigh 360 lbs. avoirdu- pois. The head alone without the tusks, weighs 414 lbs. avoirdupois. The remains of this animal have been found likewise in Iceland, Norway, Scotland, England, and in many places through the continent onwards to the Arctic ocean. 2. The Megatherium, A complete skeleton of this co- lossal spec>ies was found in diluvial soil, near ]5uenos Ayres, and sent to Madrid, The specimen is 14 feet long, and 7 Spanish feet in height. 3. The great Mastodon of the Ohio. This species ap- pears to have been as tall as the elephant, but with longer and thicker Umbs. It had tusks like the elephant, and appears to have lived on roots. Its remains abound in America, particu- larly on the banks of the Ohio. 4. The Tapir, w:hich also abounds in America. The •one named Gigantic Tapir, is about 18 feet long, and 12 feet 5. The Irish Elk, or Elk of the Isle of Man. This gi- gantic species, now api)arently extinct, occurs in a fossil state, in Ireland, Isle of Man, England, Germany, and France. The most perfect specimen of this species, which was found in the Isle of Man, may be seen in the Museum of the University of Edinburgh. It is 6 feet high, 9 feet long, and in height to the tip. of the right horn, 9 feet 7| inches. An engraving of th\s skeleton may be seen in vol. 6 of Supp. to Ency. Brit. Fvom a consideration of the phenomena above described, Geologists have been led to conclude, " that rocks novv buried 164 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. at a great depth, constituted, at one time, the surface of con- tinents, and the scat of organic life ; and that many orders of beings have been called into existence, and afterwards de- stroyed by great revolutions, which introduced new classes of mineral deposits, accompanied with new tribes of organic beings." It has also been concluded by some, that the appearance of Man upon the face of the globe, is, geologi- cally speaking, a very recent event ; before which the earth had been inhabited thousand of years by various families of plants and tribes of animals, which had been destroyed and renewed in a long series of successions. Yfhether these conclusions be neces&ar.ij inferences from the phenomena of organic remains and other geological facts, I shall not, at present, stop to inquire. It is sufficient for the Christian Philosopher to show, that, though they should be admitted in their full extent, they are not inconsistent with the records of Sacred History, as some divines have been dis}>osed to main- tain. Though it could be proved to a demonstration, that the materials of which the present system of our globe is com- posed, have existed for millions of years, it would not, in the least, invalidate the Mosaic account of the arrangement of our world. For Moses no where affirms, that the materials or substance of tile earth, were created, or brought ft-om nothing into existence, at the period when his history commences. His language, on the contrary, evidently implies, that the materials which enter into the constitution of our globe did exist., at the epoch at which he commences his narration. " The earth was without form, and void ; and darkness was upon the face of the deep." This passage plainly implies the, following things — 1. That the original atoms, or materials, out of which the terraqueous globe, in its present state, was formed, were then in existence, or, had been previously created. How long- they had been in existence is not stated. We may suppose them to have existed for a year, a thousand years, or a million of years, just as geological phenomena seem to war- rant, without in the least invalidating the authority of the Sacred Historian, who states nothing contrary to the truth ol cither supposition. 2. That the materials of our globe, as ihcn existing, were in a chaotic state. Instead of that order and beauty which we perceive on the face of nature, the whole mass presented a scene of confusion and disorder — such a scene, perhaps, as would be presented, v/ere the earth stripped of it!? verdure, were its strata universally disrupted, its moun- tains hurled into the plains, and its rivers and seas, by some terrible convulsion, to forsake their ancient channels'. 3= The GEOLOGY. 1G5 passage seems to imply, that the whole, or the greater portion of the earth, as it then existed, was covered with a deluge of water : '* Darknes;s cov^ered the lace of the deep,-^ or the Such was the state af the terrestrial system at the period when Moses commences his narration ; no intiniation being gijVeu of the period of its duration in this condition ; and, consequently, nothing asserted to nylitate against any geolo- gical system which i^ founded on the facts which have been discovcre.4 respecting the organic remains which are found in the strata of our globe. It is a mistake into which too many have been apt to fall, to suppose, that Moses begins his history at the period when the first portions of material existence were created out of nothing ; and tha^ it was his design to mark the precise, epoch when the whole assemblage of created beings throughout the universe was b^c^ight into existence. — His primary, if not his sole intention evidently was, to detail the progress of those arrangements by which the earth was gradually reduced to that foi'iri an,d order in which we now behold it, from the chaotiie n\aterials ^\;hich previously existed. And, as an emphatic and apj)roprij?,te introduction to his narra- tion, he states this importa'it trutji : '-'tn the begining God created the heaven and the eajth." This passage, being of a general and comprehensive natvu'e,, decides notliing with regard to the period, or precise epoch, at wtjich the ditferent bodies in the universe were called into being ; but is evidently intended to convey the following importcmjt truth, in opposion to all fan- ciful, chimerical, and atheistical notions respecting the origin of the world ; namely, " That, at what period soever, in the laj^se of duration, any object was brought into existence, it derived that existence from the God of Israel, the self-existent and Eternal Jehovah." "In the beginning God created the heaven and the earth." As the language of the Sacred Historian, therefore, decides nothing with regard to time — to limit the creation of every portion of the material system within the period of six thousand years, is to make an unnecessary con- cession to the intidel philosopher, which may afterwards be found inconsistent with certain facts which exist in ihe ma- terial world. But, whatever may be said with respect to the state and duration of the earth prior to the period at which Moses com- mences his narration, it is admitted by every geologist, that our globe, as to its present form and arrano-einent, has been, comparatively, of but short duration. Cuvier, one of the most enlightened geologists of the age, deduces, from certain 166 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. progressive changes on the earth's surface, as well as from the concurrent traditions of many nations, that the first appearance of man upon the face of the globe, or, at least, the renewal of the human race after some great catastrophe, cannot he refer- red to a period farther back than 5000, or 6000 years from the present time. Geologists, too, of every description, however different the systems or theories they have adopted, have all been constrained, from the evidence of tact, to admit this con- clusion, " That every part of the dry land icas once covered by the ocean ;^^ thus confirming the scriptural account of that stupendous event, the universal deluge. This event, from its very nature, must have been accompanied with the most terri- ble convulsions, both on the exterior surface, and in the inte- rior strata of the globe. Accordingly we find, that (races of this awful catastrophe exist in every region of the earth. Mr. Parkinson describes the whole island of Great Britain, as having, since its completion, " suffered considerable distur- bance from some prodigious and mysterious power. By this j)ower all the known strata, to the greatest depths that have been explored, have been more or less broken and displaced, and, in some places, have been so lifted, that some of the lowest of them have been raised to the surface ; while portions of others, to a very considerable depth and extent, have been entirely carried away." The whole of the Alpine region in Switzerland, and the North of Italy, considered as one mass, shows the most evident marks of dislocation. At the height of 3500 feet above the level of the sea, M. Saussure met with a chasm a hundred feet wide, and so deep that he saw no bot- tom. All travellers on the Alps have regarded them with horror. They mark the most evident convulsions, but show no signs of having been occasioned hy attrition. ]\[r. Towns- end, spealving of the Pyrenees, which he personally inspected, says, " What is most remarkable is, to see four enormous chasms, almost perpendicular, wliich divided both mountains and their valleys, and which appear as if they had just been rent asunder." Throughout the rano-ps of the Andes, and in every other mountainous region, snnilar chasms and disrup- tions, indicating the former operation of some tremendous power, are frequently observed by those who visit such scenes of grandeur. — In some of tlie coal mines in our own country, the coal is in some ])laces lifted up, or thrown down several himdreds of feet from the places it appears originally to have occtipiefl. " Two miles north of Newcastle," says Mr. Towns- end, " one great dyke or jauU throws down the coal 540 feet GEOLOGY. IGT — at the distance of 3 miles, it is cut off and thrown down again 240 het.''^ "An evidence of the eflccts which could be produced only by a general deluge, is also afforded by those organic remains to which I have already adverted, and particularly by those immense quantities of marine shells, which have been discov- ered in situations so elevated, and in places so far removed from the sea, as to prove that they were left there by a flood exten- ing over the whole globe. At Tourainc, in France, a hundred miles from the sea, is a bed of shells stretching 9 leagues in extent, and 20 feet in depth, and including shells not knowu to belong to the neighbouring sea. Humboldt found sea shells, on the Andes at an elevation of 14,120 feet above the level of \he sea. The slaty mountain of La Bolca, near Yerona, is famous for petrifactions, among which are enumerated more, Uian one hundred species of fish, natives of Europe, Asia, Africa, and America, liere assembled in one place. It appears, therefore, that the researches of Geology confirm he fact of a universal deluge, and thus afford a sensible proof >f the credibility of the Sacred Historian, and, consciquently, of the truth of the doctrines of Divine Revelation. But, besides the testimony which this science bears to the authenticity of Scripture History, it exhibits some of the grandest objects in the history of the physical operations of Divine Providence. It presents to our view, in a most impressive form, the majes- tic agency of God, in convulsing and disarranging the struc- ture of our globe, and which at first sprung from his hand in perfect order and beauty. When we comteniplate the objects Mhich this science embrace?, we seem to be standing on the ruins of a tbrmer world. IVe behold " hills" which " have melted like wax at the presence of the Lord," and " mountains" which "have been carried into the midst of the sea." V\'e belioid rocks of enormous size, which have l)Gen rent from their foundations, and rolled from one continent to another — - the most solid strata of the earth bent under the action of some tremendous power, and dispersed in fragments through the surrounding regions. We behold the summits of lofty mountains, over which the ocean had rolled its mighty billows — confounding lauds and seas in one universal devastation — transportmg plants and forests Irom one quarter of the world to another, and spreading universal destruction among the animated in]>;d)itants of the water and the earlh. When we enter the wild and romantic scene of a mountainous courdry, or descend into the subterraneous regions of the globe, we arc 168 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. every where struck with the vestiges of operations carried on by the }>o\vers of Nature, upon a scale of prodigious magni- tude, and u'ith the exertion of forces, the stupendous nature of which astonishes and overpowers the mind. Comtemplat- ing such scenes of grandeur, we perceive the force and sub limity of those descriptions of Deity contained in the volumt of inspiration: "The Lord reigneth,he is clothed with majes- ty ; in his hand are the deep places of the earth, the strength of hills is his also. He Kehioveth the mountains, and they know not; he overturneth them in his anger.; he shaketh the earth out of her place, and the pillars thereof tremble. At his presence the earth shook and' trembled : the foundations also of the hills moved, and were shaken, because he was wrath." " Thou coveredst the earth with the deep, as with a garment ; the waters stood above the mountains. At thy rebuke they fled; at the voice of thy thunder they hastened away." While retracing such terrific displays of Omnipotence, we are natu- rally led to inquire into the moral cause which induced^ the Benevolent Creator to inflict upon the world such overwhelm- ing desolations. For reason, as well as revelation, declares, that a moral cause must have existed. Man must have viola- ted the commands of his Maker, and frustrated the end of his creation ; and to this conclusion the Sacred Historian bears ample testimony- — " G^od saw that the wickedness of man was great in the earth, and that every imagination of the thoughts of his heart was only evil continually: and Jehovah said, I will destroy man whom I have created, from the face of the earth, both man and beast, and the creeping thing, and the fowls of the air." ASTRONOJVIY. Another science which stands in an intimate relation to reli- gion, is Astronomy. This sublime science teaches us the magnitudes and dis tances of the heavenly bodies, their arrangement, their various motions and phenomena, and the laws by which their move- ments arc regulated. It presents to our view objects the most wonderful and sublime ; whether we consider the vast magni- Inch of the bodies about which it is conversant — their inmiense number — the veto cUij of their motions — the astonishinix forces requisite to impel them in their rapid career through the regions of the sky — the vast spaces which surround them, and in which they perform their revolutions — the magnificent circles they describe — the splendor of their appearance — or the important ends thev are destined to serve in the jirand system of the ASTRONOMY. 169 universe. Having adverted to this subject, when illustrating the Omnipotence of the Deity, I shall here simply state a few additional facts with respect to the general appearance of the heavens, the bodies which compose the planetary system, and the discoveries which have been made in the region of the stars. When we lift our eyes towards the sky, we perceive an ap- parent hollow hemisphere, placed at an indefinite distance, and surrounding the earth on every hand. In the day time, the principal oi)ject which appears in the hemisphere, is the sun. In the morning, we see him rise above the distant mountains, or from the extremity of the ocean ; he gradually ascends the vault of heaven, and then declines, and disappears in the op- posite quarter of the sky. In the northern parts of the globe, where v/e reside, if, about the 21st of March, we place our- selves on an open plain, with our face towards the south, the sun will appear to rise on our left, or due east, about six in the morning, and about the same hour in the evening, he will set due west. In the month of June he rises to our left, but some- what behind us, in a direction towards the north-east, ascends to a gi'eater height at noon than in the month of March, and, after describing a large arc of the heavens, sets on our right, and still behind us, in the north-western quarter of the sky. In the month of December, if we stand in the same position, we may observe, without turning ourselves, both his rising and setting. He rises in the south-east, ascends to a small eleva- tion at noon, and sets in the south-west, after having described a very small arc of the heavens. Every day he appears to move a little towards the east, or contrary to his apparent; di- urnal motion ; for the stars which are seen to the eastward of him, appear every succeeding day to make a nearer ap- proach to the place in which he is seen. All the variety of these successive changes is accomplished within the period of 365 days 6 hours, in which time ho appears to have made a complete revolution round the heavens from west to east. The moon is the next object in the heavens which naturally attracts our attention ; and she is found to go through similar variations in the course of a month. When she first becomes visible at new moon, she appears in the western part of the. heavens, in the form -of a crescent, not far from the setting sun. Every night she increases in size, and removes to a greater distance from the sun, till, at last, she appears in the eastern part of the horizon, just as the sun disappears in the western ; at which time she presents a round fall-enlightened face. After this, she gradually m.oves farther and farther east 170 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. ward, and her enlightened part gradually decreases, till at last she seems to approach the sun as nearly in the east as she did in the west, and rises only a little before hiin in the morning, in the tbrni of a crescent. All these ditieient changes may be traced by attending to her apparent positions, from tnne to time, with respect to the fixed stars. A dark shadow is occasionally seen to move across the face of the moon, which obscures her light,, and gives her the ap- pearance of tarnished copper. Sometimes this shadow covers only a small portion of her surface ; at other times it covers the whole of her disk for an hour or two, and its margin always appears of the figure of a segment of a circle. This phenomenon, which happens, at an average, about twice every year, is termed an eclipse of the moon. It is produced by the shadow of the earth falling upon the moon, when the sun, the earth, and the moon, are nearly in a straight line ; and can happen only at the time of full moon. Sometimes the moon appears to pass across the body of the sun, when her dark side is turned towards the earth, covering his disk either in whole or in part, and intercejrting his rays from a certain portion of the earth. This is called an eclijise of the sun, and can happen only at the time of new moon. In a total eclipse of the sun, which seldom happens, the darkness is so striking, that the planets, and some of the larger stars, are distinctly seen, and the inferior animals appear struck with terror. Again, if, on a winter's evening, about six o'clock, we direct our view to the eastern quarter of the sky, we shall perceive certain stars just risen above the horizon.; if we view tl>e saniQ stars about midnight, we shall find them at a considerable ele-. vation in the south, having apparently moved over a space equal to one half of the whole hemisphere. On the next morning, about six o'clock, the same stars will be seen setting in the western part of the sky. If w^e turn our eyes towards the north, we shall perceive a similar motion in these twinkling orbs, but with this difference, that a very considerable, numbei; of them neither rise nor set, but seem to move round an im- moveable point, called the north pole Wear this point is placed the pole star, which seems to have little or no apparent motion, and which, in our latitude, appears elevated a little more than half way between the northern part of our horizon and the zemlli or point above our heads. A. person who has directed his attention to the heavens for the first time, after having made such observations, will naturally inquire — Whence come those stars which begin to appear in the east? Whither have those gone, which have disappeared in the west 2 ASTRONOMY. 171 and, Wliat becomes, during the day, of the stars which arc seen in the night? — It will soon occur to a rational observer, who is convinced of the roundness of the earth, that the stars which rise above the eastern horiz-on come from another hemisphere, which we are apt to imagine below us, and when they set, return to ^hat hemisphere again ; and, that the reason why the stars are not seen in the day-time, is, not because they are absent from our hemisphere, or have ceased to shine, but because their light is obscured by the more vivid splendor of the sun.* From ^uch observations we are led to conclude, that the globe on which we tread is suspended in empty space — is surrounded on all sides by the celestial vault — and that the whole sphere of the heavens has an apiiavenl motion round * This is put beyond all doubt, by the invention of the telescope ; by wliich instrument, adapted to an equatorial motion, we ?i.rc 'ehalJle'ci to sec many of the stars even at noon-day, Tiie Author of this work, about eleven years ago, made a number, c^ obsen/ations, by means of an Equa- torial telescope, to determine the following particulars: — What stars and planets may be conven-icntly seen in the day-time, Avhen the sun is aljove the horizon? What degrees of mno;nifying po\Ver Arc requisite for distin- guishing them? How near their conjunction with the sun they may l:)e seen; — and, wlieth'cr the diminution ^f the aperture of the telescope, or the increase of magnifying power, coikliices most to render a star or planet visible in day-light. The results of several hundreds of observations on tliese ]ioints, accompAni'ed \vith some original (.le(hictions and remarks, are inserted in " Nicholson's Philosophical Journal," for October, 1313, vol. 36, p. 109 — 123. The folfowing are some of the results which were deduced from the observations : — That a star of the first magnitude may be dis- tinguished at any time of the day, with a magnifying power of 30 times, but that a higher magnifying power is preferable — That most of the stars of the second magnitude may be seen with a power of 100 : and with a power of 60 times, when the sun is not much jiiorc than two hours above the horizon — That the ]ilanet Jupiter; when not within 30 or 40 degrees of the sun, may be seen with a power of 15 times; — and that Venus may, in most instances, be seen with a power of from 7 to 100 times, and upwards ■ — That Jupiter can scarcely be distinguished in the day-time, when within 26 degrees of the sun ; but that Venus may be dist/inctly perceived near her superior conjunction, wheri only 1 degree and 27 minutes from the sun's margin ; and, consequently, may be visible at the time of that conjunction, when her geocentric latitude equals or exceeds 1 degree 43 minutes — That she may be perceived, like a fine, slender crescent, within 35 howrs after passing her inferior conjunction, &c. &c. One practical purpose to which such oljservations on Venus, at the time of her superior conjunction, may be applied, is, to determine the difference (if any) between her polar and equatorial diameters. For, it is only at that conjunction that she pi-esetits to the earth a full enlightened hemisphere ; and in no other position can the measure of both diameters be taken, except when she makes a transit across the sun's disk. As the Earth, Mars, Jupiter, and Saturn, cu-e found to be spheriods, it is highly probable that Venus is of a similar figure ; but this point has never yet been ascertained by actual observation. See also " The Edinburgh Philos. Journal," No. 5, for Jlily 1820, p. 191 ; and Nt>. 13, f)r Julv, 1S22— "The Scots Mag." for Feb. 1814, p. 84.~" Monthly Mag." Fob. 1814, and Au-uyt 1820, p. 62. 172 ^ THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. the earth every twenty-four hours. Whether this motion be real, or only apparent, must be determined by other consider- ations. Such general views of the nocturnal heavens, which every common observer may take, have a tendency to expand the mind, and to elevate it to the contemplation of an Invisible Power, by which such mighty movements are conducted- Whether we consider the vast concave, with all its radiant orbs, moving in majestic grandeur around our globe, or the earth itself whirling round its inhabitants in an opposite direc- tion— =an idea of sublimity, and of Almighty energy, irresistibly forces itself lipoii the mind, which throws completely into the shade the mightiest effdrts of himian power. The most pow- erful mechanical engines that were eVer constructed by the Agency of man, can scarcely afford us the least assistance in forming a conception of that incomprehensible Power, which, with unceasing energy, communicates motion to revolving worlds. And yet^ such is the apathy with which the heavens are viewed by the greater part of mankind, that there are thousands who have occasionally gazed at the stars, for the space of fifty years, who are still ignorant of the fact, that they perform an apparent diurnal revolution round our globe. Again, if we contemplate the heavens with some attention, for a number of successive nights, we shall find, that by far tlie greater part of the stars never vary their positions with respect to each other. If we observe two stars at a certain apparent distance from each other, either north or south, or in any other direction, they will appear at the same distance, and in the sp.me relative position to each otherj the next evening, the next month, and the next year. The stars, for instance, which form the sicord and belt of Orion, present to our eye the same figure and relative aspect, during the whole period they ' are visible in winter, and from one year to another ; and the same is the case with all the fixed stars in the firmament. On examining the sky a lift ^ niore minutely^ however^ we per- ceive certain bodies which regularly shift their positions. Sometimes they appear to move towards the east, sometimcf! towards the west, and at other times seem to remain in a sta- tionarv position. These bodies have obtained the name of planets, or wandering stars ; and, in our latitude, arc most frequently seen, either in the eastern and western, or in Ine | Fouihcrn parts of the heavens. Ten of these planetary orbs ' have been discovered ; six of which are, for the most part, invisible to the naked eyo. By a careful examination of the moti;)ns of the:^e bodies, and tholr dirierent aspect:^, a:^lrono- ASTRONOMY. 173 mers have determined, that they all move round the sun as the centre of their motions, and form, along with the earth and several smaller globes, one grand arid harmonious system. This assemblage of planetary bodies is generally formed the Solar System, of which I shall lioiv endeavor to exhibit a brief outline. THE SOLAR SYSTEM. Of this system, the suri is the centre and the animating principle, and by far the hirgesl body that exists within its limits. The first thing that strikes the mind when contem- platinfl^ this glorious orb, is its astonishing magnitude. This vast globe istburid to be about 880,000 miles in diameter, and, consequently, contains a mass of matter equal to thirteen hundred thousand globes of the size of the earth. Were its central parts placed adjacent to the surface of the earth, its circumference would reach two hundred thousand miles beyond the moon's orbit, on every side, filling a cubical space of 681,472,000,000,000,000 miles. If it would require 18,000 years to traverse every square mile on the earth's surface, at the rate oi' 30 miles a-day; (see p. 35,) it would require more than tiDO thousand millions of years to pass over every part of the sun's surface, at the same rate. Eveii at the rate of 90 miles a-day it would require more than 80 years to go roulvl its cir- cumference. Of a l)ody so vast in its dimensions, the human mind, with all its efforts, can form iio adequate conception. It appears ari eixtensive, universe in itself; and; although no other body existed within the range of infinite space, this globe alone would afibrd a powerful deriionstration of the Oninipotence of the Creator. Were the sun a hollow sphere, surrounded by an external shell; and a luminous atmosphere ; were this shell perforated with several hundreds of openings into the internal part ; were a globe as large as the earth placed at its centre, and another globe as large as the moon, and at the same distance from ihe centre as the moon is from us, to re- volve round the central globe, — it would present to the view a universe as splendid and glorious as that which now appears to the vulgar eye, — ^a universe as large and extensive as the whole creatiori was conceived to be, by our ancestors, in the infancy of astronomy. And who can tell, but that Almighty Being, who has not left a drop of water in a stagnant pool without its inhabitants, has arranged a number of worlds within the capacious circuit of the sun, and peopled them with intelli- gent beings in the first stages of their existence, to remain there for a certain period, till they be prepared for beinj: trans- 174 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. ported to a more expansive sphere of existence ? It is easy to r.onoeive, that enjoyments as exquisite, and a range of thoughts as ample as have ever yet been experienced by the majority of the inhabitants of our world, might be afforded to myriads of beings thus placed at the centre of this magnificent luminary. This supposition is, at least, as probable as that of the cele- brated Dr. Herschel, who supposed that the exterior surface of the sun was peopled with inhabitants. For, if this were the case, the range of view of these inhabitants would be confined within the limits of two or three hundred miles, and no celes- tial body, but an immense blaze of light, would be visible in their hemisphere. Such is the variety which appears among the works of God, and such is the diversity of situations m which sensitive beings are placed, that we dare not pronounce it impossible that both these suppositions maybe realized. Though the sun seems to perform a daily circuit around our globe, he may be said, in this respect, to be fixed and immova- ble. This motion is not rea/, but only apparent^ and is owing to the globe on which we are placed, moving round its axis from west to east ; just as the objects on the bank of a river seem to move in a contrary direction, when we are sailing along its stream iri a steam-boat. The only motion which is found to exist in the sun is, a motion of rotation^ like that of a globe or ball twirled round a pivot or axis, which is performed in the space of 25 days and 10 hours. This motion has been as- certained by means of a variety of dark spots which are discov ered by the telescope on the sun's disk ; which first appear on his eastern limb, and, after a period of about thirteen days, dis- appear on his western, and, after a similar period, re-appear on his eastern edge. These spots are various, both in number, in magnitude, and in shape : sometimes 40 or 50, and some- times only one or two are visible, and at other times the sun appears entirely without spots. Most of them have a very dark nucleus, or central part, surrounded by an umbra, or fainter shade. Some of the spots are as large as would covei the whole continent of Europe, Asia, and Africa, others have been observed of the size of the whole surface of the earth ; and one was seen, in the year 1779, M'hich was computed to be more than jijly thousand miles in diameter. With regard to the nature of this globe — it appears highly probable, from the observations of Dr. Herschel, that the sun is a solid and opaque body, surrounded with luminous clouds which float in the solar atmosphere, and that the dark nucleus of the spots is the opaque body of the sun appearing through occasional openings in this atmosphere. The height of th« ASTRONOMY, 175 atmosphere, he computes to be not less than 1843, nor more than 2765 miles, consisting of two regions ; that nearest the Sim being opaque, and probably resembling the clouds of our earth ; the .outermost emitting vast quantities of light, and forming the apparent luminous globe we behold. The sun is the grand source of light and heat, both to the earth and to all the other planetary bodies. The heat he dif- fuses animates every part of our sublunary system, and all that variety of coloring Vv'hich adorns the terrestrial landscape, is produced by his rays. It has been lately discovered, that the rays of light, and the rays of heat, or caloric, are distinct from each other ; for, it can be demonstrated, that some rays from the sun produce heat, which have no power of commu- nicating light or color. The greatest heat is found in the red rays, the least in the violet rays ; and in a space beyond the red rays, where there is no light, the tem.perature is greatest. The rays of the sun have also been found to produce different chemical etiects. The white muriate of silver is blackened in the violet ray, in the space of 15 seconds, though the red will not produce the same effect in less than 20 minutes. Phosphorus is kindled in the vicinity of the red ray, and ex- tinguished in the vicinity of the violet. The solar light, there- fore, consists of three different orders of rays, one producing color, a second producing heat, and a third chemical eflects. Euler has computed that the light of the sun is equal to 6500 candles at a foot distance, while the moon would be as one candle at 7| feet; Venus at 421 feet; and Jupiter at 1320 feet. — That this immense luminary appears so small to our eyes, is owing to its vast distance, which is no less than ninety-five millions of miles. Some faint idea of this distance may be obtained, by considering, that a steam boat moving at the rate of 200 miles a-day, would require thirteen hundred years before it could traverse the space which intervenes be- tween us and the sun. " Hail sacred source of inexhausted light ! Prodigious instance of creating might! His distance; man's imagination foils ; Numbers will scarce avail to count the miles. As swift as thought he darts his radiance round To distant worlds, his system's utmost bound." — BnowN. The Planet Mercury. — Mercury is the nearest planet o the sun that has yet been discovered. He is about 37 mil- .ons of miles distant from the sun, and revolves around him in 88 days. His diameter is about 3200 miles. Before the discovery of the four new planets, Cc;es, Pallas, Juno, and 176 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. Yesta, in the beginning of the present century, this globe was considered as the smallest primary planet in the systenir His surface, however, contains above 32 millions of square miles, which is not much less than all the habitable parts of our globe. On account of his nearness to the sun, he is seldom seen by ^ naked eye ; being always near that quarter of the heavens lere the sun appears ; and therefore, few discoveries have udcn made on his surface, by tlic telescope. M'. Schroeter concludes, from certain observations, that this planet revolves round its axis in 24 hours and five rniriu'tes. The sun will appear to an inhabitant of Mercury seven times larger than to an inhabitant of the earth ; anil, if the degree of heat be in proportion to a planet^s nearness to the sun, the heat in this planet will be seven times greater than on the surface of our globe ; and, consequently, were the earth placed in the same position, all the water on its surface would boil, and soon be turned into vapor. But the All-wise Creator has, doubtless, attempered the surface of this globe, and the constitution of the beings that may occupy it, to the situation in which they are placed.* Venus, the next planet in order from the sun, revolves 'tround him in 224 days, at the distance of 68 millions of miles, and its diameter is about seven thousand seven hundred miles, >r nearly the size of the earth ; and it turns round its axis in the space of 23 hours and 20 minutes. This planet is the most brilliant orb which appears in our nocturnal heavens, and is usually distinguished by the name of the morniiug and eve- ning star. When it approaches nearest to the earth, it is about * From a vai-iety of facts wliich have been observed in relation to th© production of; calprlc, it does not appear probable, that the degi-ee of heat on the surfaces of the different ])lanets is inversely proportional to the squares of then* respective distances from the sun. It is more probable, t1mt it depends chiefly on the distribution of the substance of caloric on the sm-faces, and throughout the atmospheres of these bodies — in different quantities, according to the different situations they occupy m tlie solat system ; and that these difierent quantities of caloric are put into action by the influence of the solar r^ys, so as to produce that degree of sensible heat recj_uisite for each respective jilanetary globe. On this hypothesis — v/liich is corroborated by a great variety of facts and expernnoits—therft may be no more sensible heat fblt on the surface of the planet Mercury, than on the. surilice of Herschel, although one of these bodies is nearly 50 times nearer the sun than the other. We have only to suppose that a small quantity of cahiric exists in Mercury, and a larger quantity in Her- schel. proportionate to his ■d.istr^hce fi-om the centre of the system. On this ground, we have no reason to belifeVe^ either that the planets nearest the sun are parched with excessive heat, or that those that are most dis- tant are exposed to all the rigors of insuflerablo coltl, or that the different decrees of temperature which may be found in these bociies, render them ui'ilt for being the abodes of sensitive and intellectual beings. ASTRONOMY. 177 27 millions of miles distant ; and, at its greatest distance, it is no less than 163 millions of miles from the earth. Were the whole of its enlightened surface turned towards the earth, when it is nearest, it would exhibit a light and brilliancy, twenty-five times greater than it generally does, and appear like a small brilliant moon ; but, at that time, its dark henji- sphere is turned towards our globe. Both Venus and Mer- cury, when viewed by a telescope, appear to pass successively through all the shapes and appearances of the moon ; some- times assuming a gibbous phase, and at other times, the forni of a hall-moon, or that of a crescent ; v»hich proves, that they ^e dark bodies in themselves, and derive their light from the sun. The most distinct and beautiful views of Venus espe- cially when she appears as a crescent, are to be obtained in the day time, by means of an equatorial telescope. — From a variety of observations which the author has made with this instrument, it has been found that Venus may be seen every clear day without interruption, durhig a period of 583 day.^, with the occasional exception of 13 days, in one case, and only 3 days in another — a circumstance which cannot be affirmed of any other celestial body, the sun only excepted.* M. Schroetcr aflirms, that he has discovered mountains on the surface of this globe, one of which is 10, another 11, and a third 22 miles high. It appears also to be encompassed with + Sec Edin. Phil. Journ. No. V. July, 1820, and No. XIII. July, 1322. — I have found, from observation, that this planet rnay be seen in the day time, when onlv l'^ 43' from the sun's centre ; and, consequently, w-licn its geocentric latitude at the time of the superior conjunction exceeds that quantity, it mi\.y be distinctly seen during the whole period of 583 days, excepting aljout 35 hours before and after its w/crior couj unction. — It is well known to astronomers, that there has been a difference, of opinion ■with respect to the period ot' ihe rotation of this planet. Cass^ini, from ob- servations on a bright spot which advanced 20 ilegrces, in 24 hour;;, 34 minutes, determined the tukie of its rotation to be 23 hours and 20 minutes. On the other hand, Bianchini, from similar observations, concluded, tliat it;^ diu.rnal period was 24 days and 8 hours. The diOiculty of deciding between these two opinions, arises from the short time in which observa tions can be made on this planet, either before sim-rise, or after sun-set, •whicli prevents us from tracing, with accuracy, the progressive motion of its spots for a sufficient length of time. And, although an observer should mark the position of the spots, at the same hour, on two succeeding eve- nings, and find they had moved forward about 20 dtgrees in 24 hours, he W" xdd still be at a loss to determine, whether they had moved 20 degrees in all, since the preceding observation, or had finished a revolution, and 20 degrees more. — In " Nicholson's Philosophical Journal," vol. 3G, I endea- voured to show how this point may be determined by observations made on Venus in the day time, by which, in certain cases, the progressive mo- lion of her spots might be traced, v.ithout interruption, for 12 hours or more, which would completely settle the period of rotation. 15-* 178 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHEK. an atmosphere, the densest part of which is ahout 16,000 feel high. About twice in the course of a century, this planet appears to pass, hke a dark spot, across the sun's disk. This is tormed the transit of Venus. The last transit happened June 3, 1769; the next will happen on Decembers, 1874, v;hich will be invisible in Europe. Another will happen on the 6th December, 1882, which will be partly visible in Great Britain. The Earth is the next planet in the system. It moves round the sun in 365 days, 5 hours, and 49 minutes, at the ''istance of 95 millions of miles, and round its axis in 23 hour^ 66 minutes, 4 seconds. The former is called its annual^ ana the latter, its diurnal motion. That the earth is, in reality, a moving body, is a fact which can no longer be called in ques- tion ; it is indeed susceptible of the clearest demonstration. Bpt my limits will not perriiif to enter into a detail of the argu- ments by which it is supported. I have already adverted to Oiie consideration, from which its diurnal rotation may be in- ferred. (See pp. 47, 48.) Either the earth moves round .ts axis every day, or the whoh universe moves round it in the same time. To suppose the fatter case to be the fact, would involve a reflection on the wisdom of its Almighty Author, and would form the only exception that we know, to that beautiful proportion, harmony, and simplicity, which appear in all the works of Nature. Were it possible to construct a machine as large as the city of London, and to apply to it mechanical ])owers sufficient to make it revolve on an axis, so as to carry round a furnace for the purpose of roasthig a joint of mutton, suspended in the centre of its motion — while we might admire the ingenuity and the energies displayed in its construction — all mankind would unite in condemning it as a display of con- summate folly. But such an extravagant piece of machinery would not be half so preposterous as to suppose, that the vast universe is daily revolving around our little globe, and that all the planetary motions have an immediate respect to it. And shall v/c dare to ascribe to Him who is " the only wise God," contrivances ^\hich we would pronounce to be the perfection of i^oily in mankind X It is recorded of the Astronomer Al- phonsus. King of Castile, who lived in the 13th century, that, after having studied the Ptolemaic System, which supposes the earth at rest in the centre of the universe, he uttered the fol- lowing impious sentence : " If I had been of God's privy C^ouncil, whiMi he made the world, I would have advised hiui luitter." So that false conceptions of the System of Nature, lead to erroneous notions io'l tiiat adorable Being who is pos- ASTRONOMY. 179 scssed of infinite Perfection, We find that bodies nriiich larger than the earth have a similar rotation. The planet Jupiter, a globe 295,000 mijes in circumference, moves round his axis in less than ten hoiirs ; and all the other planetary bodies, on which spots ht\;Ve been discovered, are found to have a diurnal motion. Besides, it is found to be a universal law of nature, that smallev globes revolve round larger ; but there is no ex- ample in the universe, of a larger body revolving around a smaller. '^Jih.e riioon revolves around the earth, but she is much smaller thc<^n the earth ; the moons which move around Jupiter, Saturn, and llerschel, are all less than their primaries, and the planets which perform their revolutions around the sun are much less than that central luminary. With regard, to the a>Jw«al'revo.iutM)n of the earth, if such a motion did not exist, the planetary system would present a scene of inextricable confusion. " T^e planets would some- times move backwards',' sometimes forviards, and, at other times, remain stationary ; and would describe looped curves, so anomalous and confused, that no man in his senses could view the All-\yise*Creator as the author of so much confusion. But, by considering the eartb, as revolving in an orbit between Venus and Mars, (w"liich all celestial observations completely demonstrate,) all" the apparent irregularities of the planetary motions are completely solved and accounted for ; and the Solar System presents a scene of beauty, harmony and gran- deur, combined with a simplicity ofclesign which characterizes all the works of Omnipotehcel The Moon. — Next to the sun, the moon is to us the most interesting of all the celestial orbs. She is the constant at- tendant of the earth, and revolves around it, in 27 days, 8 hours ; but the period from one new or full moon to another, is about 29 days, 12 hours. S-he is the nearest of all the heavenly bodies ; being only aboiit two hundred and forty thousand miles distant from the earth^ She is much smaller than the earth ; being only 2, ISO miles in diameter. Her sur- face, when viewed with a telescope, presents an interesting and a variegated aspect ; being diversified with mountains, valleys, rocks, and plains, in every variety of form and posi- tion. Some of these moiuitains form long and elevated ridges, resembling the chains of the Alps and the Andes ; while others, of a conical form, rise to a great height, from the mid- dle of level plains, somewhat resembling the Peak of Tene- ritie. But the most singular feature of the moon, is, those cir- cular ridges and cavities which diversify every portion of her surface. A range of mountains of a circular form, rising 180 THE CHRISTIAN PIIILOROPHER. three or four miles above the level of the adjacent districts^ surrounds, like a mighty rampart, an extensive plain ; and, in the middle of this plain or cavity, an insulated conical hill rises to a considerable elevation. Several himdreds of these circular plains, most of which are considerably below the level of the surrounding country, may be perceived, with a good telescope, on every region of the lunar surface. They are of all dimensions, from tw^o or three miles to forty miles in dia- meter ; and, if they be adorned with verdure, they must pre- sent to the view of a spectator, placed among them, a more variegated, romantic, and sublime scenery than is to be found on the surface of our globe. An idea of some of these scenes may be acqjiired by conceiving a plain of about a hundred miles in circumference, encircled with a range of mountains, of various forms, three miles in perpendicular height, and hav- ing a mountain near the centre, whose top reaches a mile and a half above the level of the plain. From the top of this cen- tral mountain, the whole plain, with all its variety of objects, would be distinctly visible ; and the view would appear to be bounded on all sides by a lofty amphitheatre of mountains, in every diversity of shape, rearing their simimits to the sky. From the summit of the circular ridae, the conical hill in the centre, the opposite circular range, the plain below, and some of the adjacent plains, which encompass the exterior ridge of the mountains, would form another variety of view ; — and a third variety would be obtained from the various aspects of the central mountain, and the surrounding scenery, as viewed from the plains below. The Lunar mountains are of all sizes, from a furlong to five miles in perpendicular elevation. Certain luminous spots, which have been occasionally seen on t!ie dark r^ide of the moon, seem to demonstrate that lire exists in this planet. Dr. lierschel, and several other astronomers suppose, that they are volcanoes in a state of eruption. It would be a more pleasing idea, and perhaps as nearly corresponding to fact, to suppose, that those phenomena are owing to some occasional splendid illuminations, [)roduced by the Lunar inhabitants, during their long nights. Such a scene as the burning of Mos- cow, the conflagration -of an extensive forest, or the splendid illumination of a large city with gas-lights, might present simi- lar appearances to a spectator in the moon. — The bright spots of the moon are the mountainous regions : the dark spots are the plains, or more level ])arts of her surface. There may probably be rivers or small lakes on this plan-'t ; but there are no seas or large coliectiouci of water. It appears highly ASTRONOMY. 181 probable, from the observations of Schroeter, that the moon is encompassed with an atmosphere ; but no clouds, rain, nor snow seem to exist in it. The illuminating power of the light derived from the moon, according to the experiments made by Professor Leslie, is about the one hundred a)id ftftij thousandth part of the illuniii^ating power of the sun. According to the experiments of M. Boguer, it is only as 1 to 30U,000. The Moon always presents the same face to us ; which proves, that she revolves round her axis in the same time that she revolves round tlie earth.' As ^his orb derives its light from the sup, and reflects a portion of it upon the earth, so the earth performs tlie same office lib the moon. A spectator on the lunar surface would behold the earth, like a luminous orb, suspended in tlie yauU of heaven, presenting a surface about 13 times larger than the moon does to us, and appearing some- times gibbous, sometimes horned, and at other times with a round full face. The light which the earth reflects upon the dark side of the moon may be distinctly perceived by a com- mon telescope, from three, to six or eight days after the change. — The lunar surface contains about 15 millions of square miles, and is, therefore, capable of containing a popula- tion equal to that of our globe, allowing only about 53 inhabit- ants to every square mile. That tliis plaiiet is inhabited by sensitiye and intelligent beings, there is every reason to con- clude, from a consideration of the sublime scenery with which Its surface is ad,orned, and of the general beneficence of the Creator, who appears to have left no large portion of his ma- terial creation M^thout animated existences ; and it is highly probable, that direct proofs of the moon's being inhabited may hereafter be obtained, wiieh all the Yg;rieties on her surface shall have been more minutely explored.* The Elanet Mars.— Next to the earth and moon, the planet Mars performs his revolution round the sun, in one year and ten months, to the distance of 145 millions of miles. His diamel;er is about 4,200 miles, and he is distinguished from all the ot^er planets, by his rudd^j appearance, which is owing to a dense atmosphere with which he is environed. With a good telescope, his surface appears diversified by a va- riety of spots ; by the motion of whiiCh it is found, tiiat he turns round his axis in 24 hours and 40" minutes. The inclination of hjs axis to the plane of his orbit being about 28", 42^ the days and nights, and the diflTerent seasons in this planet, will foear a considerable resemblance to those we experience in our * ^«« Appendix, No, III. 182 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. terrestrial sphere.* At his nearest approach to the earth, his distance from us is about 50 milhons of miles ; and, at his greatest distance, he is about 240 millions of miles ; so that in the former case he appears nearly 25 times larger than in the latter. To a spectator in this planet, our earth will appear, alternately, as a morning and evening star, and will exhibit all the phases of the moon, just as Venus does to us, but with a less degree of apparent magnitude and splendor. A luminous zone has been observed about the poles of Mars, which is subject to successive changes. Dr. Herschel supposes that it is produced by the reflection of the sun's light from his frozen regions, and that the melting of these masses of polar ice is the cause of the variation in its magnitude and appearance. This planet moves, in its orbit, at the rate of lifty-five thousand miles an hour. The new Planets. — Between the orbs of Mars and Ju- piter, four planetary bodies have been lately discovered, ac- companied with circumstances somewhat different from those of the other bodies which compose our system. They are named Ceres, Pallas, Juno, and Vesta, The planet Ceres was discovered at Palermo, in Sicily, by M. Piazzi, on the first day of the present century. It is of a ruddy color, and appears about the size of a star of the 8th magnitude, and is consequently invisible to the naked eye. It performs its revo- lution in 4 years and 7 months, at the distance of 260 millions of miles from the sun, and is reckoned, by some astronomers, to be about 1624 miles in diameter, or about half the diameter of Mercury. It appears to be surrovuidod with a large dense atmosphere. — Pallas was discovered the following year, name- ly, on the 28th of March, 1802, by Dr. Gibers of Bremen. It is supposed to be about 2000 miles in diamete ", or nearly the size of the moon. It revolves about the sun in 4 years and 7 months, or nearly in the same time as Ceres, at the dis- tance of 266 millions of miies ; and is surrounded with a nebulosity or atmosphere, above 400 miles in height, similar to that of Ceres. The planet Juno w.as discovered on the 1st September, 1804, by Mr. Harding of Bremen. Its mean distance from the sun is about 253 millions of miles ; its revo- tion is completed in 4 years and 130 days, and its diameter is computed to be about 1425 miles. It is free from the nebu- + Tlie iiK^lination of the cartli's axis to the erhp •f', or, in other words, to the plane of its a'tniial orl)ii, is 23 (iegrees and 28 minules, which is the oanse of the diversity of st;a.s(!n.s, and of Llic ditiereut le)iji:tii of days and /ii!:;;lit3. Were the axis of l.he earth perpendicular !o its orbit, as is the case Willi tlirf plunyL Juijitwr, tlicre would be no divtraity of seasons. ASTRONOMy, 183 losity which surronnds Pallas, and is distinguished from all the other planets by the great eccentricity of its orbit ; being, at its least distance from the smi, only 189 millions of miles, and at its greatest distance 316 millions. — Vesta was discovered by Dr. Olbers on the 29th March, 1807. It appears like a star of the 5th or 6th magnitude, and may sometimes be dis- tniguished by the naked eye. Its light is more intense and white than any of the other three, and it is not surrounded with any nebulosity. It is distant from the sun about 225 millions of miles, and completes its revolution in 3 years and 240 days. Its diameter has not yet been accurately ascertained ; but from the intensity of its light, and other circumstances, it is concluded, that it exceeds in magnitude both Pallas and Juno. These planetary globes present to our view a variety of anomalies and singularities, which appear incompatible with the regularity, proportion, and harmony which were formerly supposed to characterize the arrangements of the solar sys- tem. — They are bodies much smaller in size than the other planets — they revolve nearlij at the same distances from the sun, and perform their revolutions in nearly the same periods — their orbits are much more eccentric, and have a muck greater degree of inclination to the ecliptic, than those of the old planets — and, what is altogether singular, (except in case of comets,) their orbits c7'oss each other ; so that there is a possibility that two of these bodies might happen to interfere, and to strike each other, in the course of their revolutions. The orbit of Ceres crosses the orbit of Pallas. Vesta may sometimes be at a greater distance from the sun than either Ceres, Pallas or Juno, although its mean distance is less than that of either of them, by several millions of miles ; so that the orbit of Yesta crosses the orbits of all the other three. From these and other circumstances, it has, with a high degree of probability, been concluded — that these iour planets are the fragments of a large celestial body which once revolved between Mars and Ju- piter, and which had been burst asunder by some immense irruptive force. This idea seems to have occurred to Dr. Olbers after he had discovered the planet Pallas, and he ima- gined that other fragments might possibly exist. He con- cluded, that, if they all diverged from the same point, " they ought to have two common points of reunion, or two nodes in opposite regions of the heavens, through which all the plane- tary fragments must sooner or later pass." One of these nodes he found to be in the constellation Virgo, and the other in the Whale ; and it is a remarkable comcidence, that it was in the latter of these regions that the planet Juno was discov- 184 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. ered by Mr. Harding. In order to detect the remaining frag- ments (if any existed) Dr. Olbers examined, three times every year, ail the small stars in Virgo and the. Whale ; and it was actually in the constellation Virgo, that he discovered the planet Vesta. It is not unlikely that other frfigments of a similar de- scription may be discovered. Drl Brewster attributes the fall of meteoric stones* to the. smaller fragments of these bodies happening to come within the sphere of the earth's attraction. His ingenious reasonings on this subject, and in support oj Dr. Olbers' hypothesis above stcited, may be seen in Edhi. Ency. vol. ii. p. 641, and in his " Supplementary chapters to Ferguson's Astronomy." , . , The fact to which I have now adverted seem to unfold a new scene in the history of the dispensations of the Almighty, and to warrant the conclusion, that the earth is hot the only globe in the universe which is subject to physical changes and moral revolutions. .. < .. The Planet Jupiter. — This planet is 490 millions of miles distant from the sun, arid performs its annual revolution in nearly twelve of our years, moving at the rate of twenty- nine thousand miles an hour. , It is the largest planet in the solar system ; being 89,000 miles in diameter, or about four- teen hundred times larger than the earth. Its rriotion round its axis is performed in nine hours and fifty-six minutes ; and, therefore, the portions of its surface about the equator, move at the rate 28,000 miles an hour, which is riearly twenty-seven times swifter than the earth's diurnal rotation. The figure of Jupiter is that of an oblate spheroid, the axis, or diapietei passing through the poles, being about 6000 miles shorter than that passing through the equator. The Edrth, Saturn, * Meteoric stones, or, what are generally tetrned aerolites, are stones which sometimes fall from the upper reg-ioris of the atmosphere, upon the earth. The substance of. which they, are cc^pposed is^ for .the most part, metitllic ; but the, ore of which they consist is not to be found in the same constituent proportions in any terrestrial si^bstanccs. Their fall is generally preceded by a luminous appearance, a hissing noise, and a loud explosion ; and, Avhen found imm'ediKtely after their descent, are always hot. Their size differs from siiuiU fragments, of inconsiderable weight, to the most ponderous masses. Some of the largest portions of these stones have been found to weigh from 300 lbs. to several tons ; and they have often descend- ed to the earth with a force sufficient to bury them many feet under the soil. Some have supposed that these bodies are projected from volcanoes in the moon ; others, that they proceed froni, volcanoes on the earth ; while others imagine that they are generated in the rpgions of the atmosphere ; but the tnie cause is, probably, no^ yet ascertained. In some instances, these stones hayCipcnetrated through the roofs of houses, and proved de- structive to the inhabitants. ASTRONOMy. 185 and Mars, arc also spheroids ; and it is highly probably that Mercury, Venus, and Herschel are of a similar figure, though the fact has not yet been ascertained by actual observation. — When viewed with a telescope, several spots have been occa- sionally discovered on the surface of this planet, by the mo- tion of which, its rotation was determined. But what chiefly distinguishes the surface of Jupiter is several streaky appearances, or dusky strips, which extend across his disk, in lines parallel to his equator. These are generally termed his Bells. Three of these belts, or zones, nearly equi-distant from each other, are most frequently ob- served ; but they are not regular or constant in their appear- ance.* Sometimes only one is to be seen, sometimes five, and sometimes seven or eight have been distinctly visible ; and, in the latter case, two of them have been known to dis- appear during the time of observation. On the 28th May, 1780, Dr. Herschel perceived "the uihole surface of Jupiter covered with small curved belts, or rather lines, that were not continuous across his disk." Though these belts are gener- ally parallel to each other, yei they are not always so. Their breadth is likewise variable; one belt having been observed to grow narrow, while another in its neighborhood has increased in breadth, as if the one had flowed into the other. The time of their continuance is also uncertain; sometimes they remain unchanged for several months, at other times, new belts have been formed in an hour or two. What these belts or variable appearances are it is diflicult to determine. Some have regard- ed them as strata of clouds floating in the atmosphere of Ju- piter ; while others imagine, that they are the marks of great physical revolutions which are perpetually changing the sur- face of that planet. Thfe former opinion appears the most probable. But, whatever be the nature of these belts, the sud- den changes to which they are occasionally subject, seem to indicate the rapid operation of some powerful physical agency; for some of them ave more than five thousand miles in breadth ; and since tho^y have been known to disappear in the space of an hour or two; and even during the time of a casual observa- tion — agents mOre powerful than any with which we are ac- quainted must have produced so extensive an effect. Jupiter is attended by four satellites or moons, which present + A representation of these belts, in the positions in which they most frequently appear, is exhibited in the en^ravnig, Fig. 2. Fig. 1. represents tlie double rnig of Saturn, as it appears when viewed through a powerful telescope— Figiircs 1, 3, 3, 4, arid 5, represent Saturn, Jupiter, Herschel, the Earth and M(«in, in tkeir relative sizes and proporlions. 1ft 186 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. a very beautiful appearance when viewed through a telescbpe. The first moon, or that nearest the planet, it 230,000 miles distant from its centre, and goes round it in 42h hours ; and will appear from its surface, four times larger than our moon does to us. The second moon, being farther distant, will ap- pear about the size of ours ; the third, somewhat less ; and the fourth, which is a million of miles distant from Jupiter, and takes sixteen days to go round him, will appear only about one third the diameter ol' our moon. These moons suffer frequent eclipses from passing through Jupiter's shadow, in the same way as our moon is eclipsed by passing through the shadow of the earth. By the eclipses of these moons, the motion of light was ascertained ; and they are foimd to be of essential use in determining the longitude of places on the surface of our globe. This planet, if seen from its nearest moon, will present a surface a thousand times as large as our moon does to us, and will appear in the form of a crescent, a half-moon, a gibbous phase, and a full-moon, in regular succession, every 42 hours. Jupiter's axis being nearly perpendicular to bis orbit, he has no sensible change of seasons, such as we exi)e- rience on the earth. Were we placed on the surface of this planet, with the limited powers of vision we now possess, our earth and moon would entirely disappear, as if they were blotted out from the map of creation ; and the inhabitants of these regions must have much better eyes than ours, if they know that there is such a globe as the Cctrth irt the universe. The planet Saturn. — This planet is 900 millions of miles distant from the sun, being nearly double the distance of Jupiter. Its diameter is 79,000 miles, and, consequently, it is more than 7iine hundred times the biilk of the earth. It takes 292 years to complete its revolution about the sun ; but its diurnal motion is completed in ten hours and sixteen minutes ; so that the year in this planet is nfearly thirty times the length of ours, while the day is shorter, by more than one half. The year, therefore, contains about twenty-five thou- sand one hundred and fifty dalJS^| or periods of its diurnal rota- tion, which is equal to 10,759 of our days. Saturn is of a spheroidal figure, or somewhat of the sliape of an orange ; his equatorial being more than six thousarid miles loriger than his polar diameter. His surface, like that of Jupiter, is diversified with belts and dark spots. Dr. Herschel, at certain times, perceived five belts on his surface, three of which were dark, and two bright. The dark belts had a yellowish tinge, and generally covered a larger zone of the disk of Saturn, than the belts of Jupiter occupy upon his surface. On account of the ASTRONOMY. 187 jO^reat distance of this planet from the sun, the llglit it receives from that luminary is only the nineliefli part of what we enjoy ; but, by calculation, it is found, that this quantity is a thousand times greater than the light which the full moon affords to us. Besides, it is surrounded by no fewer than seven moons, which supply it with light in the absence of the sun. Five of these moons were discovered during the seventeenth century, by Huygens and Cassini ; and the sixth and seventh were dis- covered by Dr. Herschel, in 1789, soon after his large forty feet reflecting telescope was constructed. These moons, and also those which accompany Jupiter, are estimated to be not less than the earth in magnitude, and are found, like our moon, to revolve round their axis in the same time in which they revolve about their respective primaries. Rings of Saturn. — The most extraordinary circumstance connected with this planet, is, the phenomenon of a double ring, which surrounds its body, but nowhere touches it, being thirty thousand miles distant from any part of the planet, and is carried along with the planet in its circuit round the sun. This is the most singular and astonishing object in the whole i*ange of the planetary system ; no other planet being found environed with so wonderful an appendage ; and the planets which may belong to other systems, being placed beyond the reach of our observations, no idea can be formed of the pecu- liar apparatus with which any of them may be furnished. This double ring consists of two concentric rings, detached from each other ; the innermost of which is nearly three times as broad as the outermost. The outside diameter of the exterior ring is 204,000 miles ; and, consequently, its circumference will measure six hund^'td and forty thousand miles, or eighty times the diameter of our globe. Its breadth is 7,200 miles, or nearly the diameter of the earth. Were four hundred and fifty globes, of the size of the earth, placed close to one another, on a plane, this immense ring would enclose the whole of them, together with all the interstices^ or open spaces be- tween the different globes. The outside diameter of the inner- most ring is 184,000 miles, and its breadth twenty thousand miles, or about 22 times broader than the diameter of the earth. The dark space, or interval between the two rings, is 2,800 miles. The breadth of both the rings, including the dark space between them, is thirty thousand miles, which is equal to the distance of the innermost ring from the body of Saturn. The following figure represents a view of Saturn and hi.s rings, as they would appear, were our eye perpendicular to 188 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. one of the planes of those rings ; but our eye is never so much elevated above either plane, as to have the visual ray- standing at right angles to it : it is never elevated more than 30 degrees above the planes of the rings. When Ave view Saturn through a telescope, Ave always see the ring at an oblique angle, so that it appears of an oval form, the outAvard circular rim being projected into an ellipsis more or less oblong, according to the diflerent degrees of obliquity Avith Avhich it is vicAved, as Avill be seen in the figure of Saturn in the copperplate engraving. These rings cast a deep shadoAv upon the planet, Avhich proves that they are not shihmg fluids, l3ut composed of solid matter. They appear to be possessed of a higher reflectiA^e power than the surface of Saturn ; as the light reflected by them is more brilliant than that of the planet. One obvious use of this double ring is, to reflect light upon the planet, in the absence of the sun : Avhat other purposes it may be intend- ed to subserve, in the system of Saturn, is, at present, to us unknoAvn. The sun illuminates one side of it during fifteen years, or one-half of the period of the planet's revolution ; and, during the next fifteen years, the other side is enlightened in its turn. Twice in the course of thirty years, there is a short ASTRONOMY. 189 period, during which neither side is enlightened, and when, of course, it ceases to he visible ; — namely, at the time when the sun ceases to shine on one side, and is a})Out to shine on the other. It revolves round its axis, and, conso(iuentIy, around Saturn, in ten hours and a half, which is at the rate of a thou- sand miles in a minute, or fifty-eight times swifter than the earth's equator. When viewed t\oin the middle zone of the planet, in the absence of the sun, the ringr; will appear like vast luminous arches, extending along the canoi)y of heaven, from the eastern to the western horizon ; having an apparent breadth equal to a hundred times the apparent diameter of our moon, and will be seen darkened about the middle, by the shadow of Saturn.* There is no other planet In the solar system, whose firma- ment will present such a variety of splendid and mngnificent objects, as that of Saturn. The various aspects of his seven moons, one rising above the horizon, while another is setting, and a third approaching to the meridian ; one entering into an eclipse, and another emerging from it ; one appearing as a crescent, and another with a gibbous phase ; and some- times the whole of them shining in the same hemisphere, in one bright assemblage ; — the majestic motions of the rings,— at one time illuminating the sky with their splendour, and eclipsing the stars ; at another, casting a deep shade over cer- tain regions of the planet, and unveiling to view the w^onders of the starry firmament — are scenes worthy of the majesty of the Divine Being to unfold, and of rational creatures to contem- plate. Such magnificent displays of Wisdom and Omnipo- tence, lead us to conclude that the numerous splendid objects connected with this planet, were not created merely to shed their lustre on naked rocks and barren sands ; but that an im- mense population of intelligent beings is placed in those re- gions, to enjoy the bounty, and to adore the perfections ot their great Creator. — The double ring of Saturn, when viewed through a good telescope, generally appears hke a luminous handle on each side of the planet, with a dark interval between the interior edge of the ring, and the convex body of Saturn ; which Is owing to^its oblique position with respect to our line of vision. When its outer edge is turned directly towards the + See the Engraving, fig. 7, which represenfs a view of the appearance which the rings and moons of Saturn will exhibit, in certain cases, about midnight, when beheld from a point 20 or 30 degrees north from his equa- tor. The shade on the upper i)art of tlie rings represents the shadow of the body Saturn. The shadow will appear to move gradually to tlie west as the morning approuchos. 16* 190 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER'. earth, it becomes invisible, or appears like a dark stripe across the disk of the planet. This phenomenon happens once every fifteen years. The Planet Herschel. — This planet, which is also known by the names of the Georgium Sidns, and Uranus^ was discovered by Dr. Herschel on the 13th March, 1781. It is the most distant planet from the sun, that has yet been dis- covered ; being removed at no less than 1800 millions of miles from that luminary, which is nineteen times farther than the earth is from the sun — a distance so great, that a cannon, ball, flying at the rate of 480 miles an hour, would not reach it in 400 years. Its diameter is about 35,000 miles ; and, of course, it is about eighty times larger than the earth- It ap- pears like a star of the sixth magnitude ; but can seldom be distinguished by the naked eye. It takes about 83 years and a half to complete its revolution round the sun ; and, though it is the slowest moving body in the system, it moves at the rate of 15,000 miles an hour. As the degree of sensible heat in any planet does not appear to depend altogether on its near- ness to the sun, the temperature of this planet maybe as miid as that which obtains in the most genial climate of our globe.* The diameter of the s\m, as seen from Herschel, is little more than the apparent diameter of Venus, as seen by the nakdd eye ; and the light which it receives from that luminary, is 360 times less than what we experience ; yet this proportion is found by calculation to be equal to the effect which would be produced by 248 of our full moons ; and, in the absence of the sun, there are six moons which reflect light upon tl^is dis- tant planet, all of which were discovered likewise by Dr. Her- schel. Small as the proportion of light is, which this planet receives from the sun, it is easy to conceive, that beings simi- lar to man, placed on the surface of this globe, with a slight modification of their organs of vision, might be made to per- ceive objects Avith a clearness and distinctness even superior to what we can do. We have only to suppose, that the Crea- tor has formed their eyes \vit\i piipils capable of a much larger expansion than ours ; and has endued their relina with a much greater dv'gree of nervous sensibility. At all events, we may rest assured, that He who has placed sentient beings in any region, has, by laws with which we are partly unacquainted, adapted the constitution of the inhabitant to the nature of the habitation. ♦ See Note, page 176. ASTRONOMV. 191 *' Strange and amazing must the difference be, 'Twixt this dull planet and bright Mercury; , Yet reason says, nor ran we doubt at all, Millions of beings dwell on either ball, With constitutions fitted for that spot Whei-e Providence, all-wise, has fixed their lot." Baker's Universe.. The celestial globes which I have now described, arc all the planets which are at present known to belong to the solar system. It is probable that other planetary bodies may yet be discovered between the orbits of Saturn and Ilerschel, and even far beyond the orbit of the latter ; and it is also not im- probable that planets may exist in the immense interval of 37 millions of miles between Mercury and the Sun.* These (if any exist) can be detected only by a series of day observa- tions^ made with equatorial telescopes ; as they could not be supposed to be seen, after sun-set, on account of their proxi- mity to the sun. Five pr/maryf planets, and eight secondaries^ have been discovered within the last 42 years ; and, therefore, we have no reason to conclude, that all the bodies belonging to our system have yet been detected, till every region of the heavens be more fully explored. Comets. — Besides the planetary globes to which I have now adverted, there is a class of celestial bodies which occa- sionally appear in the heavens, to which the name of Comets has been given. They are distinguished from the other ce- lestial bodies, by their ruddy appearance, and by a long train of light, called the fail, which sometimes extends over a con- siderable portion of the heavens, and which is so transparent, that the stars may be seen through it. The tail is always di- rected to that part of the heavens which is opposite to the sun, and increases in size as it approaches him, and is again gra- dually diminished, as the comet flies off to the more distant regions of space. Their apparent magnitude is very different : * The Author, some years ago, described a method by Avliich the pla- nets (if any) within tlie orbit of Mercury, may be discovered in the day- time, by means of a simple cont)-ivance for intercepting the solar rays, and by the frequent application, by a number of observers, of powerful tele- si'opes, to a certain portion of the sky, in the vicinity of the sun. The de- tails of this plan have not yet been published ; but the reader will see them alluded to in No. V. of the Edinburgh Philosophical Journal, for July, 1820, p. 191. t A primary planet is that which revolves round the sun as a centre ; as Mars, Jupitci", and Safurn. A secondary planet is one which revolves round a primary planet as its centre ; as the Moon, and the satellites of Jupiter and Saturn. The primary planets are distinguished from the fixed stars, by the steadiness of their llglit ; not having a ticiiiLiing ap- pearance, as the stars exiiibiL. 192 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER sometimes they appear only of the bigness of tho fixed stars ; at other times they equal the diameter of Venus ; and sometimes they have appeared nearly as large as the Moon. They traverse the heavens in all directions, and cross the orbits of the planets. When examined through a telescope, they appear to consist of a dark central nucleus, surrounded by a dense atmosphere, or mass of vapors. They have been ascertained to move in long narrow elUjjses or ovals, around the sun ; some of them, on their nearest approach to him, liaving been within a million of miles of his centre ; and then 4y oft^ to a region several thousands of millions of miles dis- tant. When near the sun, they move with amazing velocity. The velocity of the comet which appeared in 1680, according to Sir Isaac Newton's calculation, was eight hundred and ei-ghty thousand miles an hour. They appear to be bodies of no great density, and their size seldom exceeds that of the i^iopn. The length of the tails of some comets has been esti- mated at fifty millions of miles. According to Dr. Herschel's computations, the solid nucleus, or central part of the comet which appeared in 1811, was only 428 miles in diameter ; but the real diameter of the head, or nebulous portion of the comet, he computed to be about 127 thousand miles. The length of its tail he computed to be above one hundred millions of miles, and its breadth, nearly fifteen millions. It was nearest to the earth on the llth October, when its distance was 113 millions of miles. The number of comets which have occasionally been seen within the limits of our system, since the com- mencement of the Christian era, is about 500, of which the paths or orbits of 98 have been calculated. As these bodies cross the paths of the planets in every di- rection, there is a possibility, that some of them might strike against the earth in their approach to the sun ; and, were this to happen, the consequences would be awful beyond descrip- tion. But we may rest assured that that Almighty Being who at first launched them into existence, directs all their motions, however complicated ; and that the earth shall remain secure against all such concussions from celestial agents, till the pur- poses of his moral government in this world shall be fully ac- complished. What regions these bodies visit, when they pass bryond the limits of our view ; upon what errands they are serit, when they again revisit the central parts of our system ; what is the dilierence in their physical constitution, from that of the sun and plannts ; and v.hat important ends thry are destined to accomplish, in the economy of the universe, are inquiries which naturally arise in ihe mind, but which surpass ASTRONOMY. 193 the limited powers of the human imderst^nding at present to determine. Of this, however, we may rest assured, that they were not created in vain ; that they subserve purposes worthy, of the infinite Creator ; and that Avherever he has ex- erted his power, there also he manifests his Wisdom and Be- neficence.* Such is a general outline of the leading facts connected with that system of which we form a part. Though the ener- gies of Divine Power had never been exerted beyond the Hmits of this system, it would remain an eternal monument of the Wisdom and Omnipotence of its Author. Independent of the Sun, which is like a vast universe in itself, and of the numerous comets Avhich are continually traversing its distant regions, it contains a mass of material existence, arranged in the most beautiful order, two thousand five hundred times larger than our globe. From late observations, there is the strongest reason to conclude, that the sun, along with all this vast assemblage of bodies, is carried through the regions of the universe, towards some distant point of space, or around some wide circumference, at the rate of more than sixty thou- sand miles an hour ; and if so, it is highly probable, if not ab- solutely certain, that we shall never again occupy that portion of absolute space, through which we are this moment passing, during all the succeeding ages of eternity. Such a glorious system must have been brought into ex- istence, to subserve purposes worthy of the Infinite Wisdom and Benevolence of the Creator. To suppose that the dis tant globes, of which it is composed, with their magnificent apparatus of Rings and Moons, were created merely for the purpose of affording a few astronomers, in these latter times, a peep of them through their glasses^ would be inconsistent with every principle of reason ; and would be charging Him who is the source of Wisdom, with conduct which we would pronounce to be folly in the sons of men. Since it appears, so far as our observation extends, that matter exists solely for the sake of sensitive and intelligent beings, and that the Crea- * A comet has lately, been discpvered, whose peviocUoal revolution is found to be only S years and 107 days. At its greates,t distance from the sun, it is within tlie orbit of Jupiter, and it possesses tins' peculiar advan- tage for observation, that it will become visible ten times in thirty-three years. It was last seen in June, 1822, by the a,stronomers in the observa- tory of Paramatta, New Holland, in positions very near to tliose which had been previously calculated by Mr. Enke. It is probiiblc, that the observations Avhich may hereafter be made on this comet, will lead to more definite and accurate views of the nature and de^stination of these singular botUes. 194 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. tor made nothing in vain ; it is a conclusion to which we are necessarily led, that the planetary globes are inhabited by various orders of intellectual beings, who participate in the bounty, and celebrate the glory of then;. Creator. When this idea is taken into consideration, it gives a striking emphasis to such sublime declarations of the Sacred Volume as these : — " All nations before him are as nothing — He sit- teth upon the circle of the earth, and the inhabitants thereof are as grasshoppers — The nations are as the drop of a bucket — All the inhabitants of the world are reputed as nothing in his sight ; and he doth according to his will in the army of Ueaven, and among the inhabitants of the earth — Thou hast made heaven, and the heaven of heavens, with all their host ; and thou preservest them all, and the host of heaven ivorship- peth f/i«e— :When I consider' thy heavens, what is man, that thou art mindful of him!" If the race of Adam were the principal intelligences in the universe of God, such passages would be stripped of all their sublimity, would degenerate into mere hyperboles, and be almost without meaning. If man were the only rational being who inhabited the material \voRLD, as some airogantly imagine, it would be no wonder at ail, that God should be " mindful of him ;" nor could " all the inhabitants of this world," with any propriety, be compared to " a drop of a bucket," and be '.' reputed as nothing in his sight." — Such declarations would be contrary to fact, if this supposition were admitted ; for it assumes that man holds the. principal station in the visible universe. The expressions — " The heavens, the heaven of heaveus," and " the host of heaven worshipping God," would also, on this supposition, de- generate into something approaching to mere inanity. These expressions, if they signify any thing that is worthy of an In- spired Teacher to communicate, evidently imply, that the universe is vast and extensive, beyond the range of human comprehension — that it is peopled with myriads of inhabitants — that these inhabitants are possessed of intellectual natures, capable of appreciating the perfections of their Creator— and that they pay him a tribute of rational adoration. " The host of heaven worshippeth thee." So that the language of Scrip- ture is not only consistent with the doctrine of a plurality of worlds, but evidently supposes their existence to all the extent to which modern science can carry us. However vast the universe now appears — however numerous the worlds and systems of worlds, which may exist within its boundless range —the language of Scripture is sutFiciently comprehensive and Bublime, to express all the emotions which naturally arise in ASTRONOMY. 195 the mind, when contemplating its structure — a characteristic which will apply to no other book, or pretended revelation. i And this consideration shows not only the harmony which subsists between the discoveries of Revelation and the dis- coveries of Science;, but also fornis by itself, a strong pre- sumptive evidence, that the Records of the Bible are authentic and divine.* Vast as the Solar System, we have now been contemplatirlg, may appear, it i^ but a rhere poiilt in the map of creation. To a spectator placed in one of the stars of the seventh magnitude, not only the glories of this world, and the more resplendent scenes of the planet Saturn', but e^nsn tht3 sun himself would entirely disappear^ as if he wpre blotted out of existence. " Were the sun," says Mr. Addison, '"' wliici^ enlightens this part of the creation, with all the host of the planetary worlds that move about bin), utterly extinguislied and annihilated, they would not be missed by an eye that could take in the whole compass of nature, more th'An a grain of sand upon the sea shore. The space they possess is so ex- ceedingly little, in comparison of the whole, that it Would scarce make a blank in creation." The Fixed Stars. — When we pass from the planetary system to other regions of creations we have to traverse, in imagination, a space so immense-, that it has hitherto bafiled all the efiorts of science to determine its extent. In these remote and immeasurable spaces, are placed those immense luminous bodies usually denominated the fixed stars. The i nearest stars are, on good grounds, concluded to be at least I twenty billions of miles distant from our globe— a distance i through which light (the swiftest body in nature) could not \ travefin the space of three years ; and which a ball, moving i at the rate of 500 miles an hour, would not traverse in four f millions five hundred thousand years, or 750 times the period which has elapsed siiice the Mosaic creati()h; But how f;ir they may be placed beyond this distance, no astronomer will pretend to determine. The following consideration will prove, to those unacquainted with the mathematical principles of I astronomy, that the stars are placed at an immeasurable dis- tance. When they are viewed through a telesc<5pe which magnifies objects a thoui^and times, they appear lio larger than 'J to the naked eye ; which circumstance shows; that though we j were placed at the thousandth part of the distance from them at which we now are, they would still appear only as so many shining points ; for we should still be distant from the nearest ♦ Sec Ain.fM,jix, No. VI. , 196 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. of theni, twenty thousand millions of miles : or, in other words, were we transported several thousands of millions of miles from the spot we riow occupy, though their numbers would appear exceedingly increased; they would ^.ppear no larger than they do from our present station ; and we behooved to be carried forward thousands of millions of miles further in a long succession, before their disks appeared to expand into large circles, like the moon. Dr; Herschel viewed the stars with telescopes; magnifying six thoiisdnd times, yet they still appeared only as brilliant points; without any sensible disks, or increase of diameter. This circumstance incontestibly proves the two fotlowitig things : — 1. That the stars are luminous bodies, which shine by their o'wTi native light ; other- wise they could not be perceived at such vast distances. 2. That they are bodies of an immense size, not inferior to the sun ; and niany of them, it is probable; far exceed that luminary in bulk and splendor; The stars, on account of the ditTerence in their apparent magnitudes, have bebn distributed into several classes or orders. Those which appear largest are called stars of the first magnitude ; next to those in lustre, stars of the second magnitude, and so on to stars of the sixth magnitude, which are the smallest that can be distinguished by the naked eye. Stars of the 7th, 8th; 9th, 10th; &c. magnitudes, which cannot be seen by the naked eye, are distinguished by the name of telescopic stars. Not more tliari a thousand stars can be dis- tinguished by the naked eye, in the clearest winter's night ; but, by means of the telescope; millions have been discovered. (See p. 39.)— And; as it is probable, that; by far the greater part lie beyond the reach of the best glasses which have been, or ever will be conistructed by man — the real number of the stars may be presumed to be beyond all human calculation or conception, arid pferhaps beyond the grasp of angelic com- prehension. In conSeqLtence of recent discoveries, we have now the strongest reason to believe, that all the stars in the universe are arranged into clusters, or groupes, which astronomers distinguish by the name of Nerul^e or Starry System"?, each nebula consisting o'f rnany thousands of stars. The nearest nebula is that whitish space or zone, which is known by the name of the JSxiik\j Wciij; to which our sim is supposed to belong. It coitsists of many hundreds of thousands of stars. When Tft, Herschel examined this region^ with his powerful telescopes, he found a portion of it only 15 degrees long and 2 brotid, which <-outai(i(Ml jljhf ihousimd Stars large enough to ASTRONOMY. 107 be distinctly counted ;■ and he suspected twice as many more, which, for want of sufficient Hght in his telescope, he saw only now and then. More than two thousand five hundred nebuliC have already been observed ; and, if each of them contain as many stars as the Milky Way, several hundreds of millions of stars must exist, even within that portion of the heavens which lies open to our observation. It appears, from numerous observations, that various cluin^es are occasionally taking place in the regions of the stars. Several stars have appeared for a while in the heavens, and then vanished from the si^ht. §ome stars which were known to the ancients, canyiot now be discovered ; and stars are now distinctly visible, which were to them unknown. A few stars have gradually increased in brilliancy, while others have been constantly diminishing in lustre. Certain stars, to the number of 15, or npwfirds, are asceitained to have a periodical increase and decrease of their lustre, sometimes appearing like stars of the 1st or 2d magnitude, sometimes dinunishing to the size of the 4th or 5lh magnitude, and sometimes altogether disappear- ing to the naked eye. It also appears, that changes are taking place among the nebuhtc — that several nebula arc formed by the decomposition of larger neijulop, and that many nebulee of this kind are at present detaching themselves from the nebulro of the Milky Way. These changes seem to indicate, that mighty movements and vast operations are continually going on in the distant regions of creation, under the superintendence of the Sovereign of the Universe, upon a scale of magnitude and grandeur which overwhelms the human understanding. To explore, more extensively, the region of the starry firmament ; to mark the changes that are taking place ; to ascertain all the changeable stars ; to determine the periodical variations of their light ; the revolutions of double and triple stars ; and the motions, and other phenomena peculiar to these great bodies, will furnish employment for future enlightened generations : and will, perhaps, form a part of the studies and investigations of superior intelligences, in a higher sphere of existence, during an indefinite lapse of ages. If every one of these immense bodies be a Sun, equal or superior to ours, and encircled with a host of planetary worlds, as we have every reason to conclude, (see pp. 38, 64, 65,) how vast niust be the extent of Creation ! how numerous the worlds and beings which exist within its boundless range ! and, how great, beyond all human or angelic conception, must be the Power and tntelligence of that glorious Being, who called this systpmfrom nothin.q; into Cx'islonce, and cojitinually ^upcr- 193 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. intends all its movements ! The mind is bewildered and con- founded when it attempts to dwell on this subject ; it feels the narrow limits of its present faculties ; it longs for the powers of a seraph, to enable it to take a more expansive flight, into those regions which " eye hath not seen ;" and, while destitute of these, and chained down to this obscure corner of creation, it can only exclaim, in the language of inspiration, " Who can by searching fmd out God ? — Great is our Lord, and of great power ; his understanding is infinite ! — Great and marvellous are thy works, Lord God Almighty! — Who can utter the mighty acts of Jehovah, who can show forth all his praise !" At\er what has been now stated in relation to the leading facts of astronomy, it would be needless to spend time in endeavouring to show its connexion with religion. It will be at once admitted, that all the huge globes of luminous and opaque matter, to which we have adverted, are the workman- ship of Him " who is wonderful in counsel and excellent in working ;" and form a part of the dominions of that august Sovereign, '' whose kingdom ruleth over all." And shall it ever be insinuated, that this subject has no relation to the great object of our adoration? and that it is of no importance in our views of the Divinity, whether v, e conceive his domi- nions as circumscribed within the limits of little more than 25,000 miles, or as embracing an extent which comprehends mnumerable worlds? The objects around us in this sublunary sphere strikingly evince the superintendency, the wisdom and benevolenl;i- *ion of the heavens inspires, must be owing, in part, to lUe minds of Christian parents and teachers not having been 200 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. directed to such subject, or to the views they entertain respect ing the relation of such contemplations to the objects of reli- gion. In communicating religious instructions in reference to the attributes of God, the heavens arc seldom referred to, ex- cept in such a vague and indctinitc manner as can produce no deep nor vivid impression on the mind ; and many pious per- sons, whose views haye been confined to a narrow range of objects, have been disposed to declaim against such studies, as if they had a tendency to engender pride and self-conceit, and as if they were even dangerous to the interests of religion and piety. How very different were the fc»elings and the con- duct of the sacred writers ! They call upon every one of God's intelligent offspring to "_ stand still, and consider the won- drous works "of the Most High ;" and describe the profound emotions of piety which the contemplation of them produced on their own minds : " Lift up your eyes on high and behold ! Who hath created these things! The heavens declare the glory of God, and the firmament showcth his handy-work. — When 1 consider thy heavens, the work of thy fingers, the moon and the stars which thou hast ordained — what is man hat thou art mindful of him, and the son of man that thou yisitost him ! Thou, even thou, art Lord alone ; thou hast made heaven, and the heaven of heavens, with all their host, and thou preserves! them all ; and the hosts of heaven worship thee. All the gods of the nations are idols ; but the Lord MADE THE HEAVENS : Ilouor and Majesty are before him. — Jehovah hath prepared his throne in the heavens ; and his kingdom ruleth over all. Sing praises unto God, ye king- doms of the earth, to him that rideth on the heaven of hea- vens. Ascribe ye power to our God ; for his strength is in the heavens. Praise him for his mighty acts, praise him ac- cording to his excellent o-reafness.^^ If we would enter, with spirit, into such elevated strains of piety, we must content our selves with a passing and vacant stare at the orbs of heaven, as if they were only so many brilliant studs fixed in the canopy of the sky ; but must " consider'^' them, with fixed attention, in all the lights in which revelation and science have exhibited thsm to our view, if we wish to praise God for his mighty works, and " according to his excellent greatness." And, for his purpose, the conclusions deduced by those who have de- oted themselves to celestial investigations, ought to be pre- sented to the view of the intelligent Christian, that he may bo enabled to " speak of the glory of Jehovah's kingdom, and to talk of his power." NATURAL PHILOSOPHY. 201 Having, in the preceding sketches, cfuipiderably exceeded the limits originally prescribed tor this (li;partment of my sub- ject, I am reluctantly compelled to despatch the remaining .sciences with a few brief notices. NATURAL PHILOSOPHY, The object of JS^atural Philosophy is, to observe and de- scribe the phenomena of the material universe, with a view to discover their causes, and the laws by which the Almighty di- rects the movements of all bodies in heaven and on earth. — It embraces an investigation of the laws of gravitation, by which the planets are directed in their motions — the laws by which water, air, light, and heat are regulated, and the etl'ect.^ they produce in the various states in which they operate — the nature of colors, sounds, electricity, galvanism, and magnet- ism, and the laws of their operation — the causes which operate in the production of thunder, lightning, luminous and fiery meteors, hail, rain, snow, dew, and other atmospherical phe- nomena. In short, it embraces all the objects of Natural His- tory formerly alluded to, wdth a view to ascertain the causes of their varied appearances, and the principles that operate in the changes to which they are subject ; or, in other words, the laws by which the diversified phenomena of universal na- ture are produced and regulated. One subordinate use of the knowledge derived from this science, is, to enable us to con- struct all those mechanical engines which facilitate human labor, and increase the comforts of mankind, and all tho^se in- struments which tend to enlarge our views of the operations of nature. A still higher and nobler use to which philosophy is subservient, is, to demonstrate the Wisdom and Intelligence of the Great First Cause of all things, and to enlarge our con- ceptions of the admirable contrivance and design whion appear in the diflercnt departments of universal nature. In this view, it may be considered as forming a branch of J\'attrral Thu- oIo2;ij', or, in other words, a branch of the religion of angels, and of all other holy intelligences. This department of Natural Science has generally been divided into the folloAving branches : I. Mechanics. — This branch, considered in its most ex- tensive range, includes an investigation of the general proper- ties of matter ; such as solidity, extension, divisibility, motion, attraction, and repulsion — the laws of gravitation, and of cen- tral forces, as they appear to operate in the motions of the celestial bodies ; and on the surface of our globe, in the phe- nomena ot' failing bodies, the motions of projectiles, the vibra 17* 202 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. tioii of pendulums, &c. — the theory of machines, the princi- ples on which their energy depends ; the properties of the mechanical powers — the lever, the wheel, and axle, the jrulleij, the inclined plane, the wedge and the screw — and the effects resulting from their various combinations. From the investi- gations of philosophers on these subjects, we learn the laws by which the great bodies of the universe are directed in their motions ; the laws which bind together the different portions of matter on the surface of the earth, and which regulate the motions of animal, vegetable, and inanimate nature ; and the principles on which cranes, mills, wheel-carriages, pile- engines, threshing-machines, and other engines are con- structed ; by means of which, man has been enabled to ac- complish opei-ations far beyond the limits of his own physical powers. Without a knowledge of the laws of motion, and assistance from the combined effects of the mechanical powers, man would be a very limited being, his enjoyments would be few, and his active energies confined within a very narrow range. In a savage state, ignorant of manufactures, agriculture, archi- tecture, navigation, and the other arts which depend upon me- chanical combinations, he is exposed, without shelter, to the inclemencies of the season ; he is unable to transport himself beyond seas and oceans, to visit other climes and other tribes of his fellow-men ; he exists in tl\e desert, comfortless and unimproved ; the fertile soil, over which he roams, is covered with thorns, and briers, and thickets, Tor the haunt oi' beasts of prey ; his enjoyments are little superior to those of the lion, the hya?na, and the elephant, while he is much their inferior, in point of agility and physical strength. But when Philosophy has once demonstrated the principles of mechanics, and intro- duced the practice of the usetul Arts, " the wilderness and ihe solitary place are made glad, and the desert rejoices, and blos- soms as the rose." Cities are founded, and gradually rise to opulence and splendor ; palaces and temples are erected ; the damp cavern, and the rush-built hut, are exchanged lor the warm and comfortable apartments of a substantial mansion ; ships are built, and navigated across the ocean ; the treasures of one country are conveyed to another ; an intercourse is carried on between the most distant tribes of mankind ; com- nfierce flourishes, and machinery of all kinds is erected, for facilitating human labor, and promoting the enjoyments of man. And when the principles and the practice of " pure and unde- filed religion" accompany these physical and mechnnical ope- rations, love and affection diffiise their benign influence ; the NATURAL PHILOSOPHY. 203 prospect brightens as years roll on, and man advances, with pleasure and improvement, to the scene of his high destination. II. I/vniiosTATics treats oi' iJic jiressiire and equilibrium of fluids. From the experiments which have been made in this branch of philosophy, the following important principles, among many others, have been deduced : — (1.) That the surface of all waters which have a communis cation whilst they are at rest, will he 'perfectly level. This principle will be more clearly understood by an inspection of the following figures. If water be poured into the tube A, (Fig. 1.) it will run through the horizontal tube E, and rise in the opposite tube B, to the same height at which it stands at A. ii JO [t is on this principle that water is now conveyed under ground, throu<>-h conduit pipes, and made to rise to the level of the fountain whence it is drawn. The city of Edinburgh, a con- siderable part of which is elevated above the level of the sur- rounding country, is supplied with water from a reservoir on the Pentland hills, several miles distant. The water is con^ veyed in leaden pipes down the declivity of the hill, along the interjacent plain, and up to the entrance of the castle, whence it is distributed to all parts of the city. If the point A repre- sent the level of the reservoir, C D will represent the plain along which the water is conveyed, and C the elevation to which it rises on the castle hill. On the same principle, and in a similar manner, the city of London is supplied with water from the water-works at London Bridge. Had the ancients been acquainted with this simple but important principle, it would have saved them the labor and expense of rearing those 204 THE ciira^TiAN pmLosoi?iiER. stupendaus works of art, the Aqueducts^ which consisted of numerous arches of a vast size, and sometimes piled one above another. Fig. 2. represents'the st/p/ion, the action of which depends upon the pressure of the atmosphere. If this instrument be filled with water, or any other liquid, and the shorter leg G, plunged to the bottom of a cask, or other vessel, containing the same liquid, the water will run out at the longer leg F, till the vessel be emptied, in conse€|uence of the atmospheric pressure upon the surface of the lirpiid. On this principle, water may be conveyed over a rising ground to any distance, provided the perpendicular height of the syphon above the sur- face of the water in the fountain, does not exceed 32 or 33 feet. On the same principle are constructed the fountain at command, the cup of Tantalus, and other entertaining devices. The same principle, too, enables us to account for springs which are sometimes found on the tops of mountains, and for the phenomena of intermitting springs, or those which flow and stop by regular alternations. (2.) Any quantity of fluid, however small, may be made to counterpoise any quantity, however large. This is what has generally been termed the Hydrostatical Paradox ; and from this principle it follows, that a given quantity of water may exert a force several hundred times greater or less, according to the manner in which it is employed. This force depends on the height of the column of water, independent of its quan- tity ; for its prcssjfre depends on its perpendicular height. By means of water conveyed through a very small perpendicular tube, of great length, a very strong hogshead has been burst to pieces, and the water scattered about Avith incredible force. On this principle, the hydrostatic j^ress, and other cugines of immense power have been constructed. (3.) Every body which is heavier iiian icatcr, or ivhich sinls in it, displaces so much of the icatcr as is equal to the bulk of the body immersed in the water. On this principle, the speci- fic gravities, or com})arative weight, of all bodies are deter- mined. It appears to have been first ascertained by Archi- medes, and, by means of it, he det'^rmin^d that the golden ciown of the King of Syracuse had been adulterated by the worl-nnen. From this principle we learn, among many other things, the specific gravity of the hmnan body ; and (hat four pounds of cork will preserve a person weighing 135 pounds from sinking, so that he may remain with his head completely above water. ilijdraulics, which has sometimes been treated as a distinct NATURAL riiiLosornr. 205 department of mechanical philosophy, may be considered as a branch of hydrostatics. It teaches us what relates to the mo- lion of fluids, and how to estimate their velocity and force. On the principle of this science, all machines worked by water are constructed — as steam-engines, water-mills, common and forcing pumps, syphons, tbuntains, and tire-engines. III. Pneumatics. — This branch of philosophy treats of the nature and properties of the atmosphere, and of their eflects on solid and fluid bodies. From this science we learn, that air has iveighf, and presses on all sides, like other fluids ; that the pressure of the atmosphere upon the top of a mountain, is less than on the plain beneath ; that it presses upon our bodies with a weight of several thousand pounds more at one time than at another ; that air can be compressed into forty thou- sand times less space than it naturally occupies ; that it is of an clastic or expansive nature, and that the force of its spring is equal to its weight ; that its elasticity is increased by heat ; that it is necessary to the production of sound, the support of flame and animal life, and the germination and growth of all kinds of vegetables. These positions are proved and illustrated by such experi- ments as the following : — The general 2)ressure of the atmos- phere is proved by such experiments as those detailed in No. \l. o{ the Appendix. The following experiment proves that air is compressible. If a glass tube, open at one end, and closed at the other, be plunged with the open end downwards, into a tumbler of water, the water will rise a little way in the tube ; which shows, that the air which iilled the tube is com- j)ressed by th-; water into a smaller space. The elasticity of air is proved by tying up a bladder, with a very small quantity of air within it, and putting it under the receiver of an air pump, when it will be seen gradually to inflate, till it becomes of its lull size. A similar eflTect would take place, by carrying the bladder to the higher regions of the atmosphere. On the compression and elasticity of the air, depends the construc- tion of that dangerous and destructive instrument, the Air- gun. That it is capable of being rarified by heat, is proved by holding to the tire a half-blown bladder, lightly tied at the neck, when it will dilate to nearly its full size ; and if either a fidl-hlown bladder, or a thin glass bubble filled with air is held to a strong fire, it will burst. The elasticity of the air is such, that Mr. Boyle, by means of an air pump, caused it to ddate till it occupied fourteen thousand times the space that it usu- ally does. — That air is necessary to sound, flame, animal and 20G THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. f vegetable life, is proved by the following experiments : — When I the receiver of an air-pump is exhaii.sted of its air, a cat, a ' mouse, or a bird, placed in it, expires in a few moments, in the greatest agonies. A bell rung in the same situation pro- duces no sound ; and a lighted candle is instantly extinguish- ed. Similar experiments prove that air is necessary for the flight of birds, the ascent of smoke and vapours, the explosion of gun-powder, and the growth of plants ; and that all bodies descend equally swift in a place void of air; a guinea and a feather being found to lall to the bottom of an exhausted re- ceiver at the san'.e instant. On the principles which this science has established, have i been constructed the air-pump, the barometer, the thermome- I ter, the diving-bell, the hygrometer, the condenser, and various other instruments, which have contributed to the comfort of human life, and to the enlargement of our knowledge of the constitution of nature. IV. Acoustics. — This science treats of the nature, the phenomena, and the laws oi' sound, and the theory of musical concord and harmony. From the experiments which have been made on this subject, we learn, that air is essential to the production of soiuid ; that it arises from vibrations in the air, communicated to it by vibrations of the sounding body ; that i these vibrations, or aerial pulses, are propagated all around ia I a spherical undulatory manner ; tliat their density decreases, 1 as the squares of the distances from the sounding body in- ' crease ; that they are propagated together in great nimibers from diflerent bodies, without distiubaiice or confusion, as is evident from concerts of nmsical mstruineiits ; that water, tim- ber, and flannel, are also good conductors of sound ; that sound travels at the rate of 1142 feet in a second, or about thirteen miles in a minute ; that the softest whisper flies as fast as the loudest thunder ; and that the utmost limits, within which the loudest sounds, produced by artiiicial means, can be heard, is 180 or 200 miles ;* that sound striking against an obstacle, as the wall of a house, may, like light, be reflected, and produce another sound, which is called an echo ; and that, after it has been reflected from several places, it may be collected into one point or focus, where it will be more audible than in any other * In the war between Ens;laml and ITollanfl, in 1672, iho. noise of the gvuis was heard in thuse j)arts uf Wales wliich \v. fV. Sect. 2. ^Several o!)ier facts in relation to souiid, are detuiled in Ciuijt. 111. Art. Acowilk Funnels. NATURAL PHILOSOPHY. 207 place. On the^e principles, whispering galleries, speaking trumpets, and otber acoustic instruments are constructed. V. Optics. — This hranch of philoso})hy treats of vision, light, and colors, and of the various phenomena of visible ob- jects produced by the rays of light, reflected from mirrors, or transmitted through lenses. From this science we learu, that light flies at the rate of nearly twelve millions of miles every minute — that it moves in straight lines — that its particles may be several thousands of miles distant from each other — that every visible body emits particles of light from its surface, in all directions — that the particles of light are cxcccdino^hj small; for a lighted candle will till a cubical space of two miles every way with its rays, before it has lost the least sensible part of its substance ; and millions of rays, from a thousand objects, will pass through a hole not larger than the point of a needle, and convey to the mind an idea of the form, position, and color of every individual object — that the intensity, or degree of light decreases, as the square of the distance from the luminous body increases ; that is, at two yards' distance from a candle, we shall have only the fourth part of the light we should have at the distance of one yard ; at three yards' distance, the ninth part ; at four yards, the sixteenth part, and so on — that glass lenses may be ground into the following forms ; plano-convtx\ plano-concave^ double convex^ double concave, and meniscus, that is, convex on one side, and concave on the other — that specula, or mirrors, may be ground into either a spherical, parabolical, or cylindrical form— that, by means of such mirrors and lenses, the rays of light may be so modified as to proceed either in a divero-ino-, convevf^ing, or parallel direction, and the images of visible objects represented in a variety of new forms, positions, and magnitudes — that every ray of white light may be separa- ted into seven primary colors: red, orange, ijellow, green, blue, indigo, and violet — that the variegated coloring which appears on the face of nature is not in the ol>jects themselves, but in the light which falls upon them — that the rainbow is produced by the refraction and reflection of the solar rays m the drops of falling rain — that the rays of light are refracted, or bent out of their course, when they fall upon glass, water, and other mediums — that the light of the sun may be collected into a point or focus, and made to produce a heat more intense than that of a furnace* — that the rays from visible objects, when * This is produced by means of lenses, ov mirrors of a lare;e diameter, called burning-glasses. By these instruments the hardest metals, on which common fires, and even glass-house furnaces could produce no eftect, have been melted in a few beconds. M. Villette, a Frenchman, nearly a ecu- 208 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER, reflected from a concave mirror, convercre to a focus, and paint an image of the objects before it, and that when they pass through a convex glass, they depict an image behind it. On these and other principles demonstrated by this science, the Camera Obscura, the Magic Lantern, the Phantasmagoria, the Kaleidoscope, the Heliostata, the Micrometer— Spectacles, Opera-Glasses, Prisms, single, compound, lucernal, and solar Microscopes, reflecting and refracting Telescopes, and other optical instruments, have been constructed, by means of which the natural powers of human vision have been wonderfully increased, and our prospects into the works of God extended far beyond what former ages could have conceived. VI. Electricity. — This name has been given to a science which explains and illustrates the operations of a very subtile fluid called the electric fluid, which appears to pervade every part of nature, and to be one of the chief agents employed in producing many of the phenomena of the material world. If a piece of amber, sealing wax, or sulphur, be rubbed with a piece of flannel, it will acquire the power of attracting small bits of paper, feathers, or other light substances. If a tube of glass, two or three feet in length, and an inch or two in diameter, be rubbed pretty hard, in a dark room, with a piece of dry woollen cloth, besides attracting light substances, it will emit flashes of fire, attended with a crackling noise. This luminous matter is called electricity, or the electric fluid. If a large globe or cylin- der of glass, be turned rapidly round, and made to rub against a cushion, streams and large sparks of bluish flame will be ehcited, which will" fly round the glass, attract light bodies, and produce a pungent sensation if the hand be held to it. This glass, with all its requisite apparatus, is called an electrical ma- chine. It is found, that this fluid will pass along some bodies, and not along others. The bodies over which it pass freely fuiy ago constntcted a mirror, three feet,, elrven inchrs in diameter, and three feet two inches in focal distance, which )nelted co;);;^/- ore in eight seconds, iron ore in twenty-lbnr seconds, a lish's tooth in thirty-two seconds, cast iron in sixteen seconds, a silver sixpence in seven seconds, and tin in three seconds. This mirror condensed the solar rays 17,257 times, a de gree of heat which is about. four. hundred andninety times greater than com mon fire. Mr. Parker, of London, constructed a lens three feet in diame ter, and six feet eight inches focus, which weighed 212 ])ounds. It melted twenty grains of gold in four seconds, and ten grains of plritina in three seconds. The power of burning glasses is, as the area of the lens directly, and the square of the focus distance inversely — or, in other words, the broader the mirror or lens, and the slu)rter the focal distance, the more intense is the hoat produci.'d by such instruments. A giobt,iiar decanter of water makes a powerful burniug-glas.s ; and house furniture lia.; been set on fire by iacaut-ioasly exp:»si;ig it to flio rays of ll»e sun. i NATURAL PHILOSOPHY. 209 are water, and most other fluids, except oil and the aerial fluids : iron, copper, lead; and, in general all the metals, semi-metals, and metallic ores ; which are^ therefore, called cotiductors of electricity. But it will not pass over glass, resin, wax, sulphur, silk, baked woods, or dry woollen substances ; nor through air, except by force, m sparks^ to short distances. These bodies are, therefore, called non-conduclors. The following facts, among others, have been ascertained respecting this wonderful agent: — That all bodies with which we are acquainted, possess a greater or less share of this fluid — that the quantity usually belonging to any body produces no sensible eflects ; but when any surface becomes possessed of more or less than its natural share, it exhibits certain appear- ances, in the form of light, sound, attraction, or repulsion, which are ascribed to the power called electric — that there are two different species of the electrical fluid, or, at least, two diflTerent modifications of the same general principle, termed Ijosiiive and negative electricity — that positive and negative electricity always accompany each other ; for if a substance acquire the one, the body with which it is rubbed acquires the the other — that it moves with amazing rapidity ; having been transmitted through wire of several miles in length, without taking up any sensible space of time ; and, therefore, it is not improbable, that were an insulated conducting substance ex- tended from one continent to another, it might be made to fly to the remotest regions of the earth in a few seconds of time — that it has a power of suddenly contracting the muscles of animals, or of giving a sJwck to the animal frame — that this shock may be communicated, at the same instant, to a hun- dred persons, or to an indefinite number who form a circle, by joining their hands together — that it may be accumulated to such a degree as to kill the largest animals — that vivid sparks of this fluid, attended with a crackling noise, may be drawn from diflerent parts of \.he human body, when the person is insulated, or stand? tipon a stool supported by glass feet — that electricity sets fire to gun-powder, spirits of wine, and other inflammable substances — that it melts iron wire, and destroys the polarity of the magnetic needle — that it augments the natural evaporati"n of fluids, promotes the vegetation of plants, and increr^ses the insensible perspiration of animals ; and can be drawn from the clouds by means of electrical kites, and other elevated conductors. By means of the electrical power, small models of machinery have been set in action ; orreries to represent the movements of the planets, have been put m motion ; and small bella have been set a-ringijig for a length IS 210 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. of time ; and, in consequence of the knowledge we have ac quired of the mode of its operation in the system of nature, tho hghtnings of heaven have been arrested in their course, an<5 constrained to descend to the eartli, without producmg any injurious effects. From these, and a variety of other facts and expenments, it is now fully ascertained, that lighbiing and eleciricitv are identical ; and that it is the prime agent in producing the awful phenomena of a thunder-storm ; the lightning being ttie rapid motion of vast masses of electric matter^ and thunder the Jiotse, with its echoes, produced by the rapid motion of the ugniamg through the atmosphere. — There can be little doubt t/ia«., in combination with steam, the gasses, and other agents* i*. also produces many of the terrific phenomena of earthquakes, yolca- noes, whirlwinds, water-spouts, and hurricanes, and the su^olime coruscations of the aurora borealis. In the operations of this powerful fluid we behold a striking display of the sovereignty and majestic agency of God. In directing its energi»».s, " his way is in the whirlwind and the storm^ and the clouas are the dust of his feet ; the heavens are covered with sackcloth, the mountains quake before him, the hills melt, the earth is burned at his presence, the rocks are thrown down by him :" Neh. i. 3 — 6. It is easy to conceive, that, by a few slight modifica- tions produced by the hand of Omnipotence, this powertul fluid might become the agent of producing either the most awful and tremendous, or the most glorious and transporting scenes, over every region of our globe. As it now operates, it is cal- culated to inspire us rather with awe and terror than with admiration and joy; and to lead our thoughts to a considera- tion of the state of man as a depraved intelligence, and a rebel against his Maker. VII. Galvanism is intimately connected with electricity, though it is generally considered as a branch of Chemistry. It is only another mode of exciting ele/ctrical action. In elec- tricity the effects are produced chiefly by mechanicat action ; but the effects of Galvanism are produced by the chemical action of bodies upon each other. If we take a piece of zinc, and place it under the tongue, and lay a piece of silver, as big as a half-crown, above it ; by bringing the outer edges of these pieces in contact, we shall immediately experience a peculiar and disagreeable taste, like that of copper. The same thing may be noticed with a guinea and a piece of charcoal. If a person, in the dark, put a slip of tinfoil upon one of his eye^^ and a piece of silver in his mouth, by causing these pieces to communicate, a. faint flash will ap[)ear before his eyes, if a NATURAL PHILOSOPHY. 211 living frog or a fish, having a slip of tinfoil pasted upon its back, be placed upon a pi«ce of zinc, by forming a communi- cation between, the ziac and tinfoil, the spasms of the muscles are excited. These and similar effects are produced by that modification of electricity which has been termed Galvanism. Three different conductors, or what is called a galvanic circle, are requisite to produce such effects. A piece of copper, a piece of flannel, moistened with water or acid, and a piece of zinc, laid upon one another, form a circle ; and if this circle be repeated a number of times, a galvanic pile or battery may be formed capable of giving a powerful shock. The most common and convenient form, however, of a battery, is found to be a trough of baked wood, three or four inches deep and as many wide. In the sides are grooves, opposite to each other, into each of which is placed a double metallic plate, of zinc and copper soldered together, and the cells are then filled either with salt and water^ or with a salution of nitrous acid and water. By means of the galvanic agency, a variety of surprising effects have been, produced. Gunpowder, cotton, and other inflammable sLrbstances, have been inflamed — charcoal has been made to bu^r'n,. with a most brilliant and beautiful white flame — water has been, decomposed into its elementary parts — metals have been melted^ and set on fire — fragments of diamond, charcoal, and plumbago, have been dispersed, as if they had been evaporated — platina, the hardest and heaviest of the metals, has been melted as readily as wax in the flame of a candle — the sapphire, quartz, magnesia, lime, and the firmest compounds in nature, have been made to enter into fusion. — Its effects on the animal system are no less surprising. When applied ta a. fowl oj; a rabbit, immediately after life is extinct, it produces the most straaige and, violent convulsions on the nervous ajid muscular system, as if the vital functions were again, revived ; and when applied to the human body after death,, th.e stimujus h^as pi-oduced the most horrible contortion? and. grimace;?, in the muscles of the head and face ; and the mos:^ rapid movements in the hands and feet. The galvanic agency enables us to account for the follow- ing among other facts : — Why porter has a difi'erent and more pleasant taste,, when drunk out of a pewter vessel, than out of glass or earthen ware,. — why a silver spoon is discolored when used in eating eggs,; — why the limbs of people, under amputa- tion, are sometimes convulsed by the application of the instru- ments, — why pure mercury is oxydized when amalgamated with tin, — why works of metal, which are soldered together, 212 THE CHPaSTIAN PHILOSOPHER. soon tarnish in the places where the metals are joined, — and why the copper sheathing of ships, when fastened with iron nails, are soon corroded about the place of contact. In all these cases a galvanic circle is formed, which produces the effects. We have reason to believe, that, in combination with the discoveries which modern chemistry is daily unfolding, the agencies of this fluid will enable us to carry the arts forward towards perfection, and to trace the secret causes of some of the sublimest phenomena of nature. VIII. Magnetism. — This department of philosophy de- scribes the phenomena, and the properties of the loadstone, or natural magnet. The natural magnet is a hard dark-colored mineral body, and is usually found in iron mines. The follow- ing are some of its characteristic properties : — 1. It attracts iron and steel, and all substances which contain iron in its metallic state. 2. If a magnet be suspended by a thread, or nicely poised on a pivot, or placed on a piece of wood, and set to float in a basin of water, one end will constantly point nearly towards the north p.i>}e o£ tt^ eartht and the other towards the south ; and, hence, these parts of the magnet have been called the north and south poles. 3. When the north pole of one magnet is presented near to the south pole of another, they will attract each other ; but if the north pole of one be presented to the north pole of another, or a south pole to a south, they will repel each other. 4. A magnet placed in such a manner as to be entirely at liberty, inclines one of its poles to the horizon, and of course elevates the other above it. This property is called the dipping of the magnet. 5. Mag- nets do not point directly north and south ; but in diflTerent parts of the world with a different declinatio)i eastward or west- ward of the north ; it is also dilferent at the same place at different times. In London^ and in most places of Great Britain, the magnetic needle, at present, paints about 24 degrees to the west of the north. For more thiui, 160 years it has been gradually declining from the north to the west ; bu^ seems of late to have begun its declination to the eaiitward^ 6. Any magnet may be made to communicate the properties now mentioned, to any piece of iron or steel. For example^ by gently rubbing a penknife with a magnet, it will be immedi- ately invested with the property of attracting needles, or small pieces of iron or steel. 7. Heat weakens the power of a magnet, and the gradual additioA of weight increases the mag- qetic power. 8. The proi>erties of the magnet are not affected either by the presence or the absence of air ; and the magnetic attraction is not in the least diminished by the interposition of NATURAL PIIlLOSOPlrV. ^13 any bodies except iron. A magnet will equaliy affect the needle of a: pocket compass, when a thick board is placed between them as when it is removed". — It has been lately dis- covered, that the violet rays of ' the solar spectrum, when con- densed with a convex glass, and made to pass along a piece of steel,, have the power of communicating to it the magnetic virtue. The cause which produces these singular properties of the magnet, has hitherto remained a mystery ; but the knowledge of the polarity of the magnet has been applied to a most im- portant practical purpose. By means of it, man has now acquired the dominion of the ocean, and has learned to trace his course through the pathless deep to every region of the globe. There can be little doubt that magnetism has an inti- mate connexion with electricity, galvanism, light, heat, and chemical action ; and the discoveries which have been lately made, and the experiments which are now making by Mori- chini, Oersted, Abraham, Hansteen, Barlow, Beaufoy, and Scoresby, promise to throw some light on this mysterious agent, and on the phenomena of nature with which it is con- nected. Such is a faint outline of some of the interesting subjects which Natural Philosophy embraces. Its relation to Religion vill appear from the following considerations : — 1. Its researches have led to the invention of machines, •engines, and instruments of various kinds, which augment the energies, increase the comforts, and promote the general improvement of mankind ; and these objects are inseparably connected with the propagation of Christianity through the world. If we admit, that, in future ages, the religion of the Bible will shed its benign influence over all nations — that the external condition of the human race ^^^Ji^then be prosperous and greatly meliorated beyond what it has ever been — and, that no miraculous interposition of Deity is to be expected to bring about such desirable events — it will follow, that such objects can be accomplished only in the ordinary course of Providence, by rational investigations into the principles and powers of Nature, and the application of the inventions of science to the great objects of religion, and of human improve- ment, as I shall endeavour briefly to illustrate in the following chapter. As the destructive eflects of many physical agents, in the present constitution of our globe, are, doubtless, a con- sequence of the sin and depravity of man ; we have reason to believe that, when the economy of nature shall be more extensively and minutely investigated, and the minds of men 18* 214 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER, directed to apply their discoveries to philanthtopic and religious objects, they will be enabled to counteract, in a great measure, those devastations and fatal effects which are now produced by several of the powers of nature. The general happiness of all ranks, which will be connected with the universal exten- sion of Christianity, necessarily supposes, that this object will be accomplished ; for, were a dread of destruction from the elements of nature frequently to agitate the mind, as at present, no permanent tranquillity would be enjoyed ; nor would that ancient prediction, in reference to this era, receive its full accomplishment, that "there shall be nothing to hurt or destroy m all God's holy mountain, when the earth shall be full of the knowledge of the Lord." And since miraculous interpositions are not to be expected, to what quarter can we look ibr those subordinate agencies by which this object is to be effected, but to the discoveries and inventions of philosophical science t Science has already enabled us to remedy many of those evils which are the accidental effects of the operation of physi- cal agents. For example — the discoveries of the philosopher, with respect to the nature of the electric fluid, have enabled us to construct conductors for preserving buildings from the stroke onightnino- ; and we have every reason to hope, that, in the progress of electric, galvanic, and chemical science, more complete thunder guards, apphcable to all the situations in which a person may be exposed, will be invented. Nay, our increasing knowledge of the electric fluid, and of the che- mical agents which concur in its operation, may enable us to dissipate thunder-storms altogether, by disturbing the electri- city of the clouds by means of a scries of elevated artificial conductors. This is not only possible, but has already been in some degree efiected. The celebrated Euler imforms us, in his " Letters to a German Princess," that he corresponded with a Moravian priest, named Divisch, who assured him, " that he had averted, during a whole summer, every thunder- storm which threatened his own habitation, and the neighbour- hood, by means of a machine constructed on the principles of electricity — that the machinery sensibly attracted the clouds, and constrained them to descend quietly in a distillation, with- out any but a very distant thunder clap." Euler assures us that " the fact is undoubted, and confirmed by irresistable proof." Yea, not only may the destructive effects of lightning be averted by the inventions of philosophy, but its agency may be rendered subservient to human industry, and made to act as a mechanical power. This effect, too, has been partially accompHshcd. About the year 1811, in the village of Philips NATURAL PHILOSOPHY. 215 thai, in Eastern Prussia, an attempt was made to split an im- mense stone into a multitude of pieces, by means of lightning. A bar of iron,, in the form of a conductor, was previously fixed to the stone, and the experiment was attended with the most complete success ; for,, during the very first thundor-storm, the lightning burst the stone without displacing it.* It is, therefore, probable, that in the future ages of the world, this terrific meteor, and other destructive agents, which now Ijroduce so much alarm, and so many disastrous effects, may, by the aid of philosophy, be brought under the control of man,, and be made to minister to his enjoyment. The electric fluid has also been, in many instances, suceess-. fully applied in curing palsies, rheumatisms, spasms, obstruc- tions, and inflammation; and it is known to have a peculiar effect on the nervous system. Lightning has been known to. restore the blind to a temporary enjoyment of sight. Mr. Campbell of Succoth, in Dumbartonshire, who had been blind for seve- ral years, was led by his servant one evening through the streets of Glasgow, during a terrible thunder-storm. The lightning sometimes fluttered along the streets for a quarter of a minute without ceasing. While this fluttering lasted, Mr. C saw the street distinctly, and the changes which had been made in that part by taking down one of the city gates. When the storm was over, his entire blindness returned. — A still more remarkable instance is stated, along with this, under the article Thunder, in Dr. Gleig's Siipp. to Ency. Brit, which was written by the late Professor Robinson. It is also possible that barren deserts might be enriched with fertility, and im- mense portions of the desolate wastes of our globe prepared for the support and accommodation of human beings, by ar- resting the clouds, and drawing down their electrical virtue and their watery treasures by means of an extended series of ele- vated metallic conductors. What has been now stated is only one instance, out of many, which might be adduced, of the extensive and beneficial efl^ects which may be produced, in future ages, by the application of the discoveries of natural iicience. 2. A knowledge of Natural Philosophy enables us to detect pretended miracles, and to discriminate between those pheno- mena which are produced by the powers of nature, and the supposed effects of diabolical influence. It has been chi liy owing to ignorance of the principles of natural science, that mankind, in all ages, have been so easily imposed upon by pre- + See Monlhly IMagazIue, vol. 32, p. 162. THE CHRTSTIAN PHILOSOPHER. tenders to supernatiird powers. It is owing to the same cause, that, superstitious notions and vain alarms have spread their influence so extensively among the lower ranks of the population of every country. The pretended miracles by which Pagan and' Popish Priests endeavour to support the authority of their respective religious systems, and every species of degrading superstition, vanish into smoke, when examined by the light of modern science ; and there can be no question that an enlightened Missionary would, in many in* stances, find the principles and the instruments of natural philosophy important auxiliaries in undermining the fabric of heathen idolatry and priestcraft. They tend to dissipate a thousand idle terrors which haunt and agitate the human mind ; to detect a thousand kinds of imposture by which it has been held in cruel bondage ; and to prevent the perpetration x)f those deeds of cruelty which h^-ve uniformly marked the reign of Su- perstition.* Had our forefathers connected a knowledge of this subject with their study of the Scriptures, they would not have brought upon themselves that indelible disgrace which now attaches to their memories,, on account of their having condemned and burned at the stake hundreds of unhappy wo- men, accused of crimes of which they could not possibly have been guilty. In New-England, towards the close of the 17th century, the witchcraft phrensy rose so high, that the execu- tion of witches became a calamity more dreadful than the sword or the pestilence. Not only old women, but children of ten years were put to death ; young girls were stripped naked, and the marks of witchcraft searched for upon their bodies with the most indecent curiosity ; and those spots of the scurvy which age impresses upon the bodies of old men, were taken for evident signs of infernal power. So that ignorance of the laws and phenomena of nature has led even Christians * Mr. Douglas, in his " Hints on Missions," formerly referred to, "vvhen speaking of the facilities Avhich Christians now possess for extensive mis- sionary exertions, suggests, that Natural Philosophy might be an import- ant auxiliary to Christian Missionaries. " AW the ancient ' war weapons of victory,' excepting miracles, are at their disposal ; and new instruments of still greater potency, which the science of the latter days has been accu- mulating for a universal revolution of the mind, are ready to be brought into action, upon a scale of overpowering magnitude. Even the single re- source which is lost may yet be recompensed by equivalents, and a substi- tute, in many respects, may be found for miracles. The first effect of a miracle is, to rouse the attention, and to overawe opposing prejudices ; the second to afford a proof of the religion of which it is a sealing accom- ])animent. The first object mii!;fil be gained by the natural magic of ejcpeH- menlal Philosophy : and as to tiie second, the difference in the proof from miracles, lies rather in its being more circuitous, than in its being less con- chisivc at the present day, than in the times of tiic Apostles." NATURAL PHILOSOPHY. - 217 to commit acts of injustice and horrid cruelty. For, let it be remembered, that it was Christian magistrates and ministers, mider a pretended zeal lor the honor of God, who sanctioned such cruel and unrighteous decrees. This consideration, viewed in connection with many others, tends to show, that the Christian revelation, considered abstractly by itself, with- out a reference to the visible system of the universe, is not sufficient for all the purposes for which it was intended ; as, on the other hand, the study of the works of nature is not suffi- cient of itself to lead the mind to the true knowledge of God, without the aid of the discoveries derived from the sacred ora- cles. For, although the Bible has been in the hands of Pro- testant Christians ever since the reformation, yet it is only since the light of modern science began to ditiuse its influence, that the superstitions of the dark ages, and the vulgar notions respecting witchcraft, necromancy, and other species of infer- nal agency, began to vanish, even from the minds of Christian teachers ; as is evident from the writing of many eminent divines who flourished during the 16th and 17th centuries. As the two revelations which God has given us throw a mutual lustre on each other ; the one must always be considered as incomplete without the other. Both are necessary in ordei " to made the man of God perfect," and to enable him to pro* secute, with intelligence and success, the great objects of re- ligion ; and the Christian minister who affects to despise the aids of science in the cause of religion, has yet much to learu with respect to some of the grand bearings of the Christian system. 3. The investigations of natural philosophy unfold to us the incessant a^encij of God, and the plans by which his wise and benevolent designs in the system of nature are accomplished. From the immeasurable globes of heaven, down to the mi- nutest atoms, we perceive a regular chain of causes and ef- fects, conspiring, in a thousand different modes, to accomplish the purposes of infinite wisdom and goodness. The operation of central forces, and of the law of gravitation on the earth and in the heavens — the hydrostatical laws which regulate the pressure and the motion of fluids — the chemical properties of the atmosphere, its undulatory, refractive, and reflective pow- ers — the motion of the rays of hght, and the infinite variety of effects they produce — the process of evaporation — the agen- cies of electricity and galvanism — the properties of the mag- net, and the chemical action of acids and alkalies, and of the minutest particles of matter upon each other — ought to Le viewed as so many modifications of the agency of Deity, and 2i8 THE CHUISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. as manifestations of his Wisdom, in carrying forward those plans which regard the interests of his universal kingdom ; just as we consider the rise and fall of empires, the revolutions of nations, atid the circulation of the Scriptures in heathen lands, as so many acts of his moral administration as the Governor of mankind. For let it be carefully remembered, that all these physical agencies have ultimately a moral and intellectual bearing ; and are essentially conn-eeted with every other part of God's providential procedure. Though we may be apt to consider them as so many detached and insulated pieces of machinery, with which we have little concern, or tnay even disdain ta notice their mode of operation ; yet, in the AH-comprehensive mind of Him who takes in, at one glance, the whole chain of causes and- effects,, they are as essentially connected with his ultimate pin-poses,, and the eternal destiny of man, as are the revelations of his word. — Were a single principle or motion whjich now animates the system of nature to cease — were the agencies of electricity, for example, or the principle of evap'oration to be destroyed — the physical consti- tution of our globe would instantly be deranged ; nature would be thrown into confusion ; a^id the sentient and intellectual beings that now inhabit th,e earth would either be destroyed, oi plunged into an abyss of misery. If, therefore, we admit that the moral agency of' God is worthy of ou?" contemplation, we ought to consider his physical operation^ ajso as no less worthy of our study and investigation ; since* they form the ground- work of all his other manifestations. There is nothing, ho\yever, which so strikingly characterizes the bulk of mankind, and even the great mass of the Christian world, as that apathy and indifterence with which they view the wonders of creation which surround them. They can look on all that is grand', and beautiful,, and beneficent in na- ture, without feeling the least sentiment of admiration,, or of gratitude to that Being who is incessantly operating within them and aroundthem ; and they are disposed to consider the experiments of phibsophers, by which the wonderful agency of God is unveiled, as only so many toys and amusements for the entertainment of children. They would prefer the paltry entertainments of a card-table, of a ball-room, or of a gossiping party, to the inspection of the nicest pieces of Divine mechan- ism, and to the contemplation of the most august scene in na- ture. However lightly some religionists may be disposed to treat this subject, that spirit of indiflerence with which the visible works of God are treated, must be considered as flow- ing from the same depraved jyvinciple, which leads multitudes. f CHEMISTRV. 2lD to reject the revelations of the Bible, and to trifle with their everlasting interests. " Man," says Rollin, " lives in the midst of a world of which he is the sovereign, as a stranger, who looks with indifference upon all that passes in it, and as if it was not his concern. The universe, in all its parts, declares and points out its Author ; but, for the most part, to the deaf md blind, who have neither ears to hear, nor eyes to see. One of the greatest services that philosophy can do us, is to awaken us from this drowsiness, and rouse us from this le- thargy, which is a dishonor to humanity, and in a manner reduces us below the beasts, whose stupidity is the conse- quence of their nature, Jind not the effect of neglect or indif- ference. It awakens our curiosity, it excites our attention, and leads us as it were by the hand, tlirongh all the parts of nature, to induce us to study and search tft the wonderful works of it." — Belles Letires<, vol. 4-. Since, therefore, the science of natural philosophy is con- versant about the works of the Almighty, and its investigations have a direct tendency to filustratc the perfections of his nature, to unveil the plan of his operations, to unfold the laws by which he governs die kingdom of universal nature, and to display the order, symmetry, and proportion, ^^hich reign throughout the wliole — it would be needless to enter into any further process of reasoning, to show that the study of it is connected with the great objects of religion. Whatever studies tend to raise our minds to the Supreme Ruler of all worlds — to expand our views of his infinite knowledge and wisdom, to excite our gratitude and our admiration of the beneficent designs which appear in all his arrangements — to guard us against erroneous conceptions of his providential procedure — and to furnish us with important auxiliaries for extending the influence of his relioion through the world — must always be interesting to every Christian who wishes to enlarge his intellectual views, and to make progress in the knowledge of God. CHEMISTtlY. This science, which is intimately related to the preceding, has for its object to ascertain the ingredients, or first princi- ples, of which all matter is composed — to examine the com- pounds formed by the combination of these ingredients — to investigate those changes in natural bodies, which are not ac- companied with sensible motion, and the nature of the povrer which produces these combinations and changes. Within the limits of the last half rcislury, the empire of 220 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. Chemistry has been wonderfully extended. From an obscure and humble place among the objects of study, it has risen to a high and dignified station among those sciences which improve and adorn the human mind. No longer confined to the paltry and mercenary object of searching for the philosopher's stone, or of furnishing a little amusement, it now extends its sway over all the arts which minister to the comfort and improve- ment of social life, and over every species of animate and inanimate matter, within the range of human investigation. " The forms and appearancesj" (says Sir Humphry Davy,) " of the beings and substances of the external world, are almost infinitely various, and they are in a state of continued alteration. Even the earth itself, throughout its whole sur- face, undergoes modifications. Acted on by moisture and air, it affords the food of plants ; an immense number of vege- table productions arise from apparently the same materials ; these become the substance of animals ; one species of ani- mal matter is converted into another ; the most perfect and beautiful of the forms of organized life ultimately decay, and are resolved into inorganic aggregpaes ; and the same elemen- tary substances, difierently arranged, are contained in the inert soil ; or bloom, and emit fragrance in the flower ; or become, in animals, the active organs of mind and intelligence. In i artificial operations, changes of the same order occur : sub- | stances having the characters of earth, are converted into metals ; clays and sands are united, so as to become porce- lain ; earths and alkalies are combined into glass ; acrid and corrosive matters are formed fi-om tasteless substances ; colors are fixed upon stufis ; or changed, or made to disap-j pear ; and the productions of the vegetable, mineral, and ani-l mai kingdoms, ire converted into new forms, and made sub-: servient to the purposes of civilized life.— To trace, in detail, these diversified and complicated phenomena ; to arrange them, and deduce general laws from their analogies, is the business of chemistry." — ElerAcnts of Chemical Philosophy. Chemists have arranged the geiieral forms of mailer into, the four following classes. 'Yhe first class consists of Solids,! v»hich form the princij>ai parts of the globe, and which differ !| from each other in hardness, color, opacity, transparency, density, and other properties. The second class consists of Fluids, such as Vvater, oils„ spirits, &c., whose parts possess freedom of motion, and require great mechanical force to make them occiipy a smaller space. The third class com- prehends Elastic Fluids^ or G ahes, w^hich exist freely in the Htinos'pherc ; but mav be cuntl.u-d by solids iuA finiJ'-:, R.nc L CHEMISTRY. 2-21 their properties examined. Their parts are highly moveabio compressible, and expansive ; they are all transparent ; they present two or three varieties of color ; and they difftrr greatly in density. The fourth class comprehends Ethereal Huv.- STANCEs, which are known to us only in their states oC motion, when acting upon our organs of sense, and which are not sus- ceptible of being confined. Such are the rays of Highly and radiant heat^ which are incessantly in motion, throughout tho spaces that intervene between our globe, and the sun and the stars. — Chemists divide the substances in nature also into Simple and Compound. Simple Substances nre those which have never yet been decomposed, nor formed by art. Compound Substances are those which are formed by the union of two or more simple substances. The follov.iiig arc all the simple substances, with which we are at present ac- quainted : Caloric, Light, Oxygen, Nitrogen, Carbon, Hydrogen, Sulphur, Phosphorus, the Metals, and some of the Earths. — All that I propose, under this article, is, simply to state some of the properties of two or three of these simple substances. Caloric, or elementar}' fire, is the name now given by chemists to that element or property, which, combined witli various bodies, produces the sensation of heat, while it is pass- ing from one body to another. This substance appears to pervade the whole system of nature. There are six different sources, from whence Caloric may be procured. It nmy be produced by comhnslion, in which process the oxygen ^\s of the atmosphere is decomposed, and caloric, one of its com- ponent parts, set at liberty — hy friction, or the rubbing of two substances against each other — hy percussion, as the striking of steel against a piece of flint — by the mixture of two or more substances ; as when sulphuric acid is poured upon water or magnesia — by electricity and oalvanism. The discharge of an electric or galvanic battery, will produce a more intense degree of heat than any other means whatever. But the prin- cipal, and probably the original source of caloric, is the Sun, which furnishes the earth with a regular supply for the support and nourishment of the animal and vegetable tribes. From this source it moves at the rate of 195,000 miles in a second of time ; for it has been already stated, that the sun sends forth rays of heat, which are distinct from those whicl produce illumination, and which accompany them in their course through the ethereal regions. Caloric is the x-aiise oi' Jluidity, in all substances which aro capuhle of bcconiirig f|uid. A crrtain portion* or close of it, 222 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. reduces a solid body to the state of an incompressible fluio ; a larofer portion brings it to the state of an aeriform or gaseous fluid. Thus, a certain portion of caloric reduces ice to a state ol water ; a larger portion converts it into steam or vapor. There is reason to believe, that the hardest rocks, the densest metals, and every solid substance on the face of the earth, might be converted into a fluid, and even into a gas, were they submitted to the action of a very high temperature. This substance is called sensible caloric, when it produces the sen- sation of heat ; and latent caloric, when it forms an insensible fiart of the substance of bodies. — All bodies are, in a greater or less degree, conductors of caloric. Metals and hquids are good conductors of heat, but silk, cotton, wool, wood, &c. are bad conductors of it. For example, if we put a short poker mroof does this afford, of the infinite comprehension of the X>ivine rniud, in foreseeing all the consequences of the elements of nature, and in directing their numerous combinations in such a iuanner as to promote the happiness of animated beings ! Nitrogen, or azote, is a substance generally diffused throughout nature, and particularly in animated bodies. It is not to be found in a solid or liquid state, but, combined with caloric, it form^ nitrogen gas, which is one of the ingredients of the atmo^^phere. It is incapable of supporting either flame or animal life. Tliis is proved by introducing an animal, or a burning candle, into a vessel full of this gas : in which case, the animal is suddenly suffocated, and the candle instantly ex- tinguished. It is this gas which is expelled from the lungs at every respiration, and, rising over our heads, )--oon enters into new combinations. Though it is destructive to animal life, it appeais to be favorable to plants, which vegetate freely when surrounded with nitrogen. Hydrogen is another elementary substance, abundant in nature, and, when united to caloric, forms Hydrogen Gas. It is one of the constituent parts of umter ; for it has been com- pletely demonstrated by experiment, that water is composed of 85 parts by weight of oxygen, and 15 of hydrogen, in every hundred parts of the fluid. This gas was formerly knov\ n by the name o^ injlammahle air. It is distinguished among miners, by the name o^ fire-damp ; it abounds in coal-mines, and some- times produces the most tremendous explosions. It is inca- pable, by itself, of supporting combustion, and cannot be breathed without the most imminent danger. It is the chief constituent of oils, fats, spirits, ether, coals, and bitumen ; and is supposed to be one of the agents which produce the ignes fatui and the norihcni lights. It is the lightest of all ponderable bodies ; being from twelve to fifteen times lighter than com- raoii air. A hundred cubic inches of it weigh about 2| o-rains. On account of it ; great levity it is used for filling air-ballcons. In contact with atmospheric air, it burns with a pale blue color. Vf hen mixed with oxygen gas, it may be exploded like gun- powder, with a violent report. Carhuretted hiidrogen gas, which is carport dissolved in hydrogen, is that beautiful gas, which is now ejjuploycd in lighting t>ur streets, shops, and manufactories* Carbon is another simple substance extensively diffused throughout nature. It is found pure and solid only in the dia- -nond ; but it may be procured in the state of charcoal, by CHEMISTRY. 225 biiruing a piece of wood closely covered with sand, in a cruci- ble. Carbon enters into the composition of bitumen and pit coal, and of most animal, and some mineral substances ; and it forms nearly the whole of the solid basis of all vegetables, from the most delicate flower to the stately oak. It is also a component part of sugar, and of all kinds of wax, oils, gums, and resins. It combines with iron in various proportions, and the results are, cast iron and steel. Black lead is a composi- tion of nine parts of carbon to one of iron ; and is, therefore, called a carburet of iron. Carbon is indestructible by age, preserves its identity in all the combin.ations into which it en- ters. — Carbonic acid s^as is a combination of carbon and oxygen. It is found in a state of combination with lime, forming limestone, marble, and chalk ; and may be separated from them by heat, or by means of the mineral acids. This gas, which was formerly called ^xe^i air, is found in mines, caves, the bottoms of wells, wine cellars, brewers' vats, and in the neighborhood of lime-kilns. It is known to miners by the name of the choke-damp, and too frequently runs on deadly errands. It extinguishes flame and animal life. It is the heaviest of all the gases ; being nearly twice the weight of common air, and twenty times the weight of hydrogen. It may, therefore, be poured from one vessel to another ; and if a small quantity of it be poured upon a hghted taper, it will be instantly extinguished. It is a powerful antiseptic, or pre- server from putrefaction. Meat which has been sealed up in it (says Mr. Parkes) has been known to have preserved its texture and appearance for more than 20 years. There is no substance of more importance in civilized life than the difter- ent forms of Carbon. " In nature," says Sir H. Davy, " this element is constantly active in an important series of opera- tions. It is evolved in fermentation and conibiistion, in car- bonic acid ; it is separated from oxygen hi the organs of plants; it is a principal element in animal structures ; and is foiuid m different forms in almost all the products of organized beings." Sulphur is a substance which has been known from the earliest ages. It was used by the ancients in medicine, and its fumes have, for more than 2000 years, been employed in bleaching wool. It is found combined with many mineral substances, as arsenic, antimony, copper, and most of the metallic ores. It exists in many mineral waters, and in com- bination with vegetable and animal matters, but is most abun- dant in volcanic countries, particularly in the neighborhood of Vesuvius, Etna, and Hecla, in Iceland. It is a solid, opaque, combustible substance, of a pale yellow color, veiy brittle, and 19* 22G THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. aliiiost without taste or sme^. Iv? spc;sti% gravity is nearly twice that of water ; it ii^ a, noji-coitd\ic»oT c^ electricity, and, o£ course, becomes electric l^y friction. When heated to the temperature of 170" of r'alirenheit's thermometer, it rises up in th& form of a fine powder,, vvhich^ is easily collected in a proper vessel and is namexi^ ^^^.e. Jloicers of sulphur. It is insoluble in water, but may be dissolved in oils, in spirit of wine, and in hydrogen gas. When sulphur is heated to the temperature of 302" in thp open air, it takes fire spontaneously, and burns with a paje-I^jlue flame, and emits a grtiat quantity of fumes of a strong suiTociithT^ o.^Pl^l' W^hen heated to the temperatiu'e of 570°, it burns wifh a bright white flame, ajid emits a vast quantity of fumes. When these fumes are col- lected, they are found to consist entu-ely of sulphuric acid ; so that sulphur, by combustion, is convf^rfed into an acid. It is fhe base of several compound substances. It unites with oxygen, hydrogen, nitrogen, phosphorus, the alkalies, \he metals, and some of the earths. This substance is of great iiuportance in medicine, as it is found to penetrate to the ex- tremities of the most minute vessels, and to impregnate all the secretions. It is also used in the arts, pai'licularly in bleach- ing and dying ; it forms a very large proportion of gun-pow- der ; and one of its most common, but not least useful proper- ties, is that of its conihustihilitij, by which, with the help of a tinder-box, light is almost instantaneously produced. As this substance has not yet been decomposed, it is considered by chemists, in the mean time, as one of the simple substances. PiiospHOKUs is another siniple combustible substance, but is never found in a pure state in nature. It is commonly united to oxygen iii a, state, of ph()sphoric acid, which is found in different animal, vegetable, and mineral substances. It was first discovered by Brandt, a chemist of IIam]>urgh, in the year 1667, and afterwards by the Honorable Mr. Boyle, in 1G79. It was formei-ly obtained by a disgusting process ; but it is now extracted frcm the hones of animals, by burning them, and then reducing them to a fine powder, and afterwards pour- ing sulphuric acid upjon them. This substance, when pure, resembles bees' wax, being of a clear, transparent, yellowish color ; it is insoluble in water ; it may be cut v.ith a knife, oi twisted to pieces with the fingers ; and it is about double tlie specific gravity of water. Its most remarkable property is its very strong attraction for oxygen, from which circumstance, it barns spontaneously in the open air at the temperature of 43" ; that is, it, attracts the oxygen gas from the atmosphere, aiiJ heat and flame are produced. It gradually consumes CHEMISTRY* 227 when exposed to the common tempcratuife of air, emits a whitish smoke, and is luminous in the dark ; for this reason it is kept in phials of water ; afid as the heat of the hand is suf- ficient to inflame it^ it shcJdld seldom be handled except under water. At the temperature of 99" it melts ; it evaporates at 219", and boils at 554''. When heated to 148° it takes fire, and burns with a very bright flame, and gives out a very largo quantity of white snioke^ which is luminous in the dark ; at the same time it emits an odor, which has some resemblance to that of garlic ; and this smoke, when collected, is proved to be an acid. It burns with, the greatest splendor in oxygen gas, and when taken internally, it is found to be poisonous. If any light substance, capable of conducting heat, be placed upon the surface of boiling water, and a bit of phosphorus be laid upon it, the heat of the water will be suflicient to set the phos- phorus on fire. If we write a few words on paper with a bit of phosphorus fixed in a quill, when the writing is carried into a dark room it will appear beautifully luminous. If a piece of phosphorus, about the size of a pea, be dropped into a tumbler of hot water, and a stream of oxygen gas forced directly upon it, it will display the most brilliant combustion under water that can be imagined. All experiments with phosphorus, however, require to be performed with great cauiion. This substance is used in makhig phosphoric match-bottles, phos- phoric oil, phosphoric tapers, and various phosphoric fire- works. Fhosphorized hydrogen gas is produced by bits of phophorus remaining some hours in hydrogen gas. It is sup- posed to be this gas which is often seen hovering on the sur- face of burial grounds and marshes, known in Scotland by the name oi" spimJ.ie, and in England by that of will-o-the-wlsp. Some animals, as the glow-worm and the fire-fly, and fish in a, putrescent state, exiiibit phosphorescent qualities. M. Peron describes a singular instance of this kind in an animal which le calls the pyrosoma cUlanticum^ which he observed in his i^oyage from Europe to the Isle of France. The darkness ivas intense when it was first discovered ; and all at once, ihere appeared at some distance, as it were a vast sheet of phosphorus floating on the waves, which occupied a great space before the vessel. When the vessel had passed through his inflamed part of the sea, it was found, that this prodigious ight was occasioned by an immense number of small animals, »vhich swam at different depths, and appeared to assume vari- >us forms. Those which were deepest looked like great red lot cannon balls, while those on the surftiCi resembled cylin- ^^— o^ rr"l hot iron. Some of them were ciught, and were 228 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. found to vary in size from 3 to 7 inclies. All the exterior surface of the animal was bristled with thick long tubercles, shining like so many diamonds ; and these seemed to be the principal seat of its wonderful phosphorescence. Such is a brief description of the principal elementary sub- stances, which, in a thousand diversified forms, pervade the system of nature, and produce all that variety which we behold in the atmosphere, the waters, the earth, and the various pro- cesses of the arts. It is probable that some of these sub- stances are compounds, though they have not yet been decomposed. Yea, it is possible, and not at all improbable, that there are but two, or at most three elementary sub- stances in nature, the various modifications of which produce all the beauties and sublimities in the universe. Perhaps caloric, oxygen, and hydrogen, may ultimately be found to constitute all the elementary principles of nature. — Without prosecuting this subject farther, I shall conclude this article with a few cursory reflections, tending to illustrate its con- nexion with religion. The remarks which I have already thrown out in reference to Natural Philosophy, will equally apply to the science of Chemistry ; and, therefore, do not require to be repeated. In addition to these, the following observations may be stated : — 1. This science displays, in a striking point of view, the M'lsdom and goodness of God, in producing; y by the most simple meanSy the most astonishing and henevohnt effects. All the varied phenomena we perceive, throughout the whole system of sublunary nature, are produced by a combination of six or seven simple substances. I formerly adverted to the infinite variety Mhich exists in the vegetable kingdom, (see pp. 78 — 79.) About fifty-six thousand different species of plants have already been discovered by botanists. All those, from the humble shrub to the cedar of Lebanon, A\hich adorn the sur- face of the globe, in every clime, with such a diversity of forms, shades, and colors, are the result of the combinations of " four or five natural substances — caloric, light, water, air, and carbon." " When we consider," says Mr. Parkcs, " that the many thousand tribes of vegetables are not only all foimed from a tew simple substances, but that they all enjoy the same sun, vegetate in the same medium, and are supplied with the same nutriment, we cannot but be struck with the rich econo- my of Nature, and are almost induced to doubt the evidence of those senses with which the God of nature has furnished us. That it should be possible so to modify and intermingle a few simple substances, and t]>ence produce all the variet} of form. CHEMISTRY. 229 color, odor, &c. which are observable in the different families of vegetables, is a phenomenon too astonishing for our com- prehension. Nothing short of Omnipotence could have provided such a paradise for man." — Chemical Catechism, chap. 9. " Soft roll your incense, herbs, and fruits, and flowers, In mingled clouds to Him, whose sun exalts. Whose breath perfumes you, and whose 2:)encil paints." Thomson. What an admirable view is here opened up of the economy of Divine wisdom, and of the beneficent care which has been taken to secure the comfort and happiness of every living creature : and how ungrateful a disposition must it indicate in rational beings to overlook such benevolent arrangements ! It is highly probable, that in all other worlds disposed through- out the universe, an infinite diversity of scenery exists, and that no one globe or system exactly resembles another ; and yet, it is probable, that the primary elements of matter, or the few simple snbsfances of which our world is composed, may be of the same nature as those which form the constituent parts of every other system ; and may give birth to all the variety which exists throughout the wide extent of creation, and to all the changes and revolutions through which the different systems may pass, during every period of infinite duration. 2. From this science we have every reason to conclude, that matter is indestructible. In the various changes that take place in material substances, the particles of matter are not destroyed, but only assume new forms, and enter into new combinations. When a piece of wood, for example, is burned to ashes, none of its principles are destroyed ; the elementary substances of which it was composed, are only separated from one another, and formed into new compounds. Carbon, as already stated, appears to be indestructible by age, and to pre- serve its essential properties, in every mode of its existence. That Being, indeed, who created matter at first, may reduce it to nothing when he pleases ; but it is highly improbable that his power will ever be interposed to produce this effect ; or that any particle of matter which now exists, will ever be annihi- lated, into whatever new or varied combinations it may enter. When any particular world, or assemblage of material exist- ence, has remained in its original state for a certain period of duration, and accomplished all the ends it was intended to subserve, in that state, the materials of which it is composed, will, in all probability, be employed lor erecting a new system, and establishing a new series of events, in which new scenes, 230 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. and new beauties and sublimities will arise from new and vari- ed combinations. For the Creator does nothing in vain. But to annihilate, and again to create, would be operating in vain ; and we uniformly find, that in all the arrangements of Deity, in the present state of things. Nature is frugal and economical in all her proceedings ; so that there is no process, when thoroughly investigated, that appears unnecessary or su- perfluous. From the fact, that matter appears to be indestructible, we may learn, that the Creator may, with the self-same materials which now exist around us, new-model and arrange the globe we inhabit, after the general conflagration, so as to make a more glorious world to arise out of its ashes ; purified from those physical evils which now exist ; and fitted for the ac- commodation either of renovated men, or of other pure intel- ligences. From the same fact, combined with the considera- tion of the infinite diversity of efl^ects which the simple substances of nature are capable of producing, we may be enabled to form a conception of the ease with which the Crea- tor may new-model our bodies, after they have been dissolved in the dust ; and how, from the same original atoms, he may construct and adorn them with more glorious forms, and more delightful and exquisite senses than they now possess. In short, the rapid progress which chemical science is now making, promises, ere long, to introduce improvements among the human race, which will expand their views of the agency of God, counteract many physical evils, and promote, to an ex- tent which has never yet been experienced, their social and domestic enjoyment. The late discoveries of Chemistry tend to convince us, that the properties and powers of natural sub- stances are only beginning to be discovered. Who could have imagined, a century ago, that an invisible substance is contained in a piece of coal, capable of producing the most beautiful and splendid illumination-— that this substance may be conveyed, in a few moments, through pipes of several miles in length — and that a city, containing several hundred thou- sands of inhabitants, may be instantly lighted up by it, without the aid of either wax, oil, or tallow 1 Who could have imagin- ed, that one of the ingredients of the air we breathe is the principle of combustion — that a rod of iron may be made to burn in it with a brilliancy that dazzles the eyes — that a piece of charcoal may be made to biun with a white and splendid light, which is inferior only to the solar rays — and that the dia- mond is nothing more thnn carbon in a crystallized state, and differs only in a sUjjht degree from a bit of common charcoaH ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY. 231 Who could have surmised, that a substance would be disco- vered, of such a degree of levity, as would have power suffi- cient to buoy up a number of men to the upper parts of the atmosphere, and enable them to swim, in safety, above the regions of the clouds ? These are only specimens of still more brilliant discoveries which will, doubtless, be brought to light by the researches of future generations. We have reason to believe, that the investigations of this science will, in due time, enable us to counteract most of the diseases incident to the human frame ; and to prevent many of those fatal accidents to which mankind are now exposed. Davy's safely lamp has al- ready preserved many individuals from destruction, when working in coal mines ; and thousands, in after ages, will be indebted to this discovery, for security from the dreadful explo- sions of hydrogen gas. And, we trust, that the period is not far distant, when specific antidotes to the diseases peculiar to the different trades and occupations in which mankind are em- ployed will be discovered ; and the health and vigour of the mass of society be preserved unimpaired, amidst all the pro- cesses in which they may be engaged. — In fine, the rapid pro- gress of chemical discovery carries forward our views to a period, when man, having thoroughly explored the powers of Mature, and subjected them, in some measure, to his control, »vill be enabled to ward off most of those physical evils with which he is now annoyed, and to raise himself, in some degree, to the dignity and happiness he enjoyed before moral evil had shed its baleful influence on our terrestrial system. Such a period corresponds to many of the descriptions contained in the Sacred Oracles of the millennial state of the church ; when social, domestic, moral, and intellectual improvement shall be carried to the utmost perfection which our sublunary station will permit ; when wars shall cease ; when the knowledge of Jehovah shall cover the earth ; when every man shall sit under his vine and fig-tree, without being exposed to the least alarm ; and when there shall be nothing to hurt nor destroy throughout the church of the livmg God. And, therefore, we ought to consider the various discoveries and improvements now going forward in this, and other departments of science as preparing the way for the introduction of this long-expected and auspi- cious era. ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY. The general object of both these sciences is to investigate and describe the structure and economy of the animal frame Anatomy dissects dead bodies, Physiology investigates the 232 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. functions of those that are living. Th4 former examines the fluids, muscles, viscera, and all the other parts of the human body, in a state of rest ; the latter considers them in a state of action. The parts of the human body have been distinguished into two different kinds— solids and fluids. The solid parts are bonesy cartilages, ligaments, muscles, tendons, membranes, nerves, arteries, veins, hair, nails, and dncts, or fine tubular vessels of various kinds. Of these solid parts, the following compound organs consist ; the brain and cerebellum ; the lungs ; the heart ; the stomach ; the liver ; the spleen ; the pancreas ; the glands ; the kidneys ; the intestines ; the mesen- tery ; the larynx ; and the organs of sense — the eyes, ears, nose, and tongue. The fluid parts are, the saliva, or spittle, phlegm, serum, the chyle, blood, bile, milk, lympha, urine, the pancreatic juice, and the aqueous humour of the eyes. The human body is divided into three great cavities — the head ; the thorax, or breast ; and the abdomen, or belly. The head is formed of the bones of the cranium, and encloses the brain and cerebellum. The thorax is composed of the vertebrae of the back, the sternum, and true ribs ; and contains the heart, the pericardium, the breast, and the lungs. The abdomen is separated from the thorax by means of the diaphragm, Avhich is a fleshy and membranous substance, composed, for the most part, of muscular fibres. This cavity is forined by the lumbar vertebrce, the os sacrum, the ossa innominata, the false ribs, the peritonaeum, and a variety of muscles. It encloses the stom- ach, intestines, omentum, or caul, the liver, pancreas-, spleen, kidneys, and urinary bladder. — Without attempting any tech- nical "description of these different parts, which could convey no accurate ideas to a general reader, I shall merely state two or three facts in relation to the system of bones, muscles, and blood-vessels, as specimens of the wonderful structure of our bodily frame. The Bones may be regarded as the prop-work or basis on which the human body is constructed. They bear the same rela- tion to the animal system, as the wood-work to a building. They give shape and firmness to the body ; they support its various parts, and prevent it from sinking by its own weight ; they serve as levers for the muscles to act upon, and to defend the brain, the heart, the lungs, and other vital parts from external injury. Of the bones, some are hollow, and tilled with marrow; others are solid throughout; some are very small ; others very large; some are rounds and others flat ; some are plane, and others convex or concave ; — and all these several torms are requisite ANATOMF AND PIIYSIOLOGY. 233 for the situations they occupy, and the respective functions they have to perform. — The spine, or back-hone, consists of 24 vertebrie, or small bones, connected together by cartilages, articulations, and ligaments ; of which 7 belong to the neck, 1 2 to the back, and 5 to the loins. In the centre of each ver- tebra there is a hole for the lodgment and continuation of the spinal marrow, which extends from the brain to the rump.— From these vertebras the arched bones called ribs proceed ; and seven of them join the breast-bone on each side, where they terminate in cartilagesj and form the cavity of the thorax or chest. The five Itiwer ribs, with a number of muscles, form the cavity of the abdomen, as above stated. The spine is one of the most admirnble mechanical contrivances in the human frame. Had it consisted of only three or four bones, or had the holes in each bone, not exactly corresponded, and fitted into each other, the si)inal marrow would have been bruised, and life endangered at every bending of the body. — The skull is composed of 10 bones, and about 51 are reckon- ed to belong to the face, the orbits of the eyes, and the jaws in which the teeth are fixed. There are seldom more than 16 teeth in each jaw, or 32 in all. — The number of bones in a human body is generally estimated at about 245 ; of which there are reckoned, in the skull, head, and face, 61 ; in the trunk, 64 ; in the arms, and hands, 60 ; in the legs, and i'eet, 60. The bones are provided with ligaments or hinges, which bind and fasten them together, and prevent them from being displaced by any violent motion ; and, that the ligaments may work smoothly into one another, the joints are separated by carliiagcs or gristles, and provided with a gland for the se-ro- lion of oil or mucus, which is constantly exudmg into the joints; so that every requisite is provided by our Benevolent Creator, to prevent pain; and to promote lacility of motion. '* In con- sidering the joints," says Dr. Paley, "there is nothing, ])erhaps, which ought to move our gratitude more than the rcllection, how well (liey wear. A limb shall swing upon its hinge, or play in its socket many hundred times in an hour, for 60 years to- gether, Avithout diminution of agility ; which is a long time for any thing to last ; for any thing so much worked as the joints arc." The Muscular Svstem. — A muscle is a bundle of fleshy, and sometimes of tendinous fibres. The fleshy fibres com- pose the body of tile muscle ; and the tendinous fibres the ex- tremities. Some muscles are long and round ; some plain and circular; some are spiral, and some have slraighi fibres. Some arc double, having a tendon rLinnfif^^ tiiruugh the body 234 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. from head to tail ; some have two or more tendinous branches running'- through, with various rows and orders of tibres. All these, and several other varieties, are essentially requisite for the respective offices they have to perform in the animal sys- tem. The muscles constitute the fleshy part of the human body, and give it that varied and beautiful form we observe over uU its surtace. But their principal design is to serve as the organs of motion. They are inserted, by strong tendinous extremities, into the different bones of which the skeleton is composed ; and, by their contraction and distention, give rise to all the movements of the body. The muscles, therefore, may be considered as so many cords attached to the bones ; and the Author of Nature has fixed them according to the most perfect principles of mechanism, so as to produce the fittest motions in the parts for the movement of which they are intended. One of the most wonderful properties of the muscles is, the extraordinary force they exert, although they are composed of such slender threads or fibres. The following facts, in rela- tion to this point, are demonstrated by the celebrated Borelli, in his work, " Be jMota Jlnimalium:''^ When a man Hfts up with his teeth a weight of 200 pounds, with a rope fastened to the jaw-teeth, the muscles named Temporalis and Masseler, with which people chew, and which perform this work, exert a force of above 1 5,0001bs. weight. If any one hanghig his arm directly downwards lifts a weight of 20 pounds, with the third or last joint of his thumb, the muscle which bend the thumb and bears that weight, exerts a force of about tliree thousand liounds. When a nian standing upon his feet, leaps or springs upwards to the height of two feet, if the weight of such a man be 150 pounds, the muscles employed in that action will exert a Ibrce 2000 times greater; that is to say, a force of about three hundred thousand pounds. The heart, at each pulse or contraction, by which it protrudes the blood out of the arteries into the veins,' exerts a force of above a hundred tliousand pounds. Who can contem])late this amazing strength of the muscular system, without admiration of the power and wisdom of the Creator, who has thus endued a bundle of threads, each of them smaller than a hair, with such an astonishing degree of mechanical force ! There have been reckoned about 446 muscles in the human body, which have been dissected and distinctly described ; every one of which is essential to the performance of some one motion or other, which contributes to our ease and enjoyment; and, in most instances, a great number of them is required to perform their diflbrent functions ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY. 235 at the same time. It has been calcuhited, that about a hun- dred muscles are employed every time we breathe. — " Breath- ing with ease," says Dr. Paley, " is a blessing of every mo- ment ; yet, of all others, it is that which we possess with the least consciousness. A man in an asthma is the only man who knows how to estimate it." The Heart and Blood-vessels. — The heart is a hollow muscular organ, of a conical shape, and consists of four dis- tinct cavities. The two largest are called ventricles, and the two smallest, auricles. The ventricles send out the blood to the arteries ; the auricles receive it from the veins. The heart is enclosed in the pericardium, a membranous bag, which con- tains a quantity of water, or lymph. This water lubricates the heart, and facilitates all its motions. The heart is the general reservoir of the blood. When the heart contracts, the blood is propelled from the right ventricle into the lungs, through the pulmonary arteries, which, like all the other arte- ries, are furnished with valves that play easily forward, but ad- mit not the blood to return toward the heart. The blood, after circulating through the lungs, and having there been re- vivified by coming in contact with the air, and imbibing a por- tion of its oxygen, returns into the left auricle of the heart, by the pulmonary vein. At the same instant, the left ventricle drives the blood into the aorta, a large artery which sends off branches to supply the head and arms. Another large branch of the aorta descends along the inside of the back-bone, and detaches numerous ramifications to nourish the bowels, and inferior extremities. After serving the most remote extremi- ties of the body, the arteries are converted into veins, which, in their return to the heart, gradually unite into larger branches, till the whole terminate in one great trunk, called the vena cava, which discharges itself into the right auricle of the heart, and completes the circulation. Each ventricle of the heart is reckoned to contain about one ounce, or two table- spoonsfull of blood. The heart contracts 4000 times every hour ; and, consequently, there passes through it 250 pounds of blood in one hour. And if the mass of blood in a human body be reckoned at an average of twenty-five pounds, it will follow that the ivhole mass of blood passes through the heart, and, consequently, through the thousands of ramifications of the veins and urteries fourteen times every hour, or, about once every four minutes. We may acquire a rude idea of the force with which the blood is impelled from the heart, by consider- ing the velocity with which water issues from a syringe, or from the pipe of a fire-engine. Could we behold these rapid 236 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. motions incessantly going on within us, it would overpo>rer our minds with astonishment, and even with terror. We should be apt to feel alarmed on making the smallest exertion, lest the parts of this delicate machine should be broken or deranged, and its fimctions interrupted. The arteries, into which the blood is forced, branch in every direction through the body, like the roots and branches of a tree ; running through the substance of the bones, and every part of the animal frame, till they are lost in such fine tubes as to be wholly invisible. In the parts where the arteries are lost to the sight, the veins take their rjse ; and in their commence- ment, are also imperceptible. Respiration. — The organs of respiration are the lungs. They are divided into five lobes ; three of which lie on the right, and two on the left side of the thorax. The sub- stance of the lungs is chiefly composed of infinite ramifica- tions of the thrachea, or windpipe, which, after gradually be- coming more and more minute, terminate in little cells, or vesicles, which have a free communication with one another. At each inspiration, these pipes and cells are filled with air, which is again discharged by expiration. In this manner, a circulation of air, which is necessary to the existence of men and other animals, is constantly kept up as long as life re- mains. The air cells of the lungs open into the windpipe, by which they communicate with the external atmosphere. The whole internal structure of the lungs is lined by a transpa- rent membrane, estimated at only the thousandth part of an inch in thickness ; but whose surface, from its various con- volutions, measures fifteen square feet, which is equal to the external surface of the body. On this thin and extensive membrane, innumerable veins and arteries are distributedj some of them finer than haus ; and through these vessels all the blood of the system is successively propelled, by a most curious and admirable mechanism. It has been computed, that the lungs, on an average, contain about 280 cubic inches, or about five English quarts of air. At e^ch inspiration, about forty cubic inches of air are received into the lungs, and the same quantity discharged at eacl^ expiration. On the suppo- sition, that 20 respirations take place in a minute, it will fol- low, that, in one minute, we inhale 800 cubic inches ; in an hour 48,000 ; and in a day, one million, one hundred and fifty- two thousand cubic inches — a quantity which would fill se- venty-seven wine hogsheads, and would weigh fifty-three pounds troy. By means of this function, a vast body of air is daily brought into contact M'ith the mass of blood, and com* ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGY. 237 miinicates to it its vivifying influence ; and, theiefore, it is of the utmost importance to health, that the air, of which we breathe so considerable a quantity, should be pure, and uncon- taminated with noxious eliiuvia. Digestion. — This process is performed by the stomachy which is a membranous and muscular bag, furnished with two oritices. By the one, it has a communication with the gullet, and by the other, with the bowels. The food, after bein^ moistened by the saliva, is received into the stontach, where it is still farther diluted by the i^astric juice, which has the power of dissolving every kind of animal and vegetable sub- stance. Part of it is afterwards absorbed by the lijm'^jhatic and /ac/ea/ vessels, and carried into the circulating system, and converted into blood for supplying that nourishment which the perpetual waste of our bodies demands. Perspiration is the evacuation of the juices of the body through the pores of the skin. It has been calculated that there are above three hundred thonsaud millions ofjjores in the glands of the skin which covers the body of a middle sized man. Through these pores, more than one-half of what we eat and drink passes off by insensible perspiration. If we con- sume eight pounds of food in a day, five pounds of it are in- sensibly discharged by perspiration. During a night of seven hours' sleep, we perspire about forty ounces, or two pounds and a half. At an average, we may estimate the discharge from the surface of the body, by sensible and insensible per spiration, at from half an ounce to four ounces an hour. This is a most wonderful part of the animal economy, and is abso- lutely necessary to our health, and even to our very existence. When pariiallij obstructed, colds, rheumatisms, fevers, and other inllammatory disorders, are produced ; and were it com- pletely obstructed, the vital functions would be clogged and impeded in their movements, and death would inevitably ensue. Sensation. — The oierves are generally considered as the instruments of sensation. They are soft white cords which proceed from the brain and spinal marrow. They come forth originally by pairs. Ten pair proceed from the medullary substance of the brain, which arc distributed to all parts of the head and neck. Thirty pair proceed from the spinal marrowy through the vertebrae, to all the other parts of the body ; being forty in all. These nerves, the ramifications of which are in- finitely various and minute, are distributed upon the heart, lungs, blood-vessels, bowels, and muscles, till they terminate on the skin or external covering of the body. Impressions of 20* 238 THE CHRISTIAN PHiLOSOPHtR. external objects are received by the brain from the adjacent organs of sense, and the brain exercises it» commands over the muscles and limbs by means of the nerves. Without prosecuting these imperfect descriptions farther, I shall conclude this very hasty sketch with the following sum- mary of the parts of the body, in the words of Bonnet. — " The bones, by their joints and solidity, form the foundation of this fine machine : the Itgameuis are strings which unite the parts together : the muscles are fleshy substances, which act as elastic springs to put them in motion : the nerves, which are dispersed over the whole body, connect all the parts together : the arteries and veins, like rivulets, convey life and health throughout : the heart, placed in the centre, is the focus where the blood collects, or the acting power by means of which it circulates and is preserved : the lungs, by means of another power, draw in the external air, and expel hurtful vapors : the stomach and intestines are the magazines where every thing that is required for the daily supply is prepared : the brain, that seat of the soul, is formed in a manner suitable to the dignity of its inhabitant : the senses, which are the soul's mi- nisters, warn it of all that is necessary either for its pleasure or use.* Adorable Creator ! with what wonderful art hast thou formed us ! Though the heavens did not exist to pro- :laim thy glory ; though there were no created being upon earth but myself, my own body might suffice to convince me that thou art a God of unlimited power and infinite goodness." This subject suggests a variety of moral and religious re- flections, but the limits to which I am confined, will permit me to state only the following : — 1. The economy of the human frame, when seriously con- templated, has a tendency to excite admiration and astonish- ment, and to impress us with a seiise of our continual depend- ence Oil a Superior Power. What an immense multiplicity of machinery must be in action to enable us to breathe, to teel, and to walk ! Hundreds of bones of diversified forms, con- nected together by various modes of articulation ; hundreds of muscles to produce motion, each of them acting in a.t least ten difibrent capacities ; (see p. 83.) hundreds of tendons and ligaments to connect the bones and muscles ; hundreds of arteries to convey the blood to the remotest part of the sys- tem ; hundreds of veins to bring it b/ick to its reservoir the heart; thousands of glands secreting humors of various kinds from the blood ; thousands of lacteal and lymi)liatic tubes, * Contemplalion of Nature, vol. I. i). G4. ANATOMY AND PUVSIOLOGY. 239 absorbing and conveying nutriment to the circulating fluid ; millions of pores, through which the perspiration is continu- ally issuing ; an infinity of ramitications of nerves, ditiusing sensation throughout all the parts of this exquisite machine ; and the heart at every pulsation exerting a force of a hundred thousand pounds, in order to preserve all this complicated machinery in constant operation ! The whole of this vast system of mechanism must be in action before we can walk across our apartments ! We admire the operation of a steam- engine, and the force it exerts. But, though it is constructed of the hardest materials which the mines can supply, in a few months some of its essential parts are worn and deranged, even although its action should be frequently discontinued. But the animal machine, though constructed, for the most part, of the softest and most flabby substances, can go on without intermission in all its diversified movements, by night and by day, for the space of eighty or a hundred years ; the heart giving ninety-six thousand strokes every twenty-four hours, and the whole mass of blood rushing through a thousand pipes of all sizes every four minutes ! And, is it man that governs these nice and complicated movements ? Did he set the heart in motion, or endue it with the muscular force it exerts 1 And when it has ceased to beat, can he command it again to resume its functions 1 Man knows neither the secret springs of the machinery within him, nor the half of the purposes tor which they serve, or of the movements they perform. Can any thing more strikingly demonstrate our dependance every moment on a Superior Agent, and that it is " in God we live and move, and have our being ?' Were a single pin of the machinery within us, and over which we have no control, either broken or deranged, a thousand movements might instantly be inter- rupted, and our bodies left to crumble into the dust. It was considerations of this kind that led the cele])rated physician Galen, who was a sceptic in his youth, publicly to acknowledge that a Supreme Intelligence must have operated in ordaining the laws by which living beings are constructed. And he wrote his excellent treatise " On the uses of the parts of the human frame," as a solemn hymn to the Creator of the world. " I first endeavor from His works," he says, "to know him myself, and afterwards, by the same means, to show him to others ; to intbrm them, how great is his wisdom, his good- ness, his power." The late Dr. Hunter has observed, that Astronomy and Anatomy are the studies which present us with the most striking view of the two most wonderful attributes of the Supreme Being. The first of these fills the mind with the 240 THE CHRISTIAN philosopher. idea of his immensity in the largeness, distances, and number of the heavenly bodies ; the last astonishes lis with his intel ligence and art in the variety and delicacy of animal me chanism. 2. The study of the animal economy has a powerful ten d,ency to excite emotions of gratitude. Man is naturally u thoughtless and ungrateful creatiu-e. These dispositions are partly owing to ignorance of the wonders of the human frame, and of the admirable economy of the visible world ; and this Ignorance is owing to the want of those specific instructions which ought to be communicated by parents and teachers, in connexion with religion. For, there is no rational being who is acquainted with the structure of his animal system, and re- flects upon it with the least degree of attention, but must feel a sentiment of admiration and gratitude. The science which unfolds to us the economy of our bodies, shows us, on what an infinity of springs, and motions, and adaptations, our life and comfort depend. And when we consider, that all these movements are performed without the least care or laborious effort on our part, if we be not altogether brutish, and insen- sible of our dependance on a superior Power, we must be filled with emotions of gratitude towards Him " whose hands have made and fashioned us, and who giveth us life, and breath, and all things." Some of the motions to which I have adverted, depend upon our will ; and with what celerity do they obey its commands ? Before we can rise from our chair, and walk across our apartment, a hundred muscles must be' set in motion ; every one of these must be relaxed or con- stricted, just to a certain degree, and no more ; and all must act harmoniously at the same instant of time ; and, at the command of the soul, all these movements are instantaneously performed. When I wish to lift my hand to my head, every part of the body requisite to produce the effect is put in mo- tion : the nerves are braced, the muscles are stretched or re- laxed, the bones play in their sockets, and the whole animal machine concurs in the action, as if every nerve and muscle had heard a sovereign and resistless call. When I wish the next moment to extend my hand to my foot, all these muscles are thrown into a different state, and a new set are brought along with them into action : and thus we may vary, every moment, the .movements of the muscular system, and the mechanical actions it produces, by a simple change in our volition. Were we not daily accustomed to such varied and voluntary movements, or could we contemplate them in any other machine, we should be lost in wonder and astonishment. HISTORY. 241 Besides these voluntary motions, there are a thousand im- portant functions which have no dependance upon our will. Whether we think of it or not, whether we be sleeping or waking-, sitting or walking — the heart is incessantly exerting its muscular power at the centre of the system, and sending off streams of blood through hundreds of pipes ; the lungs are continually expanding and contracting their thousand vesicles and imbibing the vital principle of the air ; the stomach is grinding the food ; the lacteals and lymphatics are extracting nourishment for the blood ; the liver and kidneys drawing oti^ their secretions ; and the perspiration issuing from milHons of pores. These, and many other important functions with which we are unacquainted, and over which we have no con- trol, ought to be regarded as the immediate agency of the Deity within us, and should excite our incessant admiration and praise. There is one peculiarity in the constitution of our animal system, which we are apt to overlook, and for which we are ^ never sufficiently grateful ; and that is, the poiver it j^ossesses of self-restoration. A wound heals up of itself: a broken bone is made firm again by a callus ; and a dead part is sepa- rated and thrown off. If all the wounds we have ever received were still open and bleeding afresh, to what a miserable con dition should we be reduced 1 But by a system of internal powers, beyond all human comprehension, as to the mode of their operation, such dismal effects are effectually prevented. In short, when we consider, that health depends upon such a numerous assemblage of moving organs, and, that a single spring out of action, might derange the whole machine, and put a stop to all its complicated movements, can we refrain from joining with the Psalmist, in his pious exclamation, and grateful resolution, '^ How precious are thy wonderful contri- vances concerning me, O God ! how great is the sum of them ! I will praise thee ; for I am fearfully and wonderfully made. Marvellous are thy works, and that my soul knoweth right well." Omitting the consideration of several other departments of science, I shall in the meantime, notice only another subject connected with religion, and that is History. HISTORY. History embraces a record and description of past facts and events, in reference to all the nations and ages of the world, in so far as they are known, and have been transmitted to our time. As Natmal Hi.storv contains a record of the operations 242 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. of the Creator in the material world, so, sacred and civil his- tory embraces a record of his transactions in the moral and intellectual world, or, in other words, a detail of the plans and operations of Ilis Providence, in relation to the inhabitants of our globe. Through the medium of Sacred History, we learn the period and the manner of man's creation — the reason of his fall from the primitive state of integrity in which he was created, and the dismal consequences which ensued ; — the various movements of Providence in order to his recovery, and the means by which human Redemption was achieved ; — the manner in which the Gospel was at first promulgated, the countries into which it was carried, and the important effects it produced. Through the medium of Civil History we learn the deep and universal depravity of mankind, as exhibited in the wars, dissensions, and ravages, which have desolated our fallen race, in every period, and in every land ; — we learn the desperate wickedness of the human heart, in the more private acts of ferocity, cruelty, and injustice, which, in all ages, men have perpetrated upon each other ; — we behold the Righteous- ness of the Supreme Ruler of the world, and the equily of his administration, in the judgments which have been inflicted on wicked nations — and the improbability, nay, the impossibility of men being ever restored to moral order and happiness, without a more extensive diffusion of the blessings of the gospel of Peace, and a more cordial acquiescence in the fequirements of the Divine laws. Such being some of the benefits to be derived from History, it requires no additional arguments to show, that this branch of knowledge should occasionally form a subject of study to every intelligent Christian. But in order to render the study of History subservient to the interests of Religion, it is not enough merely to gratify our curiosity and imagination, by following out a succession of memorable events, by tracing the progress of armies and of battles, and listening to the groans of the vanquished, and the shouts of conquerors. This would be to study History merely as sceptics, as Athe- ists, or as writers of novels. When we contemplate the facts which the Historian presents to our view, we ought to raise our eyes to Him who is the Governor among the nations, " who doth according to his will in the armies of heaven, and among the inhabitants of the earth," and who overrules the jarring interests of mortals, for promoting the prosperity of that Kingdom which shall never be moved. We should view the immoral propensities and dispositions of mankind as por- trayed in the page of history, as evidences of the depravity of HISTORY. 243 our species, and as exciteme;ilts to propagate, with unremitting energy, the knowledge of that Religion, whose sublime doc- trines and pure precepts alune can counteract the stream of human corruption, and unite all nations in one harmonious society. We should view the contests of nations, and the results with which they are accompanied, as guided by that Invisible Hand, which " mustereth the armies to thfe battle ;" and should contemplate them either as the accomplishment of Divine predictions, as the inflictions of retributive justice, as paving the way for the introduction of rational liberty iand social happiness among men, or as ushering in that glorious period, when " tiie knowledge 6t' the Lord shall cover tliCJ earth," and the nations shall learn war no more. Thus T have taken a very cursory survey of sonic of thosS sciences which stand in a near relation to the objects of Reli- gion ; and which may, indeed^ be considered as forming so many of its subordinate branches. There are many other departments of knowledge wiiicli, at fust view, do not seem to have any relation to Theological science ; mid yctj on a closer inspection, will be found to be essentially conuectod with the several subjects of which I have been treating. For example —some may be iipt to iniagine that Arithmetic, Geometry, Trigonometry, and other branches of Mathematics, can have no relation to the leading objects of Religion. But if these sciences had never been cultivated, the most important disco- veries of astronomy, geography, natural philosophy, and che- mistry, would never have been made ; ships could not have been navigated across the ocean ; distant continents, and the numerous "isles of the sea," would have remained unexplored, iind their inhabitants left to grope in the darkness of heathen- ism ; and most of those instruments and engines by which the condition of the human race will be gradually meliorated, and the influence of Christianity extended^ would never have been invented. Such is the dependance of every branch of useful knowledge upon another, that were any one portion of science, which has a practical tendency, to be discarded, it would prevent, to a certain degree, the improvement of every other. And, consequently, if any one science can be sliown to have a connexion with religion, all the rest must likewise stand in a certain relation to it. It must^ therefore, have a pernicious eflfect on the minds of the mass of the Christian world, when preachers, in their sermons, endeavor to undervalue scientific 244 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. knowledge, by attempting to contrast it with the doctrines of Revelation. It would be just as reasonable to attempt to con- trast the several doctrines, duties, and facts, recorded in the IVew Testament with each other, in order to determine their relative importance, and to show which of them might be altogether overlooked and discarded. The series of facts and of Divine revelations comprised in the Bible ; the moral and political events which diversify the history of nations ; and the physical operations that are goirig on among the rolling worlds on high, and in the chemical changes of the invisible atoms of matter^ are all parts of o/ie comprehensive system, under the direction of the Eternal Mind ; every portion of which must have a certain relation to the whole. And, therefore, instead of attempting to degrade one part of the Divine fabric in order to enhance another, our duty is to take an expansive view of the whole, and to consider the symmetry and proportion of its parts, arid their mutual bear- ings and relations — in so far as our opportunities, and the limited faculties of our minds will permit. If the remarks which have been thrown out in this chapter, respecting the conne.tioil of the Sciences with Religion, have any foundation, it will follow — that Sermons, Lectures, Sys- tems of Divinity, and Religious Periodical works, should em- brace occasional illustrations of such subjects, for the purpose of expanding the conceptions of professed Christians, and ot enabling them to take large and comprehensive views of the perfections of tile providence of the Almighty. It is much to be regretted, that so many members of the Christian Church are absolute strangers to stich studies and contemplations ; while the time and attention that might have been devoted to such exercises, have, in many cases, been usurped by the most i grovelling aiTections, liy tbohsh pursuits, by gossiping chit- chat, and slanderous conversation. Shall the most trifling and absurd oj^inions of ancient and modern heretics be judged worthy of attention, and occiipy a i)lace in Religious journals, and even in discussions from the p'ulpit, and shall 'Mlie mighty , a<'ts of the Lord," and the visible wonders of his power and i wisdom, be thrown conjpktely into the shade 1 To survey, with an eye of intelbgeuce, the wide-exlended theatre of (he Divine OjXMations— to mark the agency of the Eternal Mind in every object wo bebokl, and in every movement within us and around us, are some of the noljlest attainments of the rational soul ; and, in conjunction with every other Christian study and acquirement, are calculated to make " the man ot (rod t)eriect, and Iborocglily furnished unto every good work." iiisTORV', 245 By such studies, we are, in some measure, assimilated to the angelic tribes, whose powet's of intellect are for ever employed in such investigations — and are gradually prepared for bearing a part in their immortal hymn — " Great and marvellous are thy works, Lord Got! Almighty ; just and true are thy ways, thou King of Saints. Thou art worthy to receive glory, and honor, and power ; for thou hast created all things, and for thy pleasure they are and were created." 21 CHAPTER HI, THE RELATION WITICH THE INVENTIONS OF HUMAN ART BEAR TO THE OBJECTS OF RELIGION. In this chapter, I shall briefly notice a fcAv philosophical and mechancical inventions which have an obvious bearing on Religion, and on the general propagation of Christianity among the nations. The first, and perhaps the most important of the inven- tions to which I allude, is the Art of Printing. This art appears to have been invented (at least in Europe) about the year 1430, by one Laurentiti.^ or Lawrence Koster, a native of Haerlem, a town in Holland. As he was walking in a wood near the city, he began to cut some letters upon the rind of a beach tree, which, for the sake of gratifying his fancy, being impressed on paper, he printed one or two lines as a specimen for his grandchildren to follow. This having suc- ceeded, he meditated greater things ; and first of all, invented a more glutinous writing ink ; because he found the common ink sunk and spread ; and thus formed whole pages of wood, with letters cut upon them.* By the gradual improvement of * I am aware, that the honor o( this hivention has been claimed by other cities besides Haerlem, parlicalarly by St.rasbm-g, and Mentz, a city of Ger- many ; and by other individuals besides Lavirentius, chiefly by one Fusl^ commonly called Dr. Faustiis ; by Schoeffei*, and by Gutenberg. It appears that the art, with many of its implements, was stolen from Laurentius by one of his servants, whom he had bound, by an oath, to secrecy, who fled to Mentz, and first commenced the process of printing in that city. Here the art was improved by Fust and SchoefFer, by their invention oi metallic, instead o( wooden types, which were first used. When Fust was in Paris, disposing of somf' Bib.cs jie had printed, at the low price (as was then thought) of sixty crowns, the number, and the uniformity of the copies he j)').s.se>:sed, created imiversal agitation and astonishment. Informations wore given to the Police against him as a magician, his lodgings were searched, and a great number of copie.s being found, they were seized,- the red mk with which ihcy were embellished, was said to be his blood ; it ART OF PRINTING. 247 this art, and its application to the diffusion of knowledge, a new era was formed in the annals of the human race, and in the progress of science, religion, and morals. To it we are chiefly indebted for our deliverance from ignorance and error, and for most of those scientific discoveries and improvements in the arts which distinguish the period in which we live. — Without its aid, the Reformation from Popery could scarcely have been achieved ; for, had the books of Luther, one of the first reformers, been multiplied by the slow process of hand- writing and copying, they could never have been diffused to any extent ; and the influence of bribery and of power might have been sufficient to have arrested their progress, or even to have erased their existence. But, being poured forth from the press in thousands at a time, they spread over the nations of Europe like an inundation, and with a rapidity which neither the authority of princes, nor the schemes of priests and car- dinals, nor the bulls of popes, could counteract or suspend. — To this noble invention it is owing that copies of the Bible have been multiplied to the extent of many millions— that ten thousands of them are to be found in every Protestant country — and that the poorest individual who expresses a desire fur it, was seriously adjudged, that he was in league wilh the Devil ; and if ho had not fled troni the city, most probably he would have sliared the fate of those whom ignorant and superstitious judges, at that time, condenmed for witclicraft. Prom this circumstance, let us learn to beware how we view the inventions of genius, and how we treat those whose ingenious contri- vances may afterwards be the means of enlightening and meliorating man- kind. See .Appendix. No. VII. Various improvements have been made, of late years, in the art of print- ing. That which has lately been announced by Dr. Church of Boston, is the most remarkable ; and, if found successfiil, will carry this art to a high degree of perfection. A principal object of this improvement is, to print constantly from new types, which is effected by simplifying the process for casting and composing. The type is delivered perfect by machinery, and laid as it is cast, in separate compartments, with unei-ring order and exactness. The composition is then effected by other apparatus, directed by keys like those of a piano-forte, and the type may then be arranged in wortls atid lines, as quickly as in the performance of notes in music. No error can arise except from touching the wrong key ; and lience an expert hand will leave little labor for the reader. It is then found less expensive under Dr. Church's economical system of re-casting, to re-melt the types, and re-cast them, than to perform the tedious operation of disiriburion. I'he melting takes place without atmospheric exjiosure, by whii^h oxydation and waste of metal are avoided. It is calculated that two men can produce 75,000 new types per hour, and in re-composing, one man will perform as much as three or four compositors. In the proditction of tv])e.s, the saving is ninety-nine parts in a hundred; and in the conij^ositii.ii, distribution, and reading, is three parts in four. In regard to press- work, Dr. C. has inven- ted a machme to work with plattens, instead of cylinders, from which he will be enabled to take 30 fine imoressiona per nnnuie. 243 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHLR. may be furnished with the " Word of Life" which will guide him to a blessed immortality. That Divine hght which is des- tined to illuminate every region of the globe, and to sanctify and reform men of all nations, and kindreds, and tongues, is Accelerated in its movements, and directed iu its course through the nations, by the invention of the Art of Printing ; and ere long, it will distribute among the inhabitants of every land, the " Law and the Testimony of the Most High," to guide their steps to the regions of eternal bliss. In short, there is not a more powerful engine in the hands of Proyidence, for diffu- sing the knowledge of the nature and the will of the Deity, and for accomplishing the grand objects of Revelation, than the art of multiplying books, and of co,nveying intelligence through the medium of the Press. Were no such art in exis- tence, we canriot conceive how an extensive and universal propagation of the doctrines of Revelation could be effected, unless after the lapse of an indefinite number of ages. But, with the assistance of this invention, in its present improved state, the island of Great Britain alone, within less than a hundred years, could furnish a copy of the Scriptiues to every inhabitant of the world, an^ would defray the expense of such an undertaking, with much more ease, and with a smaller sum than were necessary to furnish the political Wc\rfare in which we were lately engaged. These considerations teach us, that the ingenious inventions of the human mind are under the direction and control of the Governor of the world — are intimately connected with the ac- complishment of the plan of his providence, and ha^ve a ten- dency, either directly or indirectly, to promote, over every region of the earth, the progress and extension of" the kingdom of the Redeemer. They also show us, from what small be- ginnings the most magnificent operations of the Divine econo- my may derive their origin. Who could have imagined that the simple circumstance of a person amusing himself by cut- ting a few letters on the bark of a tree, and impressing them on paper, was intimately connected with the mental illumina- tion of mankind ; and that the art w hich sprung from this casual process was destined to be the principal means of illu- minating the nations, and of cortyeyiug to the ends of the earth, " the salvation of our God?" But, " lie who rules in the armies of heaven, and among the inhabitants of the earth," and who sees " the end from the beginniryg\" overrules the most minute movement of all his creatures, in subserviency to his ultimate designs, and shows himself., in this respect, t( be " vvonderfi,\l ^i caunsel, and excellent in working." THE MARINER S C0MPAS3. 249 The Mariner's Compass. — Another invention which has an intimate relation to religion, is, the Jirt of JVaingation^ and the invention of the Mariner's Compass. Navigation is the art of conducting a ship through the sea, from one port to another. This art was partly known and practised in the early ages of antiquity, by the Phenicians, tlie Carthaginians, the Egyptians, the Rom.ms, and other nations of Europe and Asia. But they had no guide to direct them in their voyages, except the sun in the day time, and the stars by night. When the sky was overcast with clouds, they were thrown into alarms, and durst not venture to any great distance from the coast, lest they should be carried forward in a course opposite to that which they intended, or be driven against hidden rocks, or unknown shores. The danger and difficulty of the navigation of the ancients, on this account, may be learned from the delibera- tions, the great preparations, and the alarms of Homer's heroes, when they were about to cross the Egean Sea, an extent of not more than 150 miles ; and the expedition of the Argonauts under Jason, across the sea of Marmora and the Euxine, to the island of Colchis, a distance of only four or live hundred miles, was viewed at a most wonderful exploit at which even the gods themselves were said to be amazed. The same thing appears from the narration we have in the Acts of the Apostles, of Paul's voyage from Cisarea to Rome. " When," says Luke, " neither sun nor stars in many days appeared, and no small tempests lay on us, all hope that we should be saved was then taken away." Being deprived of these guides, they were tossed about in the Mediterranean, not knowing whether they were carried to north, south, east, or west. So that the voyages of antiquity consisted chiefly in creeping along the coast, and seldom venturing beyond sight of land : they could not, therefore, extend their excursions by sea to distant continents and nations ; and hence, the greater portion of the terraqueous globe and its inhabitants were to them altogether unknown. It was not before the invention of the J\Iariner"s Compass, that distant voyages could be undertaken, that ex- tensive oceans could be traversed, and an intercourse earned on between remote continents and the islands of tlie ocean. It is somewhat uncertain at what precise period this noble discovery was made ; but it appears pretty evident, that tlie Manner's Compass was not commonly used in navigation be- fore the year 1420, or only a few years before the invention of Printing.* The loadstone, in all ages, was known to ha\ e the * The invention of the Compass is usually ascribed to Falvio Gioia, of Anialfi, in Campania, about the year 1302; and the Itahans are strenuous 21* 250 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. property of attracting iron ; b,iit its tendency to point towards the north and south seems to have been imnotioed ^ili the beginning of the twelfth century. About tha,t time same curi- ous pers,oas seem to have amused themselves by making to swim, in a basin of water, a loadstone suspended on a piece of cork ; and to have remarked, that, when left at liberty, one of its extremities pointed to the north. They had also re- marked, that,, when a piece of iron is rubbed against the load- stone, it acquires also the property of turning towards the north, and of attracting needles and tihngs ofiroai. From one expe- riment to another,' they proceeded to lay a needle, touched with the magnet, on two, snrjall hits of straw floating on the water, and to observe that the needle invariably turned its point towards the north. The first use they seem to have made of these experiments, was, to impose upon simple people by the appearance of magic. For example, a hollow swan, or the figure of a mermaid, was made to swim in a basin of water, and to follow a knive with a bit of bread upon its point which had been previously rubbed on the loadstone. The experimenter convinced them of his power, by commanding, iU this way, a needle laid on the surface of the water, to turn its point from the north to the east, or in any other direction. But, some geniuses, of more sublime and reflective powers of mind, seizing upon these hints, at last applied these experi- ments to the wants of navigation, and constructed an instru- ment by the help of which the mariner can now direct his course to distant lands, through the vast and pathless ocean. In consequence of the discovery of this instrument, the coasts of almost every land on the surface of the globe have been explored, and a regular intercourse opened up between the remotest regions of the earth. Without the help of this noble invention, America, in all probability, would never have lieen discovered by the eastern nations — the vast continent of jN ew-llolland — the numerous and interesting islands in the Indian and Pacific oceans — the isles of Japan, and other im- mense territories inhabited by human beings, would have re- mained as much uiiknovyn and unexplored as if they had never ill supporting this claim. Others affirm, that Marcus Paulus, a Venetian, having made a journey to China, bruu2,ht hack the invention with iiim in 1260. The Freiicli also lay chiim to the honor of ihis invention, from the circumstance, that all nations distini^-uish the AV/// pohit of the card by a Jieur de lis ; and Avith equal reason, the English have laid claim to the same honor, from the name compass, by which most nations have agreed to dis- tinguish it. But whoever were the inventors, or at whatever period this instrument was first constructed, it dues not appear that it was brought mto general use, before the period mentioned in the text. THE mariner's compass. 251 existed, A»^^ ^s the nations of Europe, and the western parts of Asia, were the sole depositories of the records of Revela- tion, they could never have conveyed, the blessinojs of salvation to remote countries^ and to unknown tribes of mankind, of whose existence they were entirely ignorant. Even although the whole terraqueous globe had been sketched out before them, in all its aspects and bearings, and ramifications of islands, continents, seas, and oceans, and the moral and politi- cal state of every trib,e of its inhabitants displayed to view ; — without a guide to direct their course through the billows of the ocean, they could hav-e afibrded no light and no relief to cheer the distant nations " who sit in darkness, and in the shadow of death." Though the art of Printing had been invented ; though millions of Bibles were now prepared, adequate to the supply of all the " kindreds of the heathen ;" though ships in abundance were equipped for the enterprise, and thousands of missionaries ready to embark, and to devote their lives to the instruction of the Pagan world — all would be of no avail, and the *' salvation o( God" could never be proclaimed to the ends of the world, unless they had a Mariner's Compass to guide their course through the trackless ocean. In this invention, then, we behold a proof of the agency of Divine Providence, in directing the efforts of human genius to subserve the most important designs, and contemplate a strik- ing specimen of the " manifold wisdom of God." When the pious and contemplative Israelite reflected on the declaration of the prophets, that " the glory of Jehovah would be reveal- ed, and that all flesh would see it together ;" — from the state of the arts which then existed, he must have felt many diflicul- ties in forming a conception of the manner in which such pre- dictions could be realized. — " The great and wide sea," now termed the Mediterranean, formed the boundary of his view, beyond which he was unable to penetrate. Of the continents, and " the isles afar ofl^," and of the far more spacious oceans that lay between, he had no knowledge ; and how " the ends of the earth" were to be reached, he could form no concep- tion ; and, in the midst of his perplexing thoughts, he could find no satisfaction only in the firm belief, that " with God alJ things are possible." But now we are enabled not only to contemplate ihe grand designs of the Divine economy, but the principal means by which they shall all, in due time, be accom- plished, in consequence of the progress of science and art, and of their consecration to the rearing and extension of the Chris- tian church. The two inventions to which I have now adverted, may 252 THE CHRISTIAN philosopheh. perhaps, be considered as among the most striking instances of the connection of human art with the objects of Rehgion But there are many other inventions which, at first view, do not appear to bear so near a relation to the progress of Christi- anity, and yet have an ultimate reference to some of its grana and interesting objects. The Telescope. — We might be apt to think, on a slight view of the matter, that there can be no immediate relation be- tween the grinding and polishing of an optic glass, and fitting two or more of them in a tube, and — the enlargement of our views of the operation of the Eternal Mind. Yet the connec- tion between these two objects, and the dependance of the latter upon the former, can be fairly demonstrated. — The son of a spectacle-maker of Middleburg in Holland, happening to amuse himself in his fiither's shop, by holding two glasses be- tween his finger and his thumb, and varying their distance, perceived the weather-cock of the church spire opposite to him, much larger than ordinary, and apparently much nearer and turned upside down. This new wonder exercised the amazement of the father ; he adjusted two glasses on a board rendering them moveable at pleasure ; and thus formed the first rude imitation of a perspective glass, by which distant ob jects are brought near to view. Galileo, a philosopher of Tus cany, hearing of the invention, set his mind to work, in ordei to bring it to perfection. He fixed his glasses at the end of long organ-pipes, and constructed a telescope, which he soon directed to different parts of the surrounding heavens. He discovered four moons revolving around the planet Jupiter — spots on the surface of the Sun, and the rotation of that globe around its axis — mountains and valleys in the moon — and numbers of fixed stars where scarcely one was visible to the naked eye. These discoveries were made about the year 1610, a short time after the first invention of the telescope. Since that period this instrument has passed through various degrees of improvement, and, by means of it, celestial won- ders have been explored in the distant spaces of the universe, which, in former times, were altogether concealed from mortal view. By the help of telescopes, combined with the art of measuring the distances and magnitudes of the heavenly bo- dies, our views of the Grandeur of the Almighty, of the pleni- tude of his Power, and of the extent of his universal Empire, are extended far beyond what could have been conceived in former ages. Our prospects of the range of the Divine oper- ations are no longer confined within the limits of the world wo inhabit ; — we can now plainly perceive, that the kingdom of THE TELESCOPE. 253 God is not only '^ an everlasting dominion," but that it ex- tends through the unlimited regions ol* space, comprehending within its vast circumference thousands of suns, and ten thou- sands of worlds, all ranged in \najestio order, at immense dis- tances from on^ another, and all supported and governed " by Him who rides on the Heaven of Heavens," whose greatness is unsearchable, and whose understanding is infinite. The telescope has also demonstrated to us the literal truth of those scriptural declarations which assert that the stars are " innumerable." Before the invention of this instrument, not more than about a thousand stars could be perceived by the unassisted eye in the clearest night. But this invention has unfolded to view not only thousands, but hundreds of thous- ands, and millions of those bright luminaries, which lie dis- persed in every direction throughout the boundless dmiensions of space. And, the higher the magnifying powers of the teles- cope are, the more numerous those celestial orbs appear ; leaving us no room to doubt, that coimtless myriads more lie hid in the distant regions of creation, far beyond the reach of the finest glasses that can be constructed by human skill, and which are known only to Him " who counts the number of the stars, and calls them by their names." In short, the telescope may be considered as serving the purpose of a vehicle for conveying us to the distant regions of space. We would consider it as a wonderful achievement, could we transport ourselves two hundred thousand miles from the earth, in the direction of the Moon, in order to take a nearer view of that celestial orb. But this instrument enables us to take a much nearer inspection of that planet, than if we had actually surmounted the force of gravitatiqn, traversed the voids of space, and left the earth 230,000 miles behind us. For^ supposing such a journey to be accomplished, we should still be ten thousand mdes distant from the orb. But a teles- cope which magnifies objects 240 times, can carry our views within ONE thousand miles of the moon ; and a telescope, such as Dr. HerschePs 40 feet reflector, which magnifies 6000 times, would enable us to view the mp.untains and vales of the moon, as if we were transported ^o a point abo,u^ 40 miles from her surface.* We can view the magnificent system of the planet * Though the highest magnifying power, of E>r. HerschePs large telescope was estimated at six thousand times, yet it does not aj>pear that the Doctor ever applied this power witii success, when viewing the moon and the planets. The deficiency of light, when using so high a power, would ren-- der the view of these objects less satisfactory than when viewed with a power of one or two thousand times. Still, it is quite certain, that if any 251 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. Saturn, by means of this instrument as distinctly, as if we had performed a journey eight hundred millions of miles in the direction of that globe, which, at the rate of 50 miles an hour would require a period of more than eighteen hundred years to accomplish. By the telescope, we can contemplate the re- gion of the fixed stars, their arrangement into systems, and their immense numbers, with the same distinctness and am plitude of view, as if we had actually taken a flight often hun- dred thousand millions of miles into those unexplored and un- e>xplorable regions, which could not be accomplished in seve- ral millions of years, though our motion were as rapid as a ball projected from a loaded cannon. We would justly consider it as a noble endowment for enabling us to take an extensive survey of the works of God, if we had the faculty of trans- porting ourselves to such immense distances from the sphere we now occupy ; but, by means of the telescopic tube, we may take nearly the same ample views, of the dominions of the Creator, without stirring a foot from the limits of our terres- trial abode. This instrument may, therefore, be considered as a providential gift, bestowed upon mankind, to serve, in the mean time, as a temporary substitute for those powers of rapid flight with which the seraphim are endowed, and for those su- perior faculties of motion with which man himself may be in- vested, when he arrives at the summit of moral perfection.* The Microscope. — The JSiicroscope is another instrument constructed on similar principles, which has greatly expanded our views of the " manifold wisdom of God." This instru- ment, which discovers to us small objects, invisible to the naked eye, was invented soon after the invention and improve- ment of the telescope. By means of this optical contrivance, we perceive a variety of wonders in almost every object in the animal, the vegetable, and the mineral kingdoms. We per- ceive that every particle of matter, however minute, has a portions of the moon's surface were viewed tlirougli an instrument of such a power, they would appear as large (IjuL not nearly so bright and distinct) as if we were placed about 40 miles distant from that body. The enlarge- ment of the angle of vision, in this case, or, the apparent distance at which the moon would be contemplated, is found by dividing the moon's dis- tance — 240,000 miles by 6000, the magnifying power of the telescope, which produces a quotient of 40 — the number of miles at which the moon would appear to be placed from the eye of the observer. Dr. Herschel ap- pears to have used the highest power of his telescopes only, or chiefly, when viewing some very minur.e objecl s in the region of the stars. TJie powers he generally used, and with which he made most of liis discoveries were, 227", 460, 754, 932, and ocrasionaliy 2010, 3108, and 6450 when inspecting double and treble stars, and the more distant neludie. ♦ See Ap].endix, JNo. VUI. THE TELESCOPE. 255 determinate form — that the very scales of the skin of a haddock are all beautifully uitervvoven and variegated, like pieces of net-work, which no art can imitate — that the points of the prickles of vegetables, though magnitied a thousand times, ap- pear as sharp and well polished as to the naked eye — that every particle of the dust on the butterfly's wing is a beautiful and regularly organized feather — that every hair of our head is a hollow tube, with bulbs and roots, furnished with a variety of threads or tilaments — and that the pores in our skin, through which the sweat and perspiration flow, are so numerous and minute, that a grain of sand would cover a hundred and twen- ty-five thousand of them. We perceive animated beings in certain liquids, so small, that fifty thousand of them would not equal the size of a mite ; and yet each of these creatures is furnished with a mouth, eyes, stomach, blood-vessels, and other organs for the performance of animal functions. In a stagnant pool which is covered with a greenish scum during the summer months, every drop of the water is found to be a world teeming with thousands of inhabitants. The mouldy substance which usually adheres to damp bodies exhibits a forest of trees and plants, where the branches, leaves, and fruit, can be plainly distinguished. In a word, by this admira- ble instrument we behold the same Almighty Hand which rounded the spacious globe on which we live, and the huge masses of the planetary orbs, and directs them in their rapid motions through the sky, — employed, at the same moment, in rounding and polishing ten thousand minute transparent globes in the eye of a fly ; and boring and arranging veins and arte- ries, and forming and clasping joints and claws, for the move- ments of a mite ! We thus learn the admirable and astonish- ing eflTects of the Wisdom of God, and that the Divine Care and Benevolence are as much displayed in the construction of the smallest insect, as in the elephant, or the whale, or in those ponderous globes which roll around us in the sky. These, and thousands of other views which the miscroscope exhibits, would never have been displayed to the human mind, had they ' not been opened up by this admirable invention. I In fine, by means of the two instruments to which I have now adverted, we behold Jehovah's empire extending to infi- nity on either hand. By the telescope we are presented with the most astonishing displays of his omnipotence, in the im- mense number, the rapid motions, and the inconceivable mag- nitude of the celestial globes ; — and, by the microscope, we behold, what is still more inconceivable, a display of his un- searchable wisdom in the Divme mechanism, by which a diop 256 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. of water is peopled with myriads of inhabitants — a fact, which, were it not subject to ocular demonstration^ would far exceed the Hmits of human conception or belief. We have thus the most striking and sensible evidence, that, from the immeasur- able luminaries of heaven, and from the loftiest seraph that stands before the throne of God, down to this lower world, and to the smallest microscopic animalcula that eludes the finest glass — He is every where present, and, by his power, intelligence, and agency, animates, supports, and directs the whole. Such views and contemplations naturally lead us to advert to the character of God as delineated by the sacred writers, that " He is of great power and mighty in strength ;" that " His understanding is infinite ;" that " His works are wonderful ;" that " His opera.ions are unsearchable and past finding out;" and they must excite the devout mind to join with fervor in the language of adoration and praise* When thy amazing works, O God ! My mental eye surveys, " Transported with the view, I'm lost In wonder, love, an. I praise." Steam Navigation. — We might have been apt to suppose that the chemical experiments i.iat were first made to demon- strate the force of Steam as a mechanical agent, could have little relation to the objects of rehgion, or even to the comfort of human life and society. Yet it has now been applied to the impelling of ships and large boats along rivers and seas, in op- position'^to both wind and tide, and with a velocity which, at an average, exceeds that of any other conveyance. We have: no reason to believe that this invention has hitherto approxi- mated to a state of perfection ; it is yet in its infancy, and may be susceptible of such improvements^ both in point of expedi- tion and of safety, as may redder it the most comfortable and speedy conveyance between distant lands, for transporting the volume of inspiration, and the heralds of the gospel of peace to " the ends of the earth." By the help of his compass the mariner is enabled to steer his course in the midst of the ocean, in the most cloudy daysj and in the darkest nights, and to transport his vessel from one end of the world to another. It now only remains, that navigation be rendered safe, uniform and expeditious, and not dependant on adverse winds, or the currents of the ocean ; and) perhaps the art of propelling ves- sels by the force of steam, when arrived at perfection, may effectuate those desirable purposes. Even at present, as the invention now stands, were a vessel fitted to encounter the waves of the Atlantic, r^onstructed of a proper figure and STEAM NAVIGATION. 257 curvature, having a proper disposition of her wheels, and hav- ing such a description of fuel, as could be easily stowed, and in sufficient quantity for the voyage — at the rate often miles an hour, she could pass from the shores of Britain to the coast of America, in less than thirteen days ; — and, even at eight miles an hour, the voyage could be completed in little more than fif- teen days ; so that intelligence might pass and repass between the eastern and western Continents within the space of a sin- gle month — a space of time very little more than was requisite, sixty years ago, for conveying intelligence between Glasgow and London. The greatest distance at which any two places on the globe lie from each other, is about 12,500 miles ; and, therefore, if a direct portion of water intervene between them, this space could be traversed in fifty-four or sixty days. And, if the isthmus of Panama, which connects North and South America, and the isthmus of Suez, which separates the Medi- terranean from the Red Sea, were cut into wide and deep canals, (which we have no doubt will be accomplished as soon as civilized nations have access to perform operations in these territories,) every country in the world could then be reached from Europe, in nearly a direct line ; or, at most by a gentle curve, instead of the long, and dangerous, and circuitous route which must now be taken in sailing the eastern parts of Asia, and the north-western shores of America. By this means, eight or nine thousand miles of sailing would be saved in a voyage from England to Nootka Sound, or the Peninsula of California ; and more than six thousand miles, in passing from London to Bombay in the East Indies ; and few places on the earth would be further distant from each other by water than 15,000 miles ; which space might be traversed at the rate mentioned abovcj in a period trom sixty-two to seventy-seven days** But we have reason to believe, that when this invention, combined with other mechanical assistances, siiall approxi- mate nearer to perfection, a much more rapid rate of motion will be effected ; and the advantages of this, in a religious, as well as in a commercial point of view, may be easily appreci- ated ; especially at the present period, when the Christian world, now aroused from their slumbers, have formed the grand design of sending a Bible to every inhabitant of the globe. When the empire of the Prince of Darkness shall be shaken throughout all its dependencies, and the nations aroused to in- quire after light, and liberty, and divine knowledge — intelli- * See Appendix, No. IX. 22 258 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. geiice would thus be rapidly communicated over every region, and between the most distant tribes. " Many would run f6 and fro, and knowledge would b(3 increased." The Ambas- sadors of the Redeemer, with the Oracles of Heaven in their hands, and the words of salvation in their mouths, would quickly be transported to every clime, " having the everlast- ing gospel to preach to every nation, and kindred, and tongue, and people." Air Balloons. — Similar remarks may be applied to the invention of Air Balloons. We have heard of seme pious people who have mourned over such inventions,- and lamented the folly of mankind in studying their construction, and wit- nessing their exhibition. Such dispositions generally proceed from a narrow range of thought, and a contracted view of the Divine Economy and arrangements in the work of Redemp- tion. Though the perversity of mankind has often apphed useful inventions to foolish, and even to vicious purposes, yet this forms no reason why such inventions should be decried ; otherwise the art of Printing, and many other useful arts, might be regarded as inimical to the humfin race. We have reason to believe that air balloons may yet be brought to such perfection, as to be Applied to purposes highly beneficial to the progress of the human mind, and subservient, in some de- gree, for effecting the purposes of Providence in the enlighten- ing and renovation of mankind. For this purpose^ it is only requisite that some contrivance, ori chemical or mechanical principles, be suggested, analogous to the sails or rudder of a ship, by which they may be moved in any direction, without being directed sdlely by the course of the wind ; and, there can be little doubt that such a contrivance is jiossible to be ef- fected. It requires only suitable encouragement to be given to ingenious experimental philosophers, and a sufficient sum of money to enable them to prosecute their experiments on an extensive scale. To the want of such pre-requisites, it is chiefly owing, that the hifits on this subject, hitherto suggest- ed, have either failed of success, or have never been carried into execution. A more simple and expeditious process for filling balloons has lately been effected — the use of the para- chute, by which a person may detach himself from the balloon, and descend to the earth, has been successfully tried, — the lightning of heaven has been drawn from the clouds, and forced to act as a mechanical power in splitting immense stones to pieces, — the atmosphere has been analyzed into its component parts, and the wonderful properties of the ingre- dients of which it is composed, exhibited in their separate state: AIR BALLOONS. 259 and why, then, shouki we consider it as at all improbable that the means of producing a horizontal direction in aerial naviga- tion, may soon be discovered"? Were this object once efiected, balloons might be applied to the purpose of surveying and ex- ploring countries hitherto inaccessible, and of conveying the messengers of divine merCy to tribes of our fellow-men, whose existence is as yet unknown. We are certain that every portion of the inhabited world must be thoroughly explored, and its inhabitants visited, before the salvation of God can be carried fully into effect ; and, for the purpose of such explorations, we must, of course, resort to the inventions of human genius in art and science. Nu- merous tribes of the sons of Adam are, doubtless, residing in regions of the earth with which we have no acquaintance, and to which we have no access, by any of the modes of convey- ance presently in use. More than one-half of the interior parts of Africa and Asia, and even of America, are wholly unknown to the inhabitants of the civilized world. The vast regions of Chinese Tartary, Thibet, Siberia, and the adjacent districts ; almost the whole interior of Africa, and the continent of New Holland — the extensive isles of Borneo, Sumatra, New Guinea, and Japan, the territory of the Amazons, and the internal parts of North America, remain, for the most part, unknown and unexplored. The lofty and impassable ranges of moun- tains, and the deep and rapid rivers, which intervene between us and many of those regions, together with the savage and plundering hordes of men, and the tribes of ravenous beasts, through which the traveller must push his way — present to European adventurers, barriers which they cannot expect to surmount, by the ordinary modes of conveyance, for a lapse of ages. But, by balloons, constructed with an apparatus for directing their motions, all such obstructions would at once be surmounted. The most impenetrable regions, now hemmed in by streams and marshes, and lofty mountains, and a barba- rous population, would be quickly laid open ; and cities and nations, lakes and rivers, and fertile plains, to which we pre now entire strangers, would soon burst upon the view. And the very circumstance, that the messengers of peace and sal- vation descended upon such unknown tribes from the regions oj the clouds, might arouse their minds, and excite their attention and regard to the message of Divine mercy which they came thither to proclaim.* Such a scene (and it may probably be * In this point of view, we cannot but feel the most poignant regret at the conduct of tiie Spaniards, after the discovery of America, towards the 260 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER, realized) would present a literal fulfilment of the prediction of " angels flying' through the midst of^^ the aerial " heaven, having the everlasting gospel to preach to them that dwell upon the earth, and to every kindred and nation." That the attention of the philosophical world is presently directed to this subject, and that we have some prospect of the views above suggested being soon realized, will appear from the following notice, which lately made its appearance in the London Scientific Jourri^ls : — ^^ A Prize being offered for the discovery of a horizontal direction in Aerostation, M. Mingreli of Bologna, M. Pietripoli of Yenice, and M. Lember of Nu- remberg, have e^ch assumed the merit of resolving this pro- blem. It does not appear that any one of these has come forward to establish, by practical experiment, the validity of his claim ; but a pamphlet has lately been reprinted at Paris (first printed at Vienna) on this subject, addressed to all the learned Societies in Europe. The following passage appears in the work : — "Professor Robertson proposes to construct an acrostic machine, 150 feet in diameter, to be capable of raising 72,954 killograms, equivalent to 149,037 lbs. weight (French.) To be capable of conveying all necessaries for the support of sixty individuals, scientific characters, to be selected by the Academicians, and the aerial navigations to last for some months, exploring different heights and climates, &c. in a|l natives of that country. When those nntutored people beheld the shipg which had conveyed Columbus and his associates from the eastern world, the dresses and martial order of his troops, and heard their music, and the thunder of their cannon, they were filled with astonishment and wonder at the strange objects presented to their view ; they fell prostrate at their feet, and viewed them as a superior race of men. When Cortes afterwards entered the territories of Mexico, the same sentiments of r^everence and admiration seemed to pervade its inhabitants. Had pure Christian motrvfes actuated the minds of these adventurers, and had it been their ruling desire to communicate to those ignorant tribes the blessings of the Gospel of peace, and to administer to their external comfort, the circumstances now stated would have been highly favourable to the success of missionary ej^ertion, and would have led tliem to listen with attention to the message from heaven. But, unfortunately for the cause of religion, treachery, lust, cruelty, selfishness and the cursed love of gold, predominated over every other feeling, affixed a stigma to the Christian name, and rendered them curses, instee^cl of blessings, to that newly-discovered race of men. It is most earnestly to be wished, that, in future expeditions in quest of unknown tribes, a fcAv intelligent and philanthropic missionaries were appointed to direct the adventurers in their moral conduct and intercourse with the people they visit, in order that nothing inconsistent with Christian principle make its appearance. The uniform manifestation of Christian benevolence, purity, and rectitude, by a superior race oi men, v.ould win the affections of a rude people far more eUcctually tlum all the pomp and ensigns of miUtary parade. AIR BALLOONS. 261 seasons. If, from accident, or wear, t'ne machine, elevated above the ocean, should tail in its functions, to be furnished with a ship that will ensure the return of the Aeronauts." Should any one be disposed to insinuate, that the views now stated on this subject are chimerical and fallacious, I beg leave to remind them, that, not more than twenty years ago, the idea of a large vessel, without oars and sails, to be navigated against the wind, with the rapidity of ten miles an hour, would have been considered as next to an impossibility, and a mere fanciful scheme, which could never be realized. Yet we now behold such vehicles transporting whole villages to the places of their destination, with a degree of ease, comfort, ai.d ex- pedition, formerly unknown. And little more than forty years have elapsed, since it would have been viewed as still more chimerical to have broached the idea, that a machine might be constructed, by which human beings might ascend more than two miles above the surface of the earth, and fly through the region of the clouds at the rate of seventy miles an hour, carrying along with them books, instruments, and provisions. Yet both these schemes have been fully realized, and, like many other inventions of the human intellect, are doubtless intended to subserve some important ends in the economy of Divine Providence.* * Balloons were fir&t constructed in the year 1,733, by Messrs. S. and J. Mongolfier, paper-mar!,ufacturers at Annonay, in France. A sheep, a cock, and a duck, were the first animals ever carried up into tlie air by these vehicles. At the end of their journey, they were found perfectly safe and unhurt, and the sheep was even feeding at perfect ease. The first Imman being who ascended into the a,tmosphere in one of these machines, was M. Pilatre de Rozier. This adventui'er ascended from amidst an astonished multitude assembled in a garden in Paris, on the 15th Octobei-, 1783, in a balloon, whose diameter was 48 feet, and its height about 74 ; and remained suspended above the city about four hours. Mr. Lunardi, an Italian, soon after, astonished the people of England and Scotland, by his aerial excur sions. Dr. G. Gregory gives the following account of his ascent : — " I was myself a spectator of the flight of Limardi, and I never was present at a sight so interesting and sublime. The beauty of the gradual ascent, united with a sentiment of terror, on account of the danger of the man, and the novelty and grandeur of the whole appearance, are more than words can express. A delicate woman was so overcome with the spectacle, that she died upon the spot, as the balloon ascended ; several fainted ; and the silent admiration of the anxious multitude was beyond any thing I had ever beheld." Balloons have been generally made of varnished silk, and of the shape of a globe or a spheroid, from thirty to fifty feet in diameter. They are filled with hydrogen gas, which, as formerly stated, is from twelve to fifteen times lighter than common air: and they rise into the atmosphere, on the same principle as a piece of cork ascends from the bottom of a pail of water. The aerial travellers are seated in a basket below the balloc^, which is attached to it by means of cords. — The Parachute is an invention, 22^^ 262 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. Acoustic Tunnels. — By means of the inventions just now adverted to, when brought to perfection, mankind may be enabled to transport themselves to every region of the globe, with a much greater degree of rapidity than has hitherto been attained. By the help of the microscope, we are enabled to contemplate the invisible worlds of life, and by the telescope we can penetrate into regions far beyond the range of the unassisted eye. By the arts of Writing and Printing, we can communicate our sentiments, after a certain lapse of time, to every quarter of the world. In the progress of human know- ledge and improvement, it would obviously be of considerable importance, could we extend the range of the human voice, and communicate intelligence to the distance of a thousand miles, m the course of two or three hours ; or could we hold an occa- sional conversation with a friend at the distance of 20 or 30 miles. From the experiments which have been lately made, in reference to the conveyance of sound, we have some ^•e£^sor^ to believe, that such objects may not be altogether unattaina- ble. It has been long known, that wood is a good conductor of sound. If a watch be laid on the end of a long bes^m of timber, its beating will be distinctly heard, on applying the ear to the other end, though it could not be heard at the same dis- tance through the air. In " Nicholson^s Philosophical Journal" for February, 1803, Mr. E. Walker describes a simple appara- tus, connected with a speaking trumpet, by means of which, at the distance of 17^ feet, he held a conversation with another in whispers, too low to be heard through the air at that dis- tance. When the ear was placed in a certain position, the words were heard as if they had been spoken by an invisible being within the trumpet. And what rendered the deception still more pleasing, the words were more distinct, softer, and more musical, than if they had been spoken through the air. About the year 1750, a merchant of Cleves, named Joris- sen, who had become almost totally deaf, sitting one day near a harpsichord, while some one was playing, and having a tobacco-pipe in his mouth, the bowl of which rested accident- ally against the body of the instrument, he was agreeably and unexpectedly surprised to hear all the notes in the most dis- tinct manner. By a little reflection and practice, he again oy wliich the voyager, in cases of alarm, maybe enabled to desert his bal- loon in mid-air, and descend, without injury, to the ground. They resemble an umbrella, but are of far greater extent. With one of these contrivances, twenty-three feet in diameter, M. Garncrin, having detached liimself from his balloon, descended from a height of more than 4000 feet, and landed without shock or accident. ACOUSTIC TUNNELS. 263 obtained the use of this vakiable sense ; for he soon learned, by means of a piece of hard wood, one end of which he placed against his teeth, while another person placed the other end on his teeth, to keep up a conversation, and to be able to understand the least whisper. In this way, two persons who have stopped their ears may converse with each other, when they hold a long stick or a series of sticks, between their teeth, or rest their teeth against them. The effect is the same, if the person who speaks rest the stick against his throat, or his breast, or when one rests the stick which he holds in his teeth against some vessel into which the other speaks ; and the effect will be the greater, the more the vessel is capable of tremulous motion. These experiments demonstrate the faci- lity with which the softest whispers may be transmitted.^-^ Water, too, is found to be a good conductor of sound. Dr, Franklin assures us, that he has heard under water, at the distance of half a mile, the sound of two stones struck against each other. It has been also observed, that the velocity of sound is much greater in solid bodies, than in the air. By a series of experiments, instituted for the purpose of determm- ing this point, Mr. Chladni found that the velocity of sound, in certain solid bodies, is 16 or 17 times as great as in air. But what has a more particular bearing on the object hinted at above, is, the experiments lately made by M. Biot, " on the transmission of sound through solid bodies, and through air, in very long tubes." These experiments were made by means of long cylindrical pipes, which were constructing for conduits and aqueducts, to embellish the city of Paris. With regard to the velocitij of sound, it was ascertained that " its trans- mission through cast iron is lOi times as quick as through air." The pipes by which he wished to ascertain at what distance sounds are audible, were 1,039 yards, or nearly five furlongs, in length. M. Biot was stationed at the one end of this s'jries of pipes, and Mr. Martin, a gentleman who assisted in the experiments, at the other. They heard the lowest voice, so as perfectly to distinguish the words, and to keep up a conversation on all the subjects of the experiments. " I wished," says M. Biot, '* to determine the point at which the human voice ceases to be audible, but could not accomplish it : words spoken as low as when we whisper a secret in another's ear, were heard and understood ; so that not to be heard, there was but one resource, that of not speaking at all. — This mode of conversing with an invisible neighbor, is so singular that we cannot help being surprised, even though Hcquainted with the cause. Between a question and answer, 264 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. the interval was not greater than was necessary for the trans- mission of sound. For Mr. Martin and me, at the distance of 1,039 yards, this time was about 51 seconds." Reports of a pistol fired at one end, occasioned a considerable explosion at the other. The air was driven out of the pipe with suffi- cient force to give the hand a smart blow, to drive light sub- stances out of it to the distance of half a yard, and to extin- guish a candle, though it was 1,039 yards distant from the place where the pistol was fired. A detailed account of these experiments may be seen in JVicJiolson^s Phil. Jour, for October, 1811. Don Gautier, the inventor of the Telegraph, suggested also the method of conveying articulate sounds to a grea,t dista.nce. He proposed to build horizontal tunnels, widening at the remoter extremity, and found that at the dis, tance of 400 fathoms, or nearly half a mile, the ticking of a watch could be heard far better than close to the ear. He calculated that a series of such tunnels, would convey a mes-. sage 900 miles in an hour. Froiii the experiments now stated, it appears highly pro- bablCi that sounds may be conveyed to an indefinite distance. If one man can converse with another at the distance of nearly three quarters of a milci by means of the softest whisper, there is every reason to believe, that they could hold a conversa- tion at the distance of 30 or 40 miles, provided the requisite tunnels w^ere constructed for this purpose. The latter case does not appear more wonderful than the former. Were this point fully determined, by experiments conducted on a more extensive scale, a variety of interesting effects would follow, from a practical application of the results. A person at one end of a large city, at an appointed hour, might communicate a message^ or hold a conversation with his friend, at another ; friends in neighbouring, or even in distant towns, might hold an occasional correspondence by articulate sounds, and recog- nize each other's identity by their tones of voice. In the case of sickness, accident, or death, intelligence could thus be instantly communicated, and the tender sympathy of friends immediately exchanged. A clergyman sitting in his own room in Edinburgh, were it at any time expedient, might address a congregation in Musselburgh or Dalkeith, or even in Glasgow. He might preach the same sermon to his own church, and the next hour to an assembly at forty miles distant. And surely there could be no valid objection to trying the effect of an invisible preacher on a Christian audience. On similar prin- ciples, an apparatus might be constructed for augmenting the strength of the human vcrice, so as to make it extend its force PRACTICAL REMARKS. 265 to an assembled multitude, composed of fifty or a hmidred thousand individuals ; and the utility of such a power, when the mass of mankind are once thoroughly aroused to attend to rational and religious instruction, may be easily conceived. In short, intelligence respecting every important discovery, occurrence, and event, might thus be communicated, through the extent of a whole kingdom, within the space of an hour after it had taken place. Let none imagine that such a project is eithe-r chimerical or impossible. M. Biot's experiment is decisive, so far as it goes ; that the softest whisper^ without any diminution of its intensity, may be communicated to the distance of nearly three quarters of a mile ; and there is nothing but actual experi- ment wanting to convince us, that the ordinary tones of the human voice may be conveyed to at least twenty times that distance. We are just now acting on a similar principle, in distributing illumination through large cities. Not thirty years ago, the idea of lighting our apartments by an invisible sub- stance, produced at ten miles' distance, would have been con- sidered as chimerical, and as impossible to be realized, as the idea of two persons conversing together, by articulate sounds, at such a distance. It appears no more wonderful, that we should be able to hear at the distance of five or six miles, than that we should be enabled to see objects at that distance by the telescope, as distinctly as if we were within a i^w yards o them. Both are the effects of those principles and laws whicl the Creator has interwoven with the system of the material world ; and when man has discovered the mode of their oper- ation, it remains with himself to apply them to his necessities. What the telescope is to the eye, acoustic tunnels would be to the ear ; and thus, those senses on which our improvement in knowledge and enjoyment chiefly depends, would be gradually carried to the utmost perfection of which our station on earth will permit. And, as to the expense of constructing such com munications for soimd, the tenth part of the millions of money expended in twenty-two years' war in which we were lately engaged, would, in all probabihty, be more than sufficient for distributing them in numerous ramifications, through the whole island of Great Britain, Even although such a project were partially to fail of success, it would be a far more honorable and useful national undertaking, than that which now occupies the attention of the despots on the continent of Europe, and might be accomplished witl;^ far less expenditure, either of blood or of money, Less than the fourth part of a million of pounds would be sufficient for trying an experiment of this 266 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. kind, on an extensive scale ; and such a sum is considered as a mere item, when fleets and armies are to be equipped for car- rying destruction through sea and land. When will the war- madness cease its rage ! When will men desist from the work of destruction, and employ their energies and their treasures in the cause of human improvement ! The m^ost chimerical projects that were ever suggested by the most enthusiastic visionary, are not half so ridiculous, and degrading to the character of man, as those ambitious and despotic schemes, in which the powers of the earth in all ages have been chiefly en- gaged, — But on this topic it is needless to enlarge, till more extended experiments shall have been undertaken. In the preceding sketches I have presented a few specimens of the relation which the inventions of human ingenuity bear to religious objects. I intended to have traced the same rela- tion in several other instances ; in the invention of the elec- trical machine, the air-p\mip, mills, clocks and watches, gas- lights, chemical fumigations, inventions for enabling us to walk upon the water, to prevent and alleviate the dangers of shipwreck, &c. &c. But, as my prescribed limits will not permit farther enlargement, I trust that what has been already stated will be sufficient to establish and illustrate my general position. From this subject we may learn — 1st, That the various processes of art, and the exertions of human ingenuity, are imder the special direction of Him who arranges all things " according to the counsel of his will." As " the Idng's heart is in the hand of the Lord, and as the rivers of waters, he turns it whithersoever he pleases ;" so, all the varied schemes and movements of the human mind, the discoveries of science, and the diversified experiments of mechanics, chemists and philosophers, are directed in such channels as may issue in the accomplishment of Plis eternal purposes, in respect to the present and future condition of the inhabitants of our world. This truth is also plainly taught us in the records of inspiration, "Doth the ploughman plough all day to sow 1 Doth he open and break the clods of his ground 1 When he hath made plain the face thereof, doth he not cast abroad the fitches, and scatter the cummin,* and cast in the wheat in the principal [place,] and the barley in the appointed place, and the rye in its proper place ? For his Go^ doth in- struct him to discretion, and doth teach him. This also cometh forth from the Lord of hosts, who is wonderful in counsel, and * Fitches is a kind of seed frequently sown in Jndea, for the use of cat- tle J and cummin is the seed of a plant somewhat like fennel. MILLENNIAL ERA. 267 excellent ill working." Agriculture has, by most nations, been attributed to the suggestions of Deity ; lor " every good and perfect gift cometh down from the Father of lights." It is he who hath taught men to dig from the bowels of the earth, iron, copper, lead, silver and gold, and to apply them to useful purposes in social hfe ; and who hath given them " wisdom and understanding" to apply the animal and vegetable produc- tions of nature to the manufacture of cloths, linen, muslin, and silk, for the use and the ornament of man. For " all things are of God." " Both riches and honor come from him, and he reigneth over all, and in his hand is power and might, and in his hand it is to make great, and to give strength to all." When tile frame of the Mosaic Tabernacle, and all its curious vessels were to be constructed, the mind of Bezaleel " was tilled with the spirit of God, in wisdom and understanding, and in knowledge, and in all manner of workmanship, to devise curious works in gold, and in silver, and in brass." And, when the fabric of the New Testament church is to be reared, and its boundaries are extended, artificers of every description, ade- quate for carrying on the different parts of the works are raised upj and inspired with the spirit of their respective de- partments — some with the spirit of writing, printing, and pub- lishing ; some with the spirit of preaching, lecturing, and cate- chising ; some with the spirit of fortitude, to make bold and daring adventures into distant barl^arous climes ; and others, with the spirit of literature, of science, and of the mechanical arts — all acting as pioneers " to prepare the w ay of the Lord," and as builders for carrying forward and completing the fabric of the Christian Church. 2dly, All the mechanical contrivances to which I have ad- verted, all the discoveries of science, and all the useful inven- tions of genius which may hereafter be exhibited, ought to be viewed as preparing the way for the millennial o'aof the church, and as having a certain tendency to the melioration of the ex- i lernal condition of mankind during its continuance. We are i certain, from the very nature of things, as well as from scrip- tural predictions, that, when this period advances towards the Summit of its glory, the external circumstances of this world's population will be comfortable, prosperous, and greatly melio- rated beyond what they have ever been in the ages that are past — " Then shall the earth yield her increase, and God, even our own God, shall bless us. Then shall he give the rain of thy seed, that thou shalt sow thy ground withal, and bread of the increase of the earth ; and it shall bo fat and plenteous. In that day shall thy cattle fee J in laigc [Mstiires; the oxen hke- 268 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. wise and the young asses that ear the ground shall eat savoury provender, which hath been winnowed with the shovel and with the fan. And the inhabitants shall not say, I am sick. They shall build houses and inhabit them, and plant vineyards, and eat the fruit of them. They shall not build, and another inhabit ; they shall not plants and another eat ; for, as the days of a tree are the days of my feoph-^ and mine elect shall long enjoy the work of their handsi They shall not labor in vain, nor bring forth for trouble ; for they are the seed of the blessed of the Lord, and their offspring with them. The seed shall be |)rosperous, the vine shall give her fruit, and the ground shall give her increase, and the heavens shall give their dew ; the evil beasts shall cease out of the land, and they shall sit every tnan under his vine, and under his fig-tree, and none shall make him afraid ; for wars shall cease to the ends of the world, and the knowledge d^ the Lord shall cover the earth as the waters cover the sea."* Diseases will be, in a great measure, banished from the world, and the life of man extended far be- yond its present duration — agriculture will be brought to per- fection — -commodious habitations erected for the comfortable accommodation of all ranks — cities built on elegant and spa- cious plans, adapted to health, ornament, and pleasure ; di- vested of all the filthy and darkness, and gloom, and nan*ow lanes which now disgrace the abodes of men — roads will be constructed on improved principles, with comfortable means of retreat for shelter and accommodation of all seasons ; and conveyances invented for the ease, and safety, and rapid con veyance of persons and property from one place to another. Either the climates of the earth will be meliorated, by the uni- versal cultivation of the soil, so that storms and tempests, thunders and lightnings, shall no longer produce their present ravages : or chemical and mechanical contrivances will be in- vented to ward off their destructive effects. The landscape of the earth will be adorned with vegetable and architectural beauty ; and, instead of horse-racing, demoralizing plays, routs, and masquerades, boxing, and bull-baits — artificial dis- plays of scenery will be exhibited, more congenial to the dig- nity of rational, renovated, and immortal minds. For " the knowledge of the Lord," and the "beauties of holiness," will pervade men of all ranks and ages, " from the least even to the greatest, "j" + Psalm Ixvii. Isaiah xxx. 23, 24. xxxiii. 24. Ixv. 21, 23, &c. 1 The various ciivumsfanf-es above-stated rnay be considered as llio natural rc:mUs ol'ii. state of society on which llie lij^hl of ycit.uce and of rt\e- MILLEINNIAL ERA. 269 Now, as we have no reason to expect any miraculous inter' ference, we must regard the past, and the future useful inven- tions of philosophy and mechanics, as having a hearing on this glorious period, and a tendency to promote the improvement an J the fehcity of those who shall live during this era of Mes- siah's reign. If diseases are to be generally abolished, it will be owing to the researches of the scientific physician in dis- covering certain antidotes against every disorder, and to the practice of tem})erance, meekness, equanimity of mind, and every other means of preserving the vigor of the animal frame. If the earth is to produce its treasures m abundance, and with ;ittle labour, it will be owing, in part, to the improvement of agricultural science, and of the instruments by which its opera- tions are conducted. If the lightnings of heaven shall no longer prove destructive to man and to the labors of his hands, it will be effected either by machinery for drawing off the electricity of a stormy cloud, or by the invention of thunder- guards^ w hich shall afford a compU^te protection from its rav- ages. In these, and numerous other instances, the inventions of men, under the guidance of the Spirit of Wisdom, will have a tendency to remove a great part of the Curse which has so long hung over our sinful world. And since the inven- tions of human skill and ingenuity for the melioration of man- kind, and for the swift conveyance of intelhgence have, of late years, been rapidily increasing, at the same time when the Christian world is roused to increased exertions in diSnemina- ting the Scriptures throughout all lands, when general know- ledge is increasingly diffused, and when the fabric of Supersti- tion and Despotism is shaking to its foundations, — these com- bined and simultaneous movements seem plainly to indicate, that that auspicious era is fast hastening on, when " the glory of Jehovah shall be revealed, and all flesh shall see it together," when "righteousness and praise shall spring forth before all ?!a.tion hcis diffused its full influence, and where the active powers of the human mind arc invariably directed by the pure principles and precepts of Christianity, That the duration of human life, at the era referred to, will be extended beyond its present boundary, appears to be intimated in some of the passages above quoted, particularly the following — ^'■Jls the days of a tree shall be the days of my people, and mine elect shall long enjoy the work of their hands." And, if the life of man Avill be thus protracted to an in- , definite period, it will follow, that those diseases which now prey upon the human frame, and cut short its vital action, will be in a great measure ex- tirpated. Both these effects may be viewed (without supposing any mira culous interference) as the natural consequence of that happiness and equanimity of mind which will flow from the practice of Christian virtues, from the enlfirffemcnt of our knowledge of the princi[)lps of nature, and ff^v;; :•• '■'.- ■ --.i .•-;■— •■ ■.' ■ .\Uir\x cn<;h aHta'e ul\--"-iv !y w'" '^<'■^^<^^^. 270 tHE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. nations," and when " Holiness to the Lord," shall be inscribed on all the pursuits, and implements, and employments of men. Lastly, — If the remarks suggested above be well founded, we may conclude, that the mechanical and philosophical inven- tions of genius are worthy of the attentive consideration of the enlightened Christian, particularly in the relation they may have to the accomplishment of religious objects. He should contemplate the experiments of scientific men, not as a waste of time, or the mere gratification of an idle curiosity, but as embodying the germs of those improvements, by which civili- zation, domestic comfort, knowledge, and moral principle may be diffused among the nations. To view such objects with apathy and indifference, as beneath the regard of a religious character, argues a weak and limited understanding, and a contracted view of the grand operations of a Superintending Providence. CHAPTER IV. SCRIPTURAL DOCTRINES AND FACTS ILLUSTRATED FROM THE SYSTEM OF NATURE.* Without spending time in any introductory observations on this subject, it may be remarked in general, I. — That scientific knowledge^ or an acquaintance with the System of JVature, may frequently serve as a guide to the true interpretation of Scripture, rt may be laid down as a universal principle, that there can be no real discrepancy between a just interpretation of Scrip- ture, and the facts of physical science ; and on this principle, the following canon is founded, which may be considered as an infallible rule for Scripture-interpretation, namely, — That no interpretation of Scripture ought to be admitted which is inconsistent with any well-authenticated facts in the material ivorld. By well-authenticated facts, I do not mean the theories of philosophers, or the deductions they may have drawn from them, nor the confident assertions or plausible reasonings of scientific men in support of any prevailing system of Natural science ; but those facts which are universally admitted, and the reality of which every scientific inquirer has it in his power to ascertain : such as that the earth is not an extended plane, but a round or globular body, and that the rays of the sun, when converged to a focus by a large convex glass, will set fire to combustible substances. Such tacts, when ascertained, ought to be considered as a revelation from God, as well as the declarations of his word. For they make known to us a * Under this head, it was originally intended to embrace an elucidation of a considerable variety of the facts recorded in the Sacred History, and of the allusions of the inspired writers to the system of nature ; but as tJie volume has already swelled beyond the limits propot^etl, I am reluctantly compelled to confine myself to the illustration of only two or three topics. 272 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. portion of his character, of his plans and his operations. — This rule may be otherwise expressed as follows : — Where a passage of Scripture is of doubtful meaning, or capable of dif- ferent interpretation^ that interpretation ought to be preferred u'hich will best agree with the established discoveries of science. For since the Author of revelation and the Author of univer- sal nature is one and the same Infinite Being, — there must exist a complete harmony between the revelations of his word, and the facts or relations which are observed in the material universe. To suppose the contrary, would be to suppose the Almighty capable of inconsistency ; a supposition which would go far to shake our confidence in the theology of Nature, as well as of Revelation. If, in any one instance, a Record claiming to be a Revelation from heaven were found to con- tradict a well-known fact in the material \\ orld ; if, for exam- ple, it asserted, m express terms, to be literally understood, that the earth is a quiescent body in the centre of the universe, or that the 'moon is no larger than a mountain; it would be a fair conclusion, either that the revelation was not Divine, or that the passages embodying such assertions are interpolations, or, that science, in reference to these points, has not yet arri- ved at the truth. The example, we are aware, is inapplicable to the Christian Revelation, which rests securely on its own basis, and to which science is gradually approximating, as it advances in the amplitude of its views, and the correctness of its deductions ; — but it shows us how necessary it is, in inter- preting the Word of God, to keep our eye fixed upon his Works ; for we may rest assured, that truth in the one will always correspond with fact in the other. To illustrate the rule now laid down, an example or two may be stated. — If it be a fact that geological research has ascertained that the materials of the strata of the earth, are of a more ancient date than the Mosaic account of the com- mencement of the present race of men ; the passages in the first chapter of Genesis, and other parts of Scri})ture, which refer to the origin of our world, must be explained as convey- ing the idea, that the earth was then merely arranged into its present form and order, out of the materials which previoushj existed in a confused mass, and which had been crca^ted by ?lie Almighty at a prior period in duration. For Moses no where asserts, that the materials of our globe Mere created, or brou?;lit into existence out of nothing, at the time to which his history refers ; but insinuates the contrary. '.' For the earth," says he, prior to its present constitution, ". was without form and void," &c. — Again, if it be a fact that the universe is iu- SCRIPTURAL FACTS ILLUSTRATED. 273 definitely extended, that, of many millions of vast globes which diversify the voids of space, only two or three have anv im- mediate connexion with the earth ; then it will appear most reasonable to conclude, that those expressions in the Mosaic history of the creation, which refer to the creation of the fixed stars, are not to he understood as referring to the time when they were brought into existence, as if they had been created about the same time with our earth ; but, as simply declaring the fact, that, at what period soever in duration they were cre- ated, they derived their existence from God. That they did not all commence their existence at that period, is demon- strable from the fact, that, within the space of 2000 years past, and even within the space of the two last centuries, new stars have appeared in the heavens, which previously did not exist in the concave of the firmament ; which, consequently, have been created since the Mosaic period ; or, at least, had undergone a change analogous to that which took place in our globe, when it emerged from a chaotic state, to the form and order in which we now behold it. Consequently, the phrase, " God rested from all his works," must be understood, not absolutely, or in reference to the whole system of nature, but merely in relation to our world ; and as importing, that the Creator then ceased to form any new species of beings on the terraqueous globe. — The same canon will direct us in the in- terpretation of those passages which refer to the last judgment, and the destruction of the present constitution of our globe. When, in reference to these events, it is said, " that the stars shall fall from heaven," that " the powers of heaven shall be shaken," and that " the earth and the heaven shall flee away," our knowledge of the system of nature leads us to conclude, either that such expressions are merely metaphorical, or that they describe only the ap2)ear0,nce, not the reality of things. For it is impossible that the stars can ever fall to the earth, since each of them is of a size vastly superior to our globe, and could never be attracted to its surface, without unhinging the laws and the fabric of universal nature. The appearance, however, of the " heaven fleeing away," would be produced, should the earth's diurnal rotation, at that period, be suddenly stopped, as will most probable happen ; in which case, all nature in this sublunary system, would be thrown into contu- sion, and the heavens, with all their host, would appear to flee away. Now, the scientific student of Scripture alone can judi- ciously apply the canon to which I have adverted ; he alone can appreciate its utility in the interpretation of the sacred 23* 274 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. oracles ; for he knows the facts which the philosopher and the astronomer have ascertained to exist in the system of nature ; from the want of which information, many divines, whose comments on Scripture have, in other respects^ been judicious,' have displayed their ignorance, and fallen into egre- gious blunders, when attempting to explain the lirst chapters oi Genesis, and several parts of the book of Job^ v/hich have tended to bring discredit on the oracles of heaven. II. — The System of Nature Confirms and Illustrates the Scriptural Doctrine of the Depravity of Man. In the preceding parts of this volume, I have stated several striking instances of Divine benevolence, which appear in the construction of the organs of the animal system, in the con- stitution of the earth, the waters, and the atmosphere, and ir. the variety of beauties and subhmities which adorn the face o' nature ; ail which proclaim, in language wdiich can scarcely be mistaken, that the Creator has a special regard to the hap piness of his creatures. — Yet the Scriptures uniformly de- clare, that man kas fallen from his primeval state of inno- cence, and has violated the laws of his Maker ; that " his heart is deceitful above all things, and desperately wicked ;" and that " destruction and misery are in his ways." Obser- vation and experience also demonstrate, that a moral disease pervades the whole human family, from the most savage to the most civilized tribes of mankind ; which has displayed its virulence in those wars and devastations which have, in all ages, convulsed the world ; and which daily displays ilself in those acts of injustice, fraud, oppression, malice, tyranny, and cruelty, which are perpetrated in every country, and among all the ranks even of civilized life. That a world inhabited by moral agents of this description would display, in its phy- sical constitution, certain indications of its Creator's displea- sure, is what we should naturally expect, from a consideration of those attributes of his nature with which we are acquainted. Accordingly, we find, that, amidst all the evidences of benevo- lence which our globe exhibits, there are not wanting, certain displays of ** the wrath of Heaven against the ungodliness and unrighteousness of men," in order to arouse them to tt sense of their guilt, and to inspire them with reverence and awe of that Being whom they have offended. The following facts, among many others, may be considered as corroborating this position. In the first place, the present state of the interior strata of DEPRAVITY OF MAN. 275 the earth may be considered as a presumptive evidence, that a moral revolution has taken place since man was placed upon the globe. When we penetrate into the interior recesses of the earth, we find its ditfcrent strata bent into the most irre- gular forms ; sometimes lying horizontally, sometimes pro- / jecting upwards,, and sometimes downwards, and thrown into ^' confusion ; as if some dreadful concussion had spread its ravages through every part of the solid crust of our globe. This is visible in every region of the earth. Wherever the miner penetrates among his subterraneous recesses, wherever he fissures and caverns of the earth are explored, and wherever the mountains lay bare their rugged cliffs, the marks of ruin, convvdsion, and disorder meet the eye of the beholder. Evidences of these facts are to be found in the records of all intelligent travellers and geologists who have visited Alpine districts, or explored the subterraneous regions of the earth ; of which I have already stated a few instances, in the article of Geology, pp. 160, 165, 166. — These facts seem evidently to indicate that the earth is not now in the same state in which it originally proceeded from the hand of its Creator ; for such a scene of disruption and derangement appears incompatible with that order, harmony and beauty Vvhich are apparent in the other departments of nature. We dare not assert, that such terrible convulsions took place by chance, or indepen- dent of the will of the Creator ; nor dare we insinuate, that they were the effects of a random display of Almighty Power ; and, therefore, we are necessarily led to infer, that a moral cause, connected with the conduct of the rational inhabitants of the globe, must have existed, to warrant so awful an inter- position of Divine Power ; for the fate of the animated beings wh.ch then peopled the earth, was involved in the conse- quences which must have attended this terrible catastrophe. The volume of Revelation on this point, concurs with the de- ductions of reason, and assigns a cause adequate to warrant the production of such an extraordinary effect. " The wick- ■ edness of man Avas great upon the earth ; the earth was FILLED WITH VIOLENCE ; evciy purposc and desire of man's heart was only evil continually." Man had frustrated the^nd of his existence ; the earth was turned into a habita- tion of demons ; the long period to which his life was pro- tracted, only served to. harden him in his wickedness, and to enable him to carry his diabolical schemes to their utmost extent, till the social state of the human race became a scene ^ of unmixed depravity and misery. And the physical effects of the punishment of this universal defection from God, are 276 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. presented to our .view in every land, and will remain to all ages, as a visible memorial that man has rebelled against the authority of his Maker. * 2. The existence of Volcanoes^ and the terrible ravages they produce, bear testimony to the state of man as a depraved iutelligence. A volcano is a mountain, generally ot^ an im- mense size, from whose summit issue lire, smoke, sulphur, and torrents of melted lava, (see p. 141.) Previous to an eruption, the smoke, which is continually ascending from the crater, or opening in the top, increases and shoots up to an immense height ; forked lightning issues from the ascending column ; showers of ashes are thrown out to the distance of forty or fifty miles ; volleys of red hot stones are discharged to a great height in the air ; the sky appears thick and dark ; the luminaries of heaven disappear ; and these terrible fore- bodings are accompanied with thunder, lightning, frequent concussions of the earth, and dreadful subterraneous bellow- ings. When these alarming appearances have continued sometimes four or five months, the lava begins to make its appearance, either boiling over the top, or forcing its way through the side of the mountain. This fiery deluge of melted minerals rolls down the declivity of the mountain, forming a dismal flaming stream, sometimes fourteen milea long, six miles broad, and 200 feet deep. In its course, it destroys orchards, vineyards, cornfields, and villages ; and sometimes cities, containing twenty thousand inhabitants, have been swallowed up and consumed. Several other phe- nomena, of awful sublimity, sometimes accompany these eruptions. In the eruption of Vesuvius, in 1794, a shock of an earthquake was felt ; and, at the same instant, a fountain of bright fire, attended M-ith the blackest smoke, and a loud report, was seen to isiiue, and to rise to a great height from the cone of the mountain ; and vv as soon succeeded by fifteen other fiery fountains, all in a direct line, extending for a mile and a half downwards. This fiery scene was accompanied with the loudest thunder, the incessant reports of which, like those of a numerous heavy artillery, were attended by a con- tinued hollow murmur, similar to tliat of the roarhig of the ocean during a violent storm. The houses in Naples, at seven miles' distance, were for several hours in a constant tremor ; the bells ringing, and doors and windows incessantly rattling and shaking. The murmur of the prayers and lamen- tations of a numerous population added to the horrors of the scene. All travellers, who have witnessed these eruptions, ?eem to be at a loss to find words sufficiently emphatic to lor.PRAVITY OF MAN. 277 express the terrors of the scene. " One cannot form a juster idea," says Bishop Berkley, " of the noise emitted by the mountain, than by i-magining a mixed sound made up of the raging of a tempest, the murmur of a troubled sea, and the roaring of thunder and artillery, confused altogether. Though we heard this at the distance of twelve miles, yet it was very terrible.^^ In 1744, the flames of Cotopaxi, in South Ame- rica, rose 3,000 feet above the brink of the crater, and its roarings were heard at the distance of six hundred miles. " At the port of Guayaquil, 150 miles distant from the crater," says Humboldt, " we heard, day and night, the noise of this volcano, like continued discharges of a battery, and we distin- guished these tremendous sounds even on the Pacific ocean." The ravages produced by volcanoes are in proportion to the terror they inspire. In the eruption of Etna, in 1669, the stream of lava destroyed, in 40 days, the habitations of 27,000 persons ; and, of 20,000 inhabitants of the city of Catania, only 3,000 escaped. In the year 79, the celebrated cities of Pompeii and Ilerculaneum were completely overwhelmed and buried underground by an eruption of Vesuvius, and the spots on which they stood remained unknown for. 1600 years. Smce that pejiod, about 40 eruptions have taken place, each of them producing the most dreadful ravages. But the vol- canoes of Asia and AiTierica are still more terrible and de- structive than those of Europe. The volcanic mountain Pichinca, near Quito, caused, on one occasion, the destruction of 35,000 mhabitants. In the year 1772, an eruption of a mountain m the island of Java, destroyed 40 villages, and several thousands of the inhabitants ; and in October, 1822, eighty-eight hamlets, and above 2000 persons, were destroyed in the same island, by a sudden eruption from a new volcano. The eruption of Tomboro, in the island of Sumbawa, in 1815, was so dreadtul, that all the Moluccas, Java, Sumatra, and : Borneo, to the distance of a thousand miles from the moun- tain, felt tremulous motions, and heard the report of explo- sions. In Java, at the distance of 340 miles, the clouds of ashes from the volcano produced utter darkness. Volcanoes are more numerous than is generally imagined They are to be found in every quarter of the world, from the icy shores of Kamtschatka to the mountains of Patagonia. Humboldt enumerates 40 volcanoes constantly burning, be- tween Cotopaxi and the Pacific Ocean ; 20 have been observed in the chain of mountains that stretches along Kamtschatka ; and many of them are to be seen in the Phillippines, the Moluccas, the Cape de Verd, the Sandwich, the Ladrone, and tUS THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER other islands in the Indian and Pacific ocean«?. It i-s stated in vol. 6th of Sup. to Enc-y. Brit, lately published, that about 205 volcanoes are known, including only those which have been active within a period to which history or tradition reaches. Europe contains 14 ; and, of the whole number, it is computed, that 107 are in islands, and 98 on the great continents. Can we then suppose, that so many engines of terror and destruction, dispersed over every quarter of the globe, are consistent with the conduct of a benevolent Creator towards an innocent race of men ? If so, we must either admit that the Creator had it not i^ his power, when arranging our terrestrial system, to prevcjit the occasional action of these dreadful ravagers, or, that he is indifferent to the happiness of his innocent ojffspring. The former admission is inconsistent with the idea of his Omnipotence, and the latter, with the idea of his universal Benevolence. It is not, therefore, enthu- siasm, but the fairest deduction of reason to conclude, that they are indications of God's displeasure against a race ot transgressors who have apostatized from his laws. 3. The same reasoning will apply to the ravages produced by earthquakes. Next to volcanoes, earthquakes are the most terrific phenomena of nature, and are even far more destructive to man, and to the labors of his hands. An earth- quake, which consists in a sudden motion of the earth, is generally preceded by a nnnbling sound, sometimes like that of a number of carriages driving furiously along the pavement of a street, sometimes like the rushing noise of a mighty wind, and sometimes like the explosions of artillery. Their effect on the surface of the earth is various. Sometimes it is instan- taneously heaved up in a perpendicular direction, and some- times it assuuies a kijid of rolling motion, from side to side. — The ravages which earthquakes have produced, are terrible beyond description ; and are accomplished almost in a mo- ment. In 1692, the city of Port-Royal, in Jamaica, was destroyed by an earthquake, in the space of two minutes, and the houses sunk into a gulph forty fhthoms deep. In 1693, an earthquake happened in Sicily, which either destroyed, or greatly damaged, fifty-four cities, and an incredible number of villages. The city of Catania was utterly overthrown : the sea all of a sudden began to roar ; mount Etna to send forth immense spires of flame ; and immediately a shock ensued, as if all the artillery in the world had been discharged. The birds flaw about astonished ; the sun was darkened ; the beasts ran howling from the hills ; a dark cloud of dust covered the air ; DEPRAVITY OF MAN. 279 and, though the shock did not last three minutes, yet nine- teen thousand of the inhal)itants of the city perished in the ruins. This shock extended to a circumference of 7000 miles. Earthquakes have been producing their ravages in various parts of the world, and in every age. Pliny informs us, that 12 cities in Asia Minor were swallowed up in one night. In ihe year 115, the city of Antioch, and a great part of the adja- cent country, were buried by an earthquake. About 300 vears after, it was again destroyed, along with 40,000 inhabi- tants ; and, after an interval of only 60 years, it was a third time overturned, with the loss of not less than 60,000 souls. In 1755, Lisbon was destroyed by an earthquake, and it buried under its ruins above 50,000 inhabitants. The effects of this terrible earthquake were felt over the greater part of Europe and Africa, and even in the midst of the Atlantic ocean ; and are calculated to have extended over a space of not less than four millions of square miles. In August, 1822, two-thirds of the city of Aleppo, which contained 40,000 houses, and 200,000 inhabitants, Avere destroyed by an earthquake, and nearly thirty thousand inhabitants were buried under the ruins. — To suppose that the human beings who have been victims to the ravages of earthquakes and volcanoes, " were sinners above all those who dwelt around them," would be the height of impiety and presumption. But, the fact that thousands of rational beings have been swept from existence, in a manner so horrible and tremendous, seems plainly to indicate, that they belonged to a race of apostate intelligences, who had violated the commands of their Creator. Such visitations are quite accordant to the idea of man being in the condition of a transgressor ; but, if he were an innocent creature, they would be altogether unaccountable, as happening under the govern- ment of a Being of unbounded benevolence. 4. The phenomena of thunder-storms, tempests, and hurri- canes, and the ravages they produce, are also presumptive proofs that man is a depraved mtelligence. In that season of the year when Nature is arrayed in her most beautiful attire, and the whole terrestrial landscape tends to inspire the mind with cheerfulness — suddenly a sable cloud emerges from the horizon — the sky assumes a baleful aspect — a dismal gloom envelopes the face of nature — the lightnings flash from one end of the horizon to another — the thunders roll with awful majesty along the verge of heaven, till at length they burst over head in tremendous explosion?^. The sturdy oak is shat- tered and despoiled of its foliage ; rocks are rent mto shivers ; 280 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. and the grazing herds are struck into a lifeless ajroup. Even man is not exempted from danger in the midst of this appall- ing scene. For hundreds in every age have fallen victims either to the direct stroke of the lightning, or to the concus- sions and conflagrations with which it has been attended. In tropical countries, the phenomena of thunder-storms are more dreadful and appalling, than in our temperate climate. The thunder frequently continues for days and weeks in almost one incessant roar ; the rains are poured down in torrents ; and the flashes of lightning follow each other in so rapid a succes- sion, that the whole atmosphere arid the surrounding hills seem to be in a blaze. In some instances, the most dreadful effects have been produced by the bursting of an electrical cloud. In 1772, a bright cloud was observed at midnight to cover a mountain in the Island of Java ; it emitted globes ot fire so luminous, that the night became as clear as day. Its effects were astonishing. Every thing Wa:s destroyed for 7 leagues round ; houses were demolished ; plantations buried in the earth ; and 2140 people lost their lives, besides 1500 head of cattle, and a vast number of horses and other animals; — Eiicij. Brit.— Art. Cloud. Is it not reasonable, then, to conclude, that such awful phe- nomena as storms, volcanoes, and earthquakes, are so many occasional indications of the frov/n of an offended Creator upon a race of transgressors, in order to arouse them to a sense of their apostacy from the God of heaven ? We cannot con- ceive that such physical operations, accompanied by so many terrific and destructive effects^ are at all compatible with the idea that man is at present m a paradisiacal state, and pos- sessed of that moral purity in which he was created. Such appaling displays of Almighty power are m complete unison with the idea, that man is a trangressor^ and that the present dispensations of God are a mixture of mercy and of judgment ; but if he belong to an innocent race of moral intelligences, they appear quite anomalous, and are altogether inexplicable,' on the supposition, that a Being of infinite benevolence and rectitude directs the operations of the physical and moral world ; more especially when we consider the admirable care which is displayed in the construction of animal bodies, iri order to prevent pain, and to produce pleasurable sensations. When man was first brought into existence, his thoughts and affections, we must suppose, were in unison with the will of his Creator ; fiis mind was serene and unruflled ; and, con- sequently, no foreboding apprehensions oT danger would, in sr^M-h • ^;;-i.{ N Uik- p'>::^c:^;i >.: of hi.^ brr-isf. f?!Tr;ifler he hi;d , DEPRAVITY OF MAN. 281 swerved from the path of primeval reetitude, and especially after the Deluge had swept away tlic inhabitants of the Ante- diluvian world, the constitution of the earth and the atmosphere seems to have undergone a mighty change, corresponding to the degraded state into which he had fallen ; so that those very elements which may have formerly ministered to his enjoy- ment — by being formed into ditFerent combinations — now con- spire to produce terror and destruction. The same important conclusion might have been deduced, from a consideration of the immense deserts of marshes and barren sands which are dispersed over the globe — the vast and frightful regions of ice around the poles — the position of the mineral strata, and the vast disproportion which the extent of the dry land bears to the expanse of the ocean — all which cir- cumstances, and many others, in conjunction with the facts above-stated, conspire to show, that man no longer stands in the rank of a pure intelligence ; and that his habitation cor- responds, in some degree, to his state of moral degradation. By overlooking this consideration, St. Pierre, and other natu- ralists have found themselves much at a loss, when attempting to vindicate the wisdom and equity of Providence, in the phy- sical disorders which exist in the present constitution of our globe. The circumstance, that man is a fallen creature, ap- pears the only clue to guide us in unravelling the mysteries oi Providence^ and to enable us to perceive the harmony and con- sistency of the Divine operations in the system of nature ; and no other consideration will fully account for the disorders which exist in the present economy of our world. But, it is a most consoling consideration, that, amidst all the physical evils which abound, the benevolence and mercy of God are admirably blended with the indications of his dis- pleasure. Thunder-storms and tempests contribute to the purification of the atmosphere : and volcanoes are converted Into funnels for vomiting up those fiery materials which pro duce earthquakes, and which might otherwise swallow up whole provinces in one mighty gulf. In the ordinary course of things, such phenomena are more terrific than destructive ; and are calculated rather to rouse an unthinking world to con- sideration^ than to prove the instruments of human destruc- tion. Compared with the miseries which men have volunta- rily inflicted on one another, the destructive cfiects of the ele- ments of nature dwindle into mere temporary and trifling acci- dents. Wo have reason to believe, that a much greater destruc- tion of human beings has been produced by two or three of the late battles in modem Euro])e, such a;- th'>se of ^Vaterloo, 282 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPH Borodina, and Smolensko, than has been produced by all th«a electrical storms» earthquakes, and volcanic eruptions, which have raged for the space of a hundred years. It has been calcu- lated, that during the Russian campaign of 1812, including men, women, and children, belonging to the French and Russians, there were not less than five hundred thousand human victims sacrificed to the demon of war. It is probable, that the des- truction produced among the human race, by the convulsions of nature, since the commencement of time, (the deluge only excepted,) does not amount to above four or five millions of lives ; but were we to take into account the destruction of human life produced by ambition, tyranny, oppression, super- stition, wars, devastations, murders, and horrid cruelties, in every period of the world, it would, doubtless, amount to seve- ral hundreds of millions. So that, amidst the most terrible dis- plays of the displeasure of God against the sins of men, mercy is mingled with judgment ; and while man is the greatest enemy and destroyer of his own species, benevolence is the jytominent feature of all the arrangements of the Deity iu the physical world. For " his tender mercies are over all his works."* III. — The discoveries ivhicli have leBu made in the system of nature, illustrate the doclrint of the Resurrection of the Dead. The doctrine of a Resurrection from the dead, at first view, appears to involve in it a variety of difficulties, and apparent contradictions. That a complex organical machine, as the human body is, consistijig of thousands of diversified i)arts for the performance of its functions, after it has been reduced to atoms, and those atoms dispersed to " the four Avinds of heaven" — should be again reared up with the same materials, in a new and more glorious form — is an idea which seems to baffle the iiuman comprehension ; and, in all probability, would never have entered the mind of man, had it not been commu- nicated by Divine Revelation. Accordingly we find, that the philosophers of antiquity, though many of them believed in the doctrine of a future state, ivever once dreamed, that the bodies of men, after they had been committed to the dust, * Tlic facts stated in this section are expressed, for the most part iu the author's own words, for the sake of compression. — 13is authorities arc, Goldsmith's " Natural Hist.," Humboldt's "Travels," Biydon's," Tour," Sir W. Hamilton's "Observations," Raffles' " History of Java," Ency. Bill. Art. Etna, Volcmw, Ertrthfiuctkey ilnlioch, Ctoud ; Thvhllciaiy iiut Scicntihc Journals fur [622, t^c. THE RESURRECTION ILLUSTRATED. 283 would ever again be reanimated ; and hence, when the Apostle Paul proposed this doctrine to the Athenian philosophers, they scouted the idea, as if it had been the reverie of a madman. And, indeed, v.ithout a strong conviction, and a lively impres- sion of the iniinite power and intelligence of God, the mind cannot rely with unshaken confidence on the declaration of a future fact so widely diflerent from all the obvious phenomena of nature, and from every thing that lies within the range of human experience. *' If a man die," says Job, " shall he live again ? There is hope of a tree, if it be cut down, that it will sprout again, and bring forth boughs like a plant. But man dieth and wasteth away ; yea, man giveth up the ghost, and where is he ?" When the mind, however, is frequently exer- cised in contemplations on the stupendous works of the Al- mighty, it must feel an impressive conviction, that " nothing can be too hard for Jehovah." When we endeavor to draw aside the veil which conceals many of the scenes of nature from the vulgar eye, we perceive a variety of operations and analogies, which tend to assist us in forming a conception, not only of the jjossihiUhj of a resurrection, but also of the manner in which it may probably be efiected, when the power of Om- nipotence is interposed. The transformations of insects afford us a beautiful illustia- tion of this subject. All the butterflies which we see flutter- ing about in the summer months, were originally caterpillars. Before they arrive at that highest stage of their existence, they pass through four different transformations. The first state of a butterfly is that of an e[)-g ; it next assumes the form of a loathsome crawling uwrm ; after remaining some time in this state, it throws off its caterpillar skin ; languishes ; refuses to eat ; ceases to move ; and is shut up, as it were, in a tomb. In this state, the animal is termed a chrysalis ; it is covered with a thin crust or shell, and remains, sometimes for six or eight months, without motion, and apparently without life. After remaining its allotted time in this torpid condition, it be- gins to acquire new life and vigor ; it bursts its imprisonment, and comes forth a butterfly, with wings tinged with the most beautiful colors. It mounts the air ; it ranges from flower to flower, and seems to rejoice in its new and splendid existence. How very different does it appear in this state from what it did in the preceding stages of its existence ! How unhkely did it seem that a rough, hairy, cratvling worm, which lay for such a length of time in a death-like torpor, and enshrouded in a tomb, should be re-animated, as it were, and changed into so beau- tiful a form, and endued with such powers of rapid motion ! 284 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. Perhaps the change to be effected on the bodies of men, at the general resurrection, may not be greater, nor more wonderful in its nature, than are the changes which take place from the^ hrst to the last stage of a caterpillar's existence. In such transformations, then, we behold a lively representation of the death and resurrection of a righteous man. " A little while he shall lie in the ground, as the seed lies in the bosom of the earth ; but he shall be raised again, and shall riever die any more." There is another illustration, taken from a consideration of the chemical changes of matter, which has a still more direct bearing on the doctrine of a resurrection. We know, that substances which are invisibly incorporated with air, water, and other fluids, and which seefn to be destroyed, may be made to re-appear in their original form by the application of certain chemical re-agents. For example ; put a small piece of solid camphor into a phial half-hlled with alcohol or spirits of wine ; in a short time the camphor will be dissolved in the fluid, and the spirit will be as transparent as at first. If water be now added, it will unite with the ardent spirit, and the cam- phor will be separated and fall to the bottom of the phiqL, In this way the camphor may be nearly ail recovered as at first ; and, by distillation, the alcohol may also be separated from the water, and exhibited in a separate state. I have already noticed, that Carbon^ which forms an essential part of all animal and vegetable substances, is found to be not only mdestructible by age, but in all its combinations, which are infinitely diversified, it still preserves its identity. In the state of carbonic acid it exists in union with earths and stories in unbounded quantities ; and though buried for thousands of vears beneath immense rocks, or in the centre of mountains, it is still carbonic acid ; for no sooner is it disengaged frani its dormity than it rises with all the life and vigor of recent formation, not in the least impaired by its torpid inactivity dur- ing a lapse of ages. The beams of the theatre at Hercula- neum were converted into charcoal (which is one of the compounds of Carbon) by the lava which overflowed that city, during an eruption of Motmt Vesuvius ; and during the lapse of 1700 years, the charcoal has remained as entire as if it had >3een formed but yesterday, and it will probably continue so to .he end of the world. In addition to thesq facts it may be stated, that provision has been made for the restoration of the fallen leaves of vegetables which rot upon the ground, and, to a careless observer, would appear to be lo^t forever. It has been shown by experin^cnt, that whenever the soil becomosj GENERAL CONFLAGRATION. 285 ;hargc(l with such matter, the oxygen of the atmosphere jombines with it, and converts it into carbonic acid gas. The consequence of which is, that this very same carbon is, in process of time, absorbed by a new race of vei2;etables, which it clothes with a new fohage, and which is itself destined to undergo similar putrefaction and renovation to the end of time."* These facts, and others of a siniilar description which might have been stated, demonstrate, that one of the con- stituent parts of animal bodies remains unalterably the same, amidst all the revolutions of time, and all the changes and decompositions which take place in the system of nature ; and, consequently, that though human bodies may remain in a state of putrefaction for ages, in the earth and in the waters, yet their component parts remain unchanged, and in readiness to enter into a new and more glorious combination, at the command of that Intelligence to whom all the principles of nature and all their diversified changes are intimately known ; and whose Power is able to direct their combinations to the accomplishment of his purposes. — Though such considera- tions as these may have no weight on certain unreflecting minds, that never meet with aiiy diflicidties in the economy either of Nature or of Redemption ; yet, the man of deep re- flection, who has frequently had his mind distracted with the apparent improbability of the accomplishment of certain Di- vine Declarations, will joyfully embrace such facts in the economy of nature, as a sensible sirpport to his faith in the promises of his God ; and will resign his body to dust and putrefaction, in the firm hope of emerging from the tomb to a future and more glorious transformation. IV. The discoveries of Science tend to illustrate the doctrine of the General Conilagration. We are informed, in the Sacred Oracles, that a period is approaching, when " the elements shall melt with fervent heat, and the earth, and the works that are therein, shall be burned up." Science has ascertained certain facts in the con- stitution of nature, which lead us to form some conception of the manner in which this awful catastrophe may probably be effected, and also of the ease with which it may be accom- plished, when the destined period shall have arrived. It was formerly stated, (pp. 73, 223,) that the atmosphere, or the air we breathe, is a compound substance, composed of two very * Pavkes' " Cliem. Catechism," p. 26G, and the additional notes. 24* 286 THE CHRISTIAN PHR.OSOPIIER. different and opposite principles, termed oxygen and n'drogen The oxygen, which forms about a fifth part of the atmosphere, is now ascertained to be the principle of flame ; a lighted taper immersed in this gas, burns with a brilliancy too great for the eye to bear ; and even a rod of iron or steel is made to. blaze under its energy. The modern infidel, lilie the scoffers of old, scouts the idea of the dissolution of the world, and of the restitution of the universe, " because all things continue as they were fi-om the beginning of the creation ; not knowing the Scriptures, nor the power of God ;" and not considering the principles and facts in the system of nature, which indicate the possibility of such an event. But, from the fact now stated, we may learn, how easily this effect may be accomplished, even in conformity with those laws which now operate in the constitution of our globe. For should the Creator issue forth his Almighty Fiat — " Let the nitrogen of the atmosphere be completely sepa- rated from the oxygen, and let the oxygen exert Us native energies without control, wherever it extends ;" — from what we know of its nature, we are warranted to conclude, that in- stantly a universal conflagration would commence throughout all the kingdoms of nature — not only wood, coals, sulphur, bitumen, and other combustible substances, but even the hardest rocks and stones, and all the meials, fossils, and minerals, and water itself, which is'a compound of two inflam- mable substances, would blaze with a rapidity which would carry destruction through the whole expanse of the terra- queous globe, and change its present aspect into that of a new world : — at the same time, all the other laws of nature might still operate as they have hitherto done since the creation of the world. I do not mean positively to assert, that this is the agent which the Almighty will certainly employ for accomplishing this terrible catastrophe, (though we think it highly probable,) since Infinite Power is.possessed of numerous resources for accomplishing its objects, which lie beyond the sphere of our knowledge and comprehension. But I have brought forward this fact, to show with what inlinite ease this event may be ac- complished, when Almighty Power is interposed. By means of the knowledge we have acquired of the constitution of the atmosphere, and by the aid of chemical apparatus, we can perform experiments on a small scale, similar in kind, though infinitely inferior in degree, to the awful event under consider- ation. And, therefore, we can easily conceive that He who formed the expansive atmosphere which surrounds us, and GF.NERAT. CONPLAGRATION. 287 who knows the native energy of its constituent principles, may, by a simple volition, make that invisible fluid, in a few moments, the cause of the destruction of the present constitu- tion of our world, and, at the same time, the means of its subsequent renovation. For as fire does not annihilate, but only changes the forms of matter, this globe on which we now tread, and which bears the marks of ruin and disruption in several parts of its structure, may come forth from the flames of the general conflagration, purified from all its physi? Q^\ eyils, adorned with new beauties and sublimities, and rendered a fit habitation for pure intelligences, either of our own species or of another order. For, though the '.' heavens,'' or the atmosphere, " shall be dissolved, and the elements melt with fervent heat ;" " yet," says the Apostle Peter, " we, according to his promise, look for new heavens and a new earth, wherein dwelleth righteousness." Whether, ^fter being thus renovated, it shall be allotted as the residence of the redeemed inhabitants of our world, is beyond our province at present to determine. But if not, it will, in all probability, be allotted as the abode of other rational beings, who may be transported from other regions, to contemplate a new province of the Divine empire, or who may be immediately created for the purpose of taking possession of this renovated world. For we have reason to laelieve, that the energies of Creating Power will be continually exerted, in replenishing the bound- less universe, throughout all the ages of infinite duration, and that no substances, or worlds which God has created, will ever be suffered to tall into annihilation — at least, that the original atoms of matter will never be destroyed, whatever new forms they may assume, and however varied the combinations into which they may enter. The above are only a few examples out of many which were intended to be specified, of the illustrations which the system of nature affords of the doctrines and facts of Revela- tion, but the narrow limits of this volume prevent further enlargement. It was also intended to follow up the preceding discussions with particular illustrations of the following topics : — The views which science affords of the incessant energies of Creating Power — the changes and revolutions which apjiear to have ha})pened, and which are still going on in the distant regions of the universe, as tending to ainplifi] our views ojthe grand and multifarious objects over which Divine Providence presides — the connection of science with a future state — the aids which the discoveries of science afford, in enabling us to ^88 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. form a conception of the scenes of future felicity — of the em- ployments of the heavenly inhabitants, and of their perpetual advances in knowledge and happiness, and in their views of the perfections of Deity— the moral rdalions ofinielligent beings to their Creator, and to each other ; and the physical grounds or reasons of those moral laws which the Deity has promul- gated for regulating the conduct, and for promoting the har- mony and order of intelligent agents — illustrations of the allusions of the Sacred writers to the system of the material world — the simultaneous progress of science and religion^ considered as an evidence of the connection of the one with the other — the moral effecis of the study of science in connec- tion with religion — replies to objections and insinuations which have been thrown out against the idea of combining the dis- coveries of Science with the discoveries of revelation, &c. But, as illustrations of these, and various other topics con- nected with them, would occupy two or three hundred pages, they must, in the mean time, be postponed.* * A work, embracing illustrations of some of the topics here stated, is pre- paring for the press, under the title of" The Philosophy of Religion ;" or, an Illustration of the Moral Laws of the Universe, on the principles of Reason and Divine Revelation." In this work, an original, and, at the same time, a popular train of thought will he prosecuted, and the diflerent topes will be enlivened Avith illustrative f\cts, borrowed from the scei^ery of pature and the moral history of mankind. CHAPTER V. BENEFICIAL EFFECTS WHICH MIGHT RESULT TO CHRISTL\N SOCIETY FROM CONNECTING THE DISCOVERIES OF SCIENCE WITH THE OBJECTS OF RELIGION. I. — The variety of topics which would he introduced into Christian Instructions, by connecting; them with the manifes- tations of Deity in the System of JVatvre, would have a TENDENCY TO ALLURE THE ATTENTION OF THE YOUNQ ■fo jiELiGious SUBJECTS, and to afford Alental Entertain- ment, and JMoral Instruction to intelligent minds of every description. Novelty and variety appear to be essentially requisite in order to rousp the attention, not only of the more ignorant but even of the more intelligent class of mankind, and to excite them to make progress in the path of intellectual and moral improvement. The principle of curiosity, which appears at a very early period of life, and which variegated scenery and novel objects tend to stimulate and to gratify — so far from being checked and decried, in a religious point of view, as some have been disposed to do, ought to be encouraged and cul- tivated in the minds both of the old and of the young. As it is a principle which God himself has implanted in our natures, for wise and important purposes, it requires only to be chastened, and directed in a proper channel, in order to become one of the most powerful auxiliaries in the cause of religion, and of intellectual improvement. To gratify this principle, and to increase jts activity, the Creator has adorned our globe with a combination of beauties and sublimities, strewed in endless variety over all its ditfcrept regions. The hills and dales, the piountains and plains ; the seas, the lakes, the rivers, the islands of every tbrm and size which diversify the surface ol the ocean ; the bays, the gulfs, and peninsulas ; the forests, the troves, the deep dells, and towering cliffs ; the infinite variety «5f trees, plants, flowers and vegetable productions of every 290 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. hue, so profusely scattered over the face of Nature ; the diver- sified productions of the mineral kingdom ; the variegated color- ing spread over the face of nature ; together with the many- thousands of different species of animated beings which tra- verse the air, the waters, and the earth — afford so many stimuli to rouse this principle into exercise, and to direct the mind to the contemplation of the Creator. And as the earth displays an endless diversity of objects, so the heavens, in so far as they have been explored, exhibit a scenery both grand and variegated. There is not a planet in the Solar System but ' differs from another, in its magnitude, in its distance from the central luminary about which it revolves, in the velocity of its motion, in the extent of the circle it describes around the sun, in the period of time in which its revolution is completed, in its rotation round its axis, in the number of moons with which it is attended, in the inclination of its axis to the plane of its orbit, and the diversity of seasons which results from this cir- cumstance ; in the density of its atmosphere, and the various appearances which diversify its surface. And if we were favored with a nearer view of these majestic orbs, we should, doubtless, behold a similar variety in every part of their inter- nal arrangements. — The surface of the moon presents a varie- gated prospect of mountains and vales, but so very different in their form, position, and arrangement, from what obtains, on the surface of our globe, that it would exhibit a scenery ' altogether new and uncommon to an inhabitant of this world, were he placed on the surface of that planet. Every comet, itoo, is distinguished from ano,ther,.by its magnitude, the extent of its atmosphere, the length of its blazing tail, the rapidity of its motion, and the figure of the curve it descrbes around the sun. 1^'ith regard to the fixed stars which are distributed, of every size, and in every direction, through the immensity of space, our senses, as well as the declaration of an inspired writer, convince us, that, in point of brilliancy, color, and mag- nitude, " one star differeth from another star in glory." And as the system of Nature in all its parts presents a boundless variety of scenery, to arouse the attention, and to gratify the desire for novelty, so the Revelation of God con- tained in the Sacred Records, displays n diversified combina- tion of the most sublime and interesting subjects and events. Were we to form an opinion of the compass of Divine Reve- lation, from the range of subjects to which the minds of some professing Christians are confined, it might all be compre- hended within the limits of five or six chapters of the New Testament ; and all the rest might be thrown aside, as a dead- VARIETY OF TOPICS IN RELIGION. 291 weight upoii the Christian Syritem. But here, as in all the other displays of the Almighty, Divine Perfeetion and Provi- dence are exhibited in the most diversified aspects. Here we have recorded a history of the creation and arrangement of our globe, — of the formation of the first human pair, — of their primeval innocence, temptation and fall, — of the arts which were cultivated in the first ages of the wrtrld, — of the increase of human wickedness, — of the building of the ark, — of the drowning of the world by a universal deluge, — of the burning of Sodom by fire from the clo\ids, — of the origin of languages, — of the dividing of the Red Sea, — of the journeying of the tribes of Israel through the deserts of Arabia, — of their con- quest of the promised land, and their wars with the nations of Canaan, — of the corporeal translation of Elijah from aarth to heaven, — of the manifestation of the Son of God in human flesh, the benevolent miracles he performed, and the triumphs he obtained overall the powers of hell and earth. We are here presented with the most interesting and affecting narra- tives, elegies^ dramatic poems, and triumphal songs, — with views of society in the earliest ages of the world, when the lives of men were prolonged to nearly a thousand years, — with splendid miracles performed in the land of Egypt, in the wil- derness of Hereby and in the " field of Zoan," when " the sun and moon stood still in their habitation ;" when the waters of the great deep were divided, and mountains shook and trem- bled^ "at the presence of Jehovah," — with the glorious inarch- ing of a whole nation through the Arabian deserts, under the guidanC'e of a miraculous pillar of clouds and fire, — with the visits of celestial messengers, and the visible symbols of " a present Deity," — with prophetical delineations of the present and future condition of the race of Adam,— with descriptions of the Power, Wisdom, I^ove,.and Majesty of the Almighty, and of his operations in Heaven and Earth, — w ith the results and bearings of the Economy of Pvedein()tian, — with Divine Songs, Odes and HymnSj composed by angels and inspired men, — with maxims of moral wisdom, examj)les of sublime^ eloquence, of strength of reasoning, ai»d of manly boldness of reproof, — with Proverbs, Parables, Allegories, Exhortations, Promises, Threatenings, and Consolatory addresses. In short, we have here detailed, in the greatest variety — History, Anti- quities, Voyages, Travels, Philosophy, Geography, Natural and Moral Science^ Biography, Arts, Epic Poetry, Epistles, Memoirs, Delineations of Nature, Sketches of Human Cha- racter, Moral Precepts, Prophecies, 3liracles, Nnrrati^ons, WundcrlVii Providences, Matvelioas Delivciance;-, the The- 292 THE CHRIStiAN PHILOSOPHER. nomena of the Air^ the "Waters^ and the Earth ; the Past, the I'resent, and the Future Scenes of the World — all blended together in one harmonious system^ without artificial order, but with a majesty and grandeur corresponding to the style ot all the other Wtirks of God^ — and all calculated to gratify the piiriciple of curiosity — to convey " reproof, correction, and instruction, in righteousness," and " to make the Man of God perfect^ and thoroughly furnished to every good work." And, as the scenes of Nature, and the scenes of Revela- tion, are thus wonderfully diversified, in order to excite the attention of intelligent beings, and to gratify the desire for Variety^ so we have every reason to believe, that the scenes, ♦objects, and dispensations, which will be be displayed in the heavenly world, will be incomparably more grand and diversi- fied. When we consider the immensity of God's Universal Kingdom^ and the numerous systems, and worlds, and beings comprehended within its vast circumference, and that the ener- gies of Creating Power may be forever exerted in raising new worlds into existence— ^vve may rest assured, that the desire of variety and of novelty, in holy intelligences, will be completely gratified throughout stn endless succession of existence ; and that the most luxuriant imagination, in its boldest excursions, can never go beyond the reality of those scenes of diversified grandeur which the Heaven of heavens will display. Now, since the book of Nature^ and the Book of Revela- tion, since all the manifestations of the Creator in heaven and earth are characterized by their sublime and diversified aspect ; we would ask, why should we not be imitators of G od, in dis- playing the diversified grandeur of his kingdom of Providence and of Grace, before the minds of those whom we profess to instruct ? Why should we confine our views to a few points in the Christian system, to a few stones in the fabric of the Divine operations, when " a wide and unbounded prospect lies before us ]" Why should we not rather attempt to rouse the moral and intellectual energies of mankind, from the pitlpit, from the press, in the schoolroom, and in the family circle, by exhibiting the boundless variety of aspect which the Revela- tions of ileaven present, and the holy tendencies of devout contemplation on the Works and the Ways of God ] that they may learn, with intelligence, to " meditate on all the works of the' Lord, and to talk of all his doings." — By enlarging and diversifying the topics of religious discussion, accor(iing to the vi3ws now stated, we have it in our power to spread out an in!c'!ecttTa! feast- to allure and to grntify every variety of taste, . — th'- \o'iu<: and the old, the learned and the unlearned; vea.. AMPLITUDE OV THE DIVINE EMPIRE. 293 even the careless and the ignorant, the sceptical and the dissi- pated, might frequently be allured by the selection of a judi- cious variety of striking and impressive objects and descrip- tions, to partake of those mental enjoyments which might ultimately issue in the happiest results. The man of an inquisitive turn of mind, who now throws aside every thing that has the appearance of religion, on account of its dulness might have his curiosity gratified amidst such a variety as that to which I allude ; and, from perceiving the bearing of every discussion on the great realities of religion and a future state, might be led to more serious inquiries after the path that leads to immortality. In a word, to associate and to amalgamate, as it were, the arts and sciences, and every department of useful knowledge, with divine subjects, is to consecrate them to their original and legitimate ends, and to present religion to the eyes of men, in its most sublime, and comprehensive, and attractive form, corresponding to what appears to be the design of the Creator, in all the manifestations he has given of himself, in the System of Nature, in the Operations of Providence, and in the Economy of Redemption. II. — Bij connectins; Science with Religion, Ckristians ivotdd be enabled to take an extensive survey of the king- dom OF CxOD. How very narrow and limited are the views of most profes- sors of religion respecting the universal Kingdom of Jehoyah, and the range of his operations ! The views of some indivi- duals are confined chiefly wdthin the limits of their own parish, or at farthest, extend only to the blue mountains that skirt their horizon, and form the boundary of their sight. Within this narfow circle, all their ideas of God, of religion, and of the relations of intelligent beings to each other, are chiefly confined. There are others, who form an extensive class of our population, whose ideas are confined nearly to to the county in which they reside, and to the adjacent dis- tricts ; and there are few, comparatively, whose views extend beyond the confines of the kingdom to which they belong — though the whole island in which we reside is less than the two thousandth part of the globe we inhabit. Of the vast fextent of this earthly ball, of its figures and motions, of its continents, seas, islands, and oceans ; of its volcanoes pnd tanges of mountains, of its numerous and diversified climp*es and landscapes ; of the various nations and tribes of mankind that people lis surface, and of the moral government of God re?pf <'*i'ir; t'^c;n, — t]u-y r?r" -7!:"^-:r r>-> r'Kv^.Jercly i-^fDr/int as 294 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. iiic untutored Greeiila rider, or the roving savage. — Witn regard to the objects-^vhich lie beyond the boundary of our world, thny have no precise and definite conceptions. When the moon is " walking in brightness" through the heavens, tli-;7 take the advantage of her light to prosecute their jour- neys ; and, when the sky is overcast with clouds, and they are anxious to travel a few miles to their destined homes, they will lift up their eyes to the heavens to see if any of the stars are tvvinkling through the gloom, that their footsteps may be directed by their glimmering rays. Beyond this they seldom soar. What may be the nature of the vast assemblage ot shining points which adorn the canopy of their habitation, and the ends they are destined to accomplish in the plan of the Creator's opcraMons, they consider as no part of their pro- vince to inquire. " Their minds, fair Science never taught to stray Far as the Solar Worlds, or Milky AVay." How very different, in point of variety, of grandeur, and ot extent, are the views of the man who connects all the different departments of knowledge, and the discoveries of science, with his prospects of God's Universal Dominion and Govern- rneiit ? With his mental eye he can traverse the different regions of the earth, and penetrate into the most distant and retired recesses where human beings have their residence. — He can contemplate and adore the conduct of Divine vSovereignty, in leaving so many nations to grope amidst the darkness of Heathen Idolatry, — he can trace the beams of the Sun of Righteousness, as they gradually arise to illume the benighted tribes of men, — he can direct his prayers, with inteUigence and fervor, in behalf of particular kindreds and ?)?<)ple, — he can devise with judgment and discrimination, .schemes for carrying the " Salvation of God" into effect, — he can realize;, in some measme, to his mental sight, the glo- ]ious and happy scenes which will be displayed in the futiu'e ;\ges of time, when " the kingdoms of this world shall become ihe kingdom of our Lord, and of his Christ," and when the '^ everlasting gospel" shall be published, and its blessings tlistributed among all who dwell upon the face of the earth. — He can bound from this earth to the planetary worlds, and fHirvey far more spacious globes, peopled v»'ith a higher order of intelligences, arra.nged and superintended by the same Almighty Sovereign, who "doth according to his will among the inhabitants of the earth." He can wing his way beyond 'he visible region of the sky, till he find himself surrounded on * cry hand with suns and systems of worlds, rising to view in AMPT.TTTJPE OF THE DIVINE EMPIRE. 29.5 boundless perspective, throughout the tracts of immensity- - diversified with scenes of magnificence, and with beings ot every order — all under the government and the wise direction of Him who "rules among the armies of heaven," and who " preserveth them all," and whom the " host of heaven woi- ship" and adore. He can soar beyond them all to the throne of God, where angels and archangels, cherubim and seraphim, celebrate the praises of their Sovereign Lord, and stand ready to announce his Will, by their rapid flight to the most distant provinces of his empire. He can descend from that lofty eminence to this terrestrial world, allotted for his temporary abode, and survey another unbounded province of the Empire of God, in those living worlds which lie hid from the unas- sisted sight, and which the microscope alone can descry. Ho can here perceive the same Hand and Intelligence which direct the rolling worlds above, and marshal all the angelic tribes — organizing, arranging, and governing the countless mvriads of animated existence which people the surface of a muddy pool. Pie can speed his course from one of those departments of Jehovah's kingdom to another, till, astoni.shev! and overwhelmed with the order, the grandeur, and extent of the wondrous scene, he is constrained to exclaim, " Great and marvellous are thy works, Lord God Almighty !" " Thinti understanding is infinite !" The limits of thy dominions arc " past finding out !" By taking such extensive surveys of the empire of Jehovah, we are enabled to perceive the spirit and references of those sublime passages in the sacred writings which proclaim the Majesty of God, and the glory of his Kingdom. Such pas- sages are diffusely scattered through the inspired volume, and have evidenjlly an extent of reference far bey«jnd wuat is generally conceived by the great mass of the Christian world. The following may sufiice as a specimen : — ' Thine, Lord ! is the greatness, and the glory, and the majesty ; for all in heaven and earth is thine ! Thine is the kingdom, Lord ! Thou art exalted above all, thou reignest over all, and in thine hand is Power and Might. — Behold the heaven, and the Heaven of heavens, is the Lord's ; the earth also, M'ith all that therein is. — Ascribe ye greatness to our God ; for there is none like unto the God of Israel, who rideth upon the heavens in his strength, and in his excellency on the sky. Thou, even thou art Lord alone ; thou hast made heaven, the Heaven of heavens, with all their host ; the earth, and all things that are therein ; the seas, and all that i ^ therein ; and than preservest them all, and the Host of HeavOvi 296 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOrHER. worshippeth thee. — He divideth tlie sea by his Power ; by his Spirit he hath garnished the heavens : Lo ! these are only parts of his ways ; but how Httle a portion is heard of him, and the thunder of his Power who can understand 1 — The Lord hath prepared his Throne in the Hecvens, and his king- dom ruieth over all. — Lord our God ! how excellent is thy name in all the earth ! who hast set thy glory above the heavens. When I consider thy heavens, the work of thy fingers, the moon and the stars, which thou hast ordained ; what is mau. that thou art mindful of him ! — His Kingdom is an everlasting Kingdom ; Honor and Majesty are before him ; all the inhabitants of the earth are reputed as nothing in his sights and he doth according to his will in the army of heaven, find among the inhabita.nts of the eavth. — He measures tjie waters in the hoiiov/ of his hand ; He mcteth out heaven with a span, and comprehendcth the dust of the earth in a measure, — lie sitteth upon the circle of the earth, and the inhabitants thereof are as grasshoppers.—-! have made the earth, and created man upon it ; I, even my hands, have stretched out the heavens, and all their host have I commanded. — The Most High dvvolleth not in temples made with hands ; for the heaven is his throne, and the earth is his footstool. — With God is awful Majesty. — Great things doth He, which we cannot comprehend ; yea, the Lord sitteth King for ever. — Praise ye the Lord in the Heavens ; praise him in the heights ; praise him all his angels ; praise ye him all his hosts. Praise hiju sun and moon ; praise him all ye stars of light ; praise him ye Heaven of heavens. Praise him ye kings of the earth, and ail people, princes, and judges of the earth ; both young men and maidens ; old men and children — let them praise the nanie of the Lord ; for his name alone is excellent, his glory is above the earth and heaven." These sublime descriptions of the Supremacy of God, and of the Grandeur of his kingdom, must convince every reflect- in<'- mind, -f the inconceivable magnificence and extent of that Dominion " which rulrth over all." It is quite evident, that we can never enter, with intelUgence, into the full hnport, and the grand references of such exalted language employed by inspired writers, unless we take into view, all the disco- veries which Science has made, both in the earth, and in the heavens, respecting the variety and extent of the Dominions of the Creator. If the " Kingdom of the Most High" were as limited in its range as most Christians seem to conceive, such descriptions might be considered as mere hyperboles, or bombast, or extravagant declamation, which far exceeds the AMPLITUDE OF THE DIVINE EMPIRE. 297 bounds of " truth and soberness." ]5iit we are certain, thai the conceptions and the language of mortals can ne /er go beyond the reahty of what actually exists within the boundless precincts of Jehovah's Empire. For " who can utter thd mighty acts of the Lord 1" or " who can show forth all h\A praise ?" The language and descriptions to which we have, now adverted, seem to have had a prospective reference t<» later and more enlightened times, when more extensive pro • spects of God's dominions would be opened up by the exer- tions of the human intellect. And were we to search all th(3 records of literature, in ancient or modern times, we should find no descriptions nor language of such a dignified nature 'i as to express the views and feelings of an enlightened Chris- I tian Philosopher, when he contemplates the sublimity and ' extent of Divine operations — except those which are to be found in the inspired volume — the strength, and majesty, and comprehension of which, no human language can ever exceed- Again, by familiarizing our minds to such extended pro- spects of God's universal kingdom, we shall be qualified and disposed to comply with the injunctions of Scripture, which represent it as an imperious duty, to communicate to the minds of others such elevated conceptions. This duty is enjoined in numerous passages of Sacred Scriptiu-e, particularly in tho book of Psalms : " Declare his glory among the heathen, and his wonders among all people. — I will extol thee, my Grod, O King. — One generation shall ]n-aise thy works ti) mother, and shall declare thy mighty acts. — lj4^1 spe-dk of 'he glorious honor of thy majesty, and of thy^wondrous works. —And men shall speak of the might of thy terrible acts ; and shall declare thy greatness. All thy works shall praise thee, Lord ; and thy saints shall bless thee. Theij shall speak i)f the glory of ihij kino-dom, and talk of thy power ; to make knoum to the sons of men thy mighty acts, and the glorious majesty of thy kingdom.^'*- When we look around us in the %vorld, and in the visible church, and mark the conceptions, and the conversation of the members of religious societies, we need scarcely say how little this ennobling duty is attended to by the mass of those who bear the Christian name. We hear abundance of idle chat about the fashions and the poli- tics of the day — how Miss A. danced so gracefully at the ball, and how Miss B. sung so sweetly at the concert : hoAV Mr. C. acted his part so well in the character of Rob Roy, and how Mr. D. made such a flaming speech at the corpora + Psalm cxlv. and xcvi. 3, 4. 25^^ 2dS THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. tion dinner. We listen to slanderous conversation, and hear abundance of mean, and base, and uncharitable insinuations against our neighbors ; which indicate the operation of malice, hatred, envy, and other malevolent tempers. We spend whole hours in boisterous disputations about metaphysical subtleties in religion, and questions " which gender strife rather than godly edifying ;" but " to speak of the glory of God's king- dom, and to talk of his Power," with the view of " making known to the sons of men his mighty works," is a duty which remains yet to be learned by a majority of those who profess the religion of Jesus. And how can they be sup- posed to be qualified to enter into the spirit of this duty, and to proclaim to others " the glorious majesty of God's king- dom," unless such subjects be illustrated in minute detail^ and proclaimed with becoming energy, both from the pulpit, and from the press 1 These powerful engines, when con ducted with judgment and discrimination, are capable of pro- ducing on the mass of mankind, a tone of thinking, and an enlargement of conception, on such subjects, which no other means can easily effect ; and it is to be hoped, that more precise and luminous details, and more vigor and animation, will soon be displayed, in this respect, than in the ages that are past. There is a certain principle of selfish'.iess which pervades the minds of many professed religionists, which leads them to conclude, that, if they can but secure their own 'personal salvation^ they need give themselves no trouble about the glory and extent of the kingdom of the Most High. " What need we care," say they, '* about nations in the far-distant parts of the world, and about the planets and the stars ; our business is to attend to the spiritual interests of our souls." Such persons seem neither to understand in what salvation really consists, and what is conducive to their spiritual inte- rests, nor to appreciate those tempers and habits which will qualify them for the enjoyment of eternal life. It forms but a very slender evidence of their possessing any spark of Christianity at all, if they wish to rest satisfied ^v^th the most vague and grovelling conceptions, and if they do not ardently aspire after a more enlarged view of the attributes of God, of the glory of his empire, and of whatever may tend to expand their conceptions of '^ the inheritance of the saints in light." We have often been astonisfied at the opinions of some of those who move in a higher sphere of intelligence, who seem to consider it as a matter of pure incU[j'erence^ whether or not Christians should attain to the highest conception in their AMPLITUDE OP THE DIV^E EMPIRE. 299 power of the God whom they worship, and of his boundless dominions ; because they conceive that such views are not essentially connected with salvation ! But we would ask such persons, how they came to know that such views are not connected with salvation 1 Though they may not have been essential to the salvation of men in the dark ages that are past, or to obscure tribes of people at present, who have no access to the proper sources of information, yet, since God, in the course of his Providence, which guides all human in- ventions and discoveries, has disclosed to us a far more ex- pansive view of the " glory of his kingdom," than former ages could obtain, for the purpose of illustrating the revela- tions of his word — who will dare to assert, that the man who has access, by his studious efforts, to contemplate this won- drous scene, and to display its grandeur to others, and yet wilfully shuts his eyes on the Divine glory therein displayed, does not ^thereby hazard the Divine displeasure 1 In this point of view, the following passage deserves a serious con- sideration : " Because they regard not the works of the Lord, nor the operations of his hands, he shall destroy them, and not build them up." We have no hesitation in admitting, that persons may have obtained salvation who never saw more of the sacred writings than what is contained in the gospel of Mark, or in one of Paul's Epistles ; but what would we say of the man who had access to all the Revelations of Heaven we now possess, and yet confined his attention solely to a chapter or two in the New Testament, and would not deign to look into any other part of the inspired volume ? We should not hesitate at once to pronounce that such a person was grossly deficient in his duty, and devoid of that reverence and submission which are due to the oracles of God. And, if it be admitted, that the person who has access to the Bible, and who refuses to peruse its important contents, is guilty of a criminal neglect, we do not see how the man, who has free access to the other volume of God's revelation, and views it as a matter of mere indifference, whether he looks into it or not, can be deemed, in this respect, entirely innocent. If it be understood, that we shall be judged according to the light and privileges we enjoy, and the use we make of them, in our improveme^it in the knowledge of God — we would deem it a hazardous position, for any one to support, That " inattention to the visible glories of the kingdom of God, and to the ' declaration of his wonders among the people,' is a matter either of indifference, or of trivial importance." For, let it be considered, further — that on the extent of our 300 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. vieivs respecting the universal Jiingdom of God, depends our conceptions of the Alajestij and Glory of the Creator himself. We become acquainted with the nature of God, only in so far as he has manifested himself to us by external operations,* and in so far as we form just conceptions of these operations. If we conceive his empire as included within the bounds of eighty or ninety thousand miles, our conceptions of the Sover- eign of that empire will be circumscribed within nearly the same limits. The mind of every reasonable man must, in- deed, admit the abstract proposition, " That the Divine Being is infinite, and, consequently, tills all space with his presence." But this infinity in our view, is nothing more than a vague conception of empi'j space, extending a little tvaij heijond the sphere of his visible operations. The mind must have some material, visible or tangible objects to rest upon, and to guide it in its excursions, when it would attempt to form the most de- finite and comprehensive conceptions of an Infinite, Eternal, and Invisible Existence. For however much we may talk about purely spiritual ideas, it is quite evident, from the nature of things, and from the very constitution of man, that we can have no ideas at all without the intervention of sensible objects. And, therefore, if we would wish to form the most sublime conceptions of God himself, we must endeavor, in the first place, to take the most extensive views which science and rev- elation exhibit, of his vast dominions. We must endeavor to form some adequate idea of the wide extent of the globe on which we dwell, its diversified scenery, and the numerous tribes of human beings, and other animated existences, visible and invisible, which people its different provinces. We must explore the vast regions of the j)lanetary system, and compare the bulk of the earth, large as it is, with some of those more magnificent globes, which would contain a thousand v/orlds as large as ours. We must next wing our way, in imagination, over a space which a cannon-ball, flying five hundred miles every hour, would not traverse in ten hundred thousand years, till we arrive at the nearest fixed stars, and find ourselves in the centre of thousands of systems and worlds, arranged at im- measurable distances from one another. We must pass from one nebula, or cluster of systems, to another ; continuing our excursions as far as the eye or the telescope can direct our view ; and, when the aid of artificial in.^trtunents begins to fail, our imagination must still take its flight far beyond the boun- daries of mortal vision, and add system to system, and nebula * Here I include tlie manifestations of Deity, as exhibited both in Di- vine llevelalion, and in the System of Nature. AMPLITUDE OF THE DIVINE EMPIRE. 301 to nebula, through the boundless regions of space, till we arrive at the grand centre of the universe, the Thione of God, around which all worlds and beings revolve, where " thousands thousands" of bright intelligences " minister to Him, and ten thousand times ten thousand stand before him." — We must consider all this magnificent assemblage of objects, not merely as so many masses of inert matter, or as a grand raree-show, to dazzle the eyes of a few hundreds of human spectators, — but as destined for purposes worthy of the plans and the intel- ligence of Him who is " the only wise God," — as peopled with numerous orders of intelligent beings, whose physical and moral economy is superintended and directed by Him, who, at the same time, rules amidst the tumults of human revolutions, and governs the living myriads which people a drop of water. In this way, then, do we come to acquire the most extensive views of the amplitude and glory of the Kingdom of the Most High ; and it is only by the same process of thought that we can ever attain the most exalted conceptions of the attributes of its almighty Sovereign. For our views of the Sovereign of the universe must always correspond with our views of the ex- tent and magnificence of those dominions which sprung from his Creating Hand, and over which he every moment presides. His essence must for ever remain imperceptible to finite minds ; for he is " the King Eternal, immortal, and Invisible, dwelling in that Light which no man can approach unto, whom no man hath seen, or can see." From his nature, as a spiritual uncompounded substance, and from his immensity, as filling infinite space with his presence, it appears impossible, in the very nature of things, that the glory of his perfections can be displayed in any other way than through the medium of the visible operations of his hands, or in the dispensations of his providence towards particular worlds or classes of intelli- gences. And if, in the future world, the souls of good men will enjoy a more glorious display than at present, of the at- tributes of Deity, it will be owing chiefly to their being placed in more favorable circumstances than they now are, for con- templating this display ; to their faculties being more invigo- rated ; and every physical and moral impediment to their exercise being completely removed ; so as to enable them to perceive more clearly than they now do, the unbounded dis- plays he has given of his infinite Power, Wisdom, and Benevo- lence. And, if we expect to be introduced to this state of enlarged vision, when we pass from the scenes of mortality, it cannot be a matter ot^ mere inJiffsrence, even now, whether or iiot our minds be prepared for such exalted employments, by 302 THE CITRTSTIAN FIITLOSOPTTEE. endeavoring to form the most ample conceptions of the attri- butes of God which can be obtained through the medium of his Word, and by a contemplation of the variety and magnifi- cence of his Works. — In the prospect of that world where we hope to spend an intermina])le existence, it must also be inter- esting to ascertain, whether or not the dominions of the univer- sal Sovereign present such an extent of empire, and such a variety of objects, that new scenes of wonder and glory may be expected to be displayed in continual succession, for the contemplation and entertainment of holy beings, while eternal ages are rolling on. And, on this point, the discoveries of science confirm and illustrate the notices of heavenly glory and felicity recorded in the inspired volume, and lead us to rest with full assurance on the prophetic declaration, that " eye hath not seen, nor ear heard, nor hath it entered into the heart of man to conceive the things which God hath prepared for them that love him." III. — By connecting the discoveries of Science irifh Religioii, the minds of Christians u-oidd he enabled to take a more minute and compreJiensive survey of the Operations of Providence. Providence is that superintendence and care which God ex ercises over all creatures and events, in order to accomplish the eternal purposes of his will. In Creation, God brought the universe out of nothing, and arranged all its provinces and inhabitants into due order. By his Providence he supports and governs all the movements of the material system, and the sensitive and rational beings with which it is peopled. It is evident, that, in proportion as our views of the Creator's Do- minions are extended, our views of his Providence will, to a certain extent, be proportiohably enlarged. For wherever worlds and beings exist, there will God be found, preserving, superintending, and governing the movements of all .creatures and events. It is chiefly, howevei-, in the world in which we reside, that the diversified dispensations of Providence can be distinctly traced. Now an acquaintance with the prominent parts of the different branches of knowledge to which I have already adverted, would enable us to take a particular and com- prehensive view, not only of the ways of God to man, but also of his arrangements in reference to all subordinate creatures and events. From the Inspired History of the Old Testament, we can trace the prominent lines of the dispensations of God towards man, particularly in regard to the Israelites and the surround- RANGE OF DIVINE PROVIDENCE. 303 I ing nations — from the Creation to a period about 400 years before the coming of Christ. But in order to perceive the farther progress and bearings of these lines till the commence- ment of the New Testament economy, we must have recourse to the most authentic records of profane history. From the era of the birth of Christ to near the close of the first centurv, we can acquire, from the Evangelists, and the History of the Apostles, a particular account of the life of Christ, of the events which preceded and accompanied the finishing of the work of redemption, and of the progress of the Gospel through Judea and the adjacent countries. But after this period we have no inspired guide to direct us in tracing the Divine Dispensations towards the various nations of the earth ; and, therefore, we must have recourse to the annals, memoirs, chronicles, and other records of the history of nations, down to the period in which we live ; otherwise we could never contemplate the continued series of events in the Divine Economy towards the inhabitants of our world. Un- less men of learning and of observation had recorded the prominent facts which have occurred in the history of nations, •for 1700 years past, we must have remained almost as igno- rant of the dispensations of God towards our race, during that period, as the inhabitants of the planet Saturn : and unless we study the events thus recorded in the writings of the histo- rian, and contemplate their varied aspects and bearings in the light of Divine Revelation, we must still remain ignorant of the grand movements and tendencies of Divine Providence. This single circumstance shows, in the clearest light, that it is the intention of God, that we should learn the operations of his Providence from the researches of Science and of History, as well as from the records of Revelation ; and that the Scriptures, though they contain every supernaluval discovery requisite to our happiness, are not of themselves sufficient to present us with a connected view of the prominent dispensa- tions of heaven, from the Creation to the period in which we live. From the science of Geography we acquire a knowledge oi the extent of the surface of the earth — of the various tribes of human inhabitants with which it is peopled — of the physi- cal aspect of the different climates they inhabit — of their arts, manners, customs, laws, religion, vices, wars, and political economy : and, consequently, we can, in these and similar respects, trace some of the aspects of Divine Providence to- wards them in relation to their present and future condition. From the same source, we learn the number of human beings which the Governor of the wotld has under his direction a 804 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. one time, which is nearly a thousand millions, or five hundred times the number of the inhabitants of Scotland. From the data afforded by this science, we may also form an estimate of the number of disembodied spirits that have passed from this world since the Creation, and are now under the superin- tendence of the Almighty in the invisible state, which cannot be much less than 145,000 millions ; and on similar grounds we may also learn the number of rational beings that are coming forward into existence, and passing into the eternal world every day, which is at least 68,-000, and, consequently, nearly 50 during each passing minute, — every individual of which, the Supreme Disposer of events superintends at his entrance into life ; and, at his departure from it, directs to his respective and eternal state of destination. All which cir- cumstances, and many others of a similar kind, must be taken into account, in order to our form.ing a comprehensive con- ception of the numerous bearings, and the incessant agency of a Superintending Providence. From JYaiural History we learn the immense number and variety of the subordinate tribes of animated beings which inhabit the different regions of earth, air, and sea — their eco- nomy and instincts — their modes of existence, and the man- ner in which the Creator provides for their various necessities. — From an acquaintance with the History of the Arts and Mechanical Inventions, we learn the gradual manner in which God directs the movem.ents of the human mind, in making those improvements and discoveries which have a bearing upon the accomplishment of his eternal plans of mercy, and which tend to enlarge our views of the amplitude and the glories of his kingdom. From JYatural Philosophy and Che- mistry, we learn the secondary causes or subordinate laws by which the Almighty supports and directs the natural constitu- tion of the world — the wonderful manner in which our lives are every moment supported— and the agencies by which fire, air, light, heat, and fertility are distributed through the globe, for promoting the comfort and happiness ''of every thing that lives." — From Anatomy and Physiology, we learn, how "fear- fully and wonderfully we are made atid preserved" — that our health and comfort depend upon the regular action of a thou- sand organical parts and functions, over which we have no control — and that our very existence every moment is depen- dant on the superintendence of a Superior Power, " in w^hose Hand our breath is, and whose aVe all our ways." By an occasional study, then, of the subjects to which we In:\c:^ now al"-nu':K v^f- W:>M!d ^i-n-!'Va:!y ex->:;Tv) fMTf c(^t(^p- RANGE OF DIVINE PROVIDENCE. 305 tions of the range and operations of Divine Providence. Every geographical exploration of a new region of the globe — every scientific improvement and discovery — every useful invention— every eruption of a volcano — every shock of an earthquake — every hurricane, and storm, and tempest — every battle of the warrior — every revolution among the nations — and every detail in the newspapers we daily read, would lead us to form some conceptions of the providential purposes of Him who is the Supreme Disposer of all events. — Even the arrangements of Divine Wisdom, with regard to the economy of the lower animals, ought not to be overlooked in such a survey. "When we consider the irnmcnse number and variety of animated beings — that there arc 500 species of quadrupeds, every species containing, perhaps, many millions of indivi- duals ; 4000 species of birds ; 2500 species of fishes ; 700 species of reptiles ; and 44,000 different kinds of insects, besides many thousands of species altogether invisible to the unassisted sight — when we consider that the structure and organization of all these difterent species are different from each other, and exactly adapted to their various situations and modes of existence, and that their muUifarious wants, in regard to food and habitation, are all provided for, and amply supplied by Him, who, at the same time, arranges and governs the affairs of ten thousand worlds — we must be lost in aston- ishment at the greatness of that Intelligence which formed them, and at the exuberance of that Bounty v/hich spreads so full a table for so immense- an assemblage of living beings I And were we transported to other worlds, we should, doubt- less, behold still more ample displays of Divine Beneficence. We are here presented with a striking commentary on such passages of the Sacred Volume as these : " The eyes of all look unto Thee, O Lord ! and thou givest them their meat in due season. Thou opcnest thy hand liberally, and sat-isfiest the desire of every living thing. The earth is full of thy riches, O Lord! so is the great and wide sea, wherein are things creeping innumerable, both great and small beasts. — These all wait upon thee, and thou givest them their meat in due season. That which thou givest them they gather : Thou openest thy hand, they are filled with good." — " O Lord, thou preservest man and beast ! How excellent is thy lovhig-kind- ness ! Therefore the children of men shall put their trust under the shadow of thy Vv-ings : They shall be abundantly satisfied with the fatness of thy house,"* (of the table thou hast spread * TliiSy ftml sCTeral other similar passages, may be considered as more espccudly a])p!ic,ablc to the bounLy oi' Providence which God has provided 2G 306 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHEH. in thy world for all thine offspring,) "and thou shalt make then- drink of the river of thy pleasures." One excellent practical effect which might flow from such contemplations would be, to inspire us with feelings of humanity towards the inferior order of animals, and to prevent us from wantonly and unnecessarily torturing, or depriving them of existence. For since the Creator and Preserver of all has so curiously organized their bodies, and fitted them for the different regions in which they reside, and so carefully provided for all their wants, it must be His will that they should enjoy happiness according to the extent of their capacities ; and, therefore, they ought to be considered as necessary parts of our sublunary system. — Another practical lesson we may derive from such surveys, is, to place an unshaken dependance upon God for our temporal subsistence, while we, at the same time, exert all our faculties in the line of active duty. " Blessed is the man who trusteth in him ; for there is no want to them that fear him. The young lions may suffer hunger, but they that fear the Lord shall not want any good thing." — He who decks the lily of the vale, and spreads out a plentiful table to the fowls of heaven, to the beasts of the forests, to the creeping insects, and even to the microscopic animalcula, wdl never fail to supply the necessary wants of those who " do His will, and hearken to the voice of His commandments." And if, at any time, we be found des- titute of daily food, and pining away in penury and squahd disease, we have too much reason to conclude, that, in one way or another, either our deviation from the path of recti- tude, or our distrust of Divine Providence, or our want ol prudence and economy, has procured for us these things. I have said, that it is chiefly in the world in which we dwell, that the dispensations of Providence can be distinctly traced. But we must nevertheless admit that the Care and Superinten- dence of God are as minutely exercised in the distant regions of the universe as in our terrestrial sphere ; though we arc not permitted, at present, to inspect the particular details of His procedure in reference to other orders of intelligences. — We are not, however, altogether ignorant of some prominent features of the physical and moral economy of other worlds, for all his creatures. The practice of spintualizhig such passages, as it is tennecl, has a tendency to carricature Scripture, and to twist it from its precise and sublime references, to accord with tiie vague fancies of inju- dicious minds. The literal meaning of Scripture is always the most appro- priate, emphatic, and sublime ; but it may, in some cases, be vised by way of arcommodation, in illustrating divine sul\jects, when it is applied with iudgiiicut and diacriuiiiiatiun. i. RANGE OF DIVINE PROVIDENCE. 307 m consequence of the cliscovcvics of modern astronomical science. With respect to their physical economy, we behold a strik- ing variety in the Divine arrangement. We perceive one planetary world surrounded by two splendid and magnificent rings, one of them 204,000, and the other 184,000 miles in diameter, stretching across its celestial canopy from one end of the heavens to another — moving with majestic grandeur around its inhabitants every ten hours, and diffusing a light* equal to several thousands of moons like ours — which may be considered as a visible and permanent emblem of the Majesty and Glory of their Creator. We perceive connected with the same globe, seven moons all larger than ours, of different ma-gnitudes, and placed at different distances, and revolving in different periods of time around that spacious world. The diversified aspects of these rings, as viewed from the different regions of the planet at different times, and the variety of appearances produced by the alternate rising and setting, cul- mination, and frequent eclipses, and other aspects of the moons, must present to the inhabitants a very grand, and varied, and magnificent scene of Divine operation.* On the other hand, we behold another planetary globe, destitute both of rings and moons, but which has the starry heavens presented to view nearly in the same aspect in which we behold them. We per- ceive a third globe much larger than them both, capable of con- taining 200 times the number of the inhabitants of our world — accompanied in its course with four moons to diffuse light in the absence of the sun, and to diversify the aspect of its sky. In some of these worlds, the succession of day and night is accomplished whhin the space of ten hours ; in others, this revolution is not com.pleted till after the lapse of twenty-four hours, or of as many days. In some, the days and nights are nearly equal on every part of their surface, and they have little variety of seasons; in others, the variety in the length of the days, and the vicissitudes of the seasons, are nearly the same as those we experience in our terrestrial world. Around some there appears a dense atmosphere, while others are environed with atmospheres more rare and transparent. Some move in the vicinity of the sun, and enjoy an abundant etHux of light and heat, while others are removed to the distance of eighteen hundred millions of miles from that central luminary. Some finish the revolution of their year in a few months ; while others require twelve, thirty, or even eighty of our years to complete * See the plate, Fig, 7. SOS THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. their annual round. Some appear adorned with majestic mountajn-scenery, and others seem i* have great changes occasionally taking place in their atmospheres, or on their sur- faces. There are lour planetary bodies lately discovered, which, there is every reason to believe^ once formed the com- ponent parts of a large globe ; but by some mighty catastro- phe in the dispensations of heaven, it appears to have been burst asunder into the fragments we now behold. If the general proposition illustrated in Section 2. of the preceding chapter be admitted, such a fact would seem to indicate that a moral revolution has taken place among the intelligent beings who had orginally been placed in those regions ; and that their fate was involved in the dreadful shock which burst asunder the globe they inhabited; just as the fate of the Antediluvians was involved in the shock by which the solid crust of our globe was disrupted, at the period of the universal deluge. These are some outlines in the economy of Providence which we can trace with regard to the arrangem^ents of other worlds ; but beyond such general aspects we are not permitted to penetrate, so long as we sojourn in tabernacles of clay.— But even such general views afford some scope to the contem-^ plative mind, for forming enlarged conceptions of the Grandeur and diversity of the Dispensations of God, in the worlds which roll in the distant regions of space. With regard to their moral economy — we may rest assured that the prominent outlines of it are materially the same as of that economy which relates to the inhabitants of our world. — The fundamental principles of the moral laws given to men, and which it is the great object of Revelation to. support and i'lustrate, are, " Thou shalt love the Lord thy God with all thy heart and understanding," and, " Thou shalt love thy neighbor as thyself." On these two commandments hang all the Law and the prophets. — Now, we must admit, from the nature of the Divine Being, and from the relations in which rational beings stand to Him, and to one another, — that the Creator has enacted these laws, as the great governing princi-. pies by which the actions of all intelligences in heaven, as well as upon earth, are to be directed. For the Governor of the world can never be supposed to issue a law to any order of rational creatures, which wouid permit them to hate their Creator, or to hate those v/hom he hus formed after his own imaoe. Such a supposition v/ould be inconsistent with the eternal rules of rectitude, and with the perfections of Deity — and the facts supposed, (if it could exist,) would intro- duce confusion and mismy throughout the wliol^ intelligeul; RANGE OF DIVINE PROVIDENCE. universe. And, therefore, we must necessarily admit, that the laws to which I now advert, are hinding upon all the rational inhabitants which exist throughout Jehovah's dominions; and that it is by these that the moral order of all the Principalities and Powers of Heaven is preserved mu] directed. In those worlds where there is no change in the succession of their inhabitants — or, in other words, where there is no death, or where they are not produced by any process analogous to gen- eration, but have a iixed and permanent residence, there will be no need for moral precepts corresponding to the fifth and the seventh commandments of our moral law ; and in those worlds where property is common, and the boimties of the Creator are equally enjoyed by all, there will be no necessity for a law corresponding to the eight commandment ; but the general principles on which these laws are founded, will be applicable to all the other circumstances and relations which actually exist ; so that the principle, and spirif, and essence of our religion must be common to all the holy inhabitants of the universe. And, theretbre, it will follow, that every intelligent being that is animated and directed by such principles and affections, will be qualified for holding delightful intercourse with all holy beings throughout the universe of God, in what- ever province of the Creator's empire he may hereafter be placed ; and, to qualify us for such harmonious and affection- ate intercourses, is one great end of the Salvation exhibited in the Gospel. So that, although we cannot, in our present state, acquire a minute and comprehensive knowledge of the moral history of other worlds, of the special interpositions oi manifestations of Deity in relation to them, or of the means by which they are carried forward in moral and intellectual improvement — yet we can trace the general principles or laws which form the basis of their moral and religious economy. — For as the laws of optics, and the principle of gravitation, pervade the whole material system, as far as the universe is visible to our assisted vision, so the principle of supreme love to God, and sincere affection to fellow-intelligences must pervade the intellectual universe, wherever it extends ; and, if any intelligent agents besides men, have violated these laws, they must experience pain, and miser}^, and disorder, analogous to those which are ielt by the inhabitants of our apostate world. Thus I have endeavored to show, that the combination of Science with Religion would tend to expand our views of Divine Providence — in the various arrangements of God, in -elation to the human race, and to the suboidinate tribes of 20* 310 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER. sensitive beings — and in reference to some of the prominent features of his administration in distant worlds. And, there- fore, though the Christian ought never to overlook the ways of Providence in relation to himself, and to his spiritual and domestic concerns, yet it would argue a selfishness and a sottishness altogether inconsistent with the noble and expan- sive spirit of Christianity, to overlook all the other parts of the Theatre of Divine Dispensations, when a very slight degree of labor and research might be instrumental in unfold- ing them to his view. TV. — The connexion of Science with Religion would have a tendency to induce upon Christians a spirit of liberality, OF CANDOR, and 0/ ACCURACY IN JUDGING OF THE OPINIONS AND ACTIONS OF MEN, and 0^ THE DIVINE PROCEDURE AND OPERATIONS. Who is the most Candid and Liberal Being in the Uni- verse 1 God. — And why is God to be considered as the most Liberal Intelligence that exists? Because he embraces a minute, a full, and comprehensive view of all the circum- stances, connexions, relations, habits, motives, temptations, modes of thinking, educational biases, physical affections, and other causes that may inflaence the sentiments or the conduct of any of his creatures. — Who among created intel- ligences may be viewed as endowed with these qualities in the next degree 1 The loftiest seraph that God has created^ who has winged his way to numerous worlds, and taken the most extensive survey of the dispensations of the Almighty, and of all creatures and events. — Who, among the sons of men, is the most iUiberal and inaccurate in judging of opinions, of persons, and of things 1 The man who has lived all his days within the smoke of his father's chimney, or within the confines of his native village — who has never looked beyond the range of his own religious party — whose thoughts have always run in one narrow tract — whose reading has been confined to two or three musty volumes, which have lain for ages on the same smoky shelt^ — who cares for nothing either in the heavens or the earth, but in so far as it ministers to his convenience, his avarice, or his sensual enjoyment — who will admit no sentiment to be true, but what he may have heard broached by his parson — and whose conversation seldom rises beyond mere gossipping chit-chat, and the slanderous remarks which are circulated among his neighbors. — Such cha.-acters are entirely unqualiiied for forming a correct judg EXPANSION OF INTELLECTUAL VIEWS. 311 mcnt, either of the sentiments and the actions of men, or of the ^Vorks and the Ways of God ; for they are completely destitute of the requisite data whereon to form a rational de- cision in relation to either of these subjects. It may be admitted as a kind of axiom, in our estimate of human character, that in proportion to the ignorance, and the narrow range of view which characterize any individual, in a similar proportion will be his want of candor and his unfitness for passing a sound judgment on any subject that is laid be- fore him, — and that the man who has taken excursions through the widest range of thought, accompanied with a correspond- ing improvement of his moral powers, will always be the most liberal and candid in his decisions on the moral and intellec- tual qualities of others. To these maxims few exceptions will generally be found. — In forming an enlightened judgment in regard to any action or object, it is essentially requisite, that we contemplate it in all its ditlerent features and aspects, and in all its minute circumstances, bearings, and relations. We would not hesitate for a moment to determine who is best qualified to give an accurate description of a city, — he who has only viewed its spires from a distance, while in rapid mo- tion in his chariot— or he who has minutely surveyed all its streets, lanes, squares, public edifices, and surrounding scenery, in every variety of aspect ; or, who appears most likely to form the myst accurate and enlightened judgment in relation to any particular kingdom — he who has just skirted along a few miles on one of its coasts, or he who has traversed its length and breadth in all directions, and mingled with every class of its inhabitants. On the same principle, it must be admitted, that he who has viewed religion in all its aspects and bearings, who has taken the most extensive survey of the manifestations of God, and of the habits and relations of men, is the best qualified to pronounce a candid and accurate deci- sion on all the intellectual and moral cases that may come before him. If the spirit of the above-sta.tcd sentiments be founded on reason and on fact, it will follow, that the more we resemble God in the amplitude of our intellectual views and benevolent , affections, the more candid, and liberal, and accurate will our judgments be in reference to all the actions, objects, and rela- tions we contemplate. — On the other hand, the man who is confined to a narrov>^ range of thought and prospect is con- tinually blundering in the estimates he forms, both in respect to physical facts, to general principles, and to moral actions. lie forms a premature and uncharitable opinion on every 312 THE CHRISTIAN PHILOSOPHER, slander and report against his neighbor. He condemns, without hesitation, and throws an uinnerited odium on whole bodies of men, because one or two of their number may have displayed weakness or folly. He hates and despises men and their opinions, because they belong not to his political or religious party. He pronounces his decisions on the motives ot men, with as much coniidence as if he had surveyed their hearts with the eye of omniscience. He cannot hear an ob- jection against his favorite opinions with patience, nor an apology for any set of principles but his own. He is arrogant 9.nd dogmatical in his assertions, and will make no concessions £0 the superior wisdom of others. He sets himself, with vio- lence, against every proposal for reformation in the church, because his forefathers never thought of it, and because such i' innovations" do not suit his humor and preconceived opi- nions. He decides, in the most confident tone, on what God fan and cannot do, as if he had taken the gauge of Infinite Perfection ; and he frets at the Divine dispensations when they do not exactly quadrate with his own humors and selfish views. With regard to the operations of the Most High, he also 'brms the most foolish, and vague, and contradictory concep- tions. Tell hirn of the vast dimensions of the planetary sys- tem, of the men and animals that live on the opposite side of the globe, of the annual and diurnal motion of^ the earth- that this world and its inhabitants are moving through the re- gions of space many thousands of miles every hour — that one of the planets is so large that it would contain 1400 worlds as spacious as ours — -that another is flying through the tracts of immensity, at the rate of a hundred thousand miles in an hour — and that light is darted from the sun with a velo- city of 195,000 miles in a moment of time — he will stare at you with astonishment at such extravagant assertions, and will sooner believe the stories of giants 100 feet high, and of fairies that can enter in crowds through the key-hole of his door. Instead of frankly acknowledging that " He is igno- rant of such subjects, and of the grounds of such conclu- sions, — that those Vvho have studied them with intelligence are best capable of judging, — that, if true, they must fill us with admiration of the glory of God — but that, as he has nitherto had no opportunity of examining such matters, he must suspend his assent till he inquire into the reasons which can be siven for such amazing; deductions :" — instead of such concessions, which are the dictates of modesty and of com- mon sense — he will tell you at once, without hesitation, and EXPANSION OF INTELLECTUAL VIEAVS. 313 Avithout a blush at his presumptuous decisions, that " it is all extravagance, and folly, and idle romance, contrary to Scrip- ture, and reason, and conmion sense ;" and will not hesitate to brand you as a heretic, for endeavoring to break loose his intellectual trammels ! — thus tacitly declaring, that he is far better qualified to pronounce a decision on such topics, than all the philosophers and divines, and all the brightest geniuses • who have appeared in the world for ages past ; though he will at the same time admit, that he never gave hiniself the trouble to examine into such matters ! Ilis views of the providential dispensations of God are equally partial and distorted. If disease, or poverty, or mis- fortune, happen to his neighbor, especially if he had with- drav/n from the religious party to which he belongs, it is con- sidered as a penal judgment for his error and apostacy. It prosperous circumstances attend his family or his religious party, it is viewed as a sign of divine approbation. He seldom views the hand of God, except in uncommon occurrences ; and then, he imagines that a miracle is performed, and that the wheels of nature are stopped in order to accomplish the event.' He seldoni looks beyond the precincts of his own church or nation, to observe the movements of the Divine footsteps towards other tribes of his fallen race. He over- looks the traces of Divine operation which are every moment to be seen above and around him — and yet, in the midst of all such partial and contracted views, he will sometimes decide on the Wisdom and Rectitude of the ways of God, with as much conhdenco, as if he had entered into the secret counsels of the Eternal, and surveyed the whole plan of his procedure. Such are a few prominent outlines of the character of thousands whose names are enrolled as members of the visi- ble church — whose illiberality and self-conceit are owing to the contracted notions they have formed of God and of Reli- gion. And, surely, it must appear desirable to every enlight- ened Christian, that every proper means should be used to pre- vent rational immortal beings from remaining enchained in such mental thraldom. On the other hand, the man v/ho takes an enlightened view of all the worlvs and dispensations of God, and of all the cir- cumstances and relatioi'S of subordinate beings, necessarily acquires a nobleness and liberality of mind, and an accuracy in judging of things hum.an and divine, which no other person can possess. He does not hastily take up an evil report against his neighbor ; for he CQusicters how unfounded such 314 THE CHRISTIAN >HII,OSOPIIER. reports often are, and how much they are owing to the insinua- tions of envy or of maHce. And when he can no longer doubt of an evil action being substantiated against any one, he does not triumph over him in the language of execration ; for he considers all the circumstances, relations, feelings, and temptations with which he may have been surrounded ; he considers, that he himself is a frail sinful creature, and might possibly have fallen in a similar way, had he been placed in the same situation. He does not trumpet forth the praises of a man who has performed one brilliant benevolent deed, as if he were a character to be admired and eulogized — while the general course of his life is marked with vice, and an utter forgetfulness of God and Religion ; nor does he fix a stigma of immorality upon the person who may have acted foolishly or sinfully, in one or two instances, while the general tenor of his conduct has been marked by purity and rectitude : for, in both cases, he considers, that it is not an insulated action., but general habits, which determine the character of of any individual. He esteems the Wise and the Good, and holds friendly intercourse with them, to whatever political or religious party they belong. He can bear, with affability and candor, to have his opinions contradicted, and can differ from his neighbor in many disputed points, while, at the same time, he values and esteems him. He will not brand a man as a Heretic or a Deist, because he takes a view of some dogmas in Theology, in a different light from what he himself does ; for he considers the difference of habits, studies, pursuits, and educational prejudices which must have influenced his opi- nions ; and makes due allowance for the range of thought to which he may have been accustomrd. He is always dis- posed to attribute the actions of others to good motives, when he has no proof of the contrary. He uses no threats nor physical force to support his opinions, or to convince gainsayers ; for he knows that no external coercion can illu- minate the mind, and that the strength of arguments, and the force of truth, can alone produce conviction. He is con- vinced how ignorant he is, notwithstanding all his study, ob- servations, and researches, and presses forward, as long a? he lives, to higher degrees of knowledge and of moral im provement. He is an active promoter of every scheme that tends to enlighten and meliorate mankind, and to extend the knowledge of Salvation to the ends of the earth ; for he considers that it IS not by miracles, but by the subordinate agency of intelli- gent beings, that God will effectuate the illumination and the EXPANSION OF INTELLECTUAL VIEWS. 315 moral renovation of our apostate race. He views the special agency of God in all the movemisnts of the Scientific, the Religious, and the PoHtical worlds and perceives Him accom- )3lishing his purpose, in the inventions of human genius, and in the economy of the minutest insectj as well as in the earth- quake, the storm, and the convulsions of nations ; for he considers the smallest atom^ and the hosts of Heaven, as equally directed by Eternal Wisdom, and equally necessary in the universal chain of creatures and events. He displays a becoming modesty in speaking of the ways and the works of God. "When he meets with any dark and afllictive dispensa- tion in the course of Providence, he does not fret and repine, but is calm and resigned, conscious that he perceives only a small portion of the chain of God's dispensations, and is, therefore, unable to form a just comparison of the connexion of any one part with the whole. When he contemplates the depraved and wretched condition of the greater part of the world, at present, and for thousands of years pastj notwith- standing the salvation which has been achieved for sinners of mankind, he is far from arraigning the Divine goodness and rectitude, in leaving so many nations "to walk in their own ways ;" for he knows not what relation this dismal scene may bear, what influence it may have, or what important impres- sions it may produce on worlds and beings with which we are at present unacquainted. He is cautious in pronouncing decisively respecting the dis- pensations of God, in regard to the universe at large. He does not, for example, assert, with the utmost confidence, as some have done, " that there never was, and never will be, to all the ages of eternity, such a bright display of the Divine Glory as in the Cross of Christ."* He admires and adores the Condescension and the Love of God, in the plan of Salva- tion, which the Gospel exhibits, and feels an interest in it far beyond that of any other special manifestation of Deity; but he dares not set limits to the Divine Attributes and Operations. He considers himself at present, with regard to the grand system of the Universe, in a situation similar to that of a small insect on one of the stones of a magnificent edifice which sees only a few hair-breadths around it, and is altogether incapable of surveying the symmetry, the order, and beauty of the structure, and informing an adequate conception of the whole. He considers that he has never yet surveyed the miliioneth part of Jehovah's empire, and, therefore, cannot + S«c Xolf, px'^-^^*^^^® acquaintance with nature and science, com- binf^-"' with Christian principle, would also induce profoimd iiumility. The man who has made excursions through the most diversified regions of thought, is deeply sensible of the little progress he has attained, and of the vast and unbounded field of Divine science which still remains to be explored. When he considers the immense variety of sublime subjects which the volume of hispiration exhibits, and of which he has obtained but a very faint and imperfect glimpse — the compre- hensive extent, and the intricate windings of the operations of - Providence, and the infinite number of beings over which it \ extends — the amplitude and magnificence of that glorious uni- verse over which Jehovah piesides, and how small a portion of it lies open to his minute inspection — he is humbled in the dust at the view of his own insignificance ; he sees himself to be a very babe in knowledge ; and, as it were, just emerging from the gloom of ignorance into the first dawnings of light and intelligence. He feels the full force and spirit of the F et',3 sentiments — "Much learning shows hoio little mortals know." When he considers the comprehensive extent of the Divine law, and its numerous bearings on every part of his conduct, and on all the diversified relations in which he stands to his God, and to his fellow men ; and when he reflects on his mul- tiplied deviations from that eternal rule of rectitude, he is ashamed and confounded in the presence of the Holy One of Israel ; and, on a review of his former pride and self-conceit, is constrained to adopt the language of Agur and of Asaph — " Surely I am more brutish than any man, and have not the understanding of a man." " So foolish was I, and ignorauty 1 was as a beast before thee." He views the meanest and the most ignorant of his species, as but a very few degrees below him in the scale of intelligence, and sees no reason why he should glory over his fellows. This sentiment might be illustrated from the example of some of the most eminent men in whose minds science and religion were combined. The Honorable IMr. Boyle was the most unwearied and successful explorer of the works of God, in the age in which he lived, and all his philosophical pur- suits were consecrated to the service of Religion. Among other excellent traits in his character, hiunilihj was the most PTETY AND HUMILITY. 31S conspicuous. " He had about him," says Bishop Burnet, •' all that unafTccted neglect of pomp in clothes, lodging, furni- ture, and equipage, which agreed with liis grave and serious course of life," and was courteous and condescending to the meanest of his fellow men. '* lie had," says the same author, " the profoundest vcjueration for the Great God of Heaven and earth, that ever I observed in any person. The very name of God was never mentioned by him without a pause, and a visible stop in his discourse ;" and the tenor of his phi- losophical and theological writings is in complete unison with these traits of character. Sir Isaac Newton, too, whose genius seemed to know no limits but those of the visible uni- verse, was distinguished !>y his modesty, huiiiilitif^ and meekness of temper. He had such an /t»/»/j/e opinion of himself, that he had no relish of the ay>plause which was so deservedly paid him. He would have let others run away with the glory of his inventions, if his friends and countrymen had not been more jealous of his honor than he was himself. He said, a little before his death, " I do not know what I may appear to the world, but to myself, I seem to have been only like a boy play- ing on the sea-shore, and diverting myself in now and then finding a pebble or a prettier shell than ordinary, whil-st the great ocean of truth lay all undiscovered before me." The same sentiment might have been illustrated from the lives of Bacon, Locke, Dr. Boerhaave, Hervey, Nieuwentyt, Ray, Derham, the Abbe Pluche, Bonnet, and other eminent characters, who devoted their stores of knowledge to the illus- tration of the Christian system. For an extensive knowledge of the operations of God has a natural tendency to produce humility and veneration ; and wherever it is combined with pride and arrogance, either among philosophers or divines, it indicates a lamentable deficiency, if not a complete destitution of Christian principle, and of all those tempers which form the bond of union among holy intelligences. After the attention of Job had been directed to the works of God, and when he had contemplated the inexplicable phenomena of the Divine agency in the material world, he was ashamed and confounded at his former presumption ; and, in deep humility, exclaimed, " I have heard of thee by the hearing of the ear ; but now mine eye see thee ; wherefore I abhor myself, and repent in dust and ashes." — In accordance with what has been now stated, we find, that the most exalted inteihgences v.ho, oi course, possess the most extensive views of the works and providential arrangements of God, are represented as also the most humble in their deportment, and at> di.-jjlaying the most 320 THE CHRISTIAN rHILOSOPIIEK. profound reverence in their incessant adorations. They ^^ fall down before him who sits upon the throne \ and cast their crowns before the throne, imying, Thoi. art woithy, O Lord, to receive glory, and honor and power ; for thou hast created all things, and for thy pleasure they are and were created." I'heir moral conduct evinces the same lowly temper of mind. They wait around the throne, in the attitude of motion, with wings outspread ready to %, on the first signa^l of their Sove^ reign's will ; they " do his commandments, hearkening to the voice of his word," and do not disdain to perform important services, in aur wretched v/orld, to the meanest human being v/ho is numbered among " the heirs of salvation." In like manner, were we endued with the gri\sp of intellect, the capa- cious minds,, the extensive knowledge,^ and the moral powers which they po^sess^ we would also display the same humble and reverential spirit, and feel ashamed of those em,otions of vanity and piide, which dispo.se so many of the human family to look down with contempt on theiv fellow mortals. If the leading train of sentiment which pervades this volume be admitted, the following general conclusions maybe ad- duced : — That,, in conducting the religious instruction of the young, the works of God in the material world, and the most sti iking discoveries which hn,ve been made as to their magni- tude, variety, and mechanismj sho,uld be ftequently exh.ibited to their view in minute detail ; as illustrations of the attributes of the Deity, and of those descriptions of his nature and ope- rations contained in the Volume of In.^piration ;— that the books put into their hf^nds shotdd contain, among iithcr sub- jects, popular and striking descriptions cf the facts and appear^ ances of nature ; — that seminaries should be established for the occasional mstruction of young persons, from the age of 15 to the age of 20 or 30, or upwa.rds, in all those popular branches of natural and moral science which have a tendency to enlarge the capacity of their minds, and to expand their con- ceptions of the incessant agency of God ; — and that die Minis ters of Heligion, in their public instructions, should frequently blond their discussions of divine topics with illustrations de- viYOi\ from the scenes of creation and providence. APPENDIX CONTAINING NOTES AND ILLUSTRATIONS. >oio« No. L p. 48. — Illustration of the rate of motion in the Heaven- ly Bodies^ on the supposition that the Earth in at rest. The distance of the sun is about 95 millions of miles ; con- sequently, the diameter of the circle he would describe around the earth would be 190 milhons, and its circumferenco 597,142,857, which forms the extent of the circuit through Avhich he moiM move in 24 hours, if the earth were at re-t. This number divided by 24, gives 24,880,952, the number ot miles he woiild move in an hour ; and this last number, divided by 60, gives 414,682, the number of miles he would move in a minute. The nearest star is reckoned to be at least 20,000,000,000,000 or twenty billions of miles distant from the earth ; consequently, its daily circuit round our globe would measure more than 125,000,000,000,000 miles. This sum divided by 86,400, the number of seconds in a day, would give 1,454,861,111, or somewhat more than one thousand tour hundred millions of miles, for its rate of motion in a second of time — a motion which, were it actually existing, would, in all probability, shatter the universe to atoms. The unlearned reader may, perhaps, acquire a more distinct idea of this explanation from the following figure : APPENDIX. Let the small circle A^ in the centre, represent the Earth, and the circle B C D E the orhit of the S\m, on the supposi- tion that he moves round the Earth every 24 hours. The line A B will represent the distance of the Sun from the Earth, or 95 millions of miles ; the line B D the diameter of the orbit he would describe ; and the circle B C D E the circumfe- rence along v/hich he would move every day, or 597 millions of miles, ^yhich is somewhat more than three times the diame- ter. If the line A F represent the distance of the nearest star, the circle F G H I will represent the circuit through Vvhich it would move every 24 hours, if the earth were at rest. It is obvious, from the figure, that since the stars are at a greater distance from the earth than the sun, the circle they would describe around the earth would be larger in proportion, and, consequently, their velocities would be proportionably more rapid ; since they would move through their larger cir- cles in the same time in which the sun moved through his niii rower sphere. But the supposition that the earth is the APPENDIX. 323 centre of all the celestial motions, and that the diflerent stars arc daily moving around it with ditlerent velocities, and the slowest of these motions is so inconceivably rapid — is so wild and extravagant, that it appears altogether inconsistent with the harmony of the universe — with the Wisdom and Intelli- gence of the Deity, and with all the other arrangements he has made in the system of nature. No. XL p. 72. — Experlrnental JUustraUons of the Pressure of the Atmosphere. The prcflsure of the atmosphere is most strikingly illustrnted \)y me;ins of the air pinnp. But as tew persons, compara- tively, possess this instrument, the following experiments, which any person may perform at pleasure, are sufficiently convincing on this point. Take a common wineglass, and till it with water ; ap[)ly a piece of paper over the mouth of the glass ; press the paper to the rim of the glass with the palm of the hand ; turn the glass upside down ; withdraw the hand from the paper, and the water will he supported by the pres- sure of the atmosphere. That it is the atmospherical pressure, and not the paper, v/jiich supports the water is evident ; for the paper, instead of being pressed down by the weight of the water, is pressed upward by the pressure of the atmosphere, and appears concave^ or hollow in the middle. If the flame of a candle be applied to the paper, it may be held, for an indefi- nite length of time, close to the paper, without setting fire to it. The same fact is proved by the following experiment : — Take a glass tube, of any length, and of a narrow bore ; put one end of it in a basin of water ; apply the mouth to the other end, and draw out the air by suction ; the water will immediately rise toward the top of the tubd ; and if the finger or thumb be applied to the top of the tube, to prevent the admission of air, and the tube removed from the basin of water, the water in the tube will be supported by the pressure of the atmosphere on the lower end. Again : — Take, a wine glass, and burn a small bit of paper in it ; and, when the paper is burning, press the palm of the hand upon the mouth of the glass, and it will adhere to the hand with considerable force. In this case, the pressure of the atmosphere will be sensihlij felt ; for it will sometimes require considerable force to detach the glass from the hand. The pressure of the atmosphere explains a variety of com- mon phenomena. When we take a draught of water out of a 324 APPENDIX. basin, or a running stream, wo inimnrso our months in the water, and make a vacuum by drawing in the air ; the pres- sure of the atmosphere upon the external surface of the\vatcr then forces it into the mouth. The same cause exphuns the process of a child sucking its mother's breasts— the action of a boy's sucker, in lifting large stones — the rise of water in pumps — the effects produced by ceiaents— the firm adhesion of snails and periwinkles to rocks and stones — the scarcity of water in the time of hard frosts — and the fact that a cask will not run by the cock, unless a hole be opened in somo other part of the cask. r^o. III. p. 253. — On the means by which it may probably be ascertained whether the Moon be a habitable world. About six years ago, the Author published, in the Monthly Magazine, a few observations on the surface of the Moon, in which a few remarks were offered on this subject. The fol- lowing is an extract from that communication : — " If we be ever to obtain an ocidar demonstration of the habitability of any of the celestial orbs, the Moon is the only one, where we can expect to trace, by our telescopes, indica- tions of the agency of sentient or intelligent beings ; and 1 am pretty much convinced, that a long continued series of observations on this planet, by a number of individuals ml different places, might completely set at rest the question,] 'Whether the Moon be a habitable world?' "Were avast: number of persons, in different parts of the world, to devoto themselves to a particular survey of the Moon — were difFerent portions of her surface allotted to dilTerent individuals, as the object of their particular research — were every mountain, hi)\ cavern, cliff, and plain accurately inspected — and every change and modification in the appearance of particular spots carefully marked and represented in a series of delineations, it might lead to some certain conclusions, both as to her phy- sical constitution, and her ultimate destination. It can be demonstrated, that a telescope which magnifies 100 times,^ will show a spot on the Moon's surface, whose diameter isf 1223 yards ; and one which magnifies a thousand times, will, of course, enable us to perceive a portion of her surface, whose size is only 122 yards : and, consequently, an object,i whether natural or artificial, of no greater extent than one of^ our large edifices, (for example, St. Paul's Church, I^ondon,) may, by such an instrument, be easily distinguished. Now, AfPENDfX. 325 if every minute point on the Lunar surface were accurately marked by numerous observers, it might be ascertained whether any changes are taking place, either from " physical causes, o,r from the operations of intelligent agents. If a large forest were cutting down — if a city were building in an open plain, or extending its former boundaries — if a barren waste were changing into a scene of vegetation — or, if an inim,ense concourse of animated beings were occasionally assembled on a particular spot, or shifting from one place to another — such changes would be indicated by certain modifi- cations of shade, color, or motion ; and, consequently, would furnish a direct proof of the agency of intelligent beings analogous to man, and of the Moon l3eing a habitable globe. For although we may never be able to distinguish the inha- bitants of the Moon (if any exist) yet if we can trace those effects which can flow only tVom the operations of intelligent agents, it would form a complete demonstration of their ex- istence, on the same ground on which a Navigator concludes an unknown island, to be inh?,bited, when he perceives human habitations, and cultivated fields. '' That changes occasionally happen on the lunar hemi- sphere next the earth, appears from the observations of Her- schel and Schroeter, particularly from those of the latter. In the transactions of the ' Society of Natural Philosophy,' at Berlin, Schroeter relates,, that on the 30th December, 1791, at 5 o'clock, p. III. with a 7 feet reflector, magnifying IGl limes, he perceived the conTme"ncement of a small crater on the south-west declivity of the volcanic mountain in the Mare CriAiU/H, haying ^. shadow of at least 2'^ b. On the 11th Jaiuiary^ at 20 mitV'tes past five, on looking at this place again, he could see neither the new crater nor its shadow. Again, on the 4th January, 1792, he perceived, in the eastern crater ax Helicon, a central mountain, of a clear gray color, 3'^ in diameter, &f which, during^ many years' observations, he had perceived no trace. ^ Tin's appearance,' he adds, ' is remarkable, as probably from the time of Hevelius, the western |)art of Helicon has been forming into its present shape, and Nature seems, in that district, to be particularly active.' — In making such minute observations as those to wdiich I allude, it would be proper, along with an inspection of the moon's luminous disk, to mark the appearances of different portions of her dark hemisphere, when it is partially enlightened by the reflected light from the earth, soon alter the appearance of new moon. These researches would require a long-coii- Hnued series of the most minute observations, by numerous 326 APPENDIX. observers in different regions of the globe, which could bo effected only by exciting, among the bulk of mankind, a ge neral attention to such investigations. "But were this object accomplished, and were numerous observations made from the tops of mountains, and in the serene sky of southern climes, where the powers of the telescope are not counter acted by dense vapors, there can be little doubt that direci proofs would be obtained that the IMoon is a habitable world ; or, at least, that the question in relation to this point would be completely set at rest." No. IV. — Remarks on the lute pi^etended dis-covery of a Lunar \ Fortijication: The British Public was lately amused by the announce- ment of a discovery said to have been made by Professor Frauenhofer, of Munich. This gentleman was said to have discovered a Jortif cation in the Moon, and to have distin- guished several lines of road, supposed to be the Mork of the lunar inhabitants. It is scarcely necessary to say, that such announcements are obviously premature. To perceive dis- tinctly the shape of an object in the Moon, which resembles a fortification, it is requisite, that that object be of a much larger srze than our terrestrial ramparts. Besides, although an object resembling one of our fortifications were perceived on the surface of the moun, there would be no reason to con- clude, that it served the same purpose as fortifications do among us. We are so much accustomed to jnar in our ter- restrial system, and reflect so little on its diabolical nature, that we are apt to imagine that it must form a necessary em- ployment even in other worlds. To be assured that a fortifi- cation existed in the Moon for the same purpose as with us, would indeed be dismal tidings from another world ; for it woidd be a necessary conclusion, from such intelligence, that the inhabitants of that globe are actuated by the same princi- ples of depravity, ambition, and revenge, which have infected the moral atmosphere of our sublunary world. With regard to the pretended discovery of the lamar roads-^ it may not be improper to remark, that such roads behooved to be at least 400 feet broad, or ten times the breadth of ours, in order to be perceived as faint lines through a ttdescope which magnifies a thousand times ; which is a higher power, I presume, than Frauenhofer can apply with disiinclutss (o 8 age, tiiat lliis gentleman, wlio was among tiie first invent- ors ofs^eam navigation, and avIio lias done so much to promote its success in the neighborhood of Glasgow, has never received any jjublic reward lor his exertions, and has been left to sink mto a state approaclung to poverty. APPENDIX. elation, \>]y daily between Perth and Dundee ; each of thenr, during most of the summer months, transporting nearly a hun- dred passengers at every trip. Steam navigation, though less understood on the Continent than with us, is now beginning to make considerable progress. There are eight Steam-boats on the Garonne, and several on the Seine. There are two on the Lake of Geneva, and two are about to be established on the Lake Constance, and there are, besides, one or two on the Danube. It is likely, that in the course of a few years such conveya'nces will be estab- lished on alt our Friths and Rivers, and the period is, no doubt, hastening on, when excursions will be taken, in such vehicles, between Europe and America. A Steam-boat of 700 tons burden, and 100 horse power, has sailed regularly, summer and winter, for tliree or four years, between New York and* New Orleans, a distance of 2000 miles, in an open sea, ex- posed to great storms ; and, by many^ she is preferred to the packets, not only for the certainty of making shorter voyages,^ but on account of greater safety. In Anjerica, steam vessels are fitted \ip with every accommodation and elegancy which art can devise ; so as to produce, if possible, as great a vari- ety of enjoyment to passengers on sea, as on land. Mr. Church, the American Consul in France, has invented a pad- dle, which revolves on the paddle wheel, by very simple mechanism, which is found to save power. In the United States, a new mode of constructing cabins has been lately in- troduced, so as to place them beyond the reach of injury from explosions of the boiler. A steam vessel of a large size has lately been fitted up, which is intended to sail between Lon- don and Calcutta. " Steam vessels have been buiH in this country from 10 to 500 tons, and trom 3 or 4 to 110 horse power. The length of the City of Edinburgh, on the upper deck, is 143 feet ; and some have lately been constructed of still larger dimensions. The American steam-boats are larger than ours, and are much more used for the conveyance of merchandise. The Fron- tinac, which plies on the Canadian side of Lake Ontario, is 170 feet long on deck, and 32 feet broad ; and the Chancel- lor Livingston, which plies on the LIudson, is of the same size. TFio velocity aimed at is generally 8 or 9 miles an hour. The proportion is, on an average, about one horse power for every four tons of burden, computed in the usual way. The velocity Is found to be nearly as the square root of the power, so that an SO horse power engine will produce only tiuice the velocity of one of 20 horse po\?cr. Something APPENDIX. 337 depends also on the make and size of the vessel. The " Sover- eign," of 210 tons, and 80 horse power, goes 9 J miles an hour in still water ; and the " James Watt," of 44S tons, and 100 horse power, is stated to go ten miles. For the paddle- boards, the rule is, that 3-lOths of a square foot of surface should be immersed in the water for each horse power. The paddle wheels vary from 10 to 15 feet in diameter, dip from 12 to 20 inches in the water, and have about one foot in breadth for each 10 horse power. Mr. Gladstone affirms, that so much power is wasted in displacing the water by the stroke of the board, that the velocity of the ship is only about one half of that of the outer surface of the paddle-v/heel. " There are two sources of apprehension in steam-boats — fire, and the bursting of the boiler. With regard to the latter, when the boiler is of low pressure, it is satisfactorily establish- ed that not the smallest danger exists. And in the best con- structed vessels, the danger from lire is completely obviated, by separating the furnace from the sides of the vessels by five inches of water." — The power of steam is now rendered sub- servient to the breaking of stones for the construction of roads. The stones are put into a kind of hopper above, and pushed down with a rake, and the machine is worked by a rotatory motion of one horse power ; and will break a ton of hard peb bies, completely, in from six to eight minutes. A steam ma- chine has also been invented for the dressing of woollen cloth, which does as much work in 50 minutes as two men could do in two days. Mon. Mag. Aug. 1823, p. 71. — A steam car- riage, for conveying goods and passengers on land, was lately constructing by Mr. Griffiths. Its rate of motion, on common roads is estimated at five miles an hour, at an average ; about three miles when going up-hill, and above seven when running down. But pecuniary embarrassments, or other impediments, have, hitherto, prevented the completion of his design. Mr. Perkins has lately made improvements on the steam- engine, which promise to carry its powers to a high degree of perfection. The engine he has lately constructed is calculated to a ten horse power, though the cylinder is no more than two inches in dianietQr, and 18 inches long, with a stroke of only 12 inches. Although the space occupied by the engine is not more than six feet by eight, yet Mr. P. considers the appara- tus (with the exception of the working cyUnder and piston) is perfectly sufficient for a thirty horse engine. When the en- gine performs full work, it consumes only two bushels of coal in the day. Mr. Perkins has also announced a discovery still more extraordinary, viz. that he has been able *' to arrest tho 338 APPENDIX. heat, after it has performed its mechanical functions, and ac- tually pump it back to the generator, to unite with a tresh por- tion of water, a3xd renew its useful labors." A particular account of Perkins* engine, accompanied with an engraving, is given in the Edin. Philos. Journal, No. 17, for July 1823. The pretensions of Mr. Perkins, however, have, not yet been so fully substantiated by experiment as to satisfy the anxious expectation of the public. An interesting Report has lately been published of a series of experiments, made with a new steam engine, invented by an American machinist, called the capillary steam engine. Three great objects are said to be accomplished by this invention, light)iess, safety, and economy of fuel. In an engine calcu- lated for a four horse power, the generator, is formed of a cop- per tube i inch in diameter, and 100 feet long, which weighs about 16 lbs. It is arranged in coils, one above another^io the form of a sugar loaf, 30 inches high ; the bottom coil being 18 inches in diameter, and the top one considevably less. The wood is prepared as is usual for a stove, and put within the coils. The steam cylinder is formed of sheet copper, three inches in diameter, 27 inches in stroke, and, with all its append- ages, weighs about 25 lbs. It has been ascertained, that the ge- nerator and main cylinder, with their contents and appendages, exclusive of fuel, need not weigh more than 20 lbs. to the horse power. JVo harm can be done by the bursting of boilers — even a safety-valve is considered as useless. In the course of the experiments, the experimenters several times burst the tube ; but, so far from doing any injury, it could not always be perceived by the spectators. To ascertain what may be done towards aerial navigation, by steam, experiments were made on the power of wings in the air, and on the power necessary to work them. The result is, that it requires a horse power to carry 30 lbs. in the air ; so that a flying engine, to be workea by charcoal, would weigh -about 30 lbs. to the horse power, wings, condenser and fuel included. It was also ascertained by experiments and calculations, that a balloon could be made to carry a man with an engine, which would push it at the rate ot 15 miles an hour in the air. A more particular detail of those experiments may be seen in the " London Mechanic^ Maga JVo. X. p. 316. — Strictures on a certain sentiment respecting the Work of Human Redtmption. The sentiment referred to in this paragraph, " That there never was, nor ever will be, through all tifie ages of eternity APPENDIX. 339 SO wonderful a display of the Divine glory, as in the eross of Christ," has been reiterated a thousand times, in sermons and in systems of divinity, and is still repeated by certain preachers as if it were an incontrovertible axiom, which ought never to be called in question ; and is, no doubt, intended to magnify the Divine attributes, and the work of redemption.* But it is nothing more than a presumptuous assumption, which has a tendency to limit the perfections of Deity, and to present a partial and distorted view of the economy of human redemp- tion. For, in the first place, it has no foundation in Scrips tiire. There is not a single passage fiom which it can be legitimately deduced. The onus prohandi, on this point, * It is not. important to determine how often the sentiment liere ex pressed lias been " reiterated in sermons and systems of Divinity." We cannot, however, beheve that it has been repeated with the same frequen- cy, as the author's language seems to imply. That there are instances, in which it was designed to exj)ress all the meaning here attributed to it, cannot be denied. But M-hy may it not have been sometimes used to dis- ti)igaish the work of mediation ti-om all tlie other favors, which God has 'conferred on our race? hi his History of Redemption, j>. 342, President Edwards says, "from v/hat has been said, one may argue, that the -work of Redemption is the greatest of all God's works, of which we have any notice, and it is the end of all his other works." This view of the subject accords with the scriptures. Though it cannot be asserted, that in a single instance they directly affirm the work of redenijjtion to be the greatest of all the works of God, yet they give it such an importance and prominency, as are conceded to no other of His dispensations. In this light the Apostles seem to have regarded it. Paul counted all the distinc- tions and honors and advantages, wliich he had acquired amongst the Jews, as loss in comparison with the glory of the Gospel. He went even farther. He declared that he counted AJ^L THINGS but loss for the excellency of the knowledge of Christ .Tesus his Lord. In this vie\v of the subject there is no presumption and no limitation of the " divine perfec- tions and operations." It has no tendency either to damp the hopes, oi* •obscure the prospects of immortal beings. On the other hand who, tliat is not presumptuous beyond endurance, "will suppose, that he now understands the full extent of the iove of Christ ■and its bearings on all the other divine operations? "Who will dare to assert, that this theme will not be sufficient forever to employ the medita- tions and the songs of the redeemed? Has any one ascertained, that it is so limited, as to be soon exhausted ? On these topics the author is hap- pily silent; or rath.er he "pronounces nothing decisively;" but affirms, that were he " to hazard a conjecture," he should say, " that the converse of the proposition" under consideration " is true." But for ourselvesi \ " we feel chained doWn to an obscure corner of God's domains," and pos- sess no light except that which he has given us. In our present condition toe dare not launch with the author into the ocean of conjecture. Guided by the revelation which God has made, we are C(»m|)elled to regard the work of Redemption as the greatest of all the dnnne works of which we have any knowledge ; and we are satisfied, that the developemcnt of the relations and bearings and effects of this stupendous work will be suffi- cient to employ all our })owers of comprehension, and >i\cx to minister to us new and constant deli;:ht. Jim. Editor. 340 APPENDIX. re=ts with those who inake the assertion. A gentleman, when lately conversing on this subject, brought forward the follow- ing interrogation, as a demonstrative argument in proof of the position in question : " Is not Redemption declared in Scripture to be the chief of all the ivorks of God V but he M-as not a little surprised, when he v/as informed, that the passage which he had partly misquoted, is applied to the Behemoth or the Elephant, as stated in Job, xl. 19. — 2dly, the assertion is as presumptuous as it is unfounded. It takes for granted, that we know all the events which have already happened, and which are now taking place throughout the whole range of God's Universal Empire. This empire ap- pears unbounded ; and that portion of it v/hich we can mi- nutely explore, is but as a point in comparison of the whole. But before we can, on good grounds, hazard such an assertion as that under consideration, we must have explored all the dispensations of God, through every portion of his vast dominions ; and be able to form a comparison between the dilTerent displays of Divine glory, made to all the diflerent classes of intellectual beings, under the government of the Creator. And Avho, among the sons of Adam, can lay claim to such high qualifications for pronouncing so sweeping a de- cision on this point ? 3dly, It sets limits to the Divine per- fections and operations. For although it could be proved, (which it cannot be,) that no such displays have hitherto been made to any other beings, yet who can take upon him to assert, that displays of Divine perfection far more glorious and astonishing, will not be exhibited during the countless ages of eternity v/hich are yet to come 1 To set limits to the operations of Almighty Power and Boundless Benevolence, during the lapse of infinite duration, is not the province of any created intelligence, and far less of man, who stands so low m the scale of universal being. 4thly, It tends to damp the hopes and prospects of immortal beings^ when looking forward to an interminalde existence. For this sentiment leads them to conclude,^that they are already acquainted with the greatest display of Divine glory which can be made ; and that what- ever scenes of wonder may be exhibited in the future v.orld. they must, of course, be all inferior to this, in point of extent: and grandeur. The Redemption of the human race, as displayed in the Christian Revelation, is a theme sufficiently grand, astonish- ing, and interesting, to command the attention of all who arfl convinced th;\t they belong to an apostate race of intelligences, and to excite the admiration aiid gratitude of all who have ' APPENDIX. 541 Experienced its benefits ; and it stands in no need of such unfounded and extravagant assertions, to display its riches ^nd glory. " Will a man speak deceitfully for God ? Shall not his excellency make you afraid? and his dread fall upon you?" — We pronounce nothirtg decisively on this subject. We feel ourselves chained do%h to an obscure corner of God's dominions, to be in the very infancy of our knowledge, and withal, to be connected with a race of beings whose " understandings are darkened by reason of sin ;" and are therefore unable to ipronounce an infallible decision on what God will, or tiili not do. Were we to hazard a conjecture on this subject, we would say, that the converse of the proposition under consideration, is moi'e probable than the proposition itself. We can conceive worlds 'ten thousand times 'more populous than ours, and peopled with a higher order of intel- lectual beings, towards whom a similar display of Benevo» lence and Mercy, were it necessary, may be made ; and, therefore, in point of the extent of its objects, we can conceive the Love of God more illustriously manifested than even to the inhabitants of out globe. But whether such an event shall ever take place, it would be presumption in us to deter- mine. For the thoughts and the ways of God as far trans- cend ours, " as the heavens are high above the earth." It ilemands oiu* highest tribute of grateful adoration, that the Almighty condescended to ** regard us in our low estate," and to deliver us from the moral degradation into which we had fallen ; but, surely, it would be unreasonable to/coii eluded, from this consideration, that, of all the rational tribes which people the universe, Man is the only favorite of the most High, " when thousand worlds are roimd." Though myriads of other intelligences were to share in similar favors, it would not lessen the happiriess conferred on us, nor ought it in the least, to detract from our admiration of " the love of God", \vhich is in Christ Jesus our Lord." ! There are a great many other vague and untenable notions \v1lich are entertained and reiterated by ceitafn commentators and divines, as indisputable axioms, which it would be of im- portance to the cause of Religion to discard ; such as — that angels are pure immaterial substances* — that they were formed on the first day of the Mosaic creation — that the wisdom of God is no where so illustriously displayed through- * In the Scriptures angels arc called Spirits. And till some evidence is offered of their materiality we shall see no reason to abandon the opinion, that they are pure s^pirits, — E(t 29 S42 APPENDIX. out the universe as in the scheme of redemption* — that the chief employment of the future world will be to pry into the mysleries of salvation^ — that sin is an wjinite evilj— that, the whole material universe was brought iiito existence at the same time with oin- earth — that the Creator ceased to create any new order of beings in the universe, after arranging the ikbric of our gloljc — -that the whole system of material nature in heaven and earth, will be destroyed at^he period of the dis- .-.o'ution of our world — that our thoughts and aflections should be completely detached from all created things, &g. &c. — ^ Several vague notions of this descrij)tion are founded on the ia'se assmription, that the globe we inhabit, and the rational , beings that have appeared on its surface from age to age, are I the chief objects of God's Superintendence and Care— and, ^ ihat the Scriptures are the onhj medium through which we can j view the plans and operations of the Deity — assumptions, which are contrary to reason, which are unwarranted in Re- velation, nay, which are directly contradicted in numerous passages of Scripture, some of which have already been referred to in the course of this volume. It would be of * To show that it is important to discard this sentiment, the autlior ought at least to liave stated some good reason for behoving it to be witli- «mL foundation. Unfil something more decisive of this point shall be made to appear, th&ie cannot be the least occasion to abandon the sentunent in question. — Ed. t Here substantially the same reply may be made as in the preceding instance. Prove, that this will not be the chief employment of heaven — Show, that any thing else will, for the inost part, occuiw the attention of Th(; spirits of just men made pei-ft>ct in glory, and the sentiment under con- .sitlo.ration will be readily renounced. Till then we shall claim the right, t<» believe, and maintain, that tlie employment of t4ie redeemed in glory ^vill ♦•oiisist, to a great extent, in beholding, admiring, and adoring Hian, who liatli loved them and died for tliem. — Ed. 1 Infinite is once used in the scriptures to qualify the term iniquity. Job xxii. 5. Is iwt thy wickedness great and thine iaiqitities infinite ? But not to insist on perhaps a too literal interprotatiojfl of the term, it will be ^.a^Hclent to show what it is ordinarily used to denote. Some authors, regarding only the very limited faculties and .powevs of himan beings, deem it impossible, that any of their deeds can be an infi- ivle (vil, ' /liicrs, considering only the infinity of the Being against whom sin is ;■ : uiiiiLted, find no difficulty in convinciiog themselves, that it is an infinite 'iliere is also a third class, who taking the word of God for their guide, ii)(j learning that sin exposes men to everlasting punishment, do not hesi- tate to denomi)iate that an infinite evil, which brings on its guilty victim sutTn-ings infinite iu duration. Understood in this last sense, we can feel no obligation to reject it. It must, however, be admitted that it is not i always used in this manner, and that it is. »oin«timuJ> an occasion of ambi^ i:ui!y.— J2c/. appendix:. 343 essential service to the cruise of Chri^lianil7, that iti! doc- trines, factf, and rporal requisitions were imiformly exhibited in their native simplicity and grandeur, without being obTscured and distorted by the vague and exfravajiant representa- tions with which they are too frequently blended by injudicious minds. No. XI. As authority has a considerable degree of v/elght on some minds, I shall conclude with an extract on the subject of this volume, from that respectable and enlightened divine, Dr. DwiGiiT, late President of Yale College: — "The works of God were by him intended to be, and arc, in fact, manifesta- tions of himscif; proofs of his character, presence, and agency. In this light he requires men continually to regard them : and to refuse this regard is considered by him as grossly wicked, and highly deserving of punishment, Psalm xxviii. 5. Isa. v. 12 — 14. I am apprehensive, that even good men are prone to pay less attention to the v/orks of creation and providence than piety demands, and the Scriptures re- quire. We say ajid hear so much concerning the insufficiency of these works to unfold the character of God, and the nature of genuine religion, that we are prone to consider them as almost uninstructive in moral things, and, in a great measure, useless to tho promotion of piety. This, however, is a palpa- ble and dangerous error. The works alone, v.ithout the aid c f the Scriptures, would, I acknowledge, be far less instructive than they now are, and utterly insutBcient to guide us in the way of righteousness. The Scriptures were designed to be a comment on these works ; to explain their nature, and ic show us the agency, purposes, wisdom, and goodness of Geo in their formation. . Thus explained, thus illtuninated, thnr become means of knowledge, very extensive and eminent.;; useful. He who does not find in the various, beautiful, sub- lime, awfid, and astonishing objects presented to us in Crema- tion and Providence, irresistible and glorious reasons, for ad- miring, adoring, loving, and praising his Creator, has n(it v claim to evangelical piety." — Sy&lcjii of Thtoloi^y, vol. iii. p. 477. Kg. XII. — List of Popular Worls on the different Sciences treated of hi this Volmtie, vjiih occasional Remarks. SELECT BOOKS OF NATURAL HISTORY. " GoldsTTiith's History of the Earth, and animated nature,'' with notes by T. Brown, Esq. published at Manchester, 6 344 APPENDIX. I vols. 8vo. The copious not^s appended to this editioft, con<- tain an account of the latest discoveries, and form a valuable , addition to the original work. — " The Gallery of Nature, and^ Art," by Dr. Mason Good, and others, 6 vols. 8vo.— " Spec'', tack de la JYature,^^ or, Nature Displayed, 7 vols. 12mo. — • ' " Nature Displayed," by Dr. Simeon Shaw, 3 vols. Svo. or itt 6 vols. 12mo. This work, though chiefly a compilation, embodies a great variety of interesting and popular descripi^ tions of the most remarkable facts in the system of nature, which are illustrated with numerous engravings, both plain and colored. — Clarke's " Hundred Wonder.s of the Wotld,'*^. 1 vol. 12mo. and Piatt's " Book of Curiosities," contain, a. number of interesting selections on this subject. — Smellie'S; " Philosophy of Natural History," 2 vols. 4to. and his trans- lation of " Buffon's Natural History."— Worlis entitled, " System" and ", Ekmients" of " NaturaJ His^oij," are nu- merous ; but tiie greatest part of thent is QDi>,fined to descrip- tions of the forms, habits, and instinct of animals. On this department of natural science, a work is just now irtcom^e of publication, by the celebrated Cuvier^^ entitled ", The Animal Kingdom,^^ with engravings, chiefly from the living subjects in the Museum of Natural History at Paris. — A popular and comprehensive History of the facts which have beeii ascer- tained respectiiag. the earth, the atmosphere, the meteors, the heavens, &c. calculated for general readers, and interspersed with appropriate moral and rehgious reflections, is still a desi-^ deratum. The facts of Natural History^ n.ext to the facts recorded in tli.e Sacred Volume, are the first subjects to which the minds of the young should be directed in the course of a general educatLop. SJSLECT BOOKS ON GEOGRAPHY. Pinkerton's^ Modern Geography, 2 vols. 4to. and the Abridgment, 1 vol. Svo. — Guthrie's Geographical Grammar. — The Glasgow Geography, in 5 vols. Svo. This work com- prehends an imnjense mass of informa;tio.n, on the historical and descriptive parts of Geography. It also contains com- prehensive comperwLs of Astronomy, Geology, Meteorology, &;c. — Make Brun's " System of Geography," Svo. Th^. English transla,iion of this work, when completed, will com^ prise the fullest and most comprehensive view of Universal Geography tliat has yet appeared in our language, including details of the most receat discoveries. Five volumes of the APPENDIX. 3^, English translation have already appeared. The first volume contains a luminous and comprehensive op.tline of the Kcience of Geology, and Physical and Mathematical Geography. — Myer's " Systeiti of Modern Geography," with maps, views, engraving's representing costumew, &c. 2 large vols. "^to. — Cooke's " System of Universal Geography," in 2 very large quarto vol^. closely printed, contains a great variety of inter- estin"- sketches in relation to Descriptive Geography, ex- tracted from the writings of modern Voyagers and Travellers; the details of incidents^ &c. being related, for the most part, m the words of the respective authors from whom the infor- mation is collected. — Winterbotham's " Geographical and historical view of the United States of America, &c." four v^ols. Svo. — Morse's " American Geography," 8vo. — Gold- smith's " Geography on a p©pular plan," contains an interest- ing account of the manners and customs of nations, for the entertainment and instruction of the yaung, illustrated with above 60 engravings. Of smaller systems, there is a great abundance in the English language, but most of them are extremely deficient, particularly in what relates to General vrcography. — On Sacred Geography, Well's Geography, mo- dernized by the Editor of Calmet's Dictionary, is the most complete work of its kind.-— On Plujsical or General Geogra- phy — Play fair's System of Geography, vol. 1. and Varenius's General Geography. A Modern sijstem. of General Geo- graphy, in a separate form, on the plan of Yarenius, is a desi- deratum. — Edin. Ency. Art. Geograph}^ — Sup. to Ency. Brit. Art. Physical Geography, &c. &c. Books of Voyages and Travels, generally contain the most circumstantial detii'fe ef the physical aspects of the ditferent countries, and of tiic dispositions and customs of their inhabitants ; and present to tlie view of the Christian Philanthropist, those facts and inci- dents, from which the moral state and character of the -variou? tribes of human beings may be inferred. The foiloNvin.>; works contain comprehensive abridgments of the most ceie brated voyages and travels. — " Pinkerton's General Collec- tion of Voyages and TraveJs in all parts of the v/orld," 17 vols. 4to. — " Mavor's Voyag-es," &c. 28 vols. ISmo. — '' The "World Dis-played," IS vols. 18mo. — " Philip's Collection of Voyages and Travels," &c. The following are among the most respectable modern pub' liications on this subject, arranged according to the ditferent quarters of the World. Asia. — "Valencia's Travels in Indio^ Arabia," &c. — " Porter's Travels in Georgia, Armenia," &e, — " Golownin's Travels in Japan." " Staunton's Account ol 20* 346' APPENDIX. Macartney's Embassy to China." *' Raffle's Travels in. Java." " Clark's Travels in Asia INIinor.^ and the Holy Land." " Chateaubriand's Travels in Palestine." "Ali Bey's, Travels iaa Arabia."— "Morier's Travels through Persia," &c Africa. — "Lyon's Travels in Northern Africa." Burckhard's, Travels in .Nubia. Bruce's Travels iii Abyssinia, Salt's^ Travels in Abyssinia. Bowdich, Hutton, and Dupuis' Ac-. i:,ount o^ Asjtaniee. Leigh's Jour, in, Egypt. Belzoni's Tra- vels in Egypt. Sonini's Travels in Egypt. Barrow's, Burr chell's, and Campbell's, Travels in Southern Africa, &c. &c, America. — Howison's Sketches of Upper Canada. Fearon's Sketches of the United States. Miss Wright's Views of Society in the United States. Humboldt's Travels in South. America. Duncan's Travels in the Unitadr States. Luccock's, Vidal's, Kosters's, and Hall's Travelsjin. South America, &c. Europe. — Henderson's and Mackenzie's Travels in Icelandi — Thompson's Travels in Sweden. — Carr's Travels in Russia, Denmark, &c. Pallas' Travels in. Russia. — =WraxaU's, N,eale's, Coxe's, and Lemaistre's Tours through France, Switzerland, Germany, &c. — Bourgoing's and Jacob's Tra- vels in Spain. — Brydon's Tour in Sicily, &.C.— Yon Buch's Travels in Norway and Lapland. — Cochrane's Travels in Siberia, &c. — Cook's, Anson's, Bryon's, Perouse's, and Bou- ganville's Voyages round the World, &c. — Prior's Universal Traveller, 1 thick vol. 12mo, closely printed with one hundred SELECT BOOKS ON GEOLOGY. Kirwau's "Mineralogy," and his "Geological Essays."— De Luc's "Geology," and his "Geological Travels." — Par- kinson's " Organic Remains of a former World," 3 vols. 4to, — " The Fosiiis of the South Downs, or Illustiations of th^ Geology of Sussex, by G. Mantel, F. L. S." The prelimi- nary Essay to this splendid work, contains several excellent remarks respecting the connexion of Geology with Religion, which are calculated to advance the interests of both. — Cuvier's " Essay on the Theory of the Earth," with illustra- tions by Professor Jumeson ; 4th edition. — Playfair's illustra- tions of the Huttonian Theory of the Earth. — Transactions of the Geological and Wernerian Societies. — Jameson's Min- eralogy. — Buckland's Account of the Discovery of a Den of Hyenas in a cavern in. Yorkshire. — Philips' " Outlines of Min- eralogy and Geology," 12mo. This last work forms a good introduction to the study of Geology, for those who are just APPENDIX. 347 CommenciHg their inquiries on this subject. The object of this science, in. the mean time, should be chiefly to the collect' ing of facts in reference to the structure of the earth, and the changes it has undergone. The exterior aspect of pur globe, and its internal recesses, must be still more extensively explored, before any theory of the earth can be established on a broad and solid foundation. It should be left to future ages to build a system with the materials, we are now preparing. POPULAR WORKS ON ASTRONOMY. Brewster's "Ferguson's Astronomy," 2 vols. 8vo. with a vol. of plates. The notes and supplementary chapters of this work, written by Dr. Brewster, contain a full and comprehen- sive detail of ali the modern discoveries in this science. — ", Bonnycastle's Introduction, to Astronomy," 1 vol. 8vo. — La Place's " System of the World'," 2 vols. 8vo. Dr. Olinthus Gregory's Astronomy, 1 vol. Svo. — Mrs. Bryan's " System of Astronomy," S-vo,-— Dr. Mylne's " Elementary Treatise on Astronomy," Svo. — Adam's" Astronomical and Geographical Essays,'-' Svo. — Philips' ',' Eight Familiar Lectures on Astro- nomy," 12mo. — Squire's ',' Grammar of Astronomy," 1 thick vol. ISmo. closely printed and illustrated with 35 plates. — The " Wonders of the Heavens," 12mo. This work contains a popular view of the principal facts of Astronomy, and is illustrated with 50 elegant engravings, of a variety of interest- ing objects connected with the scenery of the heavens ; but its discussions are too frequently blended with the peculiari- ties of a modern physical theory. — Martin's " Gentleman and Lady's Philosophy," vol. 1. — Derham's "Astro-Theology,** and Whiston's " Astronomical principles of Religion," Svo. — Baxter's " Matho," 2 vols. &c. — An elegant and compre- hensive outline of the leading facts of Astronomy, in their re- lation to revealed Religion, wijl be found in Dr. Chalmers* " Discourses on the Christian Revelation, viewed in conneo- tion with the Modern Astronomy," Svo. — The general reader in commencing his study of this science, will find Bonnycas- tle's " Introduction" a very interesting work. It is written in an elegant and animated style, and is agreeably interspersed with a number of a.ppropriate reflections ; but it is deficient in the detail of modern discoveries. He might next proceed to the perusal of Ferguson, Gregory, Squire, &c. La Place's work contains a beautitul exposition of the Newtonian System, but it is glaringly deficient in a reference to the Wisdom and Agency of a Supreme Intelligence. " An undevout astrono- mer is mad." Baxter's " Matho," contains a popular and 3 40 APPENDIX. interesting view of this 3u])ieet and forms a striking contrast to tlic apathy of La Place, wlio carei'iilly keeps out of view the agency of the Creator — the main design of this anthor being to connect the phenomena of the heavens and the earth with the attributes of Deity, and the high destination of immortal minds. Though this work passed through three editions, it^ does not seem to have been appreciated according to its merits. As it has now become scarce, a new edition, with 7wtes, con- taining a detail of modern discoveries, might be an acceptable present to the public. Those who wish to prosecute this subject to a greater extent, may be referred to " Long's Astro- nomy," 2 vols. 4to. — B^obinsoivs " Mechanical Philosophy,'* vol. 1. — Yince's "Complete System of Astronomy," 3 vols. 4to. — " La Lande Jislronomie,''^ 3 volumns 4to. — and Biot's " Traite Elementaire d' Astronomic Physique." A compre- hensive work on Descriptive Jlstrononiy, detailing, in a popular manner, all the facts which have been ascertained respecting the scenery of the heavens, accoinpanicd with a_ variety of striking delineations, and interspersed with apjn-opriate moral reflections, accommodated to the general reader, is a diside- ratum, SELECT BOOKS ON NATURAL rHILOSOniY. Ilauy's " Elementary treatise on Natural Philosophy," translated by Dr. O. Gregory, 2 vols. 8vo. This translation contains a number of valuable notes by the translator. — l.^'or-j guson's " Lectures on Select Subjects in TMcchanies," &r. by Dr. Brewster, 2 vols. 8vo. with a vol. of plates. The Appendix to this work, by Dr. Brewster, contains a mass of vahiable information on Mechanics, ilydraulich^, Dialling, and the construction of Oplieal Insinimejit.s ; besides a^arie}y of illustrative notes iiiterspersedthrough the body of the worlc. x\ new edition of this work,, comprising a detailed account of the recent discoveries in Experimentat Philosophy, has been lately pul>lished. — Nicliolson's '' Intrr^duction to Natural Phi- loso-phy," 2 vols. Svo. — Cavallo's *^ Complete Treatise on Natural and Experimental Philosophy," 4 vols. Svo. — Mar- tin's " Philcsophia Britannica," 3 vols. Svo. His " (-Jentlomun and Lady's Philosophy," 3 vols. Svo. and his Philosophical Grammar," 1 vol. Svo. — Gregory's "Economy of Nature, 3 vols. Svo. and his " Lectures on Experimental Philoso- phy, Astronomy, and Chemistry," 2 vols. 12mo. — Joyce's "Letters on Experimental Philosophy," 2 vols. 12mo. — and his ^' Scientific Dialogues," 6 vols. 18mo. — Adams' " Lec- tures on Natural and ]^2xperimental Philosophy," 4 vols., ^ APPENDIX. S49 Svo. with a vol. of plates. — Young's " Lectures on Natural Philosophy," 2 vofe. 8yo. — Walker's system of " Familiar Philosophy," 4to. in 12 lectures, with 47 quart,o engravings. — Conversations on Natural Philosophy, by the Author of Conversations, on Chemistry, 1 thick vol. 12mo. with 23 en- gravings. — Blair's " Grammar of Natural and Experimental Philosophy," especially the late editions, contains (at a small price) a comprehensive view of the principal departments of Pliilosophy, including Astronomy, GeoLogy, Chemistry, Me- teorology, &c.-— Euler's " Letters to a German Princess," 2 vok. Svo. contains a popular view of the most interesting sub- jects connected with Natural and Experimental Philosophy, Logic, and Ethijcs. This work is distinguished by a vein of dignified and scriptural piety, which runs through every part of it. Euler was one of the rnost distinguished Philosophers and Mathematicians of his day. He died in 1783, at the age of 77. A new edition of this work, with notes by Dr. Brewster, has been lat,ely published. These notes are excellent, so far as they extend ; but it is to be regretted that they are so sparingly distrib^ited, and that the passages suppressed by M. Condorcet, and De la Ci'oix, which were restored by Dr. Hunter, who trai^lated the work, and the notes of the French and English editors, are, for the most part, discarded. Not- withstanding the numerous excellent treatises which are to be found on this subject, a comprehensive work on experimental Philosophy, blended with sketches of those parts of natural history, which are connected with it, and enlivened with ap}>ro- priate reflections on the pecuhar agencies of the Deity, which appear 'n\ the various processes of nature — is still wanting to interest the general reader,^ and to attract his attention to this departrnent of knowledge. Were philosophers in their dis- cussions of natural science, more frequently to advert to the agency of the Deity, and to point out the Rehgious and Phi- lanthropic purposes to which modern discoveries might be applied, they might be the means of promoting, at the same time, the interests both of science and of religion ; by alluring general readers to dii-ect their attention to such subjects ; and by removing those groundless, prejudices which a great propor- tion of the Christian world still entertain against philosophical studies. About the period when Boyle, Ray, Derham, Nieuwenlyt, Wbiston,. Addison, the Abbe Pluche, and other Christian Philosophers flourished, more attention seems to have been paid, to this object than at present. Since the mid- dte oftlie last century, the piety of philosophers appears to have been greatly on the decline. It is to be hoped that it is a.ow 350 APPENDIX. beginning to experience a revivnl. But, whatever may be the varying sentiments and feehngs of mere philosophers, in re- ference to the agencies of the material systcjin-—" all the works af God invariably speak of their Author," to the huwable and enlightened Christian; and if he be directed to contemplate the order of nature, with an eye of intelligence, he will never be at a loss to trace the footsteps and the attributes of his Father and his God. SELECT COOKS ON CHEMISTRY. Davy's Elements of Chemical Philosophy, 8vo. — Ure's Dictionary of Chemistry, on the basis of Mr. IN icholson's, one large vol. 8vo. Henry's Epitome of Chemistry, 2 vols. 8vo. — Accum's Chemistry, 2 vols. Svo. — Thomson's system of Chemistry, 4 vols. Svo. — Murray's System of Chemistry, 4 vols. Svo. and Appendix. — Kerr's translation of Lavoisier's Elements of Chemistry, Svo. — Chaptal's Chemistry, applied to the Arts, 4 vols. Svo. — Fourcroy's Chemistry, 4 vols. — Accurn's " Chemical Amusements," and Griflui's " Chemical Recreations," contain a description of a variety of interesting Chemical facts and amusing experiments. — Gurney's Lec- tures on the Elements of Chemical Science, Svo. — Macken- zie's One Thousand Experiments in Chemistry, &c. — Mitch- ell's Dictionary of Chemistry. — Conversations on Chcm.istry, by a Lady, 2 vols. 12mo. — Joyce's Dialogues on Chemistry, 2 vols. ISmo. — Parker's Rudiments of Chemistry, ISnio. and his Chemical Catechism, Svo. — The four works last mention- ed may be recommended as popular introductions to the study of this science. Parkes' Rudiments and Catechism are dis- tinguished by their constant reference to the agency of the Deity, and by the anxiety v/hich the author displays to fix the attention of his readers on the evihat the Bridgewater Treatises are to do in eight. We wish one-eighth of the reward only may make its way to Dunfermline. Mr. Fergus's Treatise goes over the whole ground with fervor and ability; it is an excellent volume, and may be had for somewhere about about half the price of one Bridgewater octavo. — Lon- don Spectator. A work of great research and great talent. — Evangelical Magazine. A very seasonable and valuable work. Its pliilosopliy is unimpeachable, and its theology pure and elevated.— JVew Monthly Mag. This is an elegant and enlighted work, of a pious and highly gifted man. — Metroi)olitan Magazine. This excellent work contains, in a brief space, all that is likely to be useful in the Bridgewater Treatises, and displays infinitely more of original thought and patient research, than the two volumes which have been recently published by the managers of his lordship's legacy. We have never seen any work in which the necessity of a revelation was more clearly demonstrated, while at the same time its due importance was assigned to natural religion. We hope that the work will be extensively used in the education of youth ; it is admirably calculated to stimulate students to scientific research, and the ob- servation of Nature; it suggests subjects of contemplation, by which the mind must be both delighted and instructed ; and, finally, it teaches the most sublinii!' of all lessons, admiration of the power, delight in the wisdom, and gratitude for the love of our Creator. — Athencbum. LETTERS FROM THE^ORTH OF EUROPE, Or Journal of Travels in Holland, Denmark, Norway, Sweden, Finland, Russia, Prussia, and Saxony. By Charles B. Elliott, Esq. This is one of those remarkably pleasant tours which an intelligent gentle- man, who has seen much of the world, is alone calculated to write — one of those productions which engage the attention and do not fatigue it, and whicli we read from first to last with the agreeable sensation, that we are gathering the information of very extensive travel easily, by our own fireside. — London Lite- rary Oa-.ette. ■WORKS REOESi-TXilT PUBI.ISS'IED YOUNG MAN'S OWN BOOK. A Manual of Politeness, Intellectual Improvement, and Moral Deportment, calculated to form the character on a solid basis, and to insure respectability and success in life. Its contents are made up of brief and well written essays upon subjects very judiciously selected, and will prove a useful and valuable work to those who give it a careful reading, and make proper use of those hints which the author throws out. — Boston Trav. We cheerfully recommend a perusal of the Young Man's Own Book to all our young friends, for we are convinced that if they read it faithfully, they will find themselves both wiser and better.— T'/^e Young Man's Advocate. In the Young Man's Own Book, much sound advice upon a variety of im- portant subjects is administered, and a large number of rules are laid down for the regulation of conduct, the practice of which cannot fail to insure respecta- bility. — Saturday Courier. JOURNAL OF A NOBLEMAN; Being a Narrative of his residence at Vienna, during Congress. The author is quite spirited in his remarks on occurrences, and his sketches of character are picturesque and amusing. We commend this volume to our read- ers as a very entertaining production. — Daily Intel. We presume no one could take up this little volume and dip into it, without feeling regret at being obliged by any cause to put it down before it was read. The style is fine, as a>e the descriptions, the persons introduced, together with the anecdotes, and in general, the entire sketching is by the hand of a master. Everything appears natural — there is no affectation of learning — no overstrain- i,ia!72//nai/if Intel. THE CHURCH OF GOD, In a Series of Dissertations, by the Rev. Robert Wilson Evans, of Trinity College, Cambridge. The object of the writer is to show that the fundamental doctrines of the Christian Religion have been taught in the various dispensations, from the in- stitution of the Church in the family of Adam, to the more clear and perfect exposition of its principles by the Savior and iiis apostles. He is thus led to deal wholly with general principles — those in which the great body of Christians agree. This frees his work from all savor of sectarianism, and the ingenuity aud talent exhibited in its execution, commend it to the religious of every name. It would perhaps be well to say, that the above work is by the author of " Rec- tory of Valehead." — Episcopal Recorder. THE PROGRESSIVE EXPERIENCE OF THE HEART, UNDER THE DISCIPLINE OF THE HOLY GHOST, FROM REGENERATION TO MATURITY. By Mrs. Stevens. This is a work which may be recommended to religions readers and to serious inquirers, with great safety. It is written in an impressive style, and is evi- dently the production of a mind and heart thoroughly imbued with Christian knowledge and experience. The operations of the Holy Ghost upon the soul of man, are traced with a discrimination which nothing but a personal experience of his influences could have furnished. Doddridge's Rise and Progress of Reli- gion in the Soul, is an admirable book on this suliject, but Mrs. Stevens's treatise deserves an honorable place at its side, Ministers of the Gospel should consult the spiritual welfare of their people, by recommending and promoting the cir- culation of such works. — Presbyterian. 12 ^ ■WORKS PUBLISHED BY KEY So BIDDLE. . A BOOK FOR MOTHERS. Aids to Mental Development, or Hints to Parents, being a Sys tern of Mental and Moral Instruction exemplified in Conversations between a Mother and her Children ; with an Address to Mothers. By a Lady of Philadelphia. To know Low to interest and expand the mind of a child with the lessons of wisdom — to impart knowledge in such a manner as at once to gratify and excite a thirst for it, is an acquisition possessed by very few ; but it is an acquisition indispensable to the right discharge of the duties of a parent. Many must be the hours of vacancy, or mischief, aud most generally the latter, of the child whose parents have not the faculty of alluring him to knowledge and virtue, and converting the pains of atiiictiqn, into^pleasure; and he who contributes any thing towards aiding them to discharge the duties devolving on them, deserves the gratitude of the public. We have before us a book in tiiis depart- ment, entitled Aitls to Mental Development, or Hints to Parepts ; just from thq press of Key & Biddle of this city ; l2mo. iWo pp. It is in the form of a familiar conversation between a n>other and her cliikireu ; in a style delightfully natural, affectionate, and easy. The topics selected for discussion are those with which parents of intelligence and piety would wisli to make their children familiar; and the manner in which they are discussed is happily adapted to nurture the growth of both the intellectual and the moral powers. — Christian Gazette. As the subject of education is one of great importance, and is beginning to be felt as such, by many who Jiave hitherto bestowed upon it too little considera- tion, we cannot doubt that this work will meet with a ready sale, and extensive circulation ; and we can sincerely recommend it to the earnest and careful atten- tion of all parents who have young c\\i\ArGn.— Saturday Courier. AUTOBIOGRAPHY OF JOHN GALT, ESQ. " I will a round nnvarnished tale deliver." "A work of commanding interest; its every page is an illustration of the remark, — that the romance of real life exceed.s the romance of fiction. This is decidedly the happiest effort Mr. Gait has made."— JV^cw Moiitkhj Magazine. Mr. Gait's book will be road by every class of readers. It is a work full of interest aud amusement, abounding in anecdotical recollections, and every where interspersed with the shrewd and searching observations for which the author has been always distinguished. — Saturday Courier. To our readers we cheerfully commend the book as amusing and instructive: it is full of ihteresting matter, and as an autobiography will rate with the best of the day. — Philadelphia Oaiette. It is full of striking illustrations of the remarkable character of its author; and for the mind disposed to study the individualities of our species, it contains much that will reward the investigation. — Commercial Herald. It is no less entertaining and much more useful than any one of his novels. — J^ational Oazetie. It is what it purports to bo, "the autobiography of John Gait," and is inter- esting as presenting faithful illustrations of the singular character of the author — who is justly regarded as one of the best, as well .as one of the most volu- minous writers of the age. — Boston Mcr. Eve. Jour. CELEBRATED SPEECHES Of Chatham, Burke, and Erskine ; to which is added the Argu- ment of Mr. Mackintosh in the case of Peltier. Selected by a Member of the Bar. Much is gained in richness and energy of expression, and fertility of 'thought by the frequent perusal of the masterpieces of rhetoric. Historical knowledge too, is derived from them, vivified by the spirit of debate and indignant exposi- tion of wrong. Some of the speeches in this acceptable collection relate to American affairs and character— we mean that of Burke on American Taxa- tion, and those of Chatham which burst from his soul of fire. The selection is judicious, and the book indispensable for the library of every citizen who would be a public speaker. — Malional Gazette. 13^" WORKS RECENTLY PUBLISHED The frequent reading of such selections from such masters, cannot but prove advantageous to the young men of this country, where, more than in any other, dependence will be placed upon the power of eloquence; and it is well that good njodels should be furnished to those who are, or seek, thus to sway the public mind. Bring along the great truths of the argument in a captivating style, and it will soon be found that even the most uninformed will strike into the cuirent of the address, and be carried along thereby.— J7. S. Gazette. Among the great men in the intellectual world, who have astonished and delighted, charmed and instructed mankind, by the splendor, power, and mag- nificence of their oratory, none stand higher than Chatham, Burke, Erskine and Mackintosh. The speeches contained in this volume are splendid specimens of rich, ornate, powerful, and argumentative oratory, and no one possessing in the least degree a love for intellectual grandeur, can read them w'ithout feeling his heart glow with admiration, and have his soul animated with a zeal for the liberty of all mankind. — Penn. Inquirer. This volume contains some of the speeches of these great masters of English Eloquence, speeches, which, whether we refer to the momentous character of their topics, their power of thought and display of learning, or their charms of style and graces of diction, will serve as models for public speaking, and sources of instruction, political, intellectual and moral, to all future ages. — Charleston Courier. AN ESSAY ON THE SPIRIT AND INFLUENCE OF THE REFORMATION. A work which obtained the prize on the following question proposed by the National Institute of France : — " What has been the influence of the Reformation by Luther, on the political situation of the different states of Europe, and on the progress of knowledge V By C. Villers, sometime professor of philosophy in the University of Gottingen. Translated from the French. With an Introductory Essay, by Samuel Miller, D. D. Professor in the Theological Seminary at Princeton, N. J. The National Institute of France proposed the following as a prize question. "What has been the influence of the Reformation, by Luther, on the political situation of the different states of Europe, and on the progress of knowledge ?" Among the competitors was C. Villers, Professor of Philosophy, in the Univer- sity of Gottingen, and to him the prize was adjudged. Villers was not an eccle- siastic or sectarian, but a philosopher, and treats the subject in a philosophical manner. Those who are interested in tracing the causes that have given direc- tion to the course of human events, will be richly rewarded by a perusal of this Essay. THE CELEBRATED BLUE BOOK. A register of all officers and agents, civil, military, and naval, in the service of the United States, with the names, force, and con- dition of all ships and vessels belonging to the United States, and when and where built ; together with a correct list of the Presi- dents, Cashiers, and Directors of the United States Bank and its Branches, to which is appended the names, and compensation of all printers in any way employed by Congress, or any department or office of Government. Prepared at the Department of State, by William A. Weaver. "A Senator in Congress — we believe it was Mr. Leigk of Virginia — pro- nounced the said Blue Book— which heretofore, by the by, has been a sealed volume to the public at large, and only accessible to members of Congress ; the most significant commentary extant on the Constitution of the United States. And in one sense it is indeed so : for it exhibits the Executive, or patronage and ofhce-dispensing power, in a light that niay very well make one tremble for the independence of the other branches of the government. As a book of warning, therefore, not less than as a book in which much and various information is to be found, concerning the practical operation and agents of the government, we 14 BY KEY & BIDDLE. commend this publication to public notice. We rto not know that better service could be rendered the country tlian by the transmission to fevery county town in the Union, of some copies of this authentic Record, in order that farmers and others might see for themselves the migiity array of Orticers, Agents, Post- masters, (Jontracteis, &c. &.C., which constitute tlie real standing army of the Executive.— JV. Y. American. Messrs. Key & Biddle have published an edition of the Blue Book. It should be in the hands of every voter in the United States. It is a fearful account of executive patronage. — U. S. Gazette. AN ADDRESS TO THE YOUNG, by John Foster, author of Essays on Decision of Cliaracter. John Foster is allowed by men of all parties, political and religious, to be one of the most original and vigorous thinkers of the age. His well tried talents, his known freedom from cant and fanaticism, and the importance of the subject discussed, strongly commend this book to the attention of that interesting class to whom it is addressed. All his writings are worthy of careful and repeated perusal ; but his essay on " Decision of Character" and this " Address to the Young," should be the companions of all young persons who are desirous of intellectual and moral improvement. — Epis. Recorder. PICTURES OF PRIVATE LIFE. SECOND SERIES. Containing Misanthropy, and The Pains of Pleasing. " The aim of the writer is evidently to instruct as well as amuse, by offering these admirable sketches as beacons to warn the young, especially of her own sex, against errors which have shipwrecked the happiness of so many."— Gcm- tlemans^ Magazine. ^ " These pictures are charming, natural stories of the real living world ; and of the kind which we rejoice to see the public beginning to appreciate and relish ; they are delineated in simple and often beautiful language, and with a powerful moral effect." — TaiVs Magazine. "The object of the writer is to profit, as well as to amuse; to promote the love of virtue ; to exhibit the consequences of vice ; and, by a delineation of scenes and characters visible in every day life, not only to inculcate what is ex- cellent, but to show what is practical."— Zi^erary Oazettc. "This beautiful little volume can scarcely be perused without affecting and improving the head and the heart ; and to young ladies particularly, would we most earnestly recommend it." — Scots Times. " We have great pleasure in directing the attention of our readers to this very interesting volume. It is written in a style which cannot fail to entertain, and insure theanxious attention of all who peruse its pages, while the mora! senti- ments conveyed must recommend it to those who wish to combine instruction with amusenient. The work is also embellished with a most beautiful frontis- piece portrait of the heroine of one of the tales, which is itself worth the price of the volume." — Cambridge Chronicle. THE BACHELOR RECLAIMED, OR CELIBACY VAN- QUISHED, from the French, by Timothy Flint. It is a good lesson for those who are not married, and who deserve to be, for we do not hold that every bachelor deserves a wife. Things of this kind (wives we mean) are nieted out by Providence with an eye to reward and punishment ; and a man may stand on sucli neutral ground in more ways than one, that a wife for either of the above providential ends, would be entirely out of the question ; but on either side of the line, there are some : and while men will sin, or must be virtuous, there will be marrying; and if a man has any regard for his character, he will look to his standing in this manner, and read this book of Mr. Flint's translation.— t/. S. Gazette. The main incidents are connected with the history of an inveterate bachelor —the worthy president of a Bachelor's Club— who despite of himself falls in love, against his principles, marries, and contrary to expectation is happy. This _ 15 "WORKS RECENTLY PUBLISHED great revolution in sentiment is accomplished by the power of female charms, by an exhibition of the loveliness of female character, and by the force of rea- son—at least such are the conclusions of the author. — Philad. Oaz. It is, of course, a love story, and such an one as could only emanate from a French writer — light, entertaining, and with an excellent moral. An inveterate bachelor is reclaimed— his hatred towards the female sex is changed into ad- miration, and eventually he marries. This great revolution in sentiment is ac- complished by the force of female charms— by an exhibition of the loveliness of the female character. The book should be read not only by bachelors, but by un- married ladies— they may derive instruction from its pages. — Saturday Ev. Post. BEAUTIES OF ROBERT HALL. If Robert Hall wrote comparatively little, what he did write bears the impress of genius, united with piety. He was a luminary of the first order, and it is delightful to feel the influence of his beams. To those who cannot obtain his whole works, we recommend this choice selection, which certainly contains many beauties. — Episcopal Recorder. The " Beauties of Robert Hall," which have just been published by Key & Bid- die, contain selections from his various writing. They are beautiful specimens of chastened and pure composition, and are rich in sentiment and principle. These extracts contain much useful matter for reflection and meditation, and. may be perused by the old and the j^oung, the grave and the gay, the learned and the illiterate, with advantage. We have rarely seen in so small a space so much powerful thought as is exhibited in this little volume. — Boston Ev. Oaz. SKETCHES BY MRS. SIGOURNEY. Comprising- six tales. The Father — Legend of Oxford — The Family Portrait — Oriana — The Intemperate, and the Patriarch. It is the high prerogative of women to win to virtue— it is the praise of Mrs. Sigourney, that her prerogative has been exercised far beyond the domestic cir- cle. The influfentes of her mind have been felt and acknowledged wherever English Literature finds a welcome. These Sketches have been~ sought after with avidity, by those who would profit by the most delightful means of im- provement. — U. S. Gazette. Mrs. Sigourney has a moral object in each of her interesting fictions, which she pursues with constant attention and effect.— J\/'ational Gazette. The Tales and Sketches need no recommendation as the talents of the au- thoress, in this branch of literature, are well and favourably kirown — they will be read with great interest. — Saturday Ev. Post. The Sketches before us are worthy of the enticing form in which they appear — Mrs. Sigourney is a writer of great purity, taste and power ; she seldom exag- gerates incidents: is simple and unambitious in her diction ; and possesses that magical influence, — which fixes the attention, even in a recital of ordinary events. Her sentiments are touching and true, because they spring from the holy source of an unhackneyed heart. They will add a virtuous strength to the heart of every reader, as well as be an ornament to the library of the owner. — Commercial Intelligencer. To parents the work particularly commends itself, and has only to be known to be eagerly patronised. Young Ladies may learn a valuable lesson from tlie story of the " Family Portrait ;" one which they will not be likely soon to forget. — Paulson's Daily .Advertiser. This is a beautiful volume in every respect — the style of its execution, its en- graving which teaches with the force of truth, and its contents, are alike excel- lent. The graceful simplicity, good taste, classic imagery and devotional spirit, which distinguish Mrs. Sigourney's poetry, are happily blended and presented in living forms in the prosaic " Sketches" before us. In this department of letters, as in poetry, she will be read with interest and delight, be introduced by Chris- tian parents to their children as an accomplished guide and teacher, and receive the well merited commendation of thousands. — Southern Religious Telegraph. FRANCIS BERRIAN, OR THE MEXICAN PATRIOT, by Timothy Flint, Esq. .This is an all absorbing novel, we think Mr. Flint's best.— JV. Y. .American. — jQ _ BY KEY &, BIDDLE. THE YOUNG MAN'S SUNDAY BOOK: A practical manual of the christian duties of piety, benevolence and self government; prepared with particular reference to the formation of the manly character on the basis of religious principle, by the author of the Young Man's own Book. This is one of those useful little volumes that will find its way through the world, pleasing and doing good wherever it may go. It professes to be a 'jManual of the CJiristian duties of piety, benevolence, and self government, prepared with reference to the formation of a manly character on the basis of religious princi- ple.' It disclaims all sectarian views, or the desire to make proselytes for any party ; desiring but to diffuse something of the spirit and practice of Christianity among the rising generation, and to establish as widely as possible those princi- ples of virtue and goodness whidi all men profess to respect. — Penn. Inquirer. It is a summary of moral and religious duties, and is full of useful precepts and excellent admonitions. — Christian Oazette. We have not read it entire— but the evangelical sentiments and ability evinced in parts of it which we have examined, commend it to public favour and especially to the attention of young men, to whom it may be a useful and valua- ble counsellor. It contains in a series of essays of moderate length, a summary of Christian duty rather than doctrine, drawn from the writings of those whose names command respect throughout the Christian world. Its design is noble — it is to establish young men in the observance of those grand principles of virtue and goodness, which the holy Scriptures enforce with the sanctions of God's authority, and which all men, the profane as well as the pious, respect. — Southern Religious Telegraph. The Yomig Man's Sundaij Book is a Practical Manual of the Christian duties of Piety, Benevolence, and Self-government, prepared with particular reference to the formation of the manly character on the basis of Religious Principle. It professes to be a Sunnnary of duty, rather than of doctrine. Its articles are generally short, and have Ijeen drawn from the writings of men whose names command respect throughout the Christian world. It is admirably suited both in its character and form (being a small pocket volume of 3U0 pages) for a pre- sent to one just verging to manhood, wliethcr a fiiend, an apprentice, or a son : and such a book as is likely to be, not only looked at, but looked into: and that, not only on Sunday, but daily ; till its contents become familiar.— CAr. Spectator. A book that should be possessed by every young man. It is a sequel to the Young Man's Own Book. — Saturday Ev. Post. FOLCHETTO MALA SPINA, an historical Romance of the twelfth century, by the author of " Libilla Odaletta," and trans- lated from the Italian by Daniel J. Desmond, Esq. The story is one of deep interest, and the translator has allowed nothing there<^ to escape ; of the fidelity of the work we cannot speak, having no access to the original ; but as a novel, whether original or translated, the work is good.— Z7. S. Gazette. It is emphatically a fanciful and engaging work, and no one can sit down to its perusal without being chained by its magical influence, to an attention, which will be kept actively alive until the last chapter. In this there is no exaggeration, — it is a novel to make the reader feel, — to have his curiosity and sensibilities awakened, — and to produce upon the heart those striking impres- sions, which can only be excited by nature when portrayed by the enchanting descriptions of a master. The scenes, the characters, thedialogues, and the in- cidents, are so graphically sketched, and forcibly delineated, tliat we are com- pelled to admit that the production is of a more than ordinary character. Our space will not admit of pointing out particular beauties, or interesting passages; to the work itself we must refer our readers for a rich intellectual l)anquet, which is only to be obtained by its perusal. In dismissing this production, we remark that it is beaTitifulIy got up, and will form a graceful ornament to the most classical library. — Penn. Inquirer. From parts which we have read, of Mr. Desmond's translation, we have drawn a very favourable inference concerning the execution of the whole; and we know that Malaspina's pages are held in high estimation by competent European and American critics. We have noted in the Paris Revue Encyclopcdique, a strong encomium on the works of this Italian novelist. — JVational Oazette. _ "WORKS PUBLISHED BY KEY &. BIDDLE. TODD'S JOHNSON'S DICTIONARY OF THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE. To which is added a copious Vocabulary of Greek, Latin, and Scriptural proper names, divided into syllables, and accented for pronunciation. By Thomas Rees, L. L. D., F. R. S. A. The above Dictionary will make a beautiful pocket volume, same size of Young- Man's Own Book, illustrated by a likeness of John- son and Walker. The editor states that " in compiling the work he has endeavoured to furnish such an epitome of Mr. Todd's enlarged and valuable edition of Dr. Johnson's Dictionary, as would enable the generality of persons to understand the most approved American and English authors, and to write and speak the language with propriety and elegance. The most correct definitions have been given in a condensed form, and especial care has been taken to indicate the classical and fashionable pronunciation of every word." The style of printing is really very handsome ; and the embellishments, consisting of an engraving of Johnson and another of Walker, enhance the value of the edition. It is neatly bound and would be an ornament to the study of any young lady or gentleman, while the traveller, on his summer tour, would tind it an appropriate companion for his guide book and Stage Register.— Boston Traveller. This really beautiful and useful little work should be possessed by all who wish to spell and write the English language correctly. The publishers have rendered it so attractive in its appearance as to be an ornament to the parlour centre table. It will add very little weight to the trunk of the traveller, and will often relieve him from painful embarrassment.— iJ. S. Gazette. This is the age of improvement. The simple elements of education so long lying in forbidding print and binding, are now appearing as they ought, in the finest type and most beautiful and ornamental form. The Pocket Dictionary published by Key and Biddle deserves to be commended to the public generally, not only for the beauty of its execution, but for the intrinsic merit it possesses.— Charleston Courier. This beautiful little Dictionary should be the companion of every young lady and gentleman when reading or writing, whether at home or abroad.— JV. Y. Commercial Advertiser. THE MORAL TESTAMENT OF MAN. Key & Biddle have just issued under this title, a beautiful little volume made up of the sayings of the wise and good, in olden and modern times. These apothegms are all upon most interesting subjects, each one carrying with it a wholesome as well as a most agreeable influence. This little volume is to the mind and heart what a flower-garden is to the eye and nose. It delights and regales. — Commercial Herald. Good taste, judgment, and a love of doing good, must have influenced and directed the industrious compiler. This little selection of precious thoughts has been printed and bound in a style suited to the worth of the contents — apples of gold in pictures of silver.— C/. 5. Gazette. MRS. SOMERVILLE'S CONNEXION OF THE PHYSICAL SCIENCES. The style of this astonishing production is so clear and unaffected, and con- veys with so much simplicity so great a mass of profound knowledge, that it should be placed in the hands of every youth, the moment he has mastered the general rudiments of education. — Q^uarterly Review. OBSERVATIONS ON THE CHARACTER AND CUL- TURE OF THE EUROPEAN VINE, during a residence of five years in the vine-grovving- districts of France, Italy, and Swit- zerland, by S. I. Fisher, to vv'hich is added, the Manual of Swiss Vigneron, as adopted and recommended by the Agricultural Socie- ties of Geneva and Berne, by Mons. Bruin Chappius, to which is superadded, the art of wine making, by Mr. Bulos, member of the Institute of France. 18 - 1 1012 01014 3115